blob: 4ec36ad15141c1499d21807cbb5498b96a3eee2b [file] [log] [blame]
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00001//===- InstructionCombining.cpp - Combine multiple instructions -----------===//
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002//
John Criswellb576c942003-10-20 19:43:21 +00003// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
Chris Lattner4ee451d2007-12-29 20:36:04 +00005// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00007//
John Criswellb576c942003-10-20 19:43:21 +00008//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +00009//
10// InstructionCombining - Combine instructions to form fewer, simple
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +000011// instructions. This pass does not modify the CFG. This pass is where
12// algebraic simplification happens.
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000013//
14// This pass combines things like:
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +000015// %Y = add i32 %X, 1
16// %Z = add i32 %Y, 1
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000017// into:
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +000018// %Z = add i32 %X, 2
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000019//
20// This is a simple worklist driven algorithm.
21//
Chris Lattner065a6162003-09-10 05:29:43 +000022// This pass guarantees that the following canonicalizations are performed on
Chris Lattner2cd91962003-07-23 21:41:57 +000023// the program:
24// 1. If a binary operator has a constant operand, it is moved to the RHS
Chris Lattnerdf17af12003-08-12 21:53:41 +000025// 2. Bitwise operators with constant operands are always grouped so that
26// shifts are performed first, then or's, then and's, then xor's.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000027// 3. Compare instructions are converted from <,>,<=,>= to ==,!= if possible
28// 4. All cmp instructions on boolean values are replaced with logical ops
Chris Lattnere92d2f42003-08-13 04:18:28 +000029// 5. add X, X is represented as (X*2) => (X << 1)
30// 6. Multiplies with a power-of-two constant argument are transformed into
31// shifts.
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000032// ... etc.
Chris Lattner2cd91962003-07-23 21:41:57 +000033//
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000034//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
35
Chris Lattner0cea42a2004-03-13 23:54:27 +000036#define DEBUG_TYPE "instcombine"
Chris Lattner022103b2002-05-07 20:03:00 +000037#include "llvm/Transforms/Scalar.h"
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +000038#include "llvm/IntrinsicInst.h"
Chris Lattnerbd0ef772002-02-26 21:46:54 +000039#include "llvm/Pass.h"
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000040#include "llvm/DerivedTypes.h"
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +000041#include "llvm/GlobalVariable.h"
Chris Lattner79066fa2007-01-30 23:46:24 +000042#include "llvm/Analysis/ConstantFolding.h"
Chris Lattner173234a2008-06-02 01:18:21 +000043#include "llvm/Analysis/ValueTracking.h"
Chris Lattnerbc61e662003-11-02 05:57:39 +000044#include "llvm/Target/TargetData.h"
45#include "llvm/Transforms/Utils/BasicBlockUtils.h"
46#include "llvm/Transforms/Utils/Local.h"
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000047#include "llvm/Support/CallSite.h"
Nick Lewycky5be29202008-02-03 16:33:09 +000048#include "llvm/Support/ConstantRange.h"
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000049#include "llvm/Support/Debug.h"
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000050#include "llvm/Support/GetElementPtrTypeIterator.h"
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000051#include "llvm/Support/InstVisitor.h"
Chris Lattnerbcd7db52005-08-02 19:16:58 +000052#include "llvm/Support/MathExtras.h"
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +000053#include "llvm/Support/PatternMatch.h"
Chris Lattnera4f0b3a2006-08-27 12:54:02 +000054#include "llvm/Support/Compiler.h"
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000055#include "llvm/ADT/DenseMap.h"
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +000056#include "llvm/ADT/SmallVector.h"
Chris Lattner1f87a582007-02-15 19:41:52 +000057#include "llvm/ADT/SmallPtrSet.h"
Reid Spencer551ccae2004-09-01 22:55:40 +000058#include "llvm/ADT/Statistic.h"
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000059#include "llvm/ADT/STLExtras.h"
Chris Lattnerb3bc8fa2002-05-14 15:24:07 +000060#include <algorithm>
Torok Edwin3eaee312008-04-20 08:33:11 +000061#include <climits>
Reid Spencera9b81012007-03-26 17:44:01 +000062#include <sstream>
Chris Lattner67b1e1b2003-12-07 01:24:23 +000063using namespace llvm;
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +000064using namespace llvm::PatternMatch;
Brian Gaeked0fde302003-11-11 22:41:34 +000065
Chris Lattner0e5f4992006-12-19 21:40:18 +000066STATISTIC(NumCombined , "Number of insts combined");
67STATISTIC(NumConstProp, "Number of constant folds");
68STATISTIC(NumDeadInst , "Number of dead inst eliminated");
69STATISTIC(NumDeadStore, "Number of dead stores eliminated");
70STATISTIC(NumSunkInst , "Number of instructions sunk");
Chris Lattnera92f6962002-10-01 22:38:41 +000071
Chris Lattner0e5f4992006-12-19 21:40:18 +000072namespace {
Chris Lattnerf4b54612006-06-28 22:08:15 +000073 class VISIBILITY_HIDDEN InstCombiner
74 : public FunctionPass,
75 public InstVisitor<InstCombiner, Instruction*> {
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000076 // Worklist of all of the instructions that need to be simplified.
Chris Lattner2806dff2008-08-15 04:03:01 +000077 SmallVector<Instruction*, 256> Worklist;
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000078 DenseMap<Instruction*, unsigned> WorklistMap;
Chris Lattnerbc61e662003-11-02 05:57:39 +000079 TargetData *TD;
Chris Lattnerf964f322007-03-04 04:27:24 +000080 bool MustPreserveLCSSA;
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000081 public:
Nick Lewyckyecd94c82007-05-06 13:37:16 +000082 static char ID; // Pass identification, replacement for typeid
Dan Gohmanae73dc12008-09-04 17:05:41 +000083 InstCombiner() : FunctionPass(&ID) {}
Devang Patel794fd752007-05-01 21:15:47 +000084
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000085 /// AddToWorkList - Add the specified instruction to the worklist if it
86 /// isn't already in it.
87 void AddToWorkList(Instruction *I) {
Dan Gohman6b345ee2008-07-07 17:46:23 +000088 if (WorklistMap.insert(std::make_pair(I, Worklist.size())).second)
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000089 Worklist.push_back(I);
90 }
91
92 // RemoveFromWorkList - remove I from the worklist if it exists.
93 void RemoveFromWorkList(Instruction *I) {
94 DenseMap<Instruction*, unsigned>::iterator It = WorklistMap.find(I);
95 if (It == WorklistMap.end()) return; // Not in worklist.
96
97 // Don't bother moving everything down, just null out the slot.
98 Worklist[It->second] = 0;
99
100 WorklistMap.erase(It);
101 }
102
103 Instruction *RemoveOneFromWorkList() {
104 Instruction *I = Worklist.back();
105 Worklist.pop_back();
106 WorklistMap.erase(I);
107 return I;
108 }
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000109
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000110
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000111 /// AddUsersToWorkList - When an instruction is simplified, add all users of
112 /// the instruction to the work lists because they might get more simplified
113 /// now.
114 ///
Chris Lattner6dce1a72006-02-07 06:56:34 +0000115 void AddUsersToWorkList(Value &I) {
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000116 for (Value::use_iterator UI = I.use_begin(), UE = I.use_end();
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000117 UI != UE; ++UI)
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000118 AddToWorkList(cast<Instruction>(*UI));
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000119 }
120
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000121 /// AddUsesToWorkList - When an instruction is simplified, add operands to
122 /// the work lists because they might get more simplified now.
123 ///
124 void AddUsesToWorkList(Instruction &I) {
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +0000125 for (User::op_iterator i = I.op_begin(), e = I.op_end(); i != e; ++i)
126 if (Instruction *Op = dyn_cast<Instruction>(*i))
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000127 AddToWorkList(Op);
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000128 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +0000129
130 /// AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist - The specified instruction is about to become
131 /// dead. Add all of its operands to the worklist, turning them into
132 /// undef's to reduce the number of uses of those instructions.
133 ///
134 /// Return the specified operand before it is turned into an undef.
135 ///
136 Value *AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist(Instruction &I, unsigned op) {
137 Value *R = I.getOperand(op);
138
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +0000139 for (User::op_iterator i = I.op_begin(), e = I.op_end(); i != e; ++i)
140 if (Instruction *Op = dyn_cast<Instruction>(*i)) {
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000141 AddToWorkList(Op);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +0000142 // Set the operand to undef to drop the use.
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +0000143 *i = UndefValue::get(Op->getType());
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +0000144 }
145
146 return R;
147 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000148
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000149 public:
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000150 virtual bool runOnFunction(Function &F);
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +0000151
152 bool DoOneIteration(Function &F, unsigned ItNum);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000153
Chris Lattner97e52e42002-04-28 21:27:06 +0000154 virtual void getAnalysisUsage(AnalysisUsage &AU) const {
Chris Lattnerbc61e662003-11-02 05:57:39 +0000155 AU.addRequired<TargetData>();
Owen Andersond1b78a12006-07-10 19:03:49 +0000156 AU.addPreservedID(LCSSAID);
Chris Lattnercb2610e2002-10-21 20:00:28 +0000157 AU.setPreservesCFG();
Chris Lattner97e52e42002-04-28 21:27:06 +0000158 }
159
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +0000160 TargetData &getTargetData() const { return *TD; }
161
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000162 // Visitation implementation - Implement instruction combining for different
163 // instruction types. The semantics are as follows:
164 // Return Value:
165 // null - No change was made
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +0000166 // I - Change was made, I is still valid, I may be dead though
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000167 // otherwise - Change was made, replace I with returned instruction
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000168 //
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000169 Instruction *visitAdd(BinaryOperator &I);
170 Instruction *visitSub(BinaryOperator &I);
171 Instruction *visitMul(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +0000172 Instruction *visitURem(BinaryOperator &I);
173 Instruction *visitSRem(BinaryOperator &I);
174 Instruction *visitFRem(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattnerfdb19e52008-07-14 00:15:52 +0000175 bool SimplifyDivRemOfSelect(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +0000176 Instruction *commonRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
177 Instruction *commonIRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +0000178 Instruction *commonDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
179 Instruction *commonIDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
180 Instruction *visitUDiv(BinaryOperator &I);
181 Instruction *visitSDiv(BinaryOperator &I);
182 Instruction *visitFDiv(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000183 Instruction *visitAnd(BinaryOperator &I);
184 Instruction *visitOr (BinaryOperator &I);
185 Instruction *visitXor(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +0000186 Instruction *visitShl(BinaryOperator &I);
187 Instruction *visitAShr(BinaryOperator &I);
188 Instruction *visitLShr(BinaryOperator &I);
189 Instruction *commonShiftTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +0000190 Instruction *FoldFCmp_IntToFP_Cst(FCmpInst &I, Instruction *LHSI,
191 Constant *RHSC);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000192 Instruction *visitFCmpInst(FCmpInst &I);
193 Instruction *visitICmpInst(ICmpInst &I);
194 Instruction *visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast(ICmpInst &ICI);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +0000195 Instruction *visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst(ICmpInst &ICI,
196 Instruction *LHS,
197 ConstantInt *RHS);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +0000198 Instruction *FoldICmpDivCst(ICmpInst &ICI, BinaryOperator *DivI,
199 ConstantInt *DivRHS);
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +0000200
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000201 Instruction *FoldGEPICmp(User *GEPLHS, Value *RHS,
202 ICmpInst::Predicate Cond, Instruction &I);
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +0000203 Instruction *FoldShiftByConstant(Value *Op0, ConstantInt *Op1,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +0000204 BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000205 Instruction *commonCastTransforms(CastInst &CI);
206 Instruction *commonIntCastTransforms(CastInst &CI);
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +0000207 Instruction *commonPointerCastTransforms(CastInst &CI);
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +0000208 Instruction *visitTrunc(TruncInst &CI);
209 Instruction *visitZExt(ZExtInst &CI);
210 Instruction *visitSExt(SExtInst &CI);
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +0000211 Instruction *visitFPTrunc(FPTruncInst &CI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000212 Instruction *visitFPExt(CastInst &CI);
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +0000213 Instruction *visitFPToUI(FPToUIInst &FI);
214 Instruction *visitFPToSI(FPToSIInst &FI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000215 Instruction *visitUIToFP(CastInst &CI);
216 Instruction *visitSIToFP(CastInst &CI);
217 Instruction *visitPtrToInt(CastInst &CI);
Chris Lattnerf9d9e452008-01-08 07:23:51 +0000218 Instruction *visitIntToPtr(IntToPtrInst &CI);
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +0000219 Instruction *visitBitCast(BitCastInst &CI);
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +0000220 Instruction *FoldSelectOpOp(SelectInst &SI, Instruction *TI,
221 Instruction *FI);
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +0000222 Instruction *visitSelectInst(SelectInst &SI);
223 Instruction *visitSelectInstWithICmp(SelectInst &SI, ICmpInst *ICI);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000224 Instruction *visitCallInst(CallInst &CI);
225 Instruction *visitInvokeInst(InvokeInst &II);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000226 Instruction *visitPHINode(PHINode &PN);
227 Instruction *visitGetElementPtrInst(GetElementPtrInst &GEP);
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +0000228 Instruction *visitAllocationInst(AllocationInst &AI);
Chris Lattner67b1e1b2003-12-07 01:24:23 +0000229 Instruction *visitFreeInst(FreeInst &FI);
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +0000230 Instruction *visitLoadInst(LoadInst &LI);
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +0000231 Instruction *visitStoreInst(StoreInst &SI);
Chris Lattnerc4d10eb2003-06-04 04:46:00 +0000232 Instruction *visitBranchInst(BranchInst &BI);
Chris Lattner46238a62004-07-03 00:26:11 +0000233 Instruction *visitSwitchInst(SwitchInst &SI);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +0000234 Instruction *visitInsertElementInst(InsertElementInst &IE);
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +0000235 Instruction *visitExtractElementInst(ExtractElementInst &EI);
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +0000236 Instruction *visitShuffleVectorInst(ShuffleVectorInst &SVI);
Matthijs Kooijmana9012ec2008-06-11 14:05:05 +0000237 Instruction *visitExtractValueInst(ExtractValueInst &EV);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000238
239 // visitInstruction - Specify what to return for unhandled instructions...
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000240 Instruction *visitInstruction(Instruction &I) { return 0; }
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000241
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000242 private:
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +0000243 Instruction *visitCallSite(CallSite CS);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000244 bool transformConstExprCastCall(CallSite CS);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +0000245 Instruction *transformCallThroughTrampoline(CallSite CS);
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +0000246 Instruction *transformZExtICmp(ICmpInst *ICI, Instruction &CI,
247 bool DoXform = true);
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +0000248 bool WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000249
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +0000250 public:
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000251 // InsertNewInstBefore - insert an instruction New before instruction Old
252 // in the program. Add the new instruction to the worklist.
253 //
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000254 Instruction *InsertNewInstBefore(Instruction *New, Instruction &Old) {
Chris Lattnere6f9a912002-08-23 18:32:43 +0000255 assert(New && New->getParent() == 0 &&
256 "New instruction already inserted into a basic block!");
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000257 BasicBlock *BB = Old.getParent();
258 BB->getInstList().insert(&Old, New); // Insert inst
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000259 AddToWorkList(New);
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +0000260 return New;
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000261 }
262
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +0000263 /// InsertCastBefore - Insert a cast of V to TY before the instruction POS.
264 /// This also adds the cast to the worklist. Finally, this returns the
265 /// cast.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000266 Value *InsertCastBefore(Instruction::CastOps opc, Value *V, const Type *Ty,
267 Instruction &Pos) {
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +0000268 if (V->getType() == Ty) return V;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000269
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +0000270 if (Constant *CV = dyn_cast<Constant>(V))
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000271 return ConstantExpr::getCast(opc, CV, Ty);
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +0000272
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +0000273 Instruction *C = CastInst::Create(opc, V, Ty, V->getName(), &Pos);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000274 AddToWorkList(C);
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +0000275 return C;
276 }
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +0000277
278 Value *InsertBitCastBefore(Value *V, const Type *Ty, Instruction &Pos) {
279 return InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast, V, Ty, Pos);
280 }
281
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +0000282
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000283 // ReplaceInstUsesWith - This method is to be used when an instruction is
284 // found to be dead, replacable with another preexisting expression. Here
285 // we add all uses of I to the worklist, replace all uses of I with the new
286 // value, then return I, so that the inst combiner will know that I was
287 // modified.
288 //
289 Instruction *ReplaceInstUsesWith(Instruction &I, Value *V) {
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000290 AddUsersToWorkList(I); // Add all modified instrs to worklist
Chris Lattner15a76c02004-04-05 02:10:19 +0000291 if (&I != V) {
292 I.replaceAllUsesWith(V);
293 return &I;
294 } else {
295 // If we are replacing the instruction with itself, this must be in a
296 // segment of unreachable code, so just clobber the instruction.
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +0000297 I.replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner15a76c02004-04-05 02:10:19 +0000298 return &I;
299 }
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000300 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000301
Chris Lattner6dce1a72006-02-07 06:56:34 +0000302 // UpdateValueUsesWith - This method is to be used when an value is
303 // found to be replacable with another preexisting expression or was
304 // updated. Here we add all uses of I to the worklist, replace all uses of
305 // I with the new value (unless the instruction was just updated), then
306 // return true, so that the inst combiner will know that I was modified.
307 //
308 bool UpdateValueUsesWith(Value *Old, Value *New) {
309 AddUsersToWorkList(*Old); // Add all modified instrs to worklist
310 if (Old != New)
311 Old->replaceAllUsesWith(New);
312 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Old))
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000313 AddToWorkList(I);
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +0000314 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(New))
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000315 AddToWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner6dce1a72006-02-07 06:56:34 +0000316 return true;
317 }
318
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000319 // EraseInstFromFunction - When dealing with an instruction that has side
320 // effects or produces a void value, we can't rely on DCE to delete the
321 // instruction. Instead, visit methods should return the value returned by
322 // this function.
323 Instruction *EraseInstFromFunction(Instruction &I) {
324 assert(I.use_empty() && "Cannot erase instruction that is used!");
325 AddUsesToWorkList(I);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000326 RemoveFromWorkList(&I);
Chris Lattner954f66a2004-11-18 21:41:39 +0000327 I.eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000328 return 0; // Don't do anything with FI
329 }
Chris Lattner173234a2008-06-02 01:18:21 +0000330
331 void ComputeMaskedBits(Value *V, const APInt &Mask, APInt &KnownZero,
332 APInt &KnownOne, unsigned Depth = 0) const {
333 return llvm::ComputeMaskedBits(V, Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne, TD, Depth);
334 }
335
336 bool MaskedValueIsZero(Value *V, const APInt &Mask,
337 unsigned Depth = 0) const {
338 return llvm::MaskedValueIsZero(V, Mask, TD, Depth);
339 }
340 unsigned ComputeNumSignBits(Value *Op, unsigned Depth = 0) const {
341 return llvm::ComputeNumSignBits(Op, TD, Depth);
342 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000343
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +0000344 private:
Chris Lattner24c8e382003-07-24 17:35:25 +0000345 /// InsertOperandCastBefore - This inserts a cast of V to DestTy before the
346 /// InsertBefore instruction. This is specialized a bit to avoid inserting
347 /// casts that are known to not do anything...
348 ///
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000349 Value *InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::CastOps opcode,
350 Value *V, const Type *DestTy,
Chris Lattner24c8e382003-07-24 17:35:25 +0000351 Instruction *InsertBefore);
352
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000353 /// SimplifyCommutative - This performs a few simplifications for
354 /// commutative operators.
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000355 bool SimplifyCommutative(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +0000356
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000357 /// SimplifyCompare - This reorders the operands of a CmpInst to get them in
358 /// most-complex to least-complex order.
359 bool SimplifyCompare(CmpInst &I);
360
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +0000361 /// SimplifyDemandedBits - Attempts to replace V with a simpler value based
362 /// on the demanded bits.
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000363 bool SimplifyDemandedBits(Value *V, APInt DemandedMask,
364 APInt& KnownZero, APInt& KnownOne,
365 unsigned Depth = 0);
366
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +0000367 Value *SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(Value *V, uint64_t DemandedElts,
368 uint64_t &UndefElts, unsigned Depth = 0);
369
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +0000370 // FoldOpIntoPhi - Given a binary operator or cast instruction which has a
371 // PHI node as operand #0, see if we can fold the instruction into the PHI
372 // (which is only possible if all operands to the PHI are constants).
373 Instruction *FoldOpIntoPhi(Instruction &I);
374
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +0000375 // FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI - If all operands to a PHI node are the same "unary"
376 // operator and they all are only used by the PHI, PHI together their
377 // inputs, and do the operation once, to the result of the PHI.
378 Instruction *FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN);
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +0000379 Instruction *FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN);
380
381
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +0000382 Instruction *OptAndOp(Instruction *Op, ConstantInt *OpRHS,
383 ConstantInt *AndRHS, BinaryOperator &TheAnd);
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +0000384
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +0000385 Value *FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS, ConstantInt *Mask,
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +0000386 bool isSub, Instruction &I);
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +0000387 Instruction *InsertRangeTest(Value *V, Constant *Lo, Constant *Hi,
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000388 bool isSigned, bool Inside, Instruction &IB);
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +0000389 Instruction *PromoteCastOfAllocation(BitCastInst &CI, AllocationInst &AI);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +0000390 Instruction *MatchBSwap(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +0000391 bool SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock(StoreInst &SI);
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +0000392 Instruction *SimplifyMemTransfer(MemIntrinsic *MI);
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +0000393 Instruction *SimplifyMemSet(MemSetInst *MI);
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +0000394
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +0000395
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +0000396 Value *EvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const Type *Ty, bool isSigned);
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +0000397
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +0000398 bool CanEvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const IntegerType *Ty,
399 unsigned CastOpc,
400 int &NumCastsRemoved);
401 unsigned GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(Value *V,
402 unsigned PrefAlign = 0);
Matthijs Kooijmana9012ec2008-06-11 14:05:05 +0000403
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000404 };
405}
406
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +0000407char InstCombiner::ID = 0;
408static RegisterPass<InstCombiner>
409X("instcombine", "Combine redundant instructions");
410
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000411// getComplexity: Assign a complexity or rank value to LLVM Values...
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +0000412// 0 -> undef, 1 -> Const, 2 -> Other, 3 -> Arg, 3 -> Unary, 4 -> OtherInst
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000413static unsigned getComplexity(Value *V) {
414 if (isa<Instruction>(V)) {
415 if (BinaryOperator::isNeg(V) || BinaryOperator::isNot(V))
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +0000416 return 3;
417 return 4;
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000418 }
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +0000419 if (isa<Argument>(V)) return 3;
420 return isa<Constant>(V) ? (isa<UndefValue>(V) ? 0 : 1) : 2;
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000421}
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000422
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000423// isOnlyUse - Return true if this instruction will be deleted if we stop using
424// it.
425static bool isOnlyUse(Value *V) {
Chris Lattnerfd059242003-10-15 16:48:29 +0000426 return V->hasOneUse() || isa<Constant>(V);
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000427}
428
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +0000429// getPromotedType - Return the specified type promoted as it would be to pass
430// though a va_arg area...
431static const Type *getPromotedType(const Type *Ty) {
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +0000432 if (const IntegerType* ITy = dyn_cast<IntegerType>(Ty)) {
433 if (ITy->getBitWidth() < 32)
434 return Type::Int32Ty;
Chris Lattner2b7e0ad2007-05-23 01:17:04 +0000435 }
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +0000436 return Ty;
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +0000437}
438
Matthijs Kooijman7e6d9b92008-10-13 15:17:01 +0000439/// getBitCastOperand - If the specified operand is a CastInst, a constant
440/// expression bitcast, or a GetElementPtrInst with all zero indices, return the
441/// operand value, otherwise return null.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000442static Value *getBitCastOperand(Value *V) {
443 if (BitCastInst *I = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(V))
Matthijs Kooijman7e6d9b92008-10-13 15:17:01 +0000444 // BitCastInst?
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +0000445 return I->getOperand(0);
Matthijs Kooijman7e6d9b92008-10-13 15:17:01 +0000446 else if (GetElementPtrInst *GEP = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(V)) {
447 // GetElementPtrInst?
448 if (GEP->hasAllZeroIndices())
449 return GEP->getOperand(0);
450 } else if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(V)) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000451 if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::BitCast)
Matthijs Kooijman7e6d9b92008-10-13 15:17:01 +0000452 // BitCast ConstantExp?
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +0000453 return CE->getOperand(0);
Matthijs Kooijman7e6d9b92008-10-13 15:17:01 +0000454 else if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::GetElementPtr) {
455 // GetElementPtr ConstantExp?
456 for (User::op_iterator I = CE->op_begin() + 1, E = CE->op_end();
457 I != E; ++I) {
458 ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I);
459 if (!CI || !CI->isZero())
460 // Any non-zero indices? Not cast-like.
461 return 0;
462 }
463 // All-zero indices? This is just like casting.
464 return CE->getOperand(0);
465 }
466 }
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +0000467 return 0;
468}
469
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000470/// This function is a wrapper around CastInst::isEliminableCastPair. It
471/// simply extracts arguments and returns what that function returns.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000472static Instruction::CastOps
473isEliminableCastPair(
474 const CastInst *CI, ///< The first cast instruction
475 unsigned opcode, ///< The opcode of the second cast instruction
476 const Type *DstTy, ///< The target type for the second cast instruction
477 TargetData *TD ///< The target data for pointer size
478) {
479
480 const Type *SrcTy = CI->getOperand(0)->getType(); // A from above
481 const Type *MidTy = CI->getType(); // B from above
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000482
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000483 // Get the opcodes of the two Cast instructions
484 Instruction::CastOps firstOp = Instruction::CastOps(CI->getOpcode());
485 Instruction::CastOps secondOp = Instruction::CastOps(opcode);
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000486
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000487 return Instruction::CastOps(
488 CastInst::isEliminableCastPair(firstOp, secondOp, SrcTy, MidTy,
489 DstTy, TD->getIntPtrType()));
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000490}
491
492/// ValueRequiresCast - Return true if the cast from "V to Ty" actually results
493/// in any code being generated. It does not require codegen if V is simple
494/// enough or if the cast can be folded into other casts.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000495static bool ValueRequiresCast(Instruction::CastOps opcode, const Value *V,
496 const Type *Ty, TargetData *TD) {
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000497 if (V->getType() == Ty || isa<Constant>(V)) return false;
498
Chris Lattner01575b72006-05-25 23:24:33 +0000499 // If this is another cast that can be eliminated, it isn't codegen either.
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000500 if (const CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(V))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000501 if (isEliminableCastPair(CI, opcode, Ty, TD))
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000502 return false;
503 return true;
504}
505
506/// InsertOperandCastBefore - This inserts a cast of V to DestTy before the
507/// InsertBefore instruction. This is specialized a bit to avoid inserting
508/// casts that are known to not do anything...
509///
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000510Value *InstCombiner::InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::CastOps opcode,
511 Value *V, const Type *DestTy,
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000512 Instruction *InsertBefore) {
513 if (V->getType() == DestTy) return V;
514 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(V))
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000515 return ConstantExpr::getCast(opcode, C, DestTy);
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000516
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000517 return InsertCastBefore(opcode, V, DestTy, *InsertBefore);
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000518}
519
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000520// SimplifyCommutative - This performs a few simplifications for commutative
521// operators:
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000522//
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000523// 1. Order operands such that they are listed from right (least complex) to
524// left (most complex). This puts constants before unary operators before
525// binary operators.
526//
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000527// 2. Transform: (op (op V, C1), C2) ==> (op V, (op C1, C2))
528// 3. Transform: (op (op V1, C1), (op V2, C2)) ==> (op (op V1, V2), (op C1,C2))
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000529//
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000530bool InstCombiner::SimplifyCommutative(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000531 bool Changed = false;
532 if (getComplexity(I.getOperand(0)) < getComplexity(I.getOperand(1)))
533 Changed = !I.swapOperands();
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000534
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000535 if (!I.isAssociative()) return Changed;
536 Instruction::BinaryOps Opcode = I.getOpcode();
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000537 if (BinaryOperator *Op = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I.getOperand(0)))
538 if (Op->getOpcode() == Opcode && isa<Constant>(Op->getOperand(1))) {
539 if (isa<Constant>(I.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner2a9c8472003-05-27 16:40:51 +0000540 Constant *Folded = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(),
541 cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(1)),
542 cast<Constant>(Op->getOperand(1)));
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000543 I.setOperand(0, Op->getOperand(0));
544 I.setOperand(1, Folded);
545 return true;
546 } else if (BinaryOperator *Op1=dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I.getOperand(1)))
547 if (Op1->getOpcode() == Opcode && isa<Constant>(Op1->getOperand(1)) &&
548 isOnlyUse(Op) && isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
549 Constant *C1 = cast<Constant>(Op->getOperand(1));
550 Constant *C2 = cast<Constant>(Op1->getOperand(1));
551
552 // Fold (op (op V1, C1), (op V2, C2)) ==> (op (op V1, V2), (op C1,C2))
Chris Lattner2a9c8472003-05-27 16:40:51 +0000553 Constant *Folded = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), C1, C2);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +0000554 Instruction *New = BinaryOperator::Create(Opcode, Op->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000555 Op1->getOperand(0),
556 Op1->getName(), &I);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000557 AddToWorkList(New);
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000558 I.setOperand(0, New);
559 I.setOperand(1, Folded);
560 return true;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000561 }
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000562 }
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000563 return Changed;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000564}
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +0000565
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000566/// SimplifyCompare - For a CmpInst this function just orders the operands
567/// so that theyare listed from right (least complex) to left (most complex).
568/// This puts constants before unary operators before binary operators.
569bool InstCombiner::SimplifyCompare(CmpInst &I) {
570 if (getComplexity(I.getOperand(0)) >= getComplexity(I.getOperand(1)))
571 return false;
572 I.swapOperands();
573 // Compare instructions are not associative so there's nothing else we can do.
574 return true;
575}
576
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000577// dyn_castNegVal - Given a 'sub' instruction, return the RHS of the instruction
578// if the LHS is a constant zero (which is the 'negate' form).
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +0000579//
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000580static inline Value *dyn_castNegVal(Value *V) {
581 if (BinaryOperator::isNeg(V))
Chris Lattnera1df33c2005-04-24 07:30:14 +0000582 return BinaryOperator::getNegArgument(V);
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000583
Chris Lattner0ce85802004-12-14 20:08:06 +0000584 // Constants can be considered to be negated values if they can be folded.
585 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V))
586 return ConstantExpr::getNeg(C);
Nick Lewycky18b3da62008-05-23 04:54:45 +0000587
588 if (ConstantVector *C = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V))
589 if (C->getType()->getElementType()->isInteger())
590 return ConstantExpr::getNeg(C);
591
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000592 return 0;
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +0000593}
594
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000595static inline Value *dyn_castNotVal(Value *V) {
596 if (BinaryOperator::isNot(V))
Chris Lattnera1df33c2005-04-24 07:30:14 +0000597 return BinaryOperator::getNotArgument(V);
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000598
599 // Constants can be considered to be not'ed values...
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +0000600 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V))
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +0000601 return ConstantInt::get(~C->getValue());
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000602 return 0;
603}
604
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000605// dyn_castFoldableMul - If this value is a multiply that can be folded into
606// other computations (because it has a constant operand), return the
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000607// non-constant operand of the multiply, and set CST to point to the multiplier.
608// Otherwise, return null.
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000609//
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000610static inline Value *dyn_castFoldableMul(Value *V, ConstantInt *&CST) {
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +0000611 if (V->hasOneUse() && V->getType()->isInteger())
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000612 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V)) {
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000613 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul)
Chris Lattner50e60c72004-11-15 05:54:07 +0000614 if ((CST = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))))
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000615 return I->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000616 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
Chris Lattner50e60c72004-11-15 05:54:07 +0000617 if ((CST = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1)))) {
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000618 // The multiplier is really 1 << CST.
Zhou Sheng97b52c22007-03-29 01:57:21 +0000619 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(V->getType())->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +0000620 uint32_t CSTVal = CST->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng97b52c22007-03-29 01:57:21 +0000621 CST = ConstantInt::get(APInt(BitWidth, 1).shl(CSTVal));
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000622 return I->getOperand(0);
623 }
624 }
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000625 return 0;
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +0000626}
Chris Lattneraf2930e2002-08-14 17:51:49 +0000627
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +0000628/// dyn_castGetElementPtr - If this is a getelementptr instruction or constant
629/// expression, return it.
630static User *dyn_castGetElementPtr(Value *V) {
631 if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(V)) return cast<User>(V);
632 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(V))
633 if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::GetElementPtr)
634 return cast<User>(V);
635 return false;
636}
637
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +0000638/// getOpcode - If this is an Instruction or a ConstantExpr, return the
639/// opcode value. Otherwise return UserOp1.
Dan Gohmanb99e2e22008-05-29 19:53:46 +0000640static unsigned getOpcode(const Value *V) {
641 if (const Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V))
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +0000642 return I->getOpcode();
Dan Gohmanb99e2e22008-05-29 19:53:46 +0000643 if (const ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(V))
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +0000644 return CE->getOpcode();
645 // Use UserOp1 to mean there's no opcode.
646 return Instruction::UserOp1;
647}
648
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +0000649/// AddOne - Add one to a ConstantInt
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +0000650static ConstantInt *AddOne(ConstantInt *C) {
Reid Spencer2149a9d2007-03-25 19:55:33 +0000651 APInt Val(C->getValue());
652 return ConstantInt::get(++Val);
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000653}
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +0000654/// SubOne - Subtract one from a ConstantInt
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +0000655static ConstantInt *SubOne(ConstantInt *C) {
Reid Spencer2149a9d2007-03-25 19:55:33 +0000656 APInt Val(C->getValue());
657 return ConstantInt::get(--Val);
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +0000658}
659/// Add - Add two ConstantInts together
660static ConstantInt *Add(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2) {
661 return ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() + C2->getValue());
662}
663/// And - Bitwise AND two ConstantInts together
664static ConstantInt *And(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2) {
665 return ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() & C2->getValue());
666}
667/// Subtract - Subtract one ConstantInt from another
668static ConstantInt *Subtract(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2) {
669 return ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() - C2->getValue());
670}
671/// Multiply - Multiply two ConstantInts together
672static ConstantInt *Multiply(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2) {
673 return ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() * C2->getValue());
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000674}
Nick Lewyckye0cfecf2008-02-18 22:48:05 +0000675/// MultiplyOverflows - True if the multiply can not be expressed in an int
676/// this size.
677static bool MultiplyOverflows(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2, bool sign) {
678 uint32_t W = C1->getBitWidth();
679 APInt LHSExt = C1->getValue(), RHSExt = C2->getValue();
680 if (sign) {
681 LHSExt.sext(W * 2);
682 RHSExt.sext(W * 2);
683 } else {
684 LHSExt.zext(W * 2);
685 RHSExt.zext(W * 2);
686 }
687
688 APInt MulExt = LHSExt * RHSExt;
689
690 if (sign) {
691 APInt Min = APInt::getSignedMinValue(W).sext(W * 2);
692 APInt Max = APInt::getSignedMaxValue(W).sext(W * 2);
693 return MulExt.slt(Min) || MulExt.sgt(Max);
694 } else
695 return MulExt.ugt(APInt::getLowBitsSet(W * 2, W));
696}
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000697
Reid Spencere7816b52007-03-08 01:52:58 +0000698
Chris Lattner255d8912006-02-11 09:31:47 +0000699/// ShrinkDemandedConstant - Check to see if the specified operand of the
700/// specified instruction is a constant integer. If so, check to see if there
701/// are any bits set in the constant that are not demanded. If so, shrink the
702/// constant and return true.
703static bool ShrinkDemandedConstant(Instruction *I, unsigned OpNo,
Reid Spencer6b79e2d2007-03-12 17:15:10 +0000704 APInt Demanded) {
705 assert(I && "No instruction?");
706 assert(OpNo < I->getNumOperands() && "Operand index too large");
707
708 // If the operand is not a constant integer, nothing to do.
709 ConstantInt *OpC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(OpNo));
710 if (!OpC) return false;
711
712 // If there are no bits set that aren't demanded, nothing to do.
713 Demanded.zextOrTrunc(OpC->getValue().getBitWidth());
714 if ((~Demanded & OpC->getValue()) == 0)
715 return false;
716
717 // This instruction is producing bits that are not demanded. Shrink the RHS.
718 Demanded &= OpC->getValue();
719 I->setOperand(OpNo, ConstantInt::get(Demanded));
720 return true;
721}
722
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000723// ComputeSignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits - Given a signed integer type and a
724// set of known zero and one bits, compute the maximum and minimum values that
725// could have the specified known zero and known one bits, returning them in
726// min/max.
727static void ComputeSignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(const Type *Ty,
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +0000728 const APInt& KnownZero,
729 const APInt& KnownOne,
730 APInt& Min, APInt& Max) {
731 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(Ty)->getBitWidth();
732 assert(KnownZero.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
733 KnownOne.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
734 Min.getBitWidth() == BitWidth && Max.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
735 "Ty, KnownZero, KnownOne and Min, Max must have equal bitwidth.");
Reid Spencer2f549172007-03-25 04:26:16 +0000736 APInt UnknownBits = ~(KnownZero|KnownOne);
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000737
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000738 // The minimum value is when all unknown bits are zeros, EXCEPT for the sign
739 // bit if it is unknown.
740 Min = KnownOne;
741 Max = KnownOne|UnknownBits;
742
Zhou Sheng4acf1552007-03-28 05:15:57 +0000743 if (UnknownBits[BitWidth-1]) { // Sign bit is unknown
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +0000744 Min.set(BitWidth-1);
745 Max.clear(BitWidth-1);
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000746 }
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000747}
748
749// ComputeUnsignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits - Given an unsigned integer type and
750// a set of known zero and one bits, compute the maximum and minimum values that
751// could have the specified known zero and known one bits, returning them in
752// min/max.
753static void ComputeUnsignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(const Type *Ty,
Chris Lattnera9ff5eb2007-08-05 08:47:58 +0000754 const APInt &KnownZero,
755 const APInt &KnownOne,
756 APInt &Min, APInt &Max) {
757 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(Ty)->getBitWidth(); BitWidth = BitWidth;
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +0000758 assert(KnownZero.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
759 KnownOne.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
760 Min.getBitWidth() == BitWidth && Max.getBitWidth() &&
761 "Ty, KnownZero, KnownOne and Min, Max must have equal bitwidth.");
Reid Spencer2f549172007-03-25 04:26:16 +0000762 APInt UnknownBits = ~(KnownZero|KnownOne);
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000763
764 // The minimum value is when the unknown bits are all zeros.
765 Min = KnownOne;
766 // The maximum value is when the unknown bits are all ones.
767 Max = KnownOne|UnknownBits;
768}
Chris Lattner255d8912006-02-11 09:31:47 +0000769
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000770/// SimplifyDemandedBits - This function attempts to replace V with a simpler
771/// value based on the demanded bits. When this function is called, it is known
772/// that only the bits set in DemandedMask of the result of V are ever used
773/// downstream. Consequently, depending on the mask and V, it may be possible
774/// to replace V with a constant or one of its operands. In such cases, this
775/// function does the replacement and returns true. In all other cases, it
776/// returns false after analyzing the expression and setting KnownOne and known
777/// to be one in the expression. KnownZero contains all the bits that are known
778/// to be zero in the expression. These are provided to potentially allow the
779/// caller (which might recursively be SimplifyDemandedBits itself) to simplify
780/// the expression. KnownOne and KnownZero always follow the invariant that
781/// KnownOne & KnownZero == 0. That is, a bit can't be both 1 and 0. Note that
782/// the bits in KnownOne and KnownZero may only be accurate for those bits set
783/// in DemandedMask. Note also that the bitwidth of V, DemandedMask, KnownZero
784/// and KnownOne must all be the same.
785bool InstCombiner::SimplifyDemandedBits(Value *V, APInt DemandedMask,
786 APInt& KnownZero, APInt& KnownOne,
787 unsigned Depth) {
788 assert(V != 0 && "Null pointer of Value???");
789 assert(Depth <= 6 && "Limit Search Depth");
790 uint32_t BitWidth = DemandedMask.getBitWidth();
791 const IntegerType *VTy = cast<IntegerType>(V->getType());
792 assert(VTy->getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
793 KnownZero.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
794 KnownOne.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
795 "Value *V, DemandedMask, KnownZero and KnownOne \
796 must have same BitWidth");
797 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V)) {
798 // We know all of the bits for a constant!
799 KnownOne = CI->getValue() & DemandedMask;
800 KnownZero = ~KnownOne & DemandedMask;
801 return false;
802 }
803
Zhou Sheng96704452007-03-14 03:21:24 +0000804 KnownZero.clear();
805 KnownOne.clear();
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000806 if (!V->hasOneUse()) { // Other users may use these bits.
807 if (Depth != 0) { // Not at the root.
808 // Just compute the KnownZero/KnownOne bits to simplify things downstream.
809 ComputeMaskedBits(V, DemandedMask, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth);
810 return false;
811 }
812 // If this is the root being simplified, allow it to have multiple uses,
813 // just set the DemandedMask to all bits.
814 DemandedMask = APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth);
815 } else if (DemandedMask == 0) { // Not demanding any bits from V.
816 if (V != UndefValue::get(VTy))
817 return UpdateValueUsesWith(V, UndefValue::get(VTy));
818 return false;
819 } else if (Depth == 6) { // Limit search depth.
820 return false;
821 }
822
823 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
824 if (!I) return false; // Only analyze instructions.
825
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000826 APInt LHSKnownZero(BitWidth, 0), LHSKnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
827 APInt &RHSKnownZero = KnownZero, &RHSKnownOne = KnownOne;
828 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +0000829 default:
830 ComputeMaskedBits(V, DemandedMask, RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth);
831 break;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000832 case Instruction::And:
833 // If either the LHS or the RHS are Zero, the result is zero.
834 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
835 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
836 return true;
837 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
838 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
839
840 // If something is known zero on the RHS, the bits aren't demanded on the
841 // LHS.
842 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero,
843 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
844 return true;
845 assert((LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
846 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
847
848 // If all of the demanded bits are known 1 on one side, return the other.
849 // These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'and'.
850 if ((DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) ==
851 (DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownZero))
852 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
853 if ((DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) ==
854 (DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero))
855 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(1));
856
857 // If all of the demanded bits in the inputs are known zeros, return zero.
858 if ((DemandedMask & (RHSKnownZero|LHSKnownZero)) == DemandedMask)
859 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(VTy));
860
861 // If the RHS is a constant, see if we can simplify it.
862 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownZero))
863 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
864
865 // Output known-1 bits are only known if set in both the LHS & RHS.
866 RHSKnownOne &= LHSKnownOne;
867 // Output known-0 are known to be clear if zero in either the LHS | RHS.
868 RHSKnownZero |= LHSKnownZero;
869 break;
870 case Instruction::Or:
871 // If either the LHS or the RHS are One, the result is One.
872 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
873 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
874 return true;
875 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
876 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
877 // If something is known one on the RHS, the bits aren't demanded on the
878 // LHS.
879 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne,
880 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
881 return true;
882 assert((LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
883 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
884
885 // If all of the demanded bits are known zero on one side, return the other.
886 // These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'or'.
887 if ((DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownOne & RHSKnownZero) ==
888 (DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownOne))
889 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
890 if ((DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownZero) ==
891 (DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne))
892 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(1));
893
894 // If all of the potentially set bits on one side are known to be set on
895 // the other side, just use the 'other' side.
896 if ((DemandedMask & (~RHSKnownZero) & LHSKnownOne) ==
897 (DemandedMask & (~RHSKnownZero)))
898 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
899 if ((DemandedMask & (~LHSKnownZero) & RHSKnownOne) ==
900 (DemandedMask & (~LHSKnownZero)))
901 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(1));
902
903 // If the RHS is a constant, see if we can simplify it.
904 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask))
905 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
906
907 // Output known-0 bits are only known if clear in both the LHS & RHS.
908 RHSKnownZero &= LHSKnownZero;
909 // Output known-1 are known to be set if set in either the LHS | RHS.
910 RHSKnownOne |= LHSKnownOne;
911 break;
912 case Instruction::Xor: {
913 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
914 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
915 return true;
916 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
917 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
918 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask,
919 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
920 return true;
921 assert((LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
922 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
923
924 // If all of the demanded bits are known zero on one side, return the other.
925 // These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'xor'.
926 if ((DemandedMask & RHSKnownZero) == DemandedMask)
927 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
928 if ((DemandedMask & LHSKnownZero) == DemandedMask)
929 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(1));
930
931 // Output known-0 bits are known if clear or set in both the LHS & RHS.
932 APInt KnownZeroOut = (RHSKnownZero & LHSKnownZero) |
933 (RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownOne);
934 // Output known-1 are known to be set if set in only one of the LHS, RHS.
935 APInt KnownOneOut = (RHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) |
936 (RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownZero);
937
938 // If all of the demanded bits are known to be zero on one side or the
939 // other, turn this into an *inclusive* or.
940 // e.g. (A & C1)^(B & C2) -> (A & C1)|(B & C2) iff C1&C2 == 0
941 if ((DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero & ~LHSKnownZero) == 0) {
942 Instruction *Or =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +0000943 BinaryOperator::CreateOr(I->getOperand(0), I->getOperand(1),
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000944 I->getName());
945 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, *I);
946 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, Or);
947 }
948
949 // If all of the demanded bits on one side are known, and all of the set
950 // bits on that side are also known to be set on the other side, turn this
951 // into an AND, as we know the bits will be cleared.
952 // e.g. (X | C1) ^ C2 --> (X | C1) & ~C2 iff (C1&C2) == C2
953 if ((DemandedMask & (RHSKnownZero|RHSKnownOne)) == DemandedMask) {
954 // all known
955 if ((RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownOne) == RHSKnownOne) {
956 Constant *AndC = ConstantInt::get(~RHSKnownOne & DemandedMask);
957 Instruction *And =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +0000958 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(I->getOperand(0), AndC, "tmp");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000959 InsertNewInstBefore(And, *I);
960 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, And);
961 }
962 }
963
964 // If the RHS is a constant, see if we can simplify it.
965 // FIXME: for XOR, we prefer to force bits to 1 if they will make a -1.
966 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask))
967 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
968
969 RHSKnownZero = KnownZeroOut;
970 RHSKnownOne = KnownOneOut;
971 break;
972 }
973 case Instruction::Select:
974 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(2), DemandedMask,
975 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
976 return true;
977 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
978 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
979 return true;
980 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
981 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
982 assert((LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
983 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
984
985 // If the operands are constants, see if we can simplify them.
986 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask))
987 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
988 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 2, DemandedMask))
989 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
990
991 // Only known if known in both the LHS and RHS.
992 RHSKnownOne &= LHSKnownOne;
993 RHSKnownZero &= LHSKnownZero;
994 break;
995 case Instruction::Trunc: {
996 uint32_t truncBf =
997 cast<IntegerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType())->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +0000998 DemandedMask.zext(truncBf);
999 RHSKnownZero.zext(truncBf);
1000 RHSKnownOne.zext(truncBf);
1001 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask,
1002 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001003 return true;
1004 DemandedMask.trunc(BitWidth);
1005 RHSKnownZero.trunc(BitWidth);
1006 RHSKnownOne.trunc(BitWidth);
1007 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1008 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1009 break;
1010 }
1011 case Instruction::BitCast:
1012 if (!I->getOperand(0)->getType()->isInteger())
1013 return false;
1014
1015 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask,
1016 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1017 return true;
1018 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1019 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1020 break;
1021 case Instruction::ZExt: {
1022 // Compute the bits in the result that are not present in the input.
1023 const IntegerType *SrcTy = cast<IntegerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType());
Reid Spencer2f549172007-03-25 04:26:16 +00001024 uint32_t SrcBitWidth = SrcTy->getBitWidth();
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001025
Zhou Shengd48653a2007-03-29 04:45:55 +00001026 DemandedMask.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1027 RHSKnownZero.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1028 RHSKnownOne.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001029 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask,
1030 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001031 return true;
1032 DemandedMask.zext(BitWidth);
1033 RHSKnownZero.zext(BitWidth);
1034 RHSKnownOne.zext(BitWidth);
1035 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1036 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1037 // The top bits are known to be zero.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001038 RHSKnownZero |= APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - SrcBitWidth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001039 break;
1040 }
1041 case Instruction::SExt: {
1042 // Compute the bits in the result that are not present in the input.
1043 const IntegerType *SrcTy = cast<IntegerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType());
Reid Spencer2f549172007-03-25 04:26:16 +00001044 uint32_t SrcBitWidth = SrcTy->getBitWidth();
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001045
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001046 APInt InputDemandedBits = DemandedMask &
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001047 APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, SrcBitWidth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001048
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001049 APInt NewBits(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - SrcBitWidth));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001050 // If any of the sign extended bits are demanded, we know that the sign
1051 // bit is demanded.
1052 if ((NewBits & DemandedMask) != 0)
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00001053 InputDemandedBits.set(SrcBitWidth-1);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001054
Zhou Shengd48653a2007-03-29 04:45:55 +00001055 InputDemandedBits.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1056 RHSKnownZero.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1057 RHSKnownOne.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001058 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), InputDemandedBits,
1059 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001060 return true;
1061 InputDemandedBits.zext(BitWidth);
1062 RHSKnownZero.zext(BitWidth);
1063 RHSKnownOne.zext(BitWidth);
1064 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1065 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1066
1067 // If the sign bit of the input is known set or clear, then we know the
1068 // top bits of the result.
1069
1070 // If the input sign bit is known zero, or if the NewBits are not demanded
1071 // convert this into a zero extension.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001072 if (RHSKnownZero[SrcBitWidth-1] || (NewBits & ~DemandedMask) == NewBits)
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001073 {
1074 // Convert to ZExt cast
1075 CastInst *NewCast = new ZExtInst(I->getOperand(0), VTy, I->getName(), I);
1076 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, NewCast);
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001077 } else if (RHSKnownOne[SrcBitWidth-1]) { // Input sign bit known set
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001078 RHSKnownOne |= NewBits;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001079 }
1080 break;
1081 }
1082 case Instruction::Add: {
1083 // Figure out what the input bits are. If the top bits of the and result
1084 // are not demanded, then the add doesn't demand them from its input
1085 // either.
Reid Spencer55702aa2007-03-25 21:11:44 +00001086 uint32_t NLZ = DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros();
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001087
1088 // If there is a constant on the RHS, there are a variety of xformations
1089 // we can do.
1090 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
1091 // If null, this should be simplified elsewhere. Some of the xforms here
1092 // won't work if the RHS is zero.
1093 if (RHS->isZero())
1094 break;
1095
1096 // If the top bit of the output is demanded, demand everything from the
1097 // input. Otherwise, we demand all the input bits except NLZ top bits.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001098 APInt InDemandedBits(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - NLZ));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001099
1100 // Find information about known zero/one bits in the input.
1101 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), InDemandedBits,
1102 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1103 return true;
1104
1105 // If the RHS of the add has bits set that can't affect the input, reduce
1106 // the constant.
1107 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, InDemandedBits))
1108 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
1109
1110 // Avoid excess work.
1111 if (LHSKnownZero == 0 && LHSKnownOne == 0)
1112 break;
1113
1114 // Turn it into OR if input bits are zero.
1115 if ((LHSKnownZero & RHS->getValue()) == RHS->getValue()) {
1116 Instruction *Or =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001117 BinaryOperator::CreateOr(I->getOperand(0), I->getOperand(1),
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001118 I->getName());
1119 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, *I);
1120 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, Or);
1121 }
1122
1123 // We can say something about the output known-zero and known-one bits,
1124 // depending on potential carries from the input constant and the
1125 // unknowns. For example if the LHS is known to have at most the 0x0F0F0
1126 // bits set and the RHS constant is 0x01001, then we know we have a known
1127 // one mask of 0x00001 and a known zero mask of 0xE0F0E.
1128
1129 // To compute this, we first compute the potential carry bits. These are
1130 // the bits which may be modified. I'm not aware of a better way to do
1131 // this scan.
Zhou Shengb9cb95f2007-03-31 02:38:39 +00001132 const APInt& RHSVal = RHS->getValue();
1133 APInt CarryBits((~LHSKnownZero + RHSVal) ^ (~LHSKnownZero ^ RHSVal));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001134
1135 // Now that we know which bits have carries, compute the known-1/0 sets.
1136
1137 // Bits are known one if they are known zero in one operand and one in the
1138 // other, and there is no input carry.
1139 RHSKnownOne = ((LHSKnownZero & RHSVal) |
1140 (LHSKnownOne & ~RHSVal)) & ~CarryBits;
1141
1142 // Bits are known zero if they are known zero in both operands and there
1143 // is no input carry.
1144 RHSKnownZero = LHSKnownZero & ~RHSVal & ~CarryBits;
1145 } else {
1146 // If the high-bits of this ADD are not demanded, then it does not demand
1147 // the high bits of its LHS or RHS.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001148 if (DemandedMask[BitWidth-1] == 0) {
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001149 // Right fill the mask of bits for this ADD to demand the most
1150 // significant bit and all those below it.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001151 APInt DemandedFromOps(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-NLZ));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001152 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedFromOps,
1153 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1154 return true;
1155 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedFromOps,
1156 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1157 return true;
1158 }
1159 }
1160 break;
1161 }
1162 case Instruction::Sub:
1163 // If the high-bits of this SUB are not demanded, then it does not demand
1164 // the high bits of its LHS or RHS.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001165 if (DemandedMask[BitWidth-1] == 0) {
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001166 // Right fill the mask of bits for this SUB to demand the most
1167 // significant bit and all those below it.
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00001168 uint32_t NLZ = DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros();
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001169 APInt DemandedFromOps(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-NLZ));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001170 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedFromOps,
1171 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1172 return true;
1173 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedFromOps,
1174 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1175 return true;
1176 }
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001177 // Otherwise just hand the sub off to ComputeMaskedBits to fill in
1178 // the known zeros and ones.
1179 ComputeMaskedBits(V, DemandedMask, RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001180 break;
1181 case Instruction::Shl:
1182 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00001183 uint64_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001184 APInt DemandedMaskIn(DemandedMask.lshr(ShiftAmt));
1185 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMaskIn,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001186 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1187 return true;
1188 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1189 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1190 RHSKnownZero <<= ShiftAmt;
1191 RHSKnownOne <<= ShiftAmt;
1192 // low bits known zero.
Zhou Shengadc14952007-03-14 09:07:33 +00001193 if (ShiftAmt)
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00001194 RHSKnownZero |= APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001195 }
1196 break;
1197 case Instruction::LShr:
1198 // For a logical shift right
1199 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00001200 uint64_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001201
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001202 // Unsigned shift right.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001203 APInt DemandedMaskIn(DemandedMask.shl(ShiftAmt));
1204 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMaskIn,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001205 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1206 return true;
1207 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1208 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001209 RHSKnownZero = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownZero, ShiftAmt);
1210 RHSKnownOne = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownOne, ShiftAmt);
Zhou Shengadc14952007-03-14 09:07:33 +00001211 if (ShiftAmt) {
1212 // Compute the new bits that are at the top now.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001213 APInt HighBits(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt));
Zhou Shengadc14952007-03-14 09:07:33 +00001214 RHSKnownZero |= HighBits; // high bits known zero.
1215 }
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001216 }
1217 break;
1218 case Instruction::AShr:
1219 // If this is an arithmetic shift right and only the low-bit is set, we can
1220 // always convert this into a logical shr, even if the shift amount is
1221 // variable. The low bit of the shift cannot be an input sign bit unless
1222 // the shift amount is >= the size of the datatype, which is undefined.
1223 if (DemandedMask == 1) {
1224 // Perform the logical shift right.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001225 Value *NewVal = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001226 I->getOperand(0), I->getOperand(1), I->getName());
1227 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(NewVal), *I);
1228 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, NewVal);
1229 }
Chris Lattner4241e4d2007-07-15 20:54:51 +00001230
1231 // If the sign bit is the only bit demanded by this ashr, then there is no
1232 // need to do it, the shift doesn't change the high bit.
1233 if (DemandedMask.isSignBit())
1234 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001235
1236 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00001237 uint32_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001238
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001239 // Signed shift right.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001240 APInt DemandedMaskIn(DemandedMask.shl(ShiftAmt));
Lauro Ramos Venanciod0499af2007-06-06 17:08:48 +00001241 // If any of the "high bits" are demanded, we should set the sign bit as
1242 // demanded.
1243 if (DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros() <= ShiftAmt)
1244 DemandedMaskIn.set(BitWidth-1);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001245 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0),
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001246 DemandedMaskIn,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001247 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1248 return true;
1249 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1250 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1251 // Compute the new bits that are at the top now.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001252 APInt HighBits(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001253 RHSKnownZero = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownZero, ShiftAmt);
1254 RHSKnownOne = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownOne, ShiftAmt);
1255
1256 // Handle the sign bits.
1257 APInt SignBit(APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth));
1258 // Adjust to where it is now in the mask.
1259 SignBit = APIntOps::lshr(SignBit, ShiftAmt);
1260
1261 // If the input sign bit is known to be zero, or if none of the top bits
1262 // are demanded, turn this into an unsigned shift right.
Zhou Shengcc419402008-06-06 08:32:05 +00001263 if (BitWidth <= ShiftAmt || RHSKnownZero[BitWidth-ShiftAmt-1] ||
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001264 (HighBits & ~DemandedMask) == HighBits) {
1265 // Perform the logical shift right.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001266 Value *NewVal = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001267 I->getOperand(0), SA, I->getName());
1268 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(NewVal), *I);
1269 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, NewVal);
1270 } else if ((RHSKnownOne & SignBit) != 0) { // New bits are known one.
1271 RHSKnownOne |= HighBits;
1272 }
1273 }
1274 break;
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001275 case Instruction::SRem:
1276 if (ConstantInt *Rem = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
1277 APInt RA = Rem->getValue();
1278 if (RA.isPowerOf2() || (-RA).isPowerOf2()) {
Nick Lewycky3ac9e102008-07-12 05:04:38 +00001279 if (DemandedMask.ule(RA)) // srem won't affect demanded bits
1280 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
1281
Dan Gohman23e1df82008-05-06 00:51:48 +00001282 APInt LowBits = RA.isStrictlyPositive() ? (RA - 1) : ~RA;
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001283 APInt Mask2 = LowBits | APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth);
1284 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), Mask2,
1285 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1286 return true;
1287
1288 if (LHSKnownZero[BitWidth-1] || ((LHSKnownZero & LowBits) == LowBits))
1289 LHSKnownZero |= ~LowBits;
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001290
1291 KnownZero |= LHSKnownZero & DemandedMask;
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001292
1293 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0&&"Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1294 }
1295 }
1296 break;
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001297 case Instruction::URem: {
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001298 APInt KnownZero2(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne2(BitWidth, 0);
1299 APInt AllOnes = APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth);
Dan Gohmane85b7582008-05-01 19:13:24 +00001300 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), AllOnes,
1301 KnownZero2, KnownOne2, Depth+1))
1302 return true;
1303
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001304 uint32_t Leaders = KnownZero2.countLeadingOnes();
Dan Gohmane85b7582008-05-01 19:13:24 +00001305 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), AllOnes,
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001306 KnownZero2, KnownOne2, Depth+1))
1307 return true;
1308
1309 Leaders = std::max(Leaders,
1310 KnownZero2.countLeadingOnes());
1311 KnownZero = APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, Leaders) & DemandedMask;
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001312 break;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001313 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00001314 case Instruction::Call:
1315 if (IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(I)) {
1316 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1317 default: break;
1318 case Intrinsic::bswap: {
1319 // If the only bits demanded come from one byte of the bswap result,
1320 // just shift the input byte into position to eliminate the bswap.
1321 unsigned NLZ = DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros();
1322 unsigned NTZ = DemandedMask.countTrailingZeros();
1323
1324 // Round NTZ down to the next byte. If we have 11 trailing zeros, then
1325 // we need all the bits down to bit 8. Likewise, round NLZ. If we
1326 // have 14 leading zeros, round to 8.
1327 NLZ &= ~7;
1328 NTZ &= ~7;
1329 // If we need exactly one byte, we can do this transformation.
1330 if (BitWidth-NLZ-NTZ == 8) {
1331 unsigned ResultBit = NTZ;
1332 unsigned InputBit = BitWidth-NTZ-8;
1333
1334 // Replace this with either a left or right shift to get the byte into
1335 // the right place.
1336 Instruction *NewVal;
1337 if (InputBit > ResultBit)
1338 NewVal = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(I->getOperand(1),
1339 ConstantInt::get(I->getType(), InputBit-ResultBit));
1340 else
1341 NewVal = BinaryOperator::CreateShl(I->getOperand(1),
1342 ConstantInt::get(I->getType(), ResultBit-InputBit));
1343 NewVal->takeName(I);
1344 InsertNewInstBefore(NewVal, *I);
1345 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, NewVal);
1346 }
1347
1348 // TODO: Could compute known zero/one bits based on the input.
1349 break;
1350 }
1351 }
1352 }
Chris Lattner6c3bfba2008-06-18 18:11:55 +00001353 ComputeMaskedBits(V, DemandedMask, RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth);
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00001354 break;
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001355 }
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001356
1357 // If the client is only demanding bits that we know, return the known
1358 // constant.
1359 if ((DemandedMask & (RHSKnownZero|RHSKnownOne)) == DemandedMask)
1360 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(RHSKnownOne));
1361 return false;
1362}
1363
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001364
1365/// SimplifyDemandedVectorElts - The specified value producecs a vector with
1366/// 64 or fewer elements. DemandedElts contains the set of elements that are
1367/// actually used by the caller. This method analyzes which elements of the
1368/// operand are undef and returns that information in UndefElts.
1369///
1370/// If the information about demanded elements can be used to simplify the
1371/// operation, the operation is simplified, then the resultant value is
1372/// returned. This returns null if no change was made.
1373Value *InstCombiner::SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(Value *V, uint64_t DemandedElts,
1374 uint64_t &UndefElts,
1375 unsigned Depth) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001376 unsigned VWidth = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getNumElements();
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001377 assert(VWidth <= 64 && "Vector too wide to analyze!");
1378 uint64_t EltMask = ~0ULL >> (64-VWidth);
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001379 assert((DemandedElts & ~EltMask) == 0 && "Invalid DemandedElts!");
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001380
1381 if (isa<UndefValue>(V)) {
1382 // If the entire vector is undefined, just return this info.
1383 UndefElts = EltMask;
1384 return 0;
1385 } else if (DemandedElts == 0) { // If nothing is demanded, provide undef.
1386 UndefElts = EltMask;
1387 return UndefValue::get(V->getType());
1388 }
1389
1390 UndefElts = 0;
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001391 if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V)) {
1392 const Type *EltTy = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getElementType();
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001393 Constant *Undef = UndefValue::get(EltTy);
1394
1395 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
1396 for (unsigned i = 0; i != VWidth; ++i)
1397 if (!(DemandedElts & (1ULL << i))) { // If not demanded, set to undef.
1398 Elts.push_back(Undef);
1399 UndefElts |= (1ULL << i);
1400 } else if (isa<UndefValue>(CP->getOperand(i))) { // Already undef.
1401 Elts.push_back(Undef);
1402 UndefElts |= (1ULL << i);
1403 } else { // Otherwise, defined.
1404 Elts.push_back(CP->getOperand(i));
1405 }
1406
1407 // If we changed the constant, return it.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001408 Constant *NewCP = ConstantVector::get(Elts);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001409 return NewCP != CP ? NewCP : 0;
1410 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V)) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001411 // Simplify the CAZ to a ConstantVector where the non-demanded elements are
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001412 // set to undef.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001413 const Type *EltTy = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getElementType();
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001414 Constant *Zero = Constant::getNullValue(EltTy);
1415 Constant *Undef = UndefValue::get(EltTy);
1416 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
1417 for (unsigned i = 0; i != VWidth; ++i)
1418 Elts.push_back((DemandedElts & (1ULL << i)) ? Zero : Undef);
1419 UndefElts = DemandedElts ^ EltMask;
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001420 return ConstantVector::get(Elts);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001421 }
1422
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001423 // Limit search depth.
1424 if (Depth == 10)
1425 return false;
1426
1427 // If multiple users are using the root value, procede with
1428 // simplification conservatively assuming that all elements
1429 // are needed.
1430 if (!V->hasOneUse()) {
1431 // Quit if we find multiple users of a non-root value though.
1432 // They'll be handled when it's their turn to be visited by
1433 // the main instcombine process.
1434 if (Depth != 0)
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001435 // TODO: Just compute the UndefElts information recursively.
1436 return false;
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001437
1438 // Conservatively assume that all elements are needed.
1439 DemandedElts = EltMask;
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001440 }
1441
1442 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
1443 if (!I) return false; // Only analyze instructions.
1444
1445 bool MadeChange = false;
1446 uint64_t UndefElts2;
1447 Value *TmpV;
1448 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
1449 default: break;
1450
1451 case Instruction::InsertElement: {
1452 // If this is a variable index, we don't know which element it overwrites.
1453 // demand exactly the same input as we produce.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00001454 ConstantInt *Idx = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(2));
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001455 if (Idx == 0) {
1456 // Note that we can't propagate undef elt info, because we don't know
1457 // which elt is getting updated.
1458 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts,
1459 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1460 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1461 break;
1462 }
1463
1464 // If this is inserting an element that isn't demanded, remove this
1465 // insertelement.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00001466 unsigned IdxNo = Idx->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001467 if (IdxNo >= VWidth || (DemandedElts & (1ULL << IdxNo)) == 0)
1468 return AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist(*I, 0);
1469
1470 // Otherwise, the element inserted overwrites whatever was there, so the
1471 // input demanded set is simpler than the output set.
1472 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0),
1473 DemandedElts & ~(1ULL << IdxNo),
1474 UndefElts, Depth+1);
1475 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1476
1477 // The inserted element is defined.
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001478 UndefElts &= ~(1ULL << IdxNo);
1479 break;
1480 }
1481 case Instruction::ShuffleVector: {
1482 ShuffleVectorInst *Shuffle = cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(I);
1483 uint64_t LeftDemanded = 0, RightDemanded = 0;
1484 for (unsigned i = 0; i < VWidth; i++) {
1485 if (DemandedElts & (1ULL << i)) {
1486 unsigned MaskVal = Shuffle->getMaskValue(i);
1487 if (MaskVal != -1u) {
1488 assert(MaskVal < VWidth * 2 &&
1489 "shufflevector mask index out of range!");
1490 if (MaskVal < VWidth)
1491 LeftDemanded |= 1ULL << MaskVal;
1492 else
1493 RightDemanded |= 1ULL << (MaskVal - VWidth);
1494 }
1495 }
1496 }
1497
1498 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), LeftDemanded,
1499 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1500 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1501
1502 uint64_t UndefElts3;
1503 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(1), RightDemanded,
1504 UndefElts3, Depth+1);
1505 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(1, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1506
1507 bool NewUndefElts = false;
1508 for (unsigned i = 0; i < VWidth; i++) {
1509 unsigned MaskVal = Shuffle->getMaskValue(i);
Dan Gohmancb893092008-09-10 01:09:32 +00001510 if (MaskVal == -1u) {
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001511 uint64_t NewBit = 1ULL << i;
1512 UndefElts |= NewBit;
1513 } else if (MaskVal < VWidth) {
1514 uint64_t NewBit = ((UndefElts2 >> MaskVal) & 1) << i;
1515 NewUndefElts |= NewBit;
1516 UndefElts |= NewBit;
1517 } else {
1518 uint64_t NewBit = ((UndefElts3 >> (MaskVal - VWidth)) & 1) << i;
1519 NewUndefElts |= NewBit;
1520 UndefElts |= NewBit;
1521 }
1522 }
1523
1524 if (NewUndefElts) {
1525 // Add additional discovered undefs.
1526 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
1527 for (unsigned i = 0; i < VWidth; ++i) {
1528 if (UndefElts & (1ULL << i))
1529 Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
1530 else
1531 Elts.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty,
1532 Shuffle->getMaskValue(i)));
1533 }
1534 I->setOperand(2, ConstantVector::get(Elts));
1535 MadeChange = true;
1536 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001537 break;
1538 }
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001539 case Instruction::BitCast: {
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +00001540 // Vector->vector casts only.
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001541 const VectorType *VTy = dyn_cast<VectorType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType());
1542 if (!VTy) break;
1543 unsigned InVWidth = VTy->getNumElements();
1544 uint64_t InputDemandedElts = 0;
1545 unsigned Ratio;
1546
1547 if (VWidth == InVWidth) {
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +00001548 // If we are converting from <4 x i32> -> <4 x f32>, we demand the same
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001549 // elements as are demanded of us.
1550 Ratio = 1;
1551 InputDemandedElts = DemandedElts;
1552 } else if (VWidth > InVWidth) {
1553 // Untested so far.
1554 break;
1555
1556 // If there are more elements in the result than there are in the source,
1557 // then an input element is live if any of the corresponding output
1558 // elements are live.
1559 Ratio = VWidth/InVWidth;
1560 for (unsigned OutIdx = 0; OutIdx != VWidth; ++OutIdx) {
1561 if (DemandedElts & (1ULL << OutIdx))
1562 InputDemandedElts |= 1ULL << (OutIdx/Ratio);
1563 }
1564 } else {
1565 // Untested so far.
1566 break;
1567
1568 // If there are more elements in the source than there are in the result,
1569 // then an input element is live if the corresponding output element is
1570 // live.
1571 Ratio = InVWidth/VWidth;
1572 for (unsigned InIdx = 0; InIdx != InVWidth; ++InIdx)
1573 if (DemandedElts & (1ULL << InIdx/Ratio))
1574 InputDemandedElts |= 1ULL << InIdx;
1575 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001576
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001577 // div/rem demand all inputs, because they don't want divide by zero.
1578 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), InputDemandedElts,
1579 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1580 if (TmpV) {
1581 I->setOperand(0, TmpV);
1582 MadeChange = true;
1583 }
1584
1585 UndefElts = UndefElts2;
1586 if (VWidth > InVWidth) {
1587 assert(0 && "Unimp");
1588 // If there are more elements in the result than there are in the source,
1589 // then an output element is undef if the corresponding input element is
1590 // undef.
1591 for (unsigned OutIdx = 0; OutIdx != VWidth; ++OutIdx)
1592 if (UndefElts2 & (1ULL << (OutIdx/Ratio)))
1593 UndefElts |= 1ULL << OutIdx;
1594 } else if (VWidth < InVWidth) {
1595 assert(0 && "Unimp");
1596 // If there are more elements in the source than there are in the result,
1597 // then a result element is undef if all of the corresponding input
1598 // elements are undef.
1599 UndefElts = ~0ULL >> (64-VWidth); // Start out all undef.
1600 for (unsigned InIdx = 0; InIdx != InVWidth; ++InIdx)
1601 if ((UndefElts2 & (1ULL << InIdx)) == 0) // Not undef?
1602 UndefElts &= ~(1ULL << (InIdx/Ratio)); // Clear undef bit.
1603 }
1604 break;
1605 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001606 case Instruction::And:
1607 case Instruction::Or:
1608 case Instruction::Xor:
1609 case Instruction::Add:
1610 case Instruction::Sub:
1611 case Instruction::Mul:
1612 // div/rem demand all inputs, because they don't want divide by zero.
1613 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts,
1614 UndefElts, Depth+1);
1615 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1616 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(1), DemandedElts,
1617 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1618 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(1, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1619
1620 // Output elements are undefined if both are undefined. Consider things
1621 // like undef&0. The result is known zero, not undef.
1622 UndefElts &= UndefElts2;
1623 break;
1624
1625 case Instruction::Call: {
1626 IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(I);
1627 if (!II) break;
1628 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1629 default: break;
1630
1631 // Binary vector operations that work column-wise. A dest element is a
1632 // function of the corresponding input elements from the two inputs.
1633 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_sub_ss:
1634 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_mul_ss:
1635 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_min_ss:
1636 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_max_ss:
1637 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_sub_sd:
1638 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_mul_sd:
1639 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_min_sd:
1640 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_max_sd:
1641 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(II->getOperand(1), DemandedElts,
1642 UndefElts, Depth+1);
1643 if (TmpV) { II->setOperand(1, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1644 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(II->getOperand(2), DemandedElts,
1645 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1646 if (TmpV) { II->setOperand(2, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1647
1648 // If only the low elt is demanded and this is a scalarizable intrinsic,
1649 // scalarize it now.
1650 if (DemandedElts == 1) {
1651 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1652 default: break;
1653 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_sub_ss:
1654 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_mul_ss:
1655 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_sub_sd:
1656 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_mul_sd:
1657 // TODO: Lower MIN/MAX/ABS/etc
1658 Value *LHS = II->getOperand(1);
1659 Value *RHS = II->getOperand(2);
1660 // Extract the element as scalars.
1661 LHS = InsertNewInstBefore(new ExtractElementInst(LHS, 0U,"tmp"), *II);
1662 RHS = InsertNewInstBefore(new ExtractElementInst(RHS, 0U,"tmp"), *II);
1663
1664 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1665 default: assert(0 && "Case stmts out of sync!");
1666 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_sub_ss:
1667 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_sub_sd:
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001668 TmpV = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateSub(LHS, RHS,
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001669 II->getName()), *II);
1670 break;
1671 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_mul_ss:
1672 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_mul_sd:
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001673 TmpV = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateMul(LHS, RHS,
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001674 II->getName()), *II);
1675 break;
1676 }
1677
1678 Instruction *New =
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00001679 InsertElementInst::Create(UndefValue::get(II->getType()), TmpV, 0U,
1680 II->getName());
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001681 InsertNewInstBefore(New, *II);
1682 AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist(*II, 0);
1683 return New;
1684 }
1685 }
1686
1687 // Output elements are undefined if both are undefined. Consider things
1688 // like undef&0. The result is known zero, not undef.
1689 UndefElts &= UndefElts2;
1690 break;
1691 }
1692 break;
1693 }
1694 }
1695 return MadeChange ? I : 0;
1696}
1697
Dan Gohman45b4e482008-05-19 22:14:15 +00001698
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001699/// AssociativeOpt - Perform an optimization on an associative operator. This
1700/// function is designed to check a chain of associative operators for a
1701/// potential to apply a certain optimization. Since the optimization may be
1702/// applicable if the expression was reassociated, this checks the chain, then
1703/// reassociates the expression as necessary to expose the optimization
1704/// opportunity. This makes use of a special Functor, which must define
1705/// 'shouldApply' and 'apply' methods.
1706///
1707template<typename Functor>
Dan Gohman76d402b2008-05-20 01:14:05 +00001708static Instruction *AssociativeOpt(BinaryOperator &Root, const Functor &F) {
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001709 unsigned Opcode = Root.getOpcode();
1710 Value *LHS = Root.getOperand(0);
1711
1712 // Quick check, see if the immediate LHS matches...
1713 if (F.shouldApply(LHS))
1714 return F.apply(Root);
1715
1716 // Otherwise, if the LHS is not of the same opcode as the root, return.
1717 Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHS);
Chris Lattnerfd059242003-10-15 16:48:29 +00001718 while (LHSI && LHSI->getOpcode() == Opcode && LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001719 // Should we apply this transform to the RHS?
1720 bool ShouldApply = F.shouldApply(LHSI->getOperand(1));
1721
1722 // If not to the RHS, check to see if we should apply to the LHS...
1723 if (!ShouldApply && F.shouldApply(LHSI->getOperand(0))) {
1724 cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI)->swapOperands(); // Make the LHS the RHS
1725 ShouldApply = true;
1726 }
1727
1728 // If the functor wants to apply the optimization to the RHS of LHSI,
1729 // reassociate the expression from ((? op A) op B) to (? op (A op B))
1730 if (ShouldApply) {
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001731 // Now all of the instructions are in the current basic block, go ahead
1732 // and perform the reassociation.
1733 Instruction *TmpLHSI = cast<Instruction>(Root.getOperand(0));
1734
1735 // First move the selected RHS to the LHS of the root...
1736 Root.setOperand(0, LHSI->getOperand(1));
1737
1738 // Make what used to be the LHS of the root be the user of the root...
1739 Value *ExtraOperand = TmpLHSI->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001740 if (&Root == TmpLHSI) {
Chris Lattner15a76c02004-04-05 02:10:19 +00001741 Root.replaceAllUsesWith(Constant::getNullValue(TmpLHSI->getType()));
1742 return 0;
1743 }
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001744 Root.replaceAllUsesWith(TmpLHSI); // Users now use TmpLHSI
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001745 TmpLHSI->setOperand(1, &Root); // TmpLHSI now uses the root
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001746 BasicBlock::iterator ARI = &Root; ++ARI;
Dan Gohmand02d9172008-06-19 17:47:47 +00001747 TmpLHSI->moveBefore(ARI); // Move TmpLHSI to after Root
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001748 ARI = Root;
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001749
1750 // Now propagate the ExtraOperand down the chain of instructions until we
1751 // get to LHSI.
1752 while (TmpLHSI != LHSI) {
1753 Instruction *NextLHSI = cast<Instruction>(TmpLHSI->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001754 // Move the instruction to immediately before the chain we are
1755 // constructing to avoid breaking dominance properties.
Dan Gohmand02d9172008-06-19 17:47:47 +00001756 NextLHSI->moveBefore(ARI);
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001757 ARI = NextLHSI;
1758
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001759 Value *NextOp = NextLHSI->getOperand(1);
1760 NextLHSI->setOperand(1, ExtraOperand);
1761 TmpLHSI = NextLHSI;
1762 ExtraOperand = NextOp;
1763 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001764
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001765 // Now that the instructions are reassociated, have the functor perform
1766 // the transformation...
1767 return F.apply(Root);
1768 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001769
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001770 LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHSI->getOperand(0));
1771 }
1772 return 0;
1773}
1774
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +00001775namespace {
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001776
Nick Lewycky02d639f2008-05-23 04:34:58 +00001777// AddRHS - Implements: X + X --> X << 1
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001778struct AddRHS {
1779 Value *RHS;
1780 AddRHS(Value *rhs) : RHS(rhs) {}
1781 bool shouldApply(Value *LHS) const { return LHS == RHS; }
1782 Instruction *apply(BinaryOperator &Add) const {
Nick Lewycky02d639f2008-05-23 04:34:58 +00001783 return BinaryOperator::CreateShl(Add.getOperand(0),
1784 ConstantInt::get(Add.getType(), 1));
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001785 }
1786};
1787
1788// AddMaskingAnd - Implements (A & C1)+(B & C2) --> (A & C1)|(B & C2)
1789// iff C1&C2 == 0
1790struct AddMaskingAnd {
1791 Constant *C2;
1792 AddMaskingAnd(Constant *c) : C2(c) {}
1793 bool shouldApply(Value *LHS) const {
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00001794 ConstantInt *C1;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001795 return match(LHS, m_And(m_Value(), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00001796 ConstantExpr::getAnd(C1, C2)->isNullValue();
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001797 }
1798 Instruction *apply(BinaryOperator &Add) const {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001799 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Add.getOperand(0), Add.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001800 }
1801};
1802
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +00001803}
1804
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001805static Value *FoldOperationIntoSelectOperand(Instruction &I, Value *SO,
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001806 InstCombiner *IC) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001807 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(&I)) {
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001808 if (Constant *SOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(SO))
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001809 return ConstantExpr::getCast(CI->getOpcode(), SOC, I.getType());
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001810
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001811 return IC->InsertNewInstBefore(CastInst::Create(
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001812 CI->getOpcode(), SO, I.getType(), SO->getName() + ".cast"), I);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001813 }
1814
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001815 // Figure out if the constant is the left or the right argument.
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001816 bool ConstIsRHS = isa<Constant>(I.getOperand(1));
1817 Constant *ConstOperand = cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(ConstIsRHS));
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001818
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001819 if (Constant *SOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(SO)) {
1820 if (ConstIsRHS)
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001821 return ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), SOC, ConstOperand);
1822 return ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), ConstOperand, SOC);
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001823 }
1824
1825 Value *Op0 = SO, *Op1 = ConstOperand;
1826 if (!ConstIsRHS)
1827 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
1828 Instruction *New;
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001829 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(&I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001830 New = BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), Op0, Op1,SO->getName()+".op");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001831 else if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(&I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001832 New = CmpInst::Create(CI->getOpcode(), CI->getPredicate(), Op0, Op1,
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001833 SO->getName()+".cmp");
Chris Lattner326c0f32004-04-10 19:15:56 +00001834 else {
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001835 assert(0 && "Unknown binary instruction type!");
Chris Lattner326c0f32004-04-10 19:15:56 +00001836 abort();
1837 }
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001838 return IC->InsertNewInstBefore(New, I);
1839}
1840
1841// FoldOpIntoSelect - Given an instruction with a select as one operand and a
1842// constant as the other operand, try to fold the binary operator into the
1843// select arguments. This also works for Cast instructions, which obviously do
1844// not have a second operand.
1845static Instruction *FoldOpIntoSelect(Instruction &Op, SelectInst *SI,
1846 InstCombiner *IC) {
1847 // Don't modify shared select instructions
1848 if (!SI->hasOneUse()) return 0;
1849 Value *TV = SI->getOperand(1);
1850 Value *FV = SI->getOperand(2);
1851
1852 if (isa<Constant>(TV) || isa<Constant>(FV)) {
Chris Lattner956db272005-04-21 05:43:13 +00001853 // Bool selects with constant operands can be folded to logical ops.
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00001854 if (SI->getType() == Type::Int1Ty) return 0;
Chris Lattner956db272005-04-21 05:43:13 +00001855
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001856 Value *SelectTrueVal = FoldOperationIntoSelectOperand(Op, TV, IC);
1857 Value *SelectFalseVal = FoldOperationIntoSelectOperand(Op, FV, IC);
1858
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00001859 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getCondition(), SelectTrueVal,
1860 SelectFalseVal);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001861 }
1862 return 0;
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001863}
1864
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001865
1866/// FoldOpIntoPhi - Given a binary operator or cast instruction which has a PHI
1867/// node as operand #0, see if we can fold the instruction into the PHI (which
1868/// is only possible if all operands to the PHI are constants).
1869Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldOpIntoPhi(Instruction &I) {
1870 PHINode *PN = cast<PHINode>(I.getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00001871 unsigned NumPHIValues = PN->getNumIncomingValues();
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001872 if (!PN->hasOneUse() || NumPHIValues == 0) return 0;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001873
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001874 // Check to see if all of the operands of the PHI are constants. If there is
1875 // one non-constant value, remember the BB it is. If there is more than one
Chris Lattnerb3036682007-02-24 01:03:45 +00001876 // or if *it* is a PHI, bail out.
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001877 BasicBlock *NonConstBB = 0;
1878 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumPHIValues; ++i)
1879 if (!isa<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) {
1880 if (NonConstBB) return 0; // More than one non-const value.
Chris Lattnerb3036682007-02-24 01:03:45 +00001881 if (isa<PHINode>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) return 0; // Itself a phi.
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001882 NonConstBB = PN->getIncomingBlock(i);
1883
1884 // If the incoming non-constant value is in I's block, we have an infinite
1885 // loop.
1886 if (NonConstBB == I.getParent())
1887 return 0;
1888 }
1889
1890 // If there is exactly one non-constant value, we can insert a copy of the
1891 // operation in that block. However, if this is a critical edge, we would be
1892 // inserting the computation one some other paths (e.g. inside a loop). Only
1893 // do this if the pred block is unconditionally branching into the phi block.
1894 if (NonConstBB) {
1895 BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(NonConstBB->getTerminator());
1896 if (!BI || !BI->isUnconditional()) return 0;
1897 }
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001898
1899 // Okay, we can do the transformation: create the new PHI node.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00001900 PHINode *NewPN = PHINode::Create(I.getType(), "");
Chris Lattner55517062005-01-29 00:39:08 +00001901 NewPN->reserveOperandSpace(PN->getNumOperands()/2);
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001902 InsertNewInstBefore(NewPN, *PN);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00001903 NewPN->takeName(PN);
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001904
1905 // Next, add all of the operands to the PHI.
1906 if (I.getNumOperands() == 2) {
1907 Constant *C = cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00001908 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumPHIValues; ++i) {
Chris Lattnera9ff5eb2007-08-05 08:47:58 +00001909 Value *InV = 0;
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001910 if (Constant *InC = dyn_cast<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001911 if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(&I))
1912 InV = ConstantExpr::getCompare(CI->getPredicate(), InC, C);
1913 else
1914 InV = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), InC, C);
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001915 } else {
1916 assert(PN->getIncomingBlock(i) == NonConstBB);
1917 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(&I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001918 InV = BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(),
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001919 PN->getIncomingValue(i), C, "phitmp",
1920 NonConstBB->getTerminator());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001921 else if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(&I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001922 InV = CmpInst::Create(CI->getOpcode(),
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001923 CI->getPredicate(),
1924 PN->getIncomingValue(i), C, "phitmp",
1925 NonConstBB->getTerminator());
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001926 else
1927 assert(0 && "Unknown binop!");
1928
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00001929 AddToWorkList(cast<Instruction>(InV));
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001930 }
1931 NewPN->addIncoming(InV, PN->getIncomingBlock(i));
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001932 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001933 } else {
1934 CastInst *CI = cast<CastInst>(&I);
1935 const Type *RetTy = CI->getType();
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00001936 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumPHIValues; ++i) {
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001937 Value *InV;
1938 if (Constant *InC = dyn_cast<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001939 InV = ConstantExpr::getCast(CI->getOpcode(), InC, RetTy);
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001940 } else {
1941 assert(PN->getIncomingBlock(i) == NonConstBB);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001942 InV = CastInst::Create(CI->getOpcode(), PN->getIncomingValue(i),
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001943 I.getType(), "phitmp",
1944 NonConstBB->getTerminator());
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00001945 AddToWorkList(cast<Instruction>(InV));
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001946 }
1947 NewPN->addIncoming(InV, PN->getIncomingBlock(i));
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001948 }
1949 }
1950 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, NewPN);
1951}
1952
Chris Lattner2454a2e2008-01-29 06:52:45 +00001953
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +00001954/// WillNotOverflowSignedAdd - Return true if we can prove that:
1955/// (sext (add LHS, RHS)) === (add (sext LHS), (sext RHS))
1956/// This basically requires proving that the add in the original type would not
1957/// overflow to change the sign bit or have a carry out.
1958bool InstCombiner::WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS) {
1959 // There are different heuristics we can use for this. Here are some simple
1960 // ones.
1961
1962 // Add has the property that adding any two 2's complement numbers can only
1963 // have one carry bit which can change a sign. As such, if LHS and RHS each
1964 // have at least two sign bits, we know that the addition of the two values will
1965 // sign extend fine.
1966 if (ComputeNumSignBits(LHS) > 1 && ComputeNumSignBits(RHS) > 1)
1967 return true;
1968
1969
1970 // If one of the operands only has one non-zero bit, and if the other operand
1971 // has a known-zero bit in a more significant place than it (not including the
1972 // sign bit) the ripple may go up to and fill the zero, but won't change the
1973 // sign. For example, (X & ~4) + 1.
1974
1975 // TODO: Implement.
1976
1977 return false;
1978}
1979
Chris Lattner2454a2e2008-01-29 06:52:45 +00001980
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00001981Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAdd(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00001982 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00001983 Value *LHS = I.getOperand(0), *RHS = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +00001984
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00001985 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(RHS)) {
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00001986 // X + undef -> undef
1987 if (isa<UndefValue>(RHS))
1988 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
1989
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00001990 // X + 0 --> X
Chris Lattner9919e3d2006-12-02 00:13:08 +00001991 if (!I.getType()->isFPOrFPVector()) { // NOTE: -0 + +0 = +0.
Chris Lattner5e678e02005-10-17 17:56:38 +00001992 if (RHSC->isNullValue())
1993 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Chris Lattner8532cf62005-10-17 20:18:38 +00001994 } else if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHSC)) {
Dale Johannesen9e3d3ab2007-09-14 22:26:36 +00001995 if (CFP->isExactlyValue(ConstantFP::getNegativeZero
1996 (I.getType())->getValueAPF()))
Chris Lattner8532cf62005-10-17 20:18:38 +00001997 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Chris Lattner5e678e02005-10-17 17:56:38 +00001998 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001999
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00002000 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHSC)) {
Chris Lattnerb4a2f052006-11-09 05:12:27 +00002001 // X + (signbit) --> X ^ signbit
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002002 const APInt& Val = CI->getValue();
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00002003 uint32_t BitWidth = Val.getBitWidth();
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002004 if (Val == APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002005 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(LHS, RHS);
Chris Lattnerb4a2f052006-11-09 05:12:27 +00002006
2007 // See if SimplifyDemandedBits can simplify this. This handles stuff like
2008 // (X & 254)+1 -> (X&254)|1
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002009 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
2010 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
2011 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
2012 KnownZero, KnownOne))
2013 return &I;
2014 }
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00002015 }
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00002016
2017 if (isa<PHINode>(LHS))
2018 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2019 return NV;
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002020
Chris Lattner4f637d42006-01-06 17:59:59 +00002021 ConstantInt *XorRHS = 0;
2022 Value *XorLHS = 0;
Chris Lattnerc5eff442007-01-30 22:32:46 +00002023 if (isa<ConstantInt>(RHSC) &&
2024 match(LHS, m_Xor(m_Value(XorLHS), m_ConstantInt(XorRHS)))) {
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00002025 uint32_t TySizeBits = I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002026 const APInt& RHSVal = cast<ConstantInt>(RHSC)->getValue();
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002027
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00002028 uint32_t Size = TySizeBits / 2;
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002029 APInt C0080Val(APInt(TySizeBits, 1ULL).shl(Size - 1));
2030 APInt CFF80Val(-C0080Val);
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002031 do {
2032 if (TySizeBits > Size) {
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002033 // If we have ADD(XOR(AND(X, 0xFF), 0x80), 0xF..F80), it's a sext.
2034 // If we have ADD(XOR(AND(X, 0xFF), 0xF..F80), 0x80), it's a sext.
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002035 if ((RHSVal == CFF80Val && XorRHS->getValue() == C0080Val) ||
2036 (RHSVal == C0080Val && XorRHS->getValue() == CFF80Val)) {
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002037 // This is a sign extend if the top bits are known zero.
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00002038 if (!MaskedValueIsZero(XorLHS,
2039 APInt::getHighBitsSet(TySizeBits, TySizeBits - Size)))
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002040 Size = 0; // Not a sign ext, but can't be any others either.
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002041 break;
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002042 }
2043 }
2044 Size >>= 1;
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002045 C0080Val = APIntOps::lshr(C0080Val, Size);
2046 CFF80Val = APIntOps::ashr(CFF80Val, Size);
2047 } while (Size >= 1);
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002048
Reid Spencer35c38852007-03-28 01:36:16 +00002049 // FIXME: This shouldn't be necessary. When the backends can handle types
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +00002050 // with funny bit widths then this switch statement should be removed. It
2051 // is just here to get the size of the "middle" type back up to something
2052 // that the back ends can handle.
Reid Spencer35c38852007-03-28 01:36:16 +00002053 const Type *MiddleType = 0;
2054 switch (Size) {
2055 default: break;
2056 case 32: MiddleType = Type::Int32Ty; break;
2057 case 16: MiddleType = Type::Int16Ty; break;
2058 case 8: MiddleType = Type::Int8Ty; break;
2059 }
2060 if (MiddleType) {
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00002061 Instruction *NewTrunc = new TruncInst(XorLHS, MiddleType, "sext");
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002062 InsertNewInstBefore(NewTrunc, I);
Reid Spencer35c38852007-03-28 01:36:16 +00002063 return new SExtInst(NewTrunc, I.getType(), I.getName());
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002064 }
2065 }
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00002066 }
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +00002067
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002068 if (I.getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
2069 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(LHS, RHS);
2070
Nick Lewycky7d26bd82008-05-23 04:39:38 +00002071 // X + X --> X << 1
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002072 if (I.getType()->isInteger()) {
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00002073 if (Instruction *Result = AssociativeOpt(I, AddRHS(RHS))) return Result;
Chris Lattner7edc8c22005-04-07 17:14:51 +00002074
2075 if (Instruction *RHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(RHS)) {
2076 if (RHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub)
2077 if (LHS == RHSI->getOperand(1)) // A + (B - A) --> B
2078 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHSI->getOperand(0));
2079 }
2080 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHS)) {
2081 if (LHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub)
2082 if (RHS == LHSI->getOperand(1)) // (B - A) + A --> B
2083 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHSI->getOperand(0));
2084 }
Robert Bocchino71698282004-07-27 21:02:21 +00002085 }
Chris Lattnere92d2f42003-08-13 04:18:28 +00002086
Chris Lattner5c4afb92002-05-08 22:46:53 +00002087 // -A + B --> B - A
Chris Lattnerdd12f962008-02-17 21:03:36 +00002088 // -A + -B --> -(A + B)
2089 if (Value *LHSV = dyn_castNegVal(LHS)) {
Chris Lattnere10c0b92008-02-18 17:50:16 +00002090 if (LHS->getType()->isIntOrIntVector()) {
2091 if (Value *RHSV = dyn_castNegVal(RHS)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002092 Instruction *NewAdd = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSV, RHSV, "sum");
Chris Lattnere10c0b92008-02-18 17:50:16 +00002093 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAdd, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002094 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(NewAdd);
Chris Lattnere10c0b92008-02-18 17:50:16 +00002095 }
Chris Lattnerdd12f962008-02-17 21:03:36 +00002096 }
2097
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002098 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(RHS, LHSV);
Chris Lattnerdd12f962008-02-17 21:03:36 +00002099 }
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +00002100
2101 // A + -B --> A - B
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00002102 if (!isa<Constant>(RHS))
2103 if (Value *V = dyn_castNegVal(RHS))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002104 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(LHS, V);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002105
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002106
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002107 ConstantInt *C2;
2108 if (Value *X = dyn_castFoldableMul(LHS, C2)) {
2109 if (X == RHS) // X*C + X --> X * (C+1)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002110 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(RHS, AddOne(C2));
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002111
2112 // X*C1 + X*C2 --> X * (C1+C2)
2113 ConstantInt *C1;
2114 if (X == dyn_castFoldableMul(RHS, C1))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002115 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(X, Add(C1, C2));
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002116 }
2117
2118 // X + X*C --> X * (C+1)
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002119 if (dyn_castFoldableMul(RHS, C2) == LHS)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002120 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(LHS, AddOne(C2));
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002121
Chris Lattnere617c9e2007-01-05 02:17:46 +00002122 // X + ~X --> -1 since ~X = -X-1
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00002123 if (dyn_castNotVal(LHS) == RHS || dyn_castNotVal(RHS) == LHS)
2124 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere617c9e2007-01-05 02:17:46 +00002125
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002126
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00002127 // (A & C1)+(B & C2) --> (A & C1)|(B & C2) iff C1&C2 == 0
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002128 if (match(RHS, m_And(m_Value(), m_ConstantInt(C2))))
Chris Lattnere617c9e2007-01-05 02:17:46 +00002129 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, AddMaskingAnd(C2)))
2130 return R;
Chris Lattner5e0d7182008-05-19 20:01:56 +00002131
2132 // A+B --> A|B iff A and B have no bits set in common.
2133 if (const IntegerType *IT = dyn_cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())) {
2134 APInt Mask = APInt::getAllOnesValue(IT->getBitWidth());
2135 APInt LHSKnownOne(IT->getBitWidth(), 0);
2136 APInt LHSKnownZero(IT->getBitWidth(), 0);
2137 ComputeMaskedBits(LHS, Mask, LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne);
2138 if (LHSKnownZero != 0) {
2139 APInt RHSKnownOne(IT->getBitWidth(), 0);
2140 APInt RHSKnownZero(IT->getBitWidth(), 0);
2141 ComputeMaskedBits(RHS, Mask, RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne);
2142
2143 // No bits in common -> bitwise or.
Chris Lattner9d60ba92008-05-19 20:03:53 +00002144 if ((LHSKnownZero|RHSKnownZero).isAllOnesValue())
Chris Lattner5e0d7182008-05-19 20:01:56 +00002145 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(LHS, RHS);
Chris Lattner5e0d7182008-05-19 20:01:56 +00002146 }
2147 }
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +00002148
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002149 // W*X + Y*Z --> W * (X+Z) iff W == Y
Nick Lewycky0c2c3f62008-02-03 08:19:11 +00002150 if (I.getType()->isIntOrIntVector()) {
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002151 Value *W, *X, *Y, *Z;
2152 if (match(LHS, m_Mul(m_Value(W), m_Value(X))) &&
2153 match(RHS, m_Mul(m_Value(Y), m_Value(Z)))) {
2154 if (W != Y) {
2155 if (W == Z) {
Bill Wendling587c01d2008-02-26 10:53:30 +00002156 std::swap(Y, Z);
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002157 } else if (Y == X) {
Bill Wendling587c01d2008-02-26 10:53:30 +00002158 std::swap(W, X);
2159 } else if (X == Z) {
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002160 std::swap(Y, Z);
2161 std::swap(W, X);
2162 }
2163 }
2164
2165 if (W == Y) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002166 Value *NewAdd = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(X, Z,
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002167 LHS->getName()), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002168 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(W, NewAdd);
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002169 }
2170 }
2171 }
2172
Chris Lattner6b032052003-10-02 15:11:26 +00002173 if (ConstantInt *CRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHS)) {
Chris Lattner4f637d42006-01-06 17:59:59 +00002174 Value *X = 0;
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002175 if (match(LHS, m_Not(m_Value(X)))) // ~X + C --> (C-1) - X
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002176 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(SubOne(CRHS), X);
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002177
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002178 // (X & FF00) + xx00 -> (X+xx00) & FF00
2179 if (LHS->hasOneUse() && match(LHS, m_And(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(C2)))) {
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002180 Constant *Anded = And(CRHS, C2);
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002181 if (Anded == CRHS) {
2182 // See if all bits from the first bit set in the Add RHS up are included
2183 // in the mask. First, get the rightmost bit.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002184 const APInt& AddRHSV = CRHS->getValue();
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002185
2186 // Form a mask of all bits from the lowest bit added through the top.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002187 APInt AddRHSHighBits(~((AddRHSV & -AddRHSV)-1));
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002188
2189 // See if the and mask includes all of these bits.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002190 APInt AddRHSHighBitsAnd(AddRHSHighBits & C2->getValue());
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002191
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002192 if (AddRHSHighBits == AddRHSHighBitsAnd) {
2193 // Okay, the xform is safe. Insert the new add pronto.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002194 Value *NewAdd = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(X, CRHS,
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002195 LHS->getName()), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002196 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NewAdd, C2);
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002197 }
2198 }
2199 }
2200
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002201 // Try to fold constant add into select arguments.
2202 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(LHS))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002203 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002204 return R;
Chris Lattner6b032052003-10-02 15:11:26 +00002205 }
2206
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002207 // add (cast *A to intptrtype) B ->
Chris Lattner42790482007-12-20 01:56:58 +00002208 // cast (GEP (cast *A to sbyte*) B) --> intptrtype
Andrew Lenharth16d79552006-09-19 18:24:51 +00002209 {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002210 CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(LHS);
2211 Value *Other = RHS;
Andrew Lenharth16d79552006-09-19 18:24:51 +00002212 if (!CI) {
2213 CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(RHS);
2214 Other = LHS;
2215 }
Andrew Lenharth45633262006-09-20 15:37:57 +00002216 if (CI && CI->getType()->isSized() &&
Reid Spencerabaa8ca2007-01-08 16:32:00 +00002217 (CI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() ==
2218 TD->getIntPtrType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits())
Andrew Lenharth45633262006-09-20 15:37:57 +00002219 && isa<PointerType>(CI->getOperand(0)->getType())) {
Christopher Lamb43ad6b32007-12-17 01:12:55 +00002220 unsigned AS =
2221 cast<PointerType>(CI->getOperand(0)->getType())->getAddressSpace();
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +00002222 Value *I2 = InsertBitCastBefore(CI->getOperand(0),
2223 PointerType::get(Type::Int8Ty, AS), I);
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00002224 I2 = InsertNewInstBefore(GetElementPtrInst::Create(I2, Other, "ctg2"), I);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002225 return new PtrToIntInst(I2, CI->getType());
Andrew Lenharth16d79552006-09-19 18:24:51 +00002226 }
2227 }
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002228
Chris Lattner42790482007-12-20 01:56:58 +00002229 // add (select X 0 (sub n A)) A --> select X A n
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002230 {
2231 SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(LHS);
2232 Value *Other = RHS;
2233 if (!SI) {
2234 SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(RHS);
2235 Other = LHS;
2236 }
Chris Lattner42790482007-12-20 01:56:58 +00002237 if (SI && SI->hasOneUse()) {
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002238 Value *TV = SI->getTrueValue();
2239 Value *FV = SI->getFalseValue();
Chris Lattner42790482007-12-20 01:56:58 +00002240 Value *A, *N;
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002241
2242 // Can we fold the add into the argument of the select?
2243 // We check both true and false select arguments for a matching subtract.
Chris Lattner42790482007-12-20 01:56:58 +00002244 if (match(FV, m_Zero()) && match(TV, m_Sub(m_Value(N), m_Value(A))) &&
2245 A == Other) // Fold the add into the true select value.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00002246 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getCondition(), N, A);
Chris Lattner42790482007-12-20 01:56:58 +00002247 if (match(TV, m_Zero()) && match(FV, m_Sub(m_Value(N), m_Value(A))) &&
2248 A == Other) // Fold the add into the false select value.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00002249 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getCondition(), A, N);
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002250 }
2251 }
Chris Lattner2454a2e2008-01-29 06:52:45 +00002252
2253 // Check for X+0.0. Simplify it to X if we know X is not -0.0.
2254 if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHS))
2255 if (CFP->getValueAPF().isPosZero() && CannotBeNegativeZero(LHS))
2256 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Andrew Lenharth16d79552006-09-19 18:24:51 +00002257
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +00002258 // Check for (add (sext x), y), see if we can merge this into an
2259 // integer add followed by a sext.
2260 if (SExtInst *LHSConv = dyn_cast<SExtInst>(LHS)) {
2261 // (add (sext x), cst) --> (sext (add x, cst'))
2262 if (ConstantInt *RHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHS)) {
2263 Constant *CI =
2264 ConstantExpr::getTrunc(RHSC, LHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType());
2265 if (LHSConv->hasOneUse() &&
2266 ConstantExpr::getSExt(CI, I.getType()) == RHSC &&
2267 WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0), CI)) {
2268 // Insert the new, smaller add.
2269 Instruction *NewAdd = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2270 CI, "addconv");
2271 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAdd, I);
2272 return new SExtInst(NewAdd, I.getType());
2273 }
2274 }
2275
2276 // (add (sext x), (sext y)) --> (sext (add int x, y))
2277 if (SExtInst *RHSConv = dyn_cast<SExtInst>(RHS)) {
2278 // Only do this if x/y have the same type, if at last one of them has a
2279 // single use (so we don't increase the number of sexts), and if the
2280 // integer add will not overflow.
2281 if (LHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType()==RHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType()&&
2282 (LHSConv->hasOneUse() || RHSConv->hasOneUse()) &&
2283 WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2284 RHSConv->getOperand(0))) {
2285 // Insert the new integer add.
2286 Instruction *NewAdd = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2287 RHSConv->getOperand(0),
2288 "addconv");
2289 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAdd, I);
2290 return new SExtInst(NewAdd, I.getType());
2291 }
2292 }
2293 }
2294
2295 // Check for (add double (sitofp x), y), see if we can merge this into an
2296 // integer add followed by a promotion.
2297 if (SIToFPInst *LHSConv = dyn_cast<SIToFPInst>(LHS)) {
2298 // (add double (sitofp x), fpcst) --> (sitofp (add int x, intcst))
2299 // ... if the constant fits in the integer value. This is useful for things
2300 // like (double)(x & 1234) + 4.0 -> (double)((X & 1234)+4) which no longer
2301 // requires a constant pool load, and generally allows the add to be better
2302 // instcombined.
2303 if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHS)) {
2304 Constant *CI =
2305 ConstantExpr::getFPToSI(CFP, LHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType());
2306 if (LHSConv->hasOneUse() &&
2307 ConstantExpr::getSIToFP(CI, I.getType()) == CFP &&
2308 WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0), CI)) {
2309 // Insert the new integer add.
2310 Instruction *NewAdd = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2311 CI, "addconv");
2312 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAdd, I);
2313 return new SIToFPInst(NewAdd, I.getType());
2314 }
2315 }
2316
2317 // (add double (sitofp x), (sitofp y)) --> (sitofp (add int x, y))
2318 if (SIToFPInst *RHSConv = dyn_cast<SIToFPInst>(RHS)) {
2319 // Only do this if x/y have the same type, if at last one of them has a
2320 // single use (so we don't increase the number of int->fp conversions),
2321 // and if the integer add will not overflow.
2322 if (LHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType()==RHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType()&&
2323 (LHSConv->hasOneUse() || RHSConv->hasOneUse()) &&
2324 WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2325 RHSConv->getOperand(0))) {
2326 // Insert the new integer add.
2327 Instruction *NewAdd = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2328 RHSConv->getOperand(0),
2329 "addconv");
2330 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAdd, I);
2331 return new SIToFPInst(NewAdd, I.getType());
2332 }
2333 }
2334 }
2335
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002336 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002337}
2338
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002339Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSub(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002340 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002341
Chris Lattnerd137ab42008-07-17 06:07:20 +00002342 if (Op0 == Op1 && // sub X, X -> 0
2343 !I.getType()->isFPOrFPVector())
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00002344 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002345
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00002346 // If this is a 'B = x-(-A)', change to B = x+A...
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00002347 if (Value *V = dyn_castNegVal(Op1))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002348 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Op0, V);
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +00002349
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00002350 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0))
2351 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // undef - X -> undef
2352 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
2353 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X - undef -> undef
2354
Chris Lattnerd65460f2003-11-05 01:06:05 +00002355 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0)) {
2356 // Replace (-1 - A) with (~A)...
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002357 if (C->isAllOnesValue())
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002358 return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Op1);
Chris Lattner40371712002-05-09 01:29:19 +00002359
Chris Lattnerd65460f2003-11-05 01:06:05 +00002360 // C - ~X == X + (1+C)
Reid Spencer4b828e62005-06-18 17:37:34 +00002361 Value *X = 0;
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002362 if (match(Op1, m_Not(m_Value(X))))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002363 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(X, AddOne(C));
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002364
Chris Lattner76b7a062007-01-15 07:02:54 +00002365 // -(X >>u 31) -> (X >>s 31)
2366 // -(X >>s 31) -> (X >>u 31)
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00002367 if (C->isZero()) {
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00002368 if (BinaryOperator *SI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002369 if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00002370 if (ConstantInt *CU = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner9c290672004-03-12 23:53:13 +00002371 // Check to see if we are shifting out everything but the sign bit.
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00002372 if (CU->getLimitedValue(SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) ==
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00002373 SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1) {
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002374 // Ok, the transformation is safe. Insert AShr.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002375 return BinaryOperator::Create(Instruction::AShr,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002376 SI->getOperand(0), CU, SI->getName());
Chris Lattner9c290672004-03-12 23:53:13 +00002377 }
2378 }
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002379 }
2380 else if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) {
2381 if (ConstantInt *CU = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1))) {
2382 // Check to see if we are shifting out everything but the sign bit.
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00002383 if (CU->getLimitedValue(SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) ==
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002384 SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00002385 // Ok, the transformation is safe. Insert LShr.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002386 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002387 SI->getOperand(0), CU, SI->getName());
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002388 }
2389 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00002390 }
2391 }
Chris Lattnerbfe492b2004-03-13 00:11:49 +00002392 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002393
2394 // Try to fold constant sub into select arguments.
2395 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002396 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002397 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00002398
2399 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
2400 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2401 return NV;
Chris Lattnerd65460f2003-11-05 01:06:05 +00002402 }
2403
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002404 if (I.getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
2405 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Op0, Op1);
2406
Chris Lattner43d84d62005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002407 if (BinaryOperator *Op1I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
2408 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add &&
Chris Lattner9919e3d2006-12-02 00:13:08 +00002409 !Op0->getType()->isFPOrFPVector()) {
Chris Lattner08954a22005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002410 if (Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0) // X-(X+Y) == -Y
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002411 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op1I->getOperand(1), I.getName());
Chris Lattner08954a22005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002412 else if (Op1I->getOperand(1) == Op0) // X-(Y+X) == -Y
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002413 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op1I->getOperand(0), I.getName());
Chris Lattner08954a22005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002414 else if (ConstantInt *CI1 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I.getOperand(0))) {
2415 if (ConstantInt *CI2 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1I->getOperand(1)))
2416 // C1-(X+C2) --> (C1-C2)-X
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002417 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(Subtract(CI1, CI2),
Chris Lattner08954a22005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002418 Op1I->getOperand(0));
2419 }
Chris Lattner43d84d62005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002420 }
2421
Chris Lattnerfd059242003-10-15 16:48:29 +00002422 if (Op1I->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002423 // Replace (x - (y - z)) with (x + (z - y)) if the (y - z) subexpression
2424 // is not used by anyone else...
2425 //
Chris Lattner0517e722004-02-02 20:09:56 +00002426 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub &&
Chris Lattner9919e3d2006-12-02 00:13:08 +00002427 !Op1I->getType()->isFPOrFPVector()) {
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002428 // Swap the two operands of the subexpr...
2429 Value *IIOp0 = Op1I->getOperand(0), *IIOp1 = Op1I->getOperand(1);
2430 Op1I->setOperand(0, IIOp1);
2431 Op1I->setOperand(1, IIOp0);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002432
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002433 // Create the new top level add instruction...
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002434 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002435 }
2436
2437 // Replace (A - (A & B)) with (A & ~B) if this is the only use of (A&B)...
2438 //
2439 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And &&
2440 (Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0 || Op1I->getOperand(1) == Op0)) {
2441 Value *OtherOp = Op1I->getOperand(Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0);
2442
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +00002443 Value *NewNot =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002444 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(OtherOp, "B.not"), I);
2445 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, NewNot);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002446 }
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002447
Reid Spencerac5209e2006-10-16 23:08:08 +00002448 // 0 - (X sdiv C) -> (X sdiv -C)
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002449 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::SDiv)
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00002450 if (ConstantInt *CSI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0))
Zhou Sheng843f07672007-04-19 05:39:12 +00002451 if (CSI->isZero())
Chris Lattner91ccc152004-10-06 15:08:25 +00002452 if (Constant *DivRHS = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1I->getOperand(1)))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002453 return BinaryOperator::CreateSDiv(Op1I->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner91ccc152004-10-06 15:08:25 +00002454 ConstantExpr::getNeg(DivRHS));
2455
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002456 // X - X*C --> X * (1-C)
Reid Spencer4b828e62005-06-18 17:37:34 +00002457 ConstantInt *C2 = 0;
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002458 if (dyn_castFoldableMul(Op1I, C2) == Op0) {
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002459 Constant *CP1 = Subtract(ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1), C2);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002460 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Op0, CP1);
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002461 }
Dan Gohman5d066ff2007-09-17 17:31:57 +00002462
2463 // X - ((X / Y) * Y) --> X % Y
2464 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul)
2465 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op1I->getOperand(0)))
2466 if (Op0 == I->getOperand(0) &&
2467 Op1I->getOperand(1) == I->getOperand(1)) {
2468 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::SDiv)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002469 return BinaryOperator::CreateSRem(Op0, Op1I->getOperand(1));
Dan Gohman5d066ff2007-09-17 17:31:57 +00002470 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::UDiv)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002471 return BinaryOperator::CreateURem(Op0, Op1I->getOperand(1));
Dan Gohman5d066ff2007-09-17 17:31:57 +00002472 }
Chris Lattner40371712002-05-09 01:29:19 +00002473 }
Chris Lattner43d84d62005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002474 }
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002475
Chris Lattner9919e3d2006-12-02 00:13:08 +00002476 if (!Op0->getType()->isFPOrFPVector())
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00002477 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner7edc8c22005-04-07 17:14:51 +00002478 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00002479 if (Op0I->getOperand(0) == Op1) // (Y+X)-Y == X
2480 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0I->getOperand(1));
2481 else if (Op0I->getOperand(1) == Op1) // (X+Y)-Y == X
2482 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0I->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner7edc8c22005-04-07 17:14:51 +00002483 } else if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub) {
2484 if (Op0I->getOperand(0) == Op1) // (X-Y)-X == -Y
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002485 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op0I->getOperand(1), I.getName());
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00002486 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00002487 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002488
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002489 ConstantInt *C1;
2490 if (Value *X = dyn_castFoldableMul(Op0, C1)) {
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002491 if (X == Op1) // X*C - X --> X * (C-1)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002492 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Op1, SubOne(C1));
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002493
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002494 ConstantInt *C2; // X*C1 - X*C2 -> X * (C1-C2)
2495 if (X == dyn_castFoldableMul(Op1, C2))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002496 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(X, Subtract(C1, C2));
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002497 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002498 return 0;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002499}
2500
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002501/// isSignBitCheck - Given an exploded icmp instruction, return true if the
2502/// comparison only checks the sign bit. If it only checks the sign bit, set
2503/// TrueIfSigned if the result of the comparison is true when the input value is
2504/// signed.
2505static bool isSignBitCheck(ICmpInst::Predicate pred, ConstantInt *RHS,
2506 bool &TrueIfSigned) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002507 switch (pred) {
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002508 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // True if LHS s< 0
2509 TrueIfSigned = true;
2510 return RHS->isZero();
Chris Lattnercb7122b2007-07-16 04:15:34 +00002511 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE: // True if LHS s<= RHS and RHS == -1
2512 TrueIfSigned = true;
2513 return RHS->isAllOnesValue();
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002514 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // True if LHS s> -1
2515 TrueIfSigned = false;
2516 return RHS->isAllOnesValue();
Chris Lattnercb7122b2007-07-16 04:15:34 +00002517 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
2518 // True if LHS u> RHS and RHS == high-bit-mask - 1
2519 TrueIfSigned = true;
2520 return RHS->getValue() ==
2521 APInt::getSignedMaxValue(RHS->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits());
2522 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
2523 // True if LHS u>= RHS and RHS == high-bit-mask (2^7, 2^15, 2^31, etc)
2524 TrueIfSigned = true;
Chris Lattner833f25d2008-06-02 01:29:46 +00002525 return RHS->getValue().isSignBit();
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002526 default:
2527 return false;
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002528 }
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002529}
2530
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002531Instruction *InstCombiner::visitMul(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00002532 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002533 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002534
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00002535 if (isa<UndefValue>(I.getOperand(1))) // undef * X -> 0
2536 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2537
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00002538 // Simplify mul instructions with a constant RHS...
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002539 if (Constant *Op1 = dyn_cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(1))) {
2540 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnere92d2f42003-08-13 04:18:28 +00002541
2542 // ((X << C1)*C2) == (X * (C2 << C1))
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002543 if (BinaryOperator *SI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
Chris Lattnere92d2f42003-08-13 04:18:28 +00002544 if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
2545 if (Constant *ShOp = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002546 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(SI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002547 ConstantExpr::getShl(CI, ShOp));
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002548
Zhou Sheng843f07672007-04-19 05:39:12 +00002549 if (CI->isZero())
Chris Lattner515c97c2003-09-11 22:24:54 +00002550 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X * 0 == 0
2551 if (CI->equalsInt(1)) // X * 1 == X
2552 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
2553 if (CI->isAllOnesValue()) // X * -1 == 0 - X
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002554 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op0, I.getName());
Chris Lattner6c1ce212002-04-29 22:24:47 +00002555
Zhou Sheng97b52c22007-03-29 01:57:21 +00002556 const APInt& Val = cast<ConstantInt>(CI)->getValue();
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002557 if (Val.isPowerOf2()) { // Replace X*(2^C) with X << C
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002558 return BinaryOperator::CreateShl(Op0,
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002559 ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), Val.logBase2()));
Chris Lattnerbcd7db52005-08-02 19:16:58 +00002560 }
Robert Bocchino71698282004-07-27 21:02:21 +00002561 } else if (ConstantFP *Op1F = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002562 if (Op1F->isNullValue())
2563 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattner6c1ce212002-04-29 22:24:47 +00002564
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002565 // "In IEEE floating point, x*1 is not equivalent to x for nans. However,
2566 // ANSI says we can drop signals, so we can do this anyway." (from GCC)
Chris Lattnerb8cd4d32008-08-11 22:06:05 +00002567 if (Op1F->isExactlyValue(1.0))
2568 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // Eliminate 'mul double %X, 1.0'
2569 } else if (isa<VectorType>(Op1->getType())) {
2570 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(Op1))
2571 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
2572
2573 // As above, vector X*splat(1.0) -> X in all defined cases.
2574 if (ConstantVector *Op1V = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(Op1))
2575 if (ConstantFP *F = dyn_cast_or_null<ConstantFP>(Op1V->getSplatValue()))
2576 if (F->isExactlyValue(1.0))
2577 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002578 }
Chris Lattnerab51f3f2006-03-04 06:04:02 +00002579
2580 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
2581 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add && Op0I->hasOneUse() &&
Chris Lattner47c99092008-05-18 04:11:26 +00002582 isa<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1)) && isa<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnerab51f3f2006-03-04 06:04:02 +00002583 // Canonicalize (X+C1)*C2 -> X*C2+C1*C2.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002584 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Op0I->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnerab51f3f2006-03-04 06:04:02 +00002585 Op1, "tmp");
2586 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, I);
2587 Value *C1C2 = ConstantExpr::getMul(Op1,
2588 cast<Constant>(Op0I->getOperand(1)));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002589 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Add, C1C2);
Chris Lattnerab51f3f2006-03-04 06:04:02 +00002590
2591 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002592
2593 // Try to fold constant mul into select arguments.
2594 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002595 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002596 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00002597
2598 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
2599 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2600 return NV;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002601 }
2602
Chris Lattnera4f445b2003-03-10 23:23:04 +00002603 if (Value *Op0v = dyn_castNegVal(Op0)) // -X * -Y = X*Y
2604 if (Value *Op1v = dyn_castNegVal(I.getOperand(1)))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002605 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Op0v, Op1v);
Chris Lattnera4f445b2003-03-10 23:23:04 +00002606
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002607 if (I.getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
2608 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, I.getOperand(1));
2609
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002610 // If one of the operands of the multiply is a cast from a boolean value, then
2611 // we know the bool is either zero or one, so this is a 'masking' multiply.
2612 // See if we can simplify things based on how the boolean was originally
2613 // formed.
2614 CastInst *BoolCast = 0;
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002615 if (ZExtInst *CI = dyn_cast<ZExtInst>(Op0))
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00002616 if (CI->getOperand(0)->getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002617 BoolCast = CI;
2618 if (!BoolCast)
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00002619 if (ZExtInst *CI = dyn_cast<ZExtInst>(I.getOperand(1)))
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00002620 if (CI->getOperand(0)->getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002621 BoolCast = CI;
2622 if (BoolCast) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002623 if (ICmpInst *SCI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(BoolCast->getOperand(0))) {
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002624 Value *SCIOp0 = SCI->getOperand(0), *SCIOp1 = SCI->getOperand(1);
2625 const Type *SCOpTy = SCIOp0->getType();
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002626 bool TIS = false;
2627
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002628 // If the icmp is true iff the sign bit of X is set, then convert this
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002629 // multiply into a shift/and combination.
2630 if (isa<ConstantInt>(SCIOp1) &&
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002631 isSignBitCheck(SCI->getPredicate(), cast<ConstantInt>(SCIOp1), TIS) &&
2632 TIS) {
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002633 // Shift the X value right to turn it into "all signbits".
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002634 Constant *Amt = ConstantInt::get(SCIOp0->getType(),
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00002635 SCOpTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1);
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002636 Value *V =
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002637 InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002638 BinaryOperator::Create(Instruction::AShr, SCIOp0, Amt,
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002639 BoolCast->getOperand(0)->getName()+
2640 ".mask"), I);
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002641
2642 // If the multiply type is not the same as the source type, sign extend
2643 // or truncate to the multiply type.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00002644 if (I.getType() != V->getType()) {
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00002645 uint32_t SrcBits = V->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
2646 uint32_t DstBits = I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00002647 Instruction::CastOps opcode =
2648 (SrcBits == DstBits ? Instruction::BitCast :
2649 (SrcBits < DstBits ? Instruction::SExt : Instruction::Trunc));
2650 V = InsertCastBefore(opcode, V, I.getType(), I);
2651 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002652
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002653 Value *OtherOp = Op0 == BoolCast ? I.getOperand(1) : Op0;
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002654 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V, OtherOp);
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002655 }
2656 }
2657 }
2658
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002659 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002660}
2661
Chris Lattnerfdb19e52008-07-14 00:15:52 +00002662/// SimplifyDivRemOfSelect - Try to fold a divide or remainder of a select
2663/// instruction.
2664bool InstCombiner::SimplifyDivRemOfSelect(BinaryOperator &I) {
2665 SelectInst *SI = cast<SelectInst>(I.getOperand(1));
2666
2667 // div/rem X, (Cond ? 0 : Y) -> div/rem X, Y
2668 int NonNullOperand = -1;
2669 if (Constant *ST = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
2670 if (ST->isNullValue())
2671 NonNullOperand = 2;
2672 // div/rem X, (Cond ? Y : 0) -> div/rem X, Y
2673 if (Constant *ST = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(2)))
2674 if (ST->isNullValue())
2675 NonNullOperand = 1;
2676
2677 if (NonNullOperand == -1)
2678 return false;
2679
2680 Value *SelectCond = SI->getOperand(0);
2681
2682 // Change the div/rem to use 'Y' instead of the select.
2683 I.setOperand(1, SI->getOperand(NonNullOperand));
2684
2685 // Okay, we know we replace the operand of the div/rem with 'Y' with no
2686 // problem. However, the select, or the condition of the select may have
2687 // multiple uses. Based on our knowledge that the operand must be non-zero,
2688 // propagate the known value for the select into other uses of it, and
2689 // propagate a known value of the condition into its other users.
2690
2691 // If the select and condition only have a single use, don't bother with this,
2692 // early exit.
2693 if (SI->use_empty() && SelectCond->hasOneUse())
2694 return true;
2695
2696 // Scan the current block backward, looking for other uses of SI.
2697 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = &I, BBFront = I.getParent()->begin();
2698
2699 while (BBI != BBFront) {
2700 --BBI;
2701 // If we found a call to a function, we can't assume it will return, so
2702 // information from below it cannot be propagated above it.
2703 if (isa<CallInst>(BBI) && !isa<IntrinsicInst>(BBI))
2704 break;
2705
2706 // Replace uses of the select or its condition with the known values.
2707 for (Instruction::op_iterator I = BBI->op_begin(), E = BBI->op_end();
2708 I != E; ++I) {
2709 if (*I == SI) {
2710 *I = SI->getOperand(NonNullOperand);
2711 AddToWorkList(BBI);
2712 } else if (*I == SelectCond) {
2713 *I = NonNullOperand == 1 ? ConstantInt::getTrue() :
2714 ConstantInt::getFalse();
2715 AddToWorkList(BBI);
2716 }
2717 }
2718
2719 // If we past the instruction, quit looking for it.
2720 if (&*BBI == SI)
2721 SI = 0;
2722 if (&*BBI == SelectCond)
2723 SelectCond = 0;
2724
2725 // If we ran out of things to eliminate, break out of the loop.
2726 if (SelectCond == 0 && SI == 0)
2727 break;
2728
2729 }
2730 return true;
2731}
2732
2733
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002734/// This function implements the transforms on div instructions that work
2735/// regardless of the kind of div instruction it is (udiv, sdiv, or fdiv). It is
2736/// used by the visitors to those instructions.
2737/// @brief Transforms common to all three div instructions
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002738Instruction *InstCombiner::commonDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002739 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00002740
Chris Lattner50b2ca42008-02-19 06:12:18 +00002741 // undef / X -> 0 for integer.
2742 // undef / X -> undef for FP (the undef could be a snan).
2743 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0)) {
2744 if (Op0->getType()->isFPOrFPVector())
2745 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002746 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner50b2ca42008-02-19 06:12:18 +00002747 }
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002748
2749 // X / undef -> undef
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002750 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002751 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002752
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002753 return 0;
2754}
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002755
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002756/// This function implements the transforms common to both integer division
2757/// instructions (udiv and sdiv). It is called by the visitors to those integer
2758/// division instructions.
2759/// @brief Common integer divide transforms
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002760Instruction *InstCombiner::commonIDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002761 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2762
Chris Lattnerb2ae9e32008-05-16 02:59:42 +00002763 // (sdiv X, X) --> 1 (udiv X, X) --> 1
Nick Lewycky39ac3b52008-05-23 03:26:47 +00002764 if (Op0 == Op1) {
2765 if (const VectorType *Ty = dyn_cast<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
2766 ConstantInt *CI = ConstantInt::get(Ty->getElementType(), 1);
2767 std::vector<Constant*> Elts(Ty->getNumElements(), CI);
2768 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantVector::get(Elts));
2769 }
2770
2771 ConstantInt *CI = ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1);
2772 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, CI);
2773 }
Chris Lattnerb2ae9e32008-05-16 02:59:42 +00002774
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002775 if (Instruction *Common = commonDivTransforms(I))
2776 return Common;
Chris Lattnerfdb19e52008-07-14 00:15:52 +00002777
2778 // Handle cases involving: [su]div X, (select Cond, Y, Z)
2779 // This does not apply for fdiv.
2780 if (isa<SelectInst>(Op1) && SimplifyDivRemOfSelect(I))
2781 return &I;
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002782
2783 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
2784 // div X, 1 == X
2785 if (RHS->equalsInt(1))
2786 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
2787
2788 // (X / C1) / C2 -> X / (C1*C2)
2789 if (Instruction *LHS = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
2790 if (Instruction::BinaryOps(LHS->getOpcode()) == I.getOpcode())
2791 if (ConstantInt *LHSRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHS->getOperand(1))) {
Nick Lewyckye0cfecf2008-02-18 22:48:05 +00002792 if (MultiplyOverflows(RHS, LHSRHS, I.getOpcode()==Instruction::SDiv))
2793 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2794 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002795 return BinaryOperator::Create(I.getOpcode(), LHS->getOperand(0),
Nick Lewyckye0cfecf2008-02-18 22:48:05 +00002796 Multiply(RHS, LHSRHS));
Chris Lattnerbf70b832005-04-08 04:03:26 +00002797 }
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002798
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002799 if (!RHS->isZero()) { // avoid X udiv 0
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002800 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
2801 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
2802 return R;
2803 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
2804 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2805 return NV;
2806 }
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002807 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002808
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002809 // 0 / X == 0, we don't need to preserve faults!
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002810 if (ConstantInt *LHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0))
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002811 if (LHS->equalsInt(0))
2812 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2813
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002814 // It can't be division by zero, hence it must be division by one.
2815 if (I.getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
2816 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
2817
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002818 return 0;
2819}
2820
2821Instruction *InstCombiner::visitUDiv(BinaryOperator &I) {
2822 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2823
2824 // Handle the integer div common cases
2825 if (Instruction *Common = commonIDivTransforms(I))
2826 return Common;
2827
2828 // X udiv C^2 -> X >> C
2829 // Check to see if this is an unsigned division with an exact power of 2,
2830 // if so, convert to a right shift.
2831 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencer6eb0d992007-03-26 23:58:26 +00002832 if (C->getValue().isPowerOf2()) // 0 not included in isPowerOf2
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002833 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(Op0,
Zhou Sheng0fc50952007-03-25 05:01:29 +00002834 ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), C->getValue().logBase2()));
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002835 }
2836
2837 // X udiv (C1 << N), where C1 is "1<<C2" --> X >> (N+C2)
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002838 if (BinaryOperator *RHSI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I.getOperand(1))) {
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002839 if (RHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl &&
2840 isa<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002841 const APInt& C1 = cast<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))->getValue();
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002842 if (C1.isPowerOf2()) {
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002843 Value *N = RHSI->getOperand(1);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002844 const Type *NTy = N->getType();
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002845 if (uint32_t C2 = C1.logBase2()) {
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002846 Constant *C2V = ConstantInt::get(NTy, C2);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002847 N = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(N, C2V, "tmp"), I);
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002848 }
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002849 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(Op0, N);
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002850 }
2851 }
Chris Lattnerc812e5d2005-11-05 07:40:31 +00002852 }
2853
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002854 // udiv X, (Select Cond, C1, C2) --> Select Cond, (shr X, C1), (shr X, C2)
2855 // where C1&C2 are powers of two.
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002856 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002857 if (ConstantInt *STO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1)))
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002858 if (ConstantInt *SFO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(2))) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002859 const APInt &TVA = STO->getValue(), &FVA = SFO->getValue();
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002860 if (TVA.isPowerOf2() && FVA.isPowerOf2()) {
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002861 // Compute the shift amounts
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002862 uint32_t TSA = TVA.logBase2(), FSA = FVA.logBase2();
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002863 // Construct the "on true" case of the select
2864 Constant *TC = ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), TSA);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002865 Instruction *TSI = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002866 Op0, TC, SI->getName()+".t");
2867 TSI = InsertNewInstBefore(TSI, I);
2868
2869 // Construct the "on false" case of the select
2870 Constant *FC = ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), FSA);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002871 Instruction *FSI = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002872 Op0, FC, SI->getName()+".f");
2873 FSI = InsertNewInstBefore(FSI, I);
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002874
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002875 // construct the select instruction and return it.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00002876 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getOperand(0), TSI, FSI, SI->getName());
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002877 }
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002878 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002879 return 0;
2880}
2881
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002882Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSDiv(BinaryOperator &I) {
2883 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2884
2885 // Handle the integer div common cases
2886 if (Instruction *Common = commonIDivTransforms(I))
2887 return Common;
2888
2889 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
2890 // sdiv X, -1 == -X
2891 if (RHS->isAllOnesValue())
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002892 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op0);
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002893
2894 // -X/C -> X/-C
2895 if (Value *LHSNeg = dyn_castNegVal(Op0))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002896 return BinaryOperator::CreateSDiv(LHSNeg, ConstantExpr::getNeg(RHS));
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002897 }
2898
2899 // If the sign bits of both operands are zero (i.e. we can prove they are
2900 // unsigned inputs), turn this into a udiv.
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00002901 if (I.getType()->isInteger()) {
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002902 APInt Mask(APInt::getSignBit(I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()));
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002903 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op1, Mask) && MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, Mask)) {
Dan Gohmancff55092007-11-05 23:16:33 +00002904 // X sdiv Y -> X udiv Y, iff X and Y don't have sign bit set
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002905 return BinaryOperator::CreateUDiv(Op0, Op1, I.getName());
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002906 }
2907 }
2908
2909 return 0;
2910}
2911
2912Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFDiv(BinaryOperator &I) {
2913 return commonDivTransforms(I);
2914}
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002915
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002916/// This function implements the transforms on rem instructions that work
2917/// regardless of the kind of rem instruction it is (urem, srem, or frem). It
2918/// is used by the visitors to those instructions.
2919/// @brief Transforms common to all three rem instructions
2920Instruction *InstCombiner::commonRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002921 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002922
Chris Lattner50b2ca42008-02-19 06:12:18 +00002923 // 0 % X == 0 for integer, we don't need to preserve faults!
Chris Lattner19ccd5c2006-02-28 05:30:45 +00002924 if (Constant *LHS = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op0))
2925 if (LHS->isNullValue())
2926 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2927
Chris Lattner50b2ca42008-02-19 06:12:18 +00002928 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0)) { // undef % X -> 0
2929 if (I.getType()->isFPOrFPVector())
2930 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // X % undef -> undef (could be SNaN)
Chris Lattner19ccd5c2006-02-28 05:30:45 +00002931 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner50b2ca42008-02-19 06:12:18 +00002932 }
Chris Lattner19ccd5c2006-02-28 05:30:45 +00002933 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
2934 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X % undef -> undef
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002935
2936 // Handle cases involving: rem X, (select Cond, Y, Z)
Chris Lattnerfdb19e52008-07-14 00:15:52 +00002937 if (isa<SelectInst>(Op1) && SimplifyDivRemOfSelect(I))
2938 return &I;
Chris Lattner5b73c082004-07-06 07:01:22 +00002939
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002940 return 0;
2941}
2942
2943/// This function implements the transforms common to both integer remainder
2944/// instructions (urem and srem). It is called by the visitors to those integer
2945/// remainder instructions.
2946/// @brief Common integer remainder transforms
2947Instruction *InstCombiner::commonIRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
2948 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2949
2950 if (Instruction *common = commonRemTransforms(I))
2951 return common;
2952
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002953 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner19ccd5c2006-02-28 05:30:45 +00002954 // X % 0 == undef, we don't need to preserve faults!
2955 if (RHS->equalsInt(0))
2956 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, UndefValue::get(I.getType()));
2957
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002958 if (RHS->equalsInt(1)) // X % 1 == 0
2959 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2960
Chris Lattner97943922006-02-28 05:49:21 +00002961 if (Instruction *Op0I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0)) {
2962 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0I)) {
2963 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
2964 return R;
2965 } else if (isa<PHINode>(Op0I)) {
2966 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2967 return NV;
Chris Lattner97943922006-02-28 05:49:21 +00002968 }
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00002969
2970 // See if we can fold away this rem instruction.
2971 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())->getBitWidth();
2972 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
2973 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
2974 KnownZero, KnownOne))
2975 return &I;
Chris Lattner97943922006-02-28 05:49:21 +00002976 }
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002977 }
2978
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002979 return 0;
2980}
2981
2982Instruction *InstCombiner::visitURem(BinaryOperator &I) {
2983 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2984
2985 if (Instruction *common = commonIRemTransforms(I))
2986 return common;
2987
2988 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
2989 // X urem C^2 -> X and C
2990 // Check to see if this is an unsigned remainder with an exact power of 2,
2991 // if so, convert to a bitwise and.
2992 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHS))
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002993 if (C->getValue().isPowerOf2())
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002994 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, SubOne(C));
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002995 }
2996
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002997 if (Instruction *RHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(I.getOperand(1))) {
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002998 // Turn A % (C << N), where C is 2^k, into A & ((C << N)-1)
2999 if (RHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl &&
3000 isa<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))) {
Zhou Sheng0fc50952007-03-25 05:01:29 +00003001 if (cast<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))->getValue().isPowerOf2()) {
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00003002 Constant *N1 = ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(I.getType());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003003 Value *Add = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(RHSI, N1,
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00003004 "tmp"), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003005 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, Add);
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00003006 }
3007 }
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003008 }
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00003009
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003010 // urem X, (select Cond, 2^C1, 2^C2) --> select Cond, (and X, C1), (and X, C2)
3011 // where C1&C2 are powers of two.
3012 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1)) {
3013 if (ConstantInt *STO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1)))
3014 if (ConstantInt *SFO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(2))) {
3015 // STO == 0 and SFO == 0 handled above.
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00003016 if ((STO->getValue().isPowerOf2()) &&
3017 (SFO->getValue().isPowerOf2())) {
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003018 Value *TrueAnd = InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003019 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, SubOne(STO), SI->getName()+".t"), I);
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003020 Value *FalseAnd = InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003021 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, SubOne(SFO), SI->getName()+".f"), I);
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00003022 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getOperand(0), TrueAnd, FalseAnd);
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003023 }
3024 }
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00003025 }
3026
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003027 return 0;
3028}
3029
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003030Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSRem(BinaryOperator &I) {
3031 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
3032
Dan Gohmancff55092007-11-05 23:16:33 +00003033 // Handle the integer rem common cases
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003034 if (Instruction *common = commonIRemTransforms(I))
3035 return common;
3036
3037 if (Value *RHSNeg = dyn_castNegVal(Op1))
Nick Lewycky23c04302008-09-03 06:24:21 +00003038 if (!isa<Constant>(RHSNeg) ||
3039 (isa<ConstantInt>(RHSNeg) &&
3040 cast<ConstantInt>(RHSNeg)->getValue().isStrictlyPositive())) {
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003041 // X % -Y -> X % Y
3042 AddUsesToWorkList(I);
3043 I.setOperand(1, RHSNeg);
3044 return &I;
3045 }
Nick Lewyckya06cf822008-09-30 06:08:34 +00003046
Dan Gohmancff55092007-11-05 23:16:33 +00003047 // If the sign bits of both operands are zero (i.e. we can prove they are
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003048 // unsigned inputs), turn this into a urem.
Dan Gohmancff55092007-11-05 23:16:33 +00003049 if (I.getType()->isInteger()) {
3050 APInt Mask(APInt::getSignBit(I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()));
3051 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op1, Mask) && MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, Mask)) {
3052 // X srem Y -> X urem Y, iff X and Y don't have sign bit set
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003053 return BinaryOperator::CreateURem(Op0, Op1, I.getName());
Dan Gohmancff55092007-11-05 23:16:33 +00003054 }
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003055 }
3056
3057 return 0;
3058}
3059
3060Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFRem(BinaryOperator &I) {
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003061 return commonRemTransforms(I);
3062}
3063
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00003064// isOneBitSet - Return true if there is exactly one bit set in the specified
3065// constant.
3066static bool isOneBitSet(const ConstantInt *CI) {
Reid Spencer5f6a8952007-03-20 00:16:52 +00003067 return CI->getValue().isPowerOf2();
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00003068}
3069
Chris Lattnerb20ba0a2004-09-23 21:46:38 +00003070// isHighOnes - Return true if the constant is of the form 1+0+.
3071// This is the same as lowones(~X).
3072static bool isHighOnes(const ConstantInt *CI) {
Zhou Sheng2cde46c2007-03-20 12:49:06 +00003073 return (~CI->getValue() + 1).isPowerOf2();
Chris Lattnerb20ba0a2004-09-23 21:46:38 +00003074}
3075
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003076/// getICmpCode - Encode a icmp predicate into a three bit mask. These bits
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003077/// are carefully arranged to allow folding of expressions such as:
3078///
3079/// (A < B) | (A > B) --> (A != B)
3080///
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003081/// Note that this is only valid if the first and second predicates have the
3082/// same sign. Is illegal to do: (A u< B) | (A s> B)
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003083///
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003084/// Three bits are used to represent the condition, as follows:
3085/// 0 A > B
3086/// 1 A == B
3087/// 2 A < B
3088///
3089/// <=> Value Definition
3090/// 000 0 Always false
3091/// 001 1 A > B
3092/// 010 2 A == B
3093/// 011 3 A >= B
3094/// 100 4 A < B
3095/// 101 5 A != B
3096/// 110 6 A <= B
3097/// 111 7 Always true
3098///
3099static unsigned getICmpCode(const ICmpInst *ICI) {
3100 switch (ICI->getPredicate()) {
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003101 // False -> 0
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003102 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: return 1; // 001
3103 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: return 1; // 001
3104 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: return 2; // 010
3105 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE: return 3; // 011
3106 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE: return 3; // 011
3107 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: return 4; // 100
3108 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: return 4; // 100
3109 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: return 5; // 101
3110 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE: return 6; // 110
3111 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE: return 6; // 110
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003112 // True -> 7
3113 default:
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003114 assert(0 && "Invalid ICmp predicate!");
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003115 return 0;
3116 }
3117}
3118
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003119/// getFCmpCode - Similar to getICmpCode but for FCmpInst. This encodes a fcmp
3120/// predicate into a three bit mask. It also returns whether it is an ordered
3121/// predicate by reference.
3122static unsigned getFCmpCode(FCmpInst::Predicate CC, bool &isOrdered) {
3123 isOrdered = false;
3124 switch (CC) {
3125 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD: isOrdered = true; return 0; // 000
3126 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO: return 0; // 000
Evan Cheng4990b252008-10-14 18:13:38 +00003127 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGT: isOrdered = true; return 1; // 001
3128 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGT: return 1; // 001
3129 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ: isOrdered = true; return 2; // 010
3130 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UEQ: return 2; // 010
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003131 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE: isOrdered = true; return 3; // 011
3132 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGE: return 3; // 011
3133 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLT: isOrdered = true; return 4; // 100
3134 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULT: return 4; // 100
Evan Cheng4990b252008-10-14 18:13:38 +00003135 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE: isOrdered = true; return 5; // 101
3136 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNE: return 5; // 101
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003137 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE: isOrdered = true; return 6; // 110
3138 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULE: return 6; // 110
Evan Cheng40300622008-10-14 18:44:08 +00003139 // True -> 7
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003140 default:
3141 // Not expecting FCMP_FALSE and FCMP_TRUE;
3142 assert(0 && "Unexpected FCmp predicate!");
3143 return 0;
3144 }
3145}
3146
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003147/// getICmpValue - This is the complement of getICmpCode, which turns an
3148/// opcode and two operands into either a constant true or false, or a brand
Dan Gohman5d066ff2007-09-17 17:31:57 +00003149/// new ICmp instruction. The sign is passed in to determine which kind
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003150/// of predicate to use in the new icmp instruction.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003151static Value *getICmpValue(bool sign, unsigned code, Value *LHS, Value *RHS) {
3152 switch (code) {
3153 default: assert(0 && "Illegal ICmp code!");
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003154 case 0: return ConstantInt::getFalse();
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003155 case 1:
3156 if (sign)
3157 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, LHS, RHS);
3158 else
3159 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, LHS, RHS);
3160 case 2: return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, LHS, RHS);
3161 case 3:
3162 if (sign)
3163 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE, LHS, RHS);
3164 else
3165 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, LHS, RHS);
3166 case 4:
3167 if (sign)
3168 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, LHS, RHS);
3169 else
3170 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, LHS, RHS);
3171 case 5: return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, LHS, RHS);
3172 case 6:
3173 if (sign)
3174 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE, LHS, RHS);
3175 else
3176 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE, LHS, RHS);
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003177 case 7: return ConstantInt::getTrue();
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003178 }
3179}
3180
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003181/// getFCmpValue - This is the complement of getFCmpCode, which turns an
3182/// opcode and two operands into either a FCmp instruction. isordered is passed
3183/// in to determine which kind of predicate to use in the new fcmp instruction.
3184static Value *getFCmpValue(bool isordered, unsigned code,
3185 Value *LHS, Value *RHS) {
3186 switch (code) {
Evan Cheng4990b252008-10-14 18:13:38 +00003187 default: assert(0 && "Illegal FCmp code!");
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003188 case 0:
3189 if (isordered)
3190 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD, LHS, RHS);
3191 else
3192 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO, LHS, RHS);
3193 case 1:
3194 if (isordered)
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003195 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_OGT, LHS, RHS);
3196 else
3197 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_UGT, LHS, RHS);
Evan Cheng4990b252008-10-14 18:13:38 +00003198 case 2:
3199 if (isordered)
3200 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ, LHS, RHS);
3201 else
3202 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_UEQ, LHS, RHS);
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003203 case 3:
3204 if (isordered)
3205 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE, LHS, RHS);
3206 else
3207 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_UGE, LHS, RHS);
3208 case 4:
3209 if (isordered)
3210 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_OLT, LHS, RHS);
3211 else
3212 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_ULT, LHS, RHS);
3213 case 5:
3214 if (isordered)
Evan Cheng4990b252008-10-14 18:13:38 +00003215 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE, LHS, RHS);
3216 else
3217 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_UNE, LHS, RHS);
3218 case 6:
3219 if (isordered)
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003220 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE, LHS, RHS);
3221 else
3222 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_ULE, LHS, RHS);
Evan Cheng40300622008-10-14 18:44:08 +00003223 case 7: return ConstantInt::getTrue();
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003224 }
3225}
3226
3227
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003228static bool PredicatesFoldable(ICmpInst::Predicate p1, ICmpInst::Predicate p2) {
3229 return (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p1) == ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p2)) ||
3230 (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p1) &&
3231 (p2 == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ || p2 == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)) ||
3232 (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p2) &&
3233 (p1 == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ || p1 == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE));
3234}
3235
3236namespace {
3237// FoldICmpLogical - Implements (icmp1 A, B) & (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
3238struct FoldICmpLogical {
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003239 InstCombiner &IC;
3240 Value *LHS, *RHS;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003241 ICmpInst::Predicate pred;
3242 FoldICmpLogical(InstCombiner &ic, ICmpInst *ICI)
3243 : IC(ic), LHS(ICI->getOperand(0)), RHS(ICI->getOperand(1)),
3244 pred(ICI->getPredicate()) {}
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003245 bool shouldApply(Value *V) const {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003246 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(V))
3247 if (PredicatesFoldable(pred, ICI->getPredicate()))
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00003248 return ((ICI->getOperand(0) == LHS && ICI->getOperand(1) == RHS) ||
3249 (ICI->getOperand(0) == RHS && ICI->getOperand(1) == LHS));
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003250 return false;
3251 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003252 Instruction *apply(Instruction &Log) const {
3253 ICmpInst *ICI = cast<ICmpInst>(Log.getOperand(0));
3254 if (ICI->getOperand(0) != LHS) {
3255 assert(ICI->getOperand(1) == LHS);
3256 ICI->swapOperands(); // Swap the LHS and RHS of the ICmp
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003257 }
3258
Chris Lattnerbc1dbfc2007-03-13 14:27:42 +00003259 ICmpInst *RHSICI = cast<ICmpInst>(Log.getOperand(1));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003260 unsigned LHSCode = getICmpCode(ICI);
Chris Lattnerbc1dbfc2007-03-13 14:27:42 +00003261 unsigned RHSCode = getICmpCode(RHSICI);
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003262 unsigned Code;
3263 switch (Log.getOpcode()) {
3264 case Instruction::And: Code = LHSCode & RHSCode; break;
3265 case Instruction::Or: Code = LHSCode | RHSCode; break;
3266 case Instruction::Xor: Code = LHSCode ^ RHSCode; break;
Chris Lattner021c1902003-09-22 20:33:34 +00003267 default: assert(0 && "Illegal logical opcode!"); return 0;
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003268 }
3269
Chris Lattnerbc1dbfc2007-03-13 14:27:42 +00003270 bool isSigned = ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(RHSICI->getPredicate()) ||
3271 ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(ICI->getPredicate());
3272
3273 Value *RV = getICmpValue(isSigned, Code, LHS, RHS);
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003274 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(RV))
3275 return I;
3276 // Otherwise, it's a constant boolean value...
3277 return IC.ReplaceInstUsesWith(Log, RV);
3278 }
3279};
Chris Lattnerd23b5ba2006-11-15 04:53:24 +00003280} // end anonymous namespace
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003281
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003282// OptAndOp - This handles expressions of the form ((val OP C1) & C2). Where
3283// the Op parameter is 'OP', OpRHS is 'C1', and AndRHS is 'C2'. Op is
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003284// guaranteed to be a binary operator.
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003285Instruction *InstCombiner::OptAndOp(Instruction *Op,
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003286 ConstantInt *OpRHS,
3287 ConstantInt *AndRHS,
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003288 BinaryOperator &TheAnd) {
3289 Value *X = Op->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner76f7fe22004-01-12 19:47:05 +00003290 Constant *Together = 0;
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003291 if (!Op->isShift())
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00003292 Together = And(AndRHS, OpRHS);
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00003293
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003294 switch (Op->getOpcode()) {
3295 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003296 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003297 // (X ^ C1) & C2 --> (X & C2) ^ (C1&C2)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003298 Instruction *And = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003299 InsertNewInstBefore(And, TheAnd);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003300 And->takeName(Op);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003301 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(And, Together);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003302 }
3303 break;
3304 case Instruction::Or:
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003305 if (Together == AndRHS) // (X | C) & C --> C
3306 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(TheAnd, AndRHS);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003307
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003308 if (Op->hasOneUse() && Together != OpRHS) {
3309 // (X | C1) & C2 --> (X | (C1&C2)) & C2
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003310 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(X, Together);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003311 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, TheAnd);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003312 Or->takeName(Op);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003313 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Or, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003314 }
3315 break;
3316 case Instruction::Add:
Chris Lattnerfd059242003-10-15 16:48:29 +00003317 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003318 // Adding a one to a single bit bit-field should be turned into an XOR
3319 // of the bit. First thing to check is to see if this AND is with a
3320 // single bit constant.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003321 const APInt& AndRHSV = cast<ConstantInt>(AndRHS)->getValue();
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003322
3323 // If there is only one bit set...
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00003324 if (isOneBitSet(cast<ConstantInt>(AndRHS))) {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003325 // Ok, at this point, we know that we are masking the result of the
3326 // ADD down to exactly one bit. If the constant we are adding has
3327 // no bits set below this bit, then we can eliminate the ADD.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003328 const APInt& AddRHS = cast<ConstantInt>(OpRHS)->getValue();
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003329
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003330 // Check to see if any bits below the one bit set in AndRHSV are set.
3331 if ((AddRHS & (AndRHSV-1)) == 0) {
3332 // If not, the only thing that can effect the output of the AND is
3333 // the bit specified by AndRHSV. If that bit is set, the effect of
3334 // the XOR is to toggle the bit. If it is clear, then the ADD has
3335 // no effect.
3336 if ((AddRHS & AndRHSV) == 0) { // Bit is not set, noop
3337 TheAnd.setOperand(0, X);
3338 return &TheAnd;
3339 } else {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003340 // Pull the XOR out of the AND.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003341 Instruction *NewAnd = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003342 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAnd, TheAnd);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003343 NewAnd->takeName(Op);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003344 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(NewAnd, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003345 }
3346 }
3347 }
3348 }
3349 break;
Chris Lattner62a355c2003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003350
3351 case Instruction::Shl: {
3352 // We know that the AND will not produce any of the bits shifted in, so if
3353 // the anded constant includes them, clear them now!
3354 //
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003355 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHS->getType()->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003356 uint32_t OpRHSVal = OpRHS->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003357 APInt ShlMask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-OpRHSVal));
3358 ConstantInt *CI = ConstantInt::get(AndRHS->getValue() & ShlMask);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003359
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003360 if (CI->getValue() == ShlMask) {
3361 // Masking out bits that the shift already masks
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +00003362 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(TheAnd, Op); // No need for the and.
3363 } else if (CI != AndRHS) { // Reducing bits set in and.
Chris Lattner62a355c2003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003364 TheAnd.setOperand(1, CI);
3365 return &TheAnd;
3366 }
3367 break;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003368 }
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00003369 case Instruction::LShr:
3370 {
Chris Lattner62a355c2003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003371 // We know that the AND will not produce any of the bits shifted in, so if
3372 // the anded constant includes them, clear them now! This only applies to
3373 // unsigned shifts, because a signed shr may bring in set bits!
3374 //
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003375 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHS->getType()->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003376 uint32_t OpRHSVal = OpRHS->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003377 APInt ShrMask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - OpRHSVal));
3378 ConstantInt *CI = ConstantInt::get(AndRHS->getValue() & ShrMask);
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +00003379
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003380 if (CI->getValue() == ShrMask) {
3381 // Masking out bits that the shift already masks.
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00003382 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(TheAnd, Op);
3383 } else if (CI != AndRHS) {
3384 TheAnd.setOperand(1, CI); // Reduce bits set in and cst.
3385 return &TheAnd;
3386 }
3387 break;
3388 }
3389 case Instruction::AShr:
3390 // Signed shr.
3391 // See if this is shifting in some sign extension, then masking it out
3392 // with an and.
3393 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003394 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHS->getType()->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003395 uint32_t OpRHSVal = OpRHS->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003396 APInt ShrMask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - OpRHSVal));
3397 Constant *C = ConstantInt::get(AndRHS->getValue() & ShrMask);
Reid Spencer7eb76382006-12-13 17:19:09 +00003398 if (C == AndRHS) { // Masking out bits shifted in.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00003399 // (Val ashr C1) & C2 -> (Val lshr C1) & C2
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00003400 // Make the argument unsigned.
3401 Value *ShVal = Op->getOperand(0);
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003402 ShVal = InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003403 BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(ShVal, OpRHS,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003404 Op->getName()), TheAnd);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003405 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(ShVal, AndRHS, TheAnd.getName());
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +00003406 }
Chris Lattner62a355c2003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003407 }
3408 break;
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003409 }
3410 return 0;
3411}
3412
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00003413
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003414/// InsertRangeTest - Emit a computation of: (V >= Lo && V < Hi) if Inside is
3415/// true, otherwise (V < Lo || V >= Hi). In pratice, we emit the more efficient
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003416/// (V-Lo) <u Hi-Lo. This method expects that Lo <= Hi. isSigned indicates
3417/// whether to treat the V, Lo and HI as signed or not. IB is the location to
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003418/// insert new instructions.
3419Instruction *InstCombiner::InsertRangeTest(Value *V, Constant *Lo, Constant *Hi,
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003420 bool isSigned, bool Inside,
3421 Instruction &IB) {
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003422 assert(cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getICmp((isSigned ?
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00003423 ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE), Lo, Hi))->getZExtValue() &&
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003424 "Lo is not <= Hi in range emission code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003425
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003426 if (Inside) {
3427 if (Lo == Hi) // Trivially false.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003428 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, V, V);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003429
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003430 // V >= Min && V < Hi --> V < Hi
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003431 if (cast<ConstantInt>(Lo)->isMinValue(isSigned)) {
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00003432 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = (isSigned ?
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003433 ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT : ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT);
3434 return new ICmpInst(pred, V, Hi);
3435 }
3436
3437 // Emit V-Lo <u Hi-Lo
3438 Constant *NegLo = ConstantExpr::getNeg(Lo);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003439 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(V, NegLo, V->getName()+".off");
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003440 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, IB);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003441 Constant *UpperBound = ConstantExpr::getAdd(NegLo, Hi);
3442 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Add, UpperBound);
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003443 }
3444
3445 if (Lo == Hi) // Trivially true.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003446 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, V, V);
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003447
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00003448 // V < Min || V >= Hi -> V > Hi-1
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003449 Hi = SubOne(cast<ConstantInt>(Hi));
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003450 if (cast<ConstantInt>(Lo)->isMinValue(isSigned)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003451 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = (isSigned ?
3452 ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT : ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT);
3453 return new ICmpInst(pred, V, Hi);
3454 }
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00003455
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00003456 // Emit V-Lo >u Hi-1-Lo
3457 // Note that Hi has already had one subtracted from it, above.
3458 ConstantInt *NegLo = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(Lo));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003459 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(V, NegLo, V->getName()+".off");
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003460 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, IB);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003461 Constant *LowerBound = ConstantExpr::getAdd(NegLo, Hi);
3462 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, Add, LowerBound);
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003463}
3464
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003465// isRunOfOnes - Returns true iff Val consists of one contiguous run of 1s with
3466// any number of 0s on either side. The 1s are allowed to wrap from LSB to
3467// MSB, so 0x000FFF0, 0x0000FFFF, and 0xFF0000FF are all runs. 0x0F0F0000 is
3468// not, since all 1s are not contiguous.
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00003469static bool isRunOfOnes(ConstantInt *Val, uint32_t &MB, uint32_t &ME) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003470 const APInt& V = Val->getValue();
Reid Spencerf2442522007-03-24 00:42:08 +00003471 uint32_t BitWidth = Val->getType()->getBitWidth();
3472 if (!APIntOps::isShiftedMask(BitWidth, V)) return false;
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003473
3474 // look for the first zero bit after the run of ones
Reid Spencerf2442522007-03-24 00:42:08 +00003475 MB = BitWidth - ((V - 1) ^ V).countLeadingZeros();
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003476 // look for the first non-zero bit
Reid Spencerf2442522007-03-24 00:42:08 +00003477 ME = V.getActiveBits();
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003478 return true;
3479}
3480
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003481/// FoldLogicalPlusAnd - This is part of an expression (LHS +/- RHS) & Mask,
3482/// where isSub determines whether the operator is a sub. If we can fold one of
3483/// the following xforms:
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003484///
3485/// ((A & N) +/- B) & Mask -> (A +/- B) & Mask iff N&Mask == Mask
3486/// ((A | N) +/- B) & Mask -> (A +/- B) & Mask iff N&Mask == 0
3487/// ((A ^ N) +/- B) & Mask -> (A +/- B) & Mask iff N&Mask == 0
3488///
3489/// return (A +/- B).
3490///
3491Value *InstCombiner::FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS,
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003492 ConstantInt *Mask, bool isSub,
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003493 Instruction &I) {
3494 Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHS);
3495 if (!LHSI || LHSI->getNumOperands() != 2 ||
3496 !isa<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) return 0;
3497
3498 ConstantInt *N = cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
3499
3500 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
3501 default: return 0;
3502 case Instruction::And:
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00003503 if (And(N, Mask) == Mask) {
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003504 // If the AndRHS is a power of two minus one (0+1+), this is simple.
Zhou Sheng00f436c2007-03-24 15:34:37 +00003505 if ((Mask->getValue().countLeadingZeros() +
3506 Mask->getValue().countPopulation()) ==
3507 Mask->getValue().getBitWidth())
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003508 break;
3509
3510 // Otherwise, if Mask is 0+1+0+, and if B is known to have the low 0+
3511 // part, we don't need any explicit masks to take them out of A. If that
3512 // is all N is, ignore it.
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00003513 uint32_t MB = 0, ME = 0;
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003514 if (isRunOfOnes(Mask, MB, ME)) { // begin/end bit of run, inclusive
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00003515 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(RHS->getType())->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003516 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, MB-1));
Chris Lattner3bedbd92006-02-07 07:27:52 +00003517 if (MaskedValueIsZero(RHS, Mask))
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003518 break;
3519 }
3520 }
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003521 return 0;
3522 case Instruction::Or:
3523 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003524 // If the AndRHS is a power of two minus one (0+1+), and N&Mask == 0
Zhou Sheng00f436c2007-03-24 15:34:37 +00003525 if ((Mask->getValue().countLeadingZeros() +
3526 Mask->getValue().countPopulation()) == Mask->getValue().getBitWidth()
Reid Spencer6eb0d992007-03-26 23:58:26 +00003527 && And(N, Mask)->isZero())
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003528 break;
3529 return 0;
3530 }
3531
3532 Instruction *New;
3533 if (isSub)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003534 New = BinaryOperator::CreateSub(LHSI->getOperand(0), RHS, "fold");
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003535 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003536 New = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSI->getOperand(0), RHS, "fold");
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003537 return InsertNewInstBefore(New, I);
3538}
3539
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003540Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAnd(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00003541 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003542 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003543
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00003544 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // X & undef -> 0
3545 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
3546
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003547 // and X, X = X
3548 if (Op0 == Op1)
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00003549 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003550
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00003551 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +00003552 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00003553 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00003554 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())->getBitWidth();
3555 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
3556 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
Chris Lattner696ee0a2007-01-18 22:16:33 +00003557 KnownZero, KnownOne))
Reid Spencer6eb0d992007-03-26 23:58:26 +00003558 return &I;
Chris Lattner696ee0a2007-01-18 22:16:33 +00003559 } else {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00003560 if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00003561 if (CP->isAllOnesValue()) // X & <-1,-1> -> X
Chris Lattner696ee0a2007-01-18 22:16:33 +00003562 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, I.getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00003563 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(Op1)) {
3564 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X & <0,0> -> <0,0>
Chris Lattner696ee0a2007-01-18 22:16:33 +00003565 }
3566 }
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +00003567
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003568 if (ConstantInt *AndRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003569 const APInt& AndRHSMask = AndRHS->getValue();
3570 APInt NotAndRHS(~AndRHSMask);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003571
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003572 // Optimize a variety of ((val OP C1) & C2) combinations...
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003573 if (isa<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003574 Instruction *Op0I = cast<Instruction>(Op0);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003575 Value *Op0LHS = Op0I->getOperand(0);
3576 Value *Op0RHS = Op0I->getOperand(1);
3577 switch (Op0I->getOpcode()) {
3578 case Instruction::Xor:
3579 case Instruction::Or:
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003580 // If the mask is only needed on one incoming arm, push it up.
3581 if (Op0I->hasOneUse()) {
3582 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op0LHS, NotAndRHS)) {
3583 // Not masking anything out for the LHS, move to RHS.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003584 Instruction *NewRHS = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0RHS, AndRHS,
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003585 Op0RHS->getName()+".masked");
3586 InsertNewInstBefore(NewRHS, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003587 return BinaryOperator::Create(
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003588 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0I)->getOpcode(), Op0LHS, NewRHS);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003589 }
Chris Lattner3bedbd92006-02-07 07:27:52 +00003590 if (!isa<Constant>(Op0RHS) &&
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003591 MaskedValueIsZero(Op0RHS, NotAndRHS)) {
3592 // Not masking anything out for the RHS, move to LHS.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003593 Instruction *NewLHS = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0LHS, AndRHS,
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003594 Op0LHS->getName()+".masked");
3595 InsertNewInstBefore(NewLHS, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003596 return BinaryOperator::Create(
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003597 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0I)->getOpcode(), NewLHS, Op0RHS);
3598 }
3599 }
3600
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003601 break;
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003602 case Instruction::Add:
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003603 // ((A & N) + B) & AndRHS -> (A + B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == AndRHS.
3604 // ((A | N) + B) & AndRHS -> (A + B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
3605 // ((A ^ N) + B) & AndRHS -> (A + B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
3606 if (Value *V = FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Op0LHS, Op0RHS, AndRHS, false, I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003607 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V, AndRHS);
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003608 if (Value *V = FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Op0RHS, Op0LHS, AndRHS, false, I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003609 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V, AndRHS); // Add commutes
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003610 break;
3611
3612 case Instruction::Sub:
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003613 // ((A & N) - B) & AndRHS -> (A - B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == AndRHS.
3614 // ((A | N) - B) & AndRHS -> (A - B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
3615 // ((A ^ N) - B) & AndRHS -> (A - B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
3616 if (Value *V = FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Op0LHS, Op0RHS, AndRHS, true, I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003617 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V, AndRHS);
Nick Lewyckyb4d1bc92008-07-09 04:32:37 +00003618
Nick Lewycky5dcc41f2008-07-10 05:51:40 +00003619 // (A - N) & AndRHS -> -N & AndRHS iff A&AndRHS==0 and AndRHS
3620 // has 1's for all bits that the subtraction with A might affect.
3621 if (Op0I->hasOneUse()) {
3622 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHSMask.getBitWidth();
3623 uint32_t Zeros = AndRHSMask.countLeadingZeros();
3624 APInt Mask = APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - Zeros);
3625
Nick Lewyckyb4d1bc92008-07-09 04:32:37 +00003626 ConstantInt *A = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0LHS);
Nick Lewycky5dcc41f2008-07-10 05:51:40 +00003627 if (!(A && A->isZero()) && // avoid infinite recursion.
3628 MaskedValueIsZero(Op0LHS, Mask)) {
Nick Lewyckyb4d1bc92008-07-09 04:32:37 +00003629 Instruction *NewNeg = BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op0RHS);
3630 InsertNewInstBefore(NewNeg, I);
3631 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NewNeg, AndRHS);
3632 }
3633 }
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003634 break;
Nick Lewyckyd1f77bf2008-07-09 05:20:13 +00003635
3636 case Instruction::Shl:
3637 case Instruction::LShr:
3638 // (1 << x) & 1 --> zext(x == 0)
3639 // (1 >> x) & 1 --> zext(x == 0)
Nick Lewyckyd8ad4922008-07-09 07:35:26 +00003640 if (AndRHSMask == 1 && Op0LHS == AndRHS) {
Nick Lewyckyd1f77bf2008-07-09 05:20:13 +00003641 Instruction *NewICmp = new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0RHS,
3642 Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
3643 InsertNewInstBefore(NewICmp, I);
3644 return new ZExtInst(NewICmp, I.getType());
3645 }
3646 break;
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003647 }
3648
Chris Lattner58403262003-07-23 19:25:52 +00003649 if (ConstantInt *Op0CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1)))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003650 if (Instruction *Res = OptAndOp(Op0I, Op0CI, AndRHS, I))
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003651 return Res;
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003652 } else if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003653 // If this is an integer truncation or change from signed-to-unsigned, and
3654 // if the source is an and/or with immediate, transform it. This
3655 // frequently occurs for bitfield accesses.
3656 if (Instruction *CastOp = dyn_cast<Instruction>(CI->getOperand(0))) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00003657 if ((isa<TruncInst>(CI) || isa<BitCastInst>(CI)) &&
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003658 CastOp->getNumOperands() == 2)
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00003659 if (ConstantInt *AndCI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(CastOp->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003660 if (CastOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::And) {
3661 // Change: and (cast (and X, C1) to T), C2
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00003662 // into : and (cast X to T), trunc_or_bitcast(C1)&C2
3663 // This will fold the two constants together, which may allow
3664 // other simplifications.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003665 Instruction *NewCast = CastInst::CreateTruncOrBitCast(
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00003666 CastOp->getOperand(0), I.getType(),
3667 CastOp->getName()+".shrunk");
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003668 NewCast = InsertNewInstBefore(NewCast, I);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00003669 // trunc_or_bitcast(C1)&C2
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00003670 Constant *C3 = ConstantExpr::getTruncOrBitCast(AndCI,I.getType());
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00003671 C3 = ConstantExpr::getAnd(C3, AndRHS);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003672 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NewCast, C3);
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003673 } else if (CastOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
3674 // Change: and (cast (or X, C1) to T), C2
3675 // into : trunc(C1)&C2 iff trunc(C1)&C2 == C2
Chris Lattnerbb4e7b22006-12-12 19:11:20 +00003676 Constant *C3 = ConstantExpr::getTruncOrBitCast(AndCI,I.getType());
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003677 if (ConstantExpr::getAnd(C3, AndRHS) == AndRHS) // trunc(C1)&C2
3678 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, AndRHS);
3679 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00003680 }
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003681 }
Chris Lattner06782f82003-07-23 19:36:21 +00003682 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00003683
3684 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
3685 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003686 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00003687 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00003688 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
3689 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
3690 return NV;
Chris Lattnerc6a8aff2003-07-23 17:57:01 +00003691 }
3692
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00003693 Value *Op0NotVal = dyn_castNotVal(Op0);
3694 Value *Op1NotVal = dyn_castNotVal(Op1);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00003695
Chris Lattner5b62aa72004-06-18 06:07:51 +00003696 if (Op0NotVal == Op1 || Op1NotVal == Op0) // A & ~A == ~A & A == 0
3697 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
3698
Misha Brukmancb6267b2004-07-30 12:50:08 +00003699 // (~A & ~B) == (~(A | B)) - De Morgan's Law
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00003700 if (Op0NotVal && Op1NotVal && isOnlyUse(Op0) && isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003701 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Op0NotVal, Op1NotVal,
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00003702 I.getName()+".demorgan");
Chris Lattnerc6a8aff2003-07-23 17:57:01 +00003703 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003704 return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Or);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00003705 }
Chris Lattner2082ad92006-02-13 23:07:23 +00003706
3707 {
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00003708 Value *A = 0, *B = 0, *C = 0, *D = 0;
3709 if (match(Op0, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
Chris Lattner2082ad92006-02-13 23:07:23 +00003710 if (A == Op1 || B == Op1) // (A | ?) & A --> A
3711 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00003712
3713 // (A|B) & ~(A&B) -> A^B
3714 if (match(Op1, m_Not(m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D))))) {
3715 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003716 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(A, B);
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00003717 }
3718 }
3719
3720 if (match(Op1, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
Chris Lattner2082ad92006-02-13 23:07:23 +00003721 if (A == Op0 || B == Op0) // A & (A | ?) --> A
3722 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00003723
3724 // ~(A&B) & (A|B) -> A^B
3725 if (match(Op0, m_Not(m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D))))) {
3726 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003727 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(A, B);
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00003728 }
3729 }
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00003730
3731 if (Op0->hasOneUse() &&
3732 match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
3733 if (A == Op1) { // (A^B)&A -> A&(A^B)
3734 I.swapOperands(); // Simplify below
3735 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
3736 } else if (B == Op1) { // (A^B)&B -> B&(B^A)
3737 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)->swapOperands();
3738 I.swapOperands(); // Simplify below
3739 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
3740 }
3741 }
3742 if (Op1->hasOneUse() &&
3743 match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
3744 if (B == Op0) { // B&(A^B) -> B&(B^A)
3745 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)->swapOperands();
3746 std::swap(A, B);
3747 }
3748 if (A == Op0) { // A&(A^B) -> A & ~B
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003749 Instruction *NotB = BinaryOperator::CreateNot(B, "tmp");
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00003750 InsertNewInstBefore(NotB, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003751 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(A, NotB);
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00003752 }
3753 }
Chris Lattner2082ad92006-02-13 23:07:23 +00003754 }
3755
Nick Lewyckyb30591e2008-08-06 04:54:03 +00003756 { // (icmp ult A, C) & (icmp ult B, C) --> (icmp ult (A|B), C)
3757 // where C is a power of 2
3758 Value *A, *B;
3759 ConstantInt *C1, *C2;
Evan Chengab5d5e32008-08-20 23:36:48 +00003760 ICmpInst::Predicate LHSCC = ICmpInst::BAD_ICMP_PREDICATE;
3761 ICmpInst::Predicate RHSCC = ICmpInst::BAD_ICMP_PREDICATE;
Nick Lewyckyb30591e2008-08-06 04:54:03 +00003762 if (match(&I, m_And(m_ICmp(LHSCC, m_Value(A), m_ConstantInt(C1)),
3763 m_ICmp(RHSCC, m_Value(B), m_ConstantInt(C2)))))
3764 if (C1 == C2 && LHSCC == RHSCC && LHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT &&
3765 C1->getValue().isPowerOf2()) {
3766 Instruction *NewOr = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(A, B);
3767 InsertNewInstBefore(NewOr, I);
3768 return new ICmpInst(LHSCC, NewOr, C1);
3769 }
3770 }
3771
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003772 if (ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Op1)) {
3773 // (icmp1 A, B) & (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
3774 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, FoldICmpLogical(*this, RHS)))
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003775 return R;
3776
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003777 Value *LHSVal, *RHSVal;
3778 ConstantInt *LHSCst, *RHSCst;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003779 ICmpInst::Predicate LHSCC, RHSCC;
3780 if (match(Op0, m_ICmp(LHSCC, m_Value(LHSVal), m_ConstantInt(LHSCst))))
3781 if (match(RHS, m_ICmp(RHSCC, m_Value(RHSVal), m_ConstantInt(RHSCst))))
3782 if (LHSVal == RHSVal && // Found (X icmp C1) & (X icmp C2)
3783 // ICMP_[GL]E X, CST is folded to ICMP_[GL]T elsewhere.
3784 LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE && LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE &&
3785 RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE && RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE &&
3786 LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE && LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE &&
Chris Lattnereec8b9a2007-11-22 23:47:13 +00003787 RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE && RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE &&
3788
3789 // Don't try to fold ICMP_SLT + ICMP_ULT.
3790 (ICmpInst::isEquality(LHSCC) || ICmpInst::isEquality(RHSCC) ||
3791 ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(LHSCC) ==
3792 ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(RHSCC))) {
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003793 // Ensure that the larger constant is on the RHS.
Chris Lattneree2b7a42008-01-13 20:59:02 +00003794 ICmpInst::Predicate GT;
3795 if (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(LHSCC) ||
3796 (ICmpInst::isEquality(LHSCC) &&
3797 ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(RHSCC)))
3798 GT = ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT;
3799 else
3800 GT = ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT;
3801
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003802 Constant *Cmp = ConstantExpr::getICmp(GT, LHSCst, RHSCst);
3803 ICmpInst *LHS = cast<ICmpInst>(Op0);
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00003804 if (cast<ConstantInt>(Cmp)->getZExtValue()) {
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003805 std::swap(LHS, RHS);
3806 std::swap(LHSCst, RHSCst);
3807 std::swap(LHSCC, RHSCC);
3808 }
3809
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003810 // At this point, we know we have have two icmp instructions
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003811 // comparing a value against two constants and and'ing the result
3812 // together. Because of the above check, we know that we only have
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003813 // icmp eq, icmp ne, icmp [su]lt, and icmp [SU]gt here. We also know
3814 // (from the FoldICmpLogical check above), that the two constants
3815 // are not equal and that the larger constant is on the RHS
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003816 assert(LHSCst != RHSCst && "Compares not folded above?");
3817
3818 switch (LHSCC) {
3819 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003820 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003821 switch (RHSCC) {
3822 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003823 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X == 13 & X == 15) -> false
3824 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X == 13 & X > 15) -> false
3825 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X == 13 & X > 15) -> false
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003826 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003827 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X == 13 & X != 15) -> X == 13
3828 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X == 13 & X < 15) -> X == 13
3829 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X == 13 & X < 15) -> X == 13
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003830 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
3831 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003832 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003833 switch (RHSCC) {
3834 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003835 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
3836 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)) // (X != 13 & X u< 14) -> X < 13
3837 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, LHSVal, LHSCst);
3838 break; // (X != 13 & X u< 15) -> no change
3839 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
3840 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)) // (X != 13 & X s< 14) -> X < 13
3841 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, LHSVal, LHSCst);
3842 break; // (X != 13 & X s< 15) -> no change
3843 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X != 13 & X == 15) -> X == 15
3844 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X != 13 & X u> 15) -> X u> 15
3845 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X != 13 & X s> 15) -> X s> 15
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003846 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003847 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
3848 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)){// (X != 13 & X != 14) -> X-13 >u 1
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003849 Constant *AddCST = ConstantExpr::getNeg(LHSCst);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003850 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSVal, AddCST,
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003851 LHSVal->getName()+".off");
3852 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, I);
Chris Lattner424db022007-01-27 23:08:34 +00003853 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, Add,
3854 ConstantInt::get(Add->getType(), 1));
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003855 }
3856 break; // (X != 13 & X != 15) -> no change
3857 }
3858 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003859 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003860 switch (RHSCC) {
3861 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003862 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u< 13 & X == 15) -> false
3863 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u< 13 & X u> 15) -> false
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003864 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003865 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u< 13 & X s> 15) -> no change
3866 break;
3867 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X u< 13 & X != 15) -> X u< 13
3868 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u< 13 & X u< 15) -> X u< 13
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003869 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003870 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u< 13 & X s< 15) -> no change
3871 break;
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003872 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003873 break;
3874 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003875 switch (RHSCC) {
3876 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003877 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s< 13 & X == 15) -> false
3878 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s< 13 & X s> 15) -> false
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003879 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003880 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s< 13 & X u> 15) -> no change
3881 break;
3882 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X s< 13 & X != 15) -> X < 13
3883 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s< 13 & X s< 15) -> X < 13
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003884 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003885 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s< 13 & X u< 15) -> no change
3886 break;
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003887 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003888 break;
3889 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
3890 switch (RHSCC) {
3891 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Eli Friedman5c1f1722008-06-21 23:36:13 +00003892 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u> 13 & X == 15) -> X == 15
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003893 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u> 13 & X u> 15) -> X u> 15
3894 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
3895 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u> 13 & X s> 15) -> no change
3896 break;
3897 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
3898 if (RHSCst == AddOne(LHSCst)) // (X u> 13 & X != 14) -> X u> 14
3899 return new ICmpInst(LHSCC, LHSVal, RHSCst);
3900 break; // (X u> 13 & X != 15) -> no change
3901 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u> 13 & X u< 15) ->(X-14) <u 1
3902 return InsertRangeTest(LHSVal, AddOne(LHSCst), RHSCst, false,
3903 true, I);
3904 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u> 13 & X s< 15) -> no change
3905 break;
3906 }
3907 break;
3908 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
3909 switch (RHSCC) {
3910 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Chris Lattnera7d1ab02007-11-16 06:04:17 +00003911 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s> 13 & X == 15) -> X == 15
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003912 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s> 13 & X s> 15) -> X s> 15
3913 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
3914 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s> 13 & X u> 15) -> no change
3915 break;
3916 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
3917 if (RHSCst == AddOne(LHSCst)) // (X s> 13 & X != 14) -> X s> 14
3918 return new ICmpInst(LHSCC, LHSVal, RHSCst);
3919 break; // (X s> 13 & X != 15) -> no change
3920 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s> 13 & X s< 15) ->(X-14) s< 1
3921 return InsertRangeTest(LHSVal, AddOne(LHSCst), RHSCst, true,
3922 true, I);
3923 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s> 13 & X u< 15) -> no change
3924 break;
3925 }
3926 break;
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003927 }
3928 }
3929 }
3930
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00003931 // fold (and (cast A), (cast B)) -> (cast (and A, B))
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00003932 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0))
3933 if (CastInst *Op1C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op1))
3934 if (Op0C->getOpcode() == Op1C->getOpcode()) { // same cast kind ?
3935 const Type *SrcTy = Op0C->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00003936 if (SrcTy == Op1C->getOperand(0)->getType() && SrcTy->isInteger() &&
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00003937 // Only do this if the casts both really cause code to be generated.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003938 ValueRequiresCast(Op0C->getOpcode(), Op0C->getOperand(0),
3939 I.getType(), TD) &&
3940 ValueRequiresCast(Op1C->getOpcode(), Op1C->getOperand(0),
3941 I.getType(), TD)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003942 Instruction *NewOp = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0C->getOperand(0),
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00003943 Op1C->getOperand(0),
3944 I.getName());
3945 InsertNewInstBefore(NewOp, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003946 return CastInst::Create(Op0C->getOpcode(), NewOp, I.getType());
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00003947 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00003948 }
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003949
3950 // (X >> Z) & (Y >> Z) -> (X&Y) >> Z for all shifts.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003951 if (BinaryOperator *SI1 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
3952 if (BinaryOperator *SI0 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
3953 if (SI0->isShift() && SI0->getOpcode() == SI1->getOpcode() &&
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003954 SI0->getOperand(1) == SI1->getOperand(1) &&
3955 (SI0->hasOneUse() || SI1->hasOneUse())) {
3956 Instruction *NewOp =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003957 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(SI0->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003958 SI1->getOperand(0),
3959 SI0->getName()), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003960 return BinaryOperator::Create(SI1->getOpcode(), NewOp,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003961 SI1->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003962 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00003963 }
3964
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003965 // If and'ing two fcmp, try combine them into one.
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00003966 if (FCmpInst *LHS = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(I.getOperand(0))) {
3967 if (FCmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(I.getOperand(1))) {
3968 if (LHS->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD &&
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003969 RHS->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD) {
3970 // (fcmp ord x, c) & (fcmp ord y, c) -> (fcmp ord x, y)
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00003971 if (ConstantFP *LHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(LHS->getOperand(1)))
3972 if (ConstantFP *RHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHS->getOperand(1))) {
3973 // If either of the constants are nans, then the whole thing returns
3974 // false.
Chris Lattnerbe3e3482007-10-24 18:54:45 +00003975 if (LHSC->getValueAPF().isNaN() || RHSC->getValueAPF().isNaN())
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00003976 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
3977 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD, LHS->getOperand(0),
3978 RHS->getOperand(0));
3979 }
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003980 } else {
3981 Value *Op0LHS, *Op0RHS, *Op1LHS, *Op1RHS;
3982 FCmpInst::Predicate Op0CC, Op1CC;
3983 if (match(Op0, m_FCmp(Op0CC, m_Value(Op0LHS), m_Value(Op0RHS))) &&
3984 match(Op1, m_FCmp(Op1CC, m_Value(Op1LHS), m_Value(Op1RHS)))) {
Evan Cheng4990b252008-10-14 18:13:38 +00003985 if (Op0LHS == Op1RHS && Op0RHS == Op1LHS) {
3986 // Swap RHS operands to match LHS.
3987 Op1CC = FCmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Op1CC);
3988 std::swap(Op1LHS, Op1RHS);
3989 }
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003990 if (Op0LHS == Op1LHS && Op0RHS == Op1RHS) {
3991 // Simplify (fcmp cc0 x, y) & (fcmp cc1 x, y).
3992 if (Op0CC == Op1CC)
3993 return new FCmpInst((FCmpInst::Predicate)Op0CC, Op0LHS, Op0RHS);
3994 else if (Op0CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_FALSE ||
3995 Op1CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_FALSE)
3996 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
3997 else if (Op0CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_TRUE)
3998 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
3999 else if (Op1CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_TRUE)
4000 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
4001 bool Op0Ordered;
4002 bool Op1Ordered;
4003 unsigned Op0Pred = getFCmpCode(Op0CC, Op0Ordered);
4004 unsigned Op1Pred = getFCmpCode(Op1CC, Op1Ordered);
4005 if (Op1Pred == 0) {
4006 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
4007 std::swap(Op0Pred, Op1Pred);
4008 std::swap(Op0Ordered, Op1Ordered);
4009 }
4010 if (Op0Pred == 0) {
4011 // uno && ueq -> uno && (uno || eq) -> ueq
4012 // ord && olt -> ord && (ord && lt) -> olt
4013 if (Op0Ordered == Op1Ordered)
4014 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
4015 // uno && oeq -> uno && (ord && eq) -> false
4016 // uno && ord -> false
4017 if (!Op0Ordered)
4018 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
4019 // ord && ueq -> ord && (uno || eq) -> oeq
4020 return cast<Instruction>(getFCmpValue(true, Op1Pred,
4021 Op0LHS, Op0RHS));
4022 }
4023 }
4024 }
4025 }
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004026 }
4027 }
Nick Lewyckyb4d1bc92008-07-09 04:32:37 +00004028
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004029 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004030}
4031
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004032/// CollectBSwapParts - Analyze the specified subexpression and see if it is
4033/// capable of providing pieces of a bswap. The subexpression provides pieces
4034/// of a bswap if it is proven that each of the non-zero bytes in the output of
4035/// the expression came from the corresponding "byte swapped" byte in some other
4036/// value. For example, if the current subexpression is "(shl i32 %X, 24)" then
4037/// we know that the expression deposits the low byte of %X into the high byte
4038/// of the bswap result and that all other bytes are zero. This expression is
4039/// accepted, the high byte of ByteValues is set to X to indicate a correct
4040/// match.
4041///
4042/// This function returns true if the match was unsuccessful and false if so.
4043/// On entry to the function the "OverallLeftShift" is a signed integer value
4044/// indicating the number of bytes that the subexpression is later shifted. For
4045/// example, if the expression is later right shifted by 16 bits, the
4046/// OverallLeftShift value would be -2 on entry. This is used to specify which
4047/// byte of ByteValues is actually being set.
4048///
4049/// Similarly, ByteMask is a bitmask where a bit is clear if its corresponding
4050/// byte is masked to zero by a user. For example, in (X & 255), X will be
4051/// processed with a bytemask of 1. Because bytemask is 32-bits, this limits
4052/// this function to working on up to 32-byte (256 bit) values. ByteMask is
4053/// always in the local (OverallLeftShift) coordinate space.
4054///
4055static bool CollectBSwapParts(Value *V, int OverallLeftShift, uint32_t ByteMask,
4056 SmallVector<Value*, 8> &ByteValues) {
4057 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V)) {
4058 // If this is an or instruction, it may be an inner node of the bswap.
4059 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
4060 return CollectBSwapParts(I->getOperand(0), OverallLeftShift, ByteMask,
4061 ByteValues) ||
4062 CollectBSwapParts(I->getOperand(1), OverallLeftShift, ByteMask,
4063 ByteValues);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004064 }
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004065
4066 // If this is a logical shift by a constant multiple of 8, recurse with
4067 // OverallLeftShift and ByteMask adjusted.
4068 if (I->isLogicalShift() && isa<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
4069 unsigned ShAmt =
4070 cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))->getLimitedValue(~0U);
4071 // Ensure the shift amount is defined and of a byte value.
4072 if ((ShAmt & 7) || (ShAmt > 8*ByteValues.size()))
4073 return true;
4074
4075 unsigned ByteShift = ShAmt >> 3;
4076 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
4077 // X << 2 -> collect(X, +2)
4078 OverallLeftShift += ByteShift;
4079 ByteMask >>= ByteShift;
4080 } else {
4081 // X >>u 2 -> collect(X, -2)
4082 OverallLeftShift -= ByteShift;
4083 ByteMask <<= ByteShift;
Chris Lattnerde17ddc2008-10-08 06:42:28 +00004084 ByteMask &= (~0U >> (32-ByteValues.size()));
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004085 }
4086
4087 if (OverallLeftShift >= (int)ByteValues.size()) return true;
4088 if (OverallLeftShift <= -(int)ByteValues.size()) return true;
4089
4090 return CollectBSwapParts(I->getOperand(0), OverallLeftShift, ByteMask,
4091 ByteValues);
4092 }
4093
4094 // If this is a logical 'and' with a mask that clears bytes, clear the
4095 // corresponding bytes in ByteMask.
4096 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And &&
4097 isa<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
4098 // Scan every byte of the and mask, seeing if the byte is either 0 or 255.
4099 unsigned NumBytes = ByteValues.size();
4100 APInt Byte(I->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits(), 255);
4101 const APInt &AndMask = cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))->getValue();
4102
4103 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumBytes; ++i, Byte <<= 8) {
4104 // If this byte is masked out by a later operation, we don't care what
4105 // the and mask is.
4106 if ((ByteMask & (1 << i)) == 0)
4107 continue;
4108
4109 // If the AndMask is all zeros for this byte, clear the bit.
4110 APInt MaskB = AndMask & Byte;
4111 if (MaskB == 0) {
4112 ByteMask &= ~(1U << i);
4113 continue;
4114 }
4115
4116 // If the AndMask is not all ones for this byte, it's not a bytezap.
4117 if (MaskB != Byte)
4118 return true;
4119
4120 // Otherwise, this byte is kept.
4121 }
4122
4123 return CollectBSwapParts(I->getOperand(0), OverallLeftShift, ByteMask,
4124 ByteValues);
4125 }
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004126 }
4127
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004128 // Okay, we got to something that isn't a shift, 'or' or 'and'. This must be
4129 // the input value to the bswap. Some observations: 1) if more than one byte
4130 // is demanded from this input, then it could not be successfully assembled
4131 // into a byteswap. At least one of the two bytes would not be aligned with
4132 // their ultimate destination.
4133 if (!isPowerOf2_32(ByteMask)) return true;
4134 unsigned InputByteNo = CountTrailingZeros_32(ByteMask);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004135
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004136 // 2) The input and ultimate destinations must line up: if byte 3 of an i32
4137 // is demanded, it needs to go into byte 0 of the result. This means that the
4138 // byte needs to be shifted until it lands in the right byte bucket. The
4139 // shift amount depends on the position: if the byte is coming from the high
4140 // part of the value (e.g. byte 3) then it must be shifted right. If from the
4141 // low part, it must be shifted left.
4142 unsigned DestByteNo = InputByteNo + OverallLeftShift;
4143 if (InputByteNo < ByteValues.size()/2) {
4144 if (ByteValues.size()-1-DestByteNo != InputByteNo)
4145 return true;
4146 } else {
4147 if (ByteValues.size()-1-DestByteNo != InputByteNo)
4148 return true;
4149 }
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004150
4151 // If the destination byte value is already defined, the values are or'd
4152 // together, which isn't a bswap (unless it's an or of the same bits).
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004153 if (ByteValues[DestByteNo] && ByteValues[DestByteNo] != V)
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004154 return true;
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004155 ByteValues[DestByteNo] = V;
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004156 return false;
4157}
4158
4159/// MatchBSwap - Given an OR instruction, check to see if this is a bswap idiom.
4160/// If so, insert the new bswap intrinsic and return it.
4161Instruction *InstCombiner::MatchBSwap(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner55fc8c42007-04-01 20:57:36 +00004162 const IntegerType *ITy = dyn_cast<IntegerType>(I.getType());
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004163 if (!ITy || ITy->getBitWidth() % 16 ||
4164 // ByteMask only allows up to 32-byte values.
4165 ITy->getBitWidth() > 32*8)
Chris Lattner55fc8c42007-04-01 20:57:36 +00004166 return 0; // Can only bswap pairs of bytes. Can't do vectors.
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004167
4168 /// ByteValues - For each byte of the result, we keep track of which value
4169 /// defines each byte.
Chris Lattner535014f2007-02-15 22:52:10 +00004170 SmallVector<Value*, 8> ByteValues;
Chris Lattner55fc8c42007-04-01 20:57:36 +00004171 ByteValues.resize(ITy->getBitWidth()/8);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004172
4173 // Try to find all the pieces corresponding to the bswap.
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004174 uint32_t ByteMask = ~0U >> (32-ByteValues.size());
4175 if (CollectBSwapParts(&I, 0, ByteMask, ByteValues))
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004176 return 0;
4177
4178 // Check to see if all of the bytes come from the same value.
4179 Value *V = ByteValues[0];
4180 if (V == 0) return 0; // Didn't find a byte? Must be zero.
4181
4182 // Check to make sure that all of the bytes come from the same value.
4183 for (unsigned i = 1, e = ByteValues.size(); i != e; ++i)
4184 if (ByteValues[i] != V)
4185 return 0;
Chandler Carruth69940402007-08-04 01:51:18 +00004186 const Type *Tys[] = { ITy };
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004187 Module *M = I.getParent()->getParent()->getParent();
Chandler Carruth69940402007-08-04 01:51:18 +00004188 Function *F = Intrinsic::getDeclaration(M, Intrinsic::bswap, Tys, 1);
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00004189 return CallInst::Create(F, V);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004190}
4191
4192
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004193Instruction *InstCombiner::visitOr(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00004194 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004195 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004196
Chris Lattner42593e62007-03-24 23:56:43 +00004197 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // X | undef -> -1
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004198 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00004199
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00004200 // or X, X = X
4201 if (Op0 == Op1)
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00004202 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004203
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00004204 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
4205 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Chris Lattner42593e62007-03-24 23:56:43 +00004206 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
4207 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())->getBitWidth();
4208 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
4209 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
4210 KnownZero, KnownOne))
4211 return &I;
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00004212 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(Op1)) {
4213 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // X | <0,0> -> X
4214 } else if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(Op1)) {
4215 if (CP->isAllOnesValue()) // X | <-1,-1> -> <-1,-1>
4216 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, I.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner42593e62007-03-24 23:56:43 +00004217 }
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00004218
4219
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00004220
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004221 // or X, -1 == -1
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004222 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner4f637d42006-01-06 17:59:59 +00004223 ConstantInt *C1 = 0; Value *X = 0;
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004224 // (X & C1) | C2 --> (X | C2) & (C1|C2)
4225 if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(C1))) && isOnlyUse(Op0)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004226 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(X, RHS);
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004227 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00004228 Or->takeName(Op0);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004229 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Or,
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00004230 ConstantInt::get(RHS->getValue() | C1->getValue()));
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004231 }
Chris Lattnerad44ebf2003-07-23 18:29:44 +00004232
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004233 // (X ^ C1) | C2 --> (X | C2) ^ (C1&~C2)
4234 if (match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(C1))) && isOnlyUse(Op0)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004235 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(X, RHS);
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004236 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00004237 Or->takeName(Op0);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004238 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Or,
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00004239 ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() & ~RHS->getValue()));
Chris Lattnerad44ebf2003-07-23 18:29:44 +00004240 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00004241
4242 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
4243 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00004244 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00004245 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00004246 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
4247 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
4248 return NV;
Chris Lattnerad44ebf2003-07-23 18:29:44 +00004249 }
4250
Chris Lattner4f637d42006-01-06 17:59:59 +00004251 Value *A = 0, *B = 0;
4252 ConstantInt *C1 = 0, *C2 = 0;
Chris Lattnerf4d4c872005-05-07 23:49:08 +00004253
4254 if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))))
4255 if (A == Op1 || B == Op1) // (A & ?) | A --> A
4256 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
4257 if (match(Op1, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))))
4258 if (A == Op0 || B == Op0) // A | (A & ?) --> A
4259 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
4260
Chris Lattner6423d4c2006-07-10 20:25:24 +00004261 // (A | B) | C and A | (B | C) -> bswap if possible.
4262 // (A >> B) | (C << D) and (A << B) | (B >> C) -> bswap if possible.
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004263 if (match(Op0, m_Or(m_Value(), m_Value())) ||
Chris Lattner6423d4c2006-07-10 20:25:24 +00004264 match(Op1, m_Or(m_Value(), m_Value())) ||
4265 (match(Op0, m_Shift(m_Value(), m_Value())) &&
4266 match(Op1, m_Shift(m_Value(), m_Value())))) {
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004267 if (Instruction *BSwap = MatchBSwap(I))
4268 return BSwap;
4269 }
4270
Chris Lattner6e4c6492005-05-09 04:58:36 +00004271 // (X^C)|Y -> (X|Y)^C iff Y&C == 0
4272 if (Op0->hasOneUse() && match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00004273 MaskedValueIsZero(Op1, C1->getValue())) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004274 Instruction *NOr = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(A, Op1);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00004275 InsertNewInstBefore(NOr, I);
4276 NOr->takeName(Op0);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004277 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(NOr, C1);
Chris Lattner6e4c6492005-05-09 04:58:36 +00004278 }
4279
4280 // Y|(X^C) -> (X|Y)^C iff Y&C == 0
4281 if (Op1->hasOneUse() && match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00004282 MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, C1->getValue())) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004283 Instruction *NOr = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(A, Op0);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00004284 InsertNewInstBefore(NOr, I);
4285 NOr->takeName(Op0);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004286 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(NOr, C1);
Chris Lattner6e4c6492005-05-09 04:58:36 +00004287 }
4288
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00004289 // (A & C)|(B & D)
Chris Lattner2384d7b2007-06-19 05:43:49 +00004290 Value *C = 0, *D = 0;
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00004291 if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(C))) &&
4292 match(Op1, m_And(m_Value(B), m_Value(D)))) {
Chris Lattner6cae0e02007-04-08 07:55:22 +00004293 Value *V1 = 0, *V2 = 0, *V3 = 0;
4294 C1 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(C);
4295 C2 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(D);
4296 if (C1 && C2) { // (A & C1)|(B & C2)
4297 // If we have: ((V + N) & C1) | (V & C2)
4298 // .. and C2 = ~C1 and C2 is 0+1+ and (N & C2) == 0
4299 // replace with V+N.
4300 if (C1->getValue() == ~C2->getValue()) {
4301 if ((C2->getValue() & (C2->getValue()+1)) == 0 && // C2 == 0+1+
4302 match(A, m_Add(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)))) {
4303 // Add commutes, try both ways.
4304 if (V1 == B && MaskedValueIsZero(V2, C2->getValue()))
4305 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
4306 if (V2 == B && MaskedValueIsZero(V1, C2->getValue()))
4307 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
4308 }
4309 // Or commutes, try both ways.
4310 if ((C1->getValue() & (C1->getValue()+1)) == 0 &&
4311 match(B, m_Add(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)))) {
4312 // Add commutes, try both ways.
4313 if (V1 == A && MaskedValueIsZero(V2, C1->getValue()))
4314 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
4315 if (V2 == A && MaskedValueIsZero(V1, C1->getValue()))
4316 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
4317 }
4318 }
Chris Lattner044e5332007-04-08 08:01:49 +00004319 V1 = 0; V2 = 0; V3 = 0;
Chris Lattner6cae0e02007-04-08 07:55:22 +00004320 }
4321
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00004322 // Check to see if we have any common things being and'ed. If so, find the
4323 // terms for V1 & (V2|V3).
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00004324 if (isOnlyUse(Op0) || isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
4325 if (A == B) // (A & C)|(A & D) == A & (C|D)
4326 V1 = A, V2 = C, V3 = D;
4327 else if (A == D) // (A & C)|(B & A) == A & (B|C)
4328 V1 = A, V2 = B, V3 = C;
4329 else if (C == B) // (A & C)|(C & D) == C & (A|D)
4330 V1 = C, V2 = A, V3 = D;
4331 else if (C == D) // (A & C)|(B & C) == C & (A|B)
4332 V1 = C, V2 = A, V3 = B;
4333
4334 if (V1) {
4335 Value *Or =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004336 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateOr(V2, V3, "tmp"), I);
4337 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V1, Or);
Chris Lattner0b7c0bf2005-09-18 06:02:59 +00004338 }
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00004339 }
Dan Gohmanb493b272008-10-28 22:38:57 +00004340
4341 // (A & sext(C0)) | (B & ~sext(C0) -> C0 ? A : B
4342 if (isa<SExtInst>(C) &&
4343 cast<User>(C)->getOperand(0)->getType() == Type::Int1Ty) {
4344 if (match(D, m_Not(m_Value(C))))
4345 return SelectInst::Create(cast<User>(C)->getOperand(0), A, B);
4346 // And commutes, try both ways.
4347 if (match(B, m_Not(m_Value(C))))
4348 return SelectInst::Create(cast<User>(C)->getOperand(0), A, D);
4349 }
4350 // Or commutes, try both ways.
4351 if (isa<SExtInst>(D) &&
4352 cast<User>(D)->getOperand(0)->getType() == Type::Int1Ty) {
4353 if (match(C, m_Not(m_Value(D))))
4354 return SelectInst::Create(cast<User>(D)->getOperand(0), A, B);
4355 // And commutes, try both ways.
4356 if (match(A, m_Not(m_Value(D))))
4357 return SelectInst::Create(cast<User>(D)->getOperand(0), C, B);
4358 }
Chris Lattnere9bed7d2005-09-18 03:42:07 +00004359 }
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004360
4361 // (X >> Z) | (Y >> Z) -> (X|Y) >> Z for all shifts.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00004362 if (BinaryOperator *SI1 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
4363 if (BinaryOperator *SI0 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
4364 if (SI0->isShift() && SI0->getOpcode() == SI1->getOpcode() &&
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004365 SI0->getOperand(1) == SI1->getOperand(1) &&
4366 (SI0->hasOneUse() || SI1->hasOneUse())) {
4367 Instruction *NewOp =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004368 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateOr(SI0->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004369 SI1->getOperand(0),
4370 SI0->getName()), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004371 return BinaryOperator::Create(SI1->getOpcode(), NewOp,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00004372 SI1->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004373 }
4374 }
Chris Lattner67ca7682003-08-12 19:11:07 +00004375
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004376 if (match(Op0, m_Not(m_Value(A)))) { // ~A | Op1
4377 if (A == Op1) // ~A | A == -1
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004378 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004379 } else {
4380 A = 0;
4381 }
Chris Lattnerf4d4c872005-05-07 23:49:08 +00004382 // Note, A is still live here!
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004383 if (match(Op1, m_Not(m_Value(B)))) { // Op0 | ~B
4384 if (Op0 == B)
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004385 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnera27231a2003-03-10 23:13:59 +00004386
Misha Brukmancb6267b2004-07-30 12:50:08 +00004387 // (~A | ~B) == (~(A & B)) - De Morgan's Law
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004388 if (A && isOnlyUse(Op0) && isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004389 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(A, B,
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004390 I.getName()+".demorgan"), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004391 return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(And);
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004392 }
Chris Lattnera27231a2003-03-10 23:13:59 +00004393 }
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004394
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004395 // (icmp1 A, B) | (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
4396 if (ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(I.getOperand(1))) {
4397 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, FoldICmpLogical(*this, RHS)))
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00004398 return R;
4399
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004400 Value *LHSVal, *RHSVal;
4401 ConstantInt *LHSCst, *RHSCst;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004402 ICmpInst::Predicate LHSCC, RHSCC;
4403 if (match(Op0, m_ICmp(LHSCC, m_Value(LHSVal), m_ConstantInt(LHSCst))))
4404 if (match(RHS, m_ICmp(RHSCC, m_Value(RHSVal), m_ConstantInt(RHSCst))))
4405 if (LHSVal == RHSVal && // Found (X icmp C1) | (X icmp C2)
4406 // icmp [us][gl]e x, cst is folded to icmp [us][gl]t elsewhere.
4407 LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE && LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE &&
4408 RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE && RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE &&
4409 LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE && LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE &&
Chris Lattner88858872007-05-11 05:55:56 +00004410 RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE && RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE &&
4411 // We can't fold (ugt x, C) | (sgt x, C2).
4412 PredicatesFoldable(LHSCC, RHSCC)) {
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004413 // Ensure that the larger constant is on the RHS.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004414 ICmpInst *LHS = cast<ICmpInst>(Op0);
Chris Lattner88858872007-05-11 05:55:56 +00004415 bool NeedsSwap;
Nick Lewyckya06cf822008-09-30 06:08:34 +00004416 if (ICmpInst::isEquality(LHSCC) ? ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(RHSCC)
4417 : ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(LHSCC))
Chris Lattner3aea1bd2007-05-11 16:58:45 +00004418 NeedsSwap = LHSCst->getValue().sgt(RHSCst->getValue());
Chris Lattner88858872007-05-11 05:55:56 +00004419 else
Chris Lattner3aea1bd2007-05-11 16:58:45 +00004420 NeedsSwap = LHSCst->getValue().ugt(RHSCst->getValue());
Chris Lattner88858872007-05-11 05:55:56 +00004421
4422 if (NeedsSwap) {
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004423 std::swap(LHS, RHS);
4424 std::swap(LHSCst, RHSCst);
4425 std::swap(LHSCC, RHSCC);
4426 }
4427
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004428 // At this point, we know we have have two icmp instructions
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004429 // comparing a value against two constants and or'ing the result
4430 // together. Because of the above check, we know that we only have
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004431 // ICMP_EQ, ICMP_NE, ICMP_LT, and ICMP_GT here. We also know (from the
4432 // FoldICmpLogical check above), that the two constants are not
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004433 // equal.
4434 assert(LHSCst != RHSCst && "Compares not folded above?");
4435
4436 switch (LHSCC) {
4437 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004438 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004439 switch (RHSCC) {
4440 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004441 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004442 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)) {// (X == 13 | X == 14) -> X-13 <u 2
4443 Constant *AddCST = ConstantExpr::getNeg(LHSCst);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004444 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSVal, AddCST,
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004445 LHSVal->getName()+".off");
4446 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, I);
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00004447 AddCST = Subtract(AddOne(RHSCst), LHSCst);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004448 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Add, AddCST);
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004449 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004450 break; // (X == 13 | X == 15) -> no change
4451 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X == 13 | X u> 14) -> no change
4452 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X == 13 | X s> 14) -> no change
Chris Lattner240d6f42005-04-19 06:04:18 +00004453 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004454 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X == 13 | X != 15) -> X != 15
4455 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X == 13 | X u< 15) -> X u< 15
4456 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X == 13 | X s< 15) -> X s< 15
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004457 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
4458 }
4459 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004460 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004461 switch (RHSCC) {
4462 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004463 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X != 13 | X == 15) -> X != 13
4464 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X != 13 | X u> 15) -> X != 13
4465 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X != 13 | X s> 15) -> X != 13
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004466 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004467 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X != 13 | X != 15) -> true
4468 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X != 13 | X u< 15) -> true
4469 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X != 13 | X s< 15) -> true
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004470 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004471 }
4472 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004473 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004474 switch (RHSCC) {
4475 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004476 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u< 13 | X == 14) -> no change
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004477 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004478 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u< 13 | X u> 15) ->(X-13) u> 2
Chris Lattner74e012a2007-11-01 02:18:41 +00004479 // If RHSCst is [us]MAXINT, it is always false. Not handling
4480 // this can cause overflow.
4481 if (RHSCst->isMaxValue(false))
4482 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004483 return InsertRangeTest(LHSVal, LHSCst, AddOne(RHSCst), false,
4484 false, I);
4485 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u< 13 | X s> 15) -> no change
4486 break;
4487 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X u< 13 | X != 15) -> X != 15
4488 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u< 13 | X u< 15) -> X u< 15
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004489 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004490 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u< 13 | X s< 15) -> no change
4491 break;
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004492 }
4493 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004494 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004495 switch (RHSCC) {
4496 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004497 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s< 13 | X == 14) -> no change
4498 break;
4499 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s< 13 | X s> 15) ->(X-13) s> 2
Chris Lattner74e012a2007-11-01 02:18:41 +00004500 // If RHSCst is [us]MAXINT, it is always false. Not handling
4501 // this can cause overflow.
4502 if (RHSCst->isMaxValue(true))
4503 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004504 return InsertRangeTest(LHSVal, LHSCst, AddOne(RHSCst), true,
4505 false, I);
4506 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s< 13 | X u> 15) -> no change
4507 break;
4508 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X s< 13 | X != 15) -> X != 15
4509 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s< 13 | X s< 15) -> X s< 15
4510 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
4511 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s< 13 | X u< 15) -> no change
4512 break;
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004513 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004514 break;
4515 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
4516 switch (RHSCC) {
4517 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
4518 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u> 13 | X == 15) -> X u> 13
4519 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u> 13 | X u> 15) -> X u> 13
4520 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
4521 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u> 13 | X s> 15) -> no change
4522 break;
4523 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X u> 13 | X != 15) -> true
4524 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u> 13 | X u< 15) -> true
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004525 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004526 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u> 13 | X s< 15) -> no change
4527 break;
4528 }
4529 break;
4530 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
4531 switch (RHSCC) {
4532 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
4533 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s> 13 | X == 15) -> X > 13
4534 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s> 13 | X s> 15) -> X > 13
4535 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
4536 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s> 13 | X u> 15) -> no change
4537 break;
4538 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X s> 13 | X != 15) -> true
4539 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s> 13 | X s< 15) -> true
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004540 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004541 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s> 13 | X u< 15) -> no change
4542 break;
4543 }
4544 break;
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004545 }
4546 }
4547 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004548
4549 // fold (or (cast A), (cast B)) -> (cast (or A, B))
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004550 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004551 if (CastInst *Op1C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004552 if (Op0C->getOpcode() == Op1C->getOpcode()) {// same cast kind ?
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00004553 if (!isa<ICmpInst>(Op0C->getOperand(0)) ||
4554 !isa<ICmpInst>(Op1C->getOperand(0))) {
4555 const Type *SrcTy = Op0C->getOperand(0)->getType();
4556 if (SrcTy == Op1C->getOperand(0)->getType() && SrcTy->isInteger() &&
4557 // Only do this if the casts both really cause code to be
4558 // generated.
4559 ValueRequiresCast(Op0C->getOpcode(), Op0C->getOperand(0),
4560 I.getType(), TD) &&
4561 ValueRequiresCast(Op1C->getOpcode(), Op1C->getOperand(0),
4562 I.getType(), TD)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004563 Instruction *NewOp = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Op0C->getOperand(0),
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00004564 Op1C->getOperand(0),
4565 I.getName());
4566 InsertNewInstBefore(NewOp, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004567 return CastInst::Create(Op0C->getOpcode(), NewOp, I.getType());
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00004568 }
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004569 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004570 }
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004571 }
4572
4573
4574 // (fcmp uno x, c) | (fcmp uno y, c) -> (fcmp uno x, y)
4575 if (FCmpInst *LHS = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(I.getOperand(0))) {
4576 if (FCmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(I.getOperand(1))) {
4577 if (LHS->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO &&
Chris Lattner5ebd9362008-02-29 06:09:11 +00004578 RHS->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO &&
Evan Cheng40300622008-10-14 18:44:08 +00004579 LHS->getOperand(0)->getType() == RHS->getOperand(0)->getType()) {
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004580 if (ConstantFP *LHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(LHS->getOperand(1)))
4581 if (ConstantFP *RHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHS->getOperand(1))) {
4582 // If either of the constants are nans, then the whole thing returns
4583 // true.
Chris Lattnerbe3e3482007-10-24 18:54:45 +00004584 if (LHSC->getValueAPF().isNaN() || RHSC->getValueAPF().isNaN())
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004585 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
4586
4587 // Otherwise, no need to compare the two constants, compare the
4588 // rest.
4589 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO, LHS->getOperand(0),
4590 RHS->getOperand(0));
4591 }
Evan Cheng40300622008-10-14 18:44:08 +00004592 } else {
4593 Value *Op0LHS, *Op0RHS, *Op1LHS, *Op1RHS;
4594 FCmpInst::Predicate Op0CC, Op1CC;
4595 if (match(Op0, m_FCmp(Op0CC, m_Value(Op0LHS), m_Value(Op0RHS))) &&
4596 match(Op1, m_FCmp(Op1CC, m_Value(Op1LHS), m_Value(Op1RHS)))) {
4597 if (Op0LHS == Op1RHS && Op0RHS == Op1LHS) {
4598 // Swap RHS operands to match LHS.
4599 Op1CC = FCmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Op1CC);
4600 std::swap(Op1LHS, Op1RHS);
4601 }
4602 if (Op0LHS == Op1LHS && Op0RHS == Op1RHS) {
4603 // Simplify (fcmp cc0 x, y) | (fcmp cc1 x, y).
4604 if (Op0CC == Op1CC)
4605 return new FCmpInst((FCmpInst::Predicate)Op0CC, Op0LHS, Op0RHS);
4606 else if (Op0CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_TRUE ||
4607 Op1CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_TRUE)
4608 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
4609 else if (Op0CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_FALSE)
4610 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
4611 else if (Op1CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_FALSE)
4612 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
4613 bool Op0Ordered;
4614 bool Op1Ordered;
4615 unsigned Op0Pred = getFCmpCode(Op0CC, Op0Ordered);
4616 unsigned Op1Pred = getFCmpCode(Op1CC, Op1Ordered);
4617 if (Op0Ordered == Op1Ordered) {
4618 // If both are ordered or unordered, return a new fcmp with
4619 // or'ed predicates.
4620 Value *RV = getFCmpValue(Op0Ordered, Op0Pred|Op1Pred,
4621 Op0LHS, Op0RHS);
4622 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(RV))
4623 return I;
4624 // Otherwise, it's a constant boolean value...
4625 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RV);
4626 }
4627 }
4628 }
4629 }
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004630 }
4631 }
Chris Lattnere9bed7d2005-09-18 03:42:07 +00004632
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004633 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004634}
4635
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +00004636namespace {
4637
Chris Lattnerc317d392004-02-16 01:20:27 +00004638// XorSelf - Implements: X ^ X --> 0
4639struct XorSelf {
4640 Value *RHS;
4641 XorSelf(Value *rhs) : RHS(rhs) {}
4642 bool shouldApply(Value *LHS) const { return LHS == RHS; }
4643 Instruction *apply(BinaryOperator &Xor) const {
4644 return &Xor;
4645 }
4646};
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004647
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +00004648}
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004649
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004650Instruction *InstCombiner::visitXor(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00004651 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004652 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004653
Evan Chengd34af782008-03-25 20:07:13 +00004654 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) {
4655 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0))
4656 // Handle undef ^ undef -> 0 special case. This is a common
4657 // idiom (misuse).
4658 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00004659 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X ^ undef -> undef
Evan Chengd34af782008-03-25 20:07:13 +00004660 }
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00004661
Chris Lattnerc317d392004-02-16 01:20:27 +00004662 // xor X, X = 0, even if X is nested in a sequence of Xor's.
4663 if (Instruction *Result = AssociativeOpt(I, XorSelf(Op1))) {
Chris Lattnera9ff5eb2007-08-05 08:47:58 +00004664 assert(Result == &I && "AssociativeOpt didn't work?"); Result=Result;
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00004665 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnerc317d392004-02-16 01:20:27 +00004666 }
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00004667
4668 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
4669 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00004670 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
4671 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())->getBitWidth();
4672 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
4673 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
4674 KnownZero, KnownOne))
4675 return &I;
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00004676 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(Op1)) {
4677 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // X ^ <0,0> -> X
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00004678 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004679
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004680 // Is this a ~ operation?
4681 if (Value *NotOp = dyn_castNotVal(&I)) {
4682 // ~(~X & Y) --> (X | ~Y) - De Morgan's Law
4683 // ~(~X | Y) === (X & ~Y) - De Morgan's Law
4684 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NotOp)) {
4685 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And ||
4686 Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
4687 if (dyn_castNotVal(Op0I->getOperand(1))) Op0I->swapOperands();
4688 if (Value *Op0NotVal = dyn_castNotVal(Op0I->getOperand(0))) {
4689 Instruction *NotY =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004690 BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Op0I->getOperand(1),
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004691 Op0I->getOperand(1)->getName()+".not");
4692 InsertNewInstBefore(NotY, I);
4693 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004694 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Op0NotVal, NotY);
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004695 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004696 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0NotVal, NotY);
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004697 }
4698 }
4699 }
4700 }
4701
4702
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004703 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Nick Lewyckyf947b3e2007-08-06 20:04:16 +00004704 // xor (cmp A, B), true = not (cmp A, B) = !cmp A, B
4705 if (RHS == ConstantInt::getTrue() && Op0->hasOneUse()) {
4706 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Op0))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004707 return new ICmpInst(ICI->getInversePredicate(),
4708 ICI->getOperand(0), ICI->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnerad5b4fb2003-11-04 23:50:51 +00004709
Nick Lewyckyf947b3e2007-08-06 20:04:16 +00004710 if (FCmpInst *FCI = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(Op0))
4711 return new FCmpInst(FCI->getInversePredicate(),
4712 FCI->getOperand(0), FCI->getOperand(1));
4713 }
4714
Nick Lewycky517e1f52008-05-31 19:01:33 +00004715 // fold (xor(zext(cmp)), 1) and (xor(sext(cmp)), -1) to ext(!cmp).
4716 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
4717 if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(Op0C->getOperand(0))) {
4718 if (CI->hasOneUse() && Op0C->hasOneUse()) {
4719 Instruction::CastOps Opcode = Op0C->getOpcode();
4720 if (Opcode == Instruction::ZExt || Opcode == Instruction::SExt) {
4721 if (RHS == ConstantExpr::getCast(Opcode, ConstantInt::getTrue(),
4722 Op0C->getDestTy())) {
4723 Instruction *NewCI = InsertNewInstBefore(CmpInst::Create(
4724 CI->getOpcode(), CI->getInversePredicate(),
4725 CI->getOperand(0), CI->getOperand(1)), I);
4726 NewCI->takeName(CI);
4727 return CastInst::Create(Opcode, NewCI, Op0C->getType());
4728 }
4729 }
4730 }
4731 }
4732 }
4733
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004734 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattnerd65460f2003-11-05 01:06:05 +00004735 // ~(c-X) == X-c-1 == X+(-c-1)
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004736 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub && RHS->isAllOnesValue())
4737 if (Constant *Op0I0C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op0I->getOperand(0))) {
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00004738 Constant *NegOp0I0C = ConstantExpr::getNeg(Op0I0C);
4739 Constant *ConstantRHS = ConstantExpr::getSub(NegOp0I0C,
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004740 ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004741 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Op0I->getOperand(1), ConstantRHS);
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004742 }
Chris Lattner5c6e2db2007-04-02 05:36:22 +00004743
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00004744 if (ConstantInt *Op0CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00004745 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
Chris Lattner689d24b2003-11-04 23:37:10 +00004746 // ~(X-c) --> (-c-1)-X
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004747 if (RHS->isAllOnesValue()) {
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00004748 Constant *NegOp0CI = ConstantExpr::getNeg(Op0CI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004749 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00004750 ConstantExpr::getSub(NegOp0CI,
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004751 ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1)),
Chris Lattner689d24b2003-11-04 23:37:10 +00004752 Op0I->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattneracf4e072007-04-02 05:42:22 +00004753 } else if (RHS->getValue().isSignBit()) {
Chris Lattner5c6e2db2007-04-02 05:36:22 +00004754 // (X + C) ^ signbit -> (X + C + signbit)
4755 Constant *C = ConstantInt::get(RHS->getValue() + Op0CI->getValue());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004756 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Op0I->getOperand(0), C);
Chris Lattnercd1d6d52007-04-02 05:48:58 +00004757
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004758 }
Chris Lattner02bd1b32006-02-26 19:57:54 +00004759 } else if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
4760 // (X|C1)^C2 -> X^(C1|C2) iff X&~C1 == 0
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00004761 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op0I->getOperand(0), Op0CI->getValue())) {
Chris Lattner02bd1b32006-02-26 19:57:54 +00004762 Constant *NewRHS = ConstantExpr::getOr(Op0CI, RHS);
4763 // Anything in both C1 and C2 is known to be zero, remove it from
4764 // NewRHS.
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00004765 Constant *CommonBits = And(Op0CI, RHS);
Chris Lattner02bd1b32006-02-26 19:57:54 +00004766 NewRHS = ConstantExpr::getAnd(NewRHS,
4767 ConstantExpr::getNot(CommonBits));
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00004768 AddToWorkList(Op0I);
Chris Lattner02bd1b32006-02-26 19:57:54 +00004769 I.setOperand(0, Op0I->getOperand(0));
4770 I.setOperand(1, NewRHS);
4771 return &I;
4772 }
Chris Lattnereca0c5c2003-07-23 21:37:07 +00004773 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00004774 }
Chris Lattner05bd1b22002-08-20 18:24:26 +00004775 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00004776
4777 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
4778 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00004779 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00004780 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00004781 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
4782 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
4783 return NV;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004784 }
4785
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00004786 if (Value *X = dyn_castNotVal(Op0)) // ~A ^ A == -1
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004787 if (X == Op1)
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004788 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004789
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00004790 if (Value *X = dyn_castNotVal(Op1)) // A ^ ~A == -1
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004791 if (X == Op0)
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004792 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004793
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004794
4795 BinaryOperator *Op1I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1);
4796 if (Op1I) {
4797 Value *A, *B;
4798 if (match(Op1I, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
4799 if (A == Op0) { // B^(B|A) == (A|B)^B
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004800 Op1I->swapOperands();
Chris Lattnercb40a372003-03-10 18:24:17 +00004801 I.swapOperands();
4802 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004803 } else if (B == Op0) { // B^(A|B) == (A|B)^B
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004804 I.swapOperands(); // Simplified below.
Chris Lattnercb40a372003-03-10 18:24:17 +00004805 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004806 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004807 } else if (match(Op1I, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
4808 if (Op0 == A) // A^(A^B) == B
4809 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
4810 else if (Op0 == B) // A^(B^A) == B
4811 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
4812 } else if (match(Op1I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && Op1I->hasOneUse()){
Chris Lattner6abbdf92007-04-01 05:36:37 +00004813 if (A == Op0) { // A^(A&B) -> A^(B&A)
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004814 Op1I->swapOperands();
Chris Lattner6abbdf92007-04-01 05:36:37 +00004815 std::swap(A, B);
4816 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004817 if (B == Op0) { // A^(B&A) -> (B&A)^A
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004818 I.swapOperands(); // Simplified below.
4819 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
4820 }
Chris Lattner26ca7e12004-02-16 03:54:20 +00004821 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004822 }
4823
4824 BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0);
4825 if (Op0I) {
4826 Value *A, *B;
4827 if (match(Op0I, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && Op0I->hasOneUse()) {
4828 if (A == Op1) // (B|A)^B == (A|B)^B
4829 std::swap(A, B);
4830 if (B == Op1) { // (A|B)^B == A & ~B
4831 Instruction *NotB =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004832 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Op1, "tmp"), I);
4833 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(A, NotB);
Chris Lattnercb40a372003-03-10 18:24:17 +00004834 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004835 } else if (match(Op0I, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
4836 if (Op1 == A) // (A^B)^A == B
4837 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
4838 else if (Op1 == B) // (B^A)^A == B
4839 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
4840 } else if (match(Op0I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && Op0I->hasOneUse()){
4841 if (A == Op1) // (A&B)^A -> (B&A)^A
4842 std::swap(A, B);
4843 if (B == Op1 && // (B&A)^A == ~B & A
Chris Lattnerae1ab392006-04-01 22:05:01 +00004844 !isa<ConstantInt>(Op1)) { // Canonical form is (B&C)^C
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004845 Instruction *N =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004846 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(A, "tmp"), I);
4847 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(N, Op1);
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004848 }
Chris Lattnercb40a372003-03-10 18:24:17 +00004849 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004850 }
4851
4852 // (X >> Z) ^ (Y >> Z) -> (X^Y) >> Z for all shifts.
4853 if (Op0I && Op1I && Op0I->isShift() &&
4854 Op0I->getOpcode() == Op1I->getOpcode() &&
4855 Op0I->getOperand(1) == Op1I->getOperand(1) &&
4856 (Op1I->hasOneUse() || Op1I->hasOneUse())) {
4857 Instruction *NewOp =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004858 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Op0I->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004859 Op1I->getOperand(0),
4860 Op0I->getName()), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004861 return BinaryOperator::Create(Op1I->getOpcode(), NewOp,
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004862 Op1I->getOperand(1));
4863 }
4864
4865 if (Op0I && Op1I) {
4866 Value *A, *B, *C, *D;
4867 // (A & B)^(A | B) -> A ^ B
4868 if (match(Op0I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
4869 match(Op1I, m_Or(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
4870 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004871 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(A, B);
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004872 }
4873 // (A | B)^(A & B) -> A ^ B
4874 if (match(Op0I, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
4875 match(Op1I, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
4876 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004877 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(A, B);
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004878 }
4879
4880 // (A & B)^(C & D)
4881 if ((Op0I->hasOneUse() || Op1I->hasOneUse()) &&
4882 match(Op0I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
4883 match(Op1I, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
4884 // (X & Y)^(X & Y) -> (Y^Z) & X
4885 Value *X = 0, *Y = 0, *Z = 0;
4886 if (A == C)
4887 X = A, Y = B, Z = D;
4888 else if (A == D)
4889 X = A, Y = B, Z = C;
4890 else if (B == C)
4891 X = B, Y = A, Z = D;
4892 else if (B == D)
4893 X = B, Y = A, Z = C;
4894
4895 if (X) {
4896 Instruction *NewOp =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004897 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Y, Z, Op0->getName()), I);
4898 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NewOp, X);
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004899 }
4900 }
4901 }
4902
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004903 // (icmp1 A, B) ^ (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
4904 if (ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(I.getOperand(1)))
4905 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, FoldICmpLogical(*this, RHS)))
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00004906 return R;
4907
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004908 // fold (xor (cast A), (cast B)) -> (cast (xor A, B))
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004909 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004910 if (CastInst *Op1C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004911 if (Op0C->getOpcode() == Op1C->getOpcode()) { // same cast kind?
4912 const Type *SrcTy = Op0C->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00004913 if (SrcTy == Op1C->getOperand(0)->getType() && SrcTy->isInteger() &&
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004914 // Only do this if the casts both really cause code to be generated.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004915 ValueRequiresCast(Op0C->getOpcode(), Op0C->getOperand(0),
4916 I.getType(), TD) &&
4917 ValueRequiresCast(Op1C->getOpcode(), Op1C->getOperand(0),
4918 I.getType(), TD)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004919 Instruction *NewOp = BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Op0C->getOperand(0),
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004920 Op1C->getOperand(0),
4921 I.getName());
4922 InsertNewInstBefore(NewOp, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004923 return CastInst::Create(Op0C->getOpcode(), NewOp, I.getType());
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004924 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004925 }
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004926 }
Nick Lewycky517e1f52008-05-31 19:01:33 +00004927
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004928 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004929}
4930
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004931/// AddWithOverflow - Compute Result = In1+In2, returning true if the result
4932/// overflowed for this type.
4933static bool AddWithOverflow(ConstantInt *&Result, ConstantInt *In1,
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00004934 ConstantInt *In2, bool IsSigned = false) {
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00004935 Result = cast<ConstantInt>(Add(In1, In2));
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004936
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00004937 if (IsSigned)
4938 if (In2->getValue().isNegative())
4939 return Result->getValue().sgt(In1->getValue());
4940 else
4941 return Result->getValue().slt(In1->getValue());
4942 else
4943 return Result->getValue().ult(In1->getValue());
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004944}
4945
Dan Gohman1df3fd62008-09-10 23:30:57 +00004946/// SubWithOverflow - Compute Result = In1-In2, returning true if the result
4947/// overflowed for this type.
4948static bool SubWithOverflow(ConstantInt *&Result, ConstantInt *In1,
4949 ConstantInt *In2, bool IsSigned = false) {
Dan Gohmanbcb37fd2008-09-11 18:53:02 +00004950 Result = cast<ConstantInt>(Subtract(In1, In2));
Dan Gohman1df3fd62008-09-10 23:30:57 +00004951
4952 if (IsSigned)
4953 if (In2->getValue().isNegative())
4954 return Result->getValue().slt(In1->getValue());
4955 else
4956 return Result->getValue().sgt(In1->getValue());
4957 else
4958 return Result->getValue().ugt(In1->getValue());
4959}
4960
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004961/// EmitGEPOffset - Given a getelementptr instruction/constantexpr, emit the
4962/// code necessary to compute the offset from the base pointer (without adding
4963/// in the base pointer). Return the result as a signed integer of intptr size.
4964static Value *EmitGEPOffset(User *GEP, Instruction &I, InstCombiner &IC) {
4965 TargetData &TD = IC.getTargetData();
4966 gep_type_iterator GTI = gep_type_begin(GEP);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004967 const Type *IntPtrTy = TD.getIntPtrType();
4968 Value *Result = Constant::getNullValue(IntPtrTy);
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004969
4970 // Build a mask for high order bits.
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00004971 unsigned IntPtrWidth = TD.getPointerSizeInBits();
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004972 uint64_t PtrSizeMask = ~0ULL >> (64-IntPtrWidth);
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004973
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +00004974 for (User::op_iterator i = GEP->op_begin() + 1, e = GEP->op_end(); i != e;
4975 ++i, ++GTI) {
4976 Value *Op = *i;
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +00004977 uint64_t Size = TD.getABITypeSize(GTI.getIndexedType()) & PtrSizeMask;
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004978 if (ConstantInt *OpC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op)) {
4979 if (OpC->isZero()) continue;
4980
4981 // Handle a struct index, which adds its field offset to the pointer.
4982 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(*GTI)) {
4983 Size = TD.getStructLayout(STy)->getElementOffset(OpC->getZExtValue());
4984
4985 if (ConstantInt *RC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Result))
4986 Result = ConstantInt::get(RC->getValue() + APInt(IntPtrWidth, Size));
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00004987 else
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004988 Result = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004989 BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Result,
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004990 ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, Size),
4991 GEP->getName()+".offs"), I);
4992 continue;
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00004993 }
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004994
4995 Constant *Scale = ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, Size);
4996 Constant *OC = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(OpC, IntPtrTy, true /*SExt*/);
4997 Scale = ConstantExpr::getMul(OC, Scale);
4998 if (Constant *RC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Result))
4999 Result = ConstantExpr::getAdd(RC, Scale);
5000 else {
5001 // Emit an add instruction.
5002 Result = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005003 BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Result, Scale,
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005004 GEP->getName()+".offs"), I);
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00005005 }
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005006 continue;
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005007 }
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005008 // Convert to correct type.
5009 if (Op->getType() != IntPtrTy) {
5010 if (Constant *OpC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op))
5011 Op = ConstantExpr::getSExt(OpC, IntPtrTy);
5012 else
5013 Op = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(new SExtInst(Op, IntPtrTy,
5014 Op->getName()+".c"), I);
5015 }
5016 if (Size != 1) {
5017 Constant *Scale = ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, Size);
5018 if (Constant *OpC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op))
5019 Op = ConstantExpr::getMul(OpC, Scale);
5020 else // We'll let instcombine(mul) convert this to a shl if possible.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005021 Op = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Op, Scale,
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005022 GEP->getName()+".idx"), I);
5023 }
5024
5025 // Emit an add instruction.
5026 if (isa<Constant>(Op) && isa<Constant>(Result))
5027 Result = ConstantExpr::getAdd(cast<Constant>(Op),
5028 cast<Constant>(Result));
5029 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005030 Result = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Op, Result,
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005031 GEP->getName()+".offs"), I);
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005032 }
5033 return Result;
5034}
5035
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005036
5037/// EvaluateGEPOffsetExpression - Return an value that can be used to compare of
5038/// the *offset* implied by GEP to zero. For example, if we have &A[i], we want
5039/// to return 'i' for "icmp ne i, 0". Note that, in general, indices can be
5040/// complex, and scales are involved. The above expression would also be legal
5041/// to codegen as "icmp ne (i*4), 0" (assuming A is a pointer to i32). This
5042/// later form is less amenable to optimization though, and we are allowed to
5043/// generate the first by knowing that pointer arithmetic doesn't overflow.
5044///
5045/// If we can't emit an optimized form for this expression, this returns null.
5046///
5047static Value *EvaluateGEPOffsetExpression(User *GEP, Instruction &I,
5048 InstCombiner &IC) {
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005049 TargetData &TD = IC.getTargetData();
5050 gep_type_iterator GTI = gep_type_begin(GEP);
5051
5052 // Check to see if this gep only has a single variable index. If so, and if
5053 // any constant indices are a multiple of its scale, then we can compute this
5054 // in terms of the scale of the variable index. For example, if the GEP
5055 // implies an offset of "12 + i*4", then we can codegen this as "3 + i",
5056 // because the expression will cross zero at the same point.
5057 unsigned i, e = GEP->getNumOperands();
5058 int64_t Offset = 0;
5059 for (i = 1; i != e; ++i, ++GTI) {
5060 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(GEP->getOperand(i))) {
5061 // Compute the aggregate offset of constant indices.
5062 if (CI->isZero()) continue;
5063
5064 // Handle a struct index, which adds its field offset to the pointer.
5065 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(*GTI)) {
5066 Offset += TD.getStructLayout(STy)->getElementOffset(CI->getZExtValue());
5067 } else {
5068 uint64_t Size = TD.getABITypeSize(GTI.getIndexedType());
5069 Offset += Size*CI->getSExtValue();
5070 }
5071 } else {
5072 // Found our variable index.
5073 break;
5074 }
5075 }
5076
5077 // If there are no variable indices, we must have a constant offset, just
5078 // evaluate it the general way.
5079 if (i == e) return 0;
5080
5081 Value *VariableIdx = GEP->getOperand(i);
5082 // Determine the scale factor of the variable element. For example, this is
5083 // 4 if the variable index is into an array of i32.
5084 uint64_t VariableScale = TD.getABITypeSize(GTI.getIndexedType());
5085
5086 // Verify that there are no other variable indices. If so, emit the hard way.
5087 for (++i, ++GTI; i != e; ++i, ++GTI) {
5088 ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(GEP->getOperand(i));
5089 if (!CI) return 0;
5090
5091 // Compute the aggregate offset of constant indices.
5092 if (CI->isZero()) continue;
5093
5094 // Handle a struct index, which adds its field offset to the pointer.
5095 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(*GTI)) {
5096 Offset += TD.getStructLayout(STy)->getElementOffset(CI->getZExtValue());
5097 } else {
5098 uint64_t Size = TD.getABITypeSize(GTI.getIndexedType());
5099 Offset += Size*CI->getSExtValue();
5100 }
5101 }
5102
5103 // Okay, we know we have a single variable index, which must be a
5104 // pointer/array/vector index. If there is no offset, life is simple, return
5105 // the index.
5106 unsigned IntPtrWidth = TD.getPointerSizeInBits();
5107 if (Offset == 0) {
5108 // Cast to intptrty in case a truncation occurs. If an extension is needed,
5109 // we don't need to bother extending: the extension won't affect where the
5110 // computation crosses zero.
5111 if (VariableIdx->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() > IntPtrWidth)
5112 VariableIdx = new TruncInst(VariableIdx, TD.getIntPtrType(),
5113 VariableIdx->getNameStart(), &I);
5114 return VariableIdx;
5115 }
5116
5117 // Otherwise, there is an index. The computation we will do will be modulo
5118 // the pointer size, so get it.
5119 uint64_t PtrSizeMask = ~0ULL >> (64-IntPtrWidth);
5120
5121 Offset &= PtrSizeMask;
5122 VariableScale &= PtrSizeMask;
5123
5124 // To do this transformation, any constant index must be a multiple of the
5125 // variable scale factor. For example, we can evaluate "12 + 4*i" as "3 + i",
5126 // but we can't evaluate "10 + 3*i" in terms of i. Check that the offset is a
5127 // multiple of the variable scale.
5128 int64_t NewOffs = Offset / (int64_t)VariableScale;
5129 if (Offset != NewOffs*(int64_t)VariableScale)
5130 return 0;
5131
5132 // Okay, we can do this evaluation. Start by converting the index to intptr.
5133 const Type *IntPtrTy = TD.getIntPtrType();
5134 if (VariableIdx->getType() != IntPtrTy)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005135 VariableIdx = CastInst::CreateIntegerCast(VariableIdx, IntPtrTy,
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005136 true /*SExt*/,
5137 VariableIdx->getNameStart(), &I);
5138 Constant *OffsetVal = ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, NewOffs);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005139 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(VariableIdx, OffsetVal, "offset", &I);
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005140}
5141
5142
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005143/// FoldGEPICmp - Fold comparisons between a GEP instruction and something
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005144/// else. At this point we know that the GEP is on the LHS of the comparison.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005145Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldGEPICmp(User *GEPLHS, Value *RHS,
5146 ICmpInst::Predicate Cond,
5147 Instruction &I) {
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005148 assert(dyn_castGetElementPtr(GEPLHS) && "LHS is not a getelementptr!");
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00005149
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005150 // Look through bitcasts.
5151 if (BitCastInst *BCI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(RHS))
5152 RHS = BCI->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00005153
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005154 Value *PtrBase = GEPLHS->getOperand(0);
5155 if (PtrBase == RHS) {
Chris Lattner7c95deb2008-02-05 04:45:32 +00005156 // ((gep Ptr, OFFSET) cmp Ptr) ---> (OFFSET cmp 0).
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005157 // This transformation (ignoring the base and scales) is valid because we
5158 // know pointers can't overflow. See if we can output an optimized form.
5159 Value *Offset = EvaluateGEPOffsetExpression(GEPLHS, I, *this);
5160
5161 // If not, synthesize the offset the hard way.
5162 if (Offset == 0)
5163 Offset = EmitGEPOffset(GEPLHS, I, *this);
Chris Lattner7c95deb2008-02-05 04:45:32 +00005164 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond), Offset,
5165 Constant::getNullValue(Offset->getType()));
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005166 } else if (User *GEPRHS = dyn_castGetElementPtr(RHS)) {
Chris Lattnera70b66d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00005167 // If the base pointers are different, but the indices are the same, just
5168 // compare the base pointer.
5169 if (PtrBase != GEPRHS->getOperand(0)) {
5170 bool IndicesTheSame = GEPLHS->getNumOperands()==GEPRHS->getNumOperands();
Jeff Cohen00b168892005-07-27 06:12:32 +00005171 IndicesTheSame &= GEPLHS->getOperand(0)->getType() ==
Chris Lattner93b94a62005-04-26 14:40:41 +00005172 GEPRHS->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattnera70b66d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00005173 if (IndicesTheSame)
5174 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPLHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
5175 if (GEPLHS->getOperand(i) != GEPRHS->getOperand(i)) {
5176 IndicesTheSame = false;
5177 break;
5178 }
5179
5180 // If all indices are the same, just compare the base pointers.
5181 if (IndicesTheSame)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005182 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond),
5183 GEPLHS->getOperand(0), GEPRHS->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnera70b66d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00005184
5185 // Otherwise, the base pointers are different and the indices are
5186 // different, bail out.
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005187 return 0;
Chris Lattnera70b66d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00005188 }
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005189
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00005190 // If one of the GEPs has all zero indices, recurse.
5191 bool AllZeros = true;
5192 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPLHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
5193 if (!isa<Constant>(GEPLHS->getOperand(i)) ||
5194 !cast<Constant>(GEPLHS->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
5195 AllZeros = false;
5196 break;
5197 }
5198 if (AllZeros)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005199 return FoldGEPICmp(GEPRHS, GEPLHS->getOperand(0),
5200 ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Cond), I);
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00005201
5202 // If the other GEP has all zero indices, recurse.
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00005203 AllZeros = true;
5204 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPRHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
5205 if (!isa<Constant>(GEPRHS->getOperand(i)) ||
5206 !cast<Constant>(GEPRHS->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
5207 AllZeros = false;
5208 break;
5209 }
5210 if (AllZeros)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005211 return FoldGEPICmp(GEPLHS, GEPRHS->getOperand(0), Cond, I);
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00005212
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00005213 if (GEPLHS->getNumOperands() == GEPRHS->getNumOperands()) {
5214 // If the GEPs only differ by one index, compare it.
5215 unsigned NumDifferences = 0; // Keep track of # differences.
5216 unsigned DiffOperand = 0; // The operand that differs.
5217 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPRHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
5218 if (GEPLHS->getOperand(i) != GEPRHS->getOperand(i)) {
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005219 if (GEPLHS->getOperand(i)->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() !=
5220 GEPRHS->getOperand(i)->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) {
Chris Lattner45f57b82005-01-21 23:06:49 +00005221 // Irreconcilable differences.
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00005222 NumDifferences = 2;
5223 break;
5224 } else {
5225 if (NumDifferences++) break;
5226 DiffOperand = i;
5227 }
5228 }
5229
5230 if (NumDifferences == 0) // SAME GEP?
5231 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, // No comparison is needed here.
Nick Lewycky455e1762007-09-06 02:40:25 +00005232 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
Nick Lewyckyfc1efbb2008-05-17 07:33:39 +00005233 ICmpInst::isTrueWhenEqual(Cond)));
Nick Lewycky455e1762007-09-06 02:40:25 +00005234
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00005235 else if (NumDifferences == 1) {
Chris Lattner45f57b82005-01-21 23:06:49 +00005236 Value *LHSV = GEPLHS->getOperand(DiffOperand);
5237 Value *RHSV = GEPRHS->getOperand(DiffOperand);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005238 // Make sure we do a signed comparison here.
5239 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond), LHSV, RHSV);
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00005240 }
5241 }
5242
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005243 // Only lower this if the icmp is the only user of the GEP or if we expect
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005244 // the result to fold to a constant!
5245 if ((isa<ConstantExpr>(GEPLHS) || GEPLHS->hasOneUse()) &&
5246 (isa<ConstantExpr>(GEPRHS) || GEPRHS->hasOneUse())) {
5247 // ((gep Ptr, OFFSET1) cmp (gep Ptr, OFFSET2) ---> (OFFSET1 cmp OFFSET2)
5248 Value *L = EmitGEPOffset(GEPLHS, I, *this);
5249 Value *R = EmitGEPOffset(GEPRHS, I, *this);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005250 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond), L, R);
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005251 }
5252 }
5253 return 0;
5254}
5255
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005256/// FoldFCmp_IntToFP_Cst - Fold fcmp ([us]itofp x, cst) if possible.
5257///
5258Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldFCmp_IntToFP_Cst(FCmpInst &I,
5259 Instruction *LHSI,
5260 Constant *RHSC) {
5261 if (!isa<ConstantFP>(RHSC)) return 0;
5262 const APFloat &RHS = cast<ConstantFP>(RHSC)->getValueAPF();
5263
5264 // Get the width of the mantissa. We don't want to hack on conversions that
5265 // might lose information from the integer, e.g. "i64 -> float"
Chris Lattner7be1c452008-05-19 21:17:23 +00005266 int MantissaWidth = LHSI->getType()->getFPMantissaWidth();
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005267 if (MantissaWidth == -1) return 0; // Unknown.
5268
5269 // Check to see that the input is converted from an integer type that is small
5270 // enough that preserves all bits. TODO: check here for "known" sign bits.
5271 // This would allow us to handle (fptosi (x >>s 62) to float) if x is i64 f.e.
5272 unsigned InputSize = LHSI->getOperand(0)->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
5273
5274 // If this is a uitofp instruction, we need an extra bit to hold the sign.
5275 if (isa<UIToFPInst>(LHSI))
5276 ++InputSize;
5277
5278 // If the conversion would lose info, don't hack on this.
5279 if ((int)InputSize > MantissaWidth)
5280 return 0;
5281
5282 // Otherwise, we can potentially simplify the comparison. We know that it
5283 // will always come through as an integer value and we know the constant is
5284 // not a NAN (it would have been previously simplified).
5285 assert(!RHS.isNaN() && "NaN comparison not already folded!");
5286
5287 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred;
5288 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
5289 default: assert(0 && "Unexpected predicate!");
5290 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UEQ:
5291 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ: Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ; break;
5292 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGT:
5293 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGT: Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT; break;
5294 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGE:
5295 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE: Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE; break;
5296 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULT:
5297 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLT: Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT; break;
5298 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULE:
5299 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE: Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE; break;
5300 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNE:
5301 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE: Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_NE; break;
5302 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD:
5303 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
5304 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO:
5305 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
5306 }
5307
5308 const IntegerType *IntTy = cast<IntegerType>(LHSI->getOperand(0)->getType());
5309
5310 // Now we know that the APFloat is a normal number, zero or inf.
5311
Chris Lattner85162782008-05-20 03:50:52 +00005312 // See if the FP constant is too large for the integer. For example,
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005313 // comparing an i8 to 300.0.
5314 unsigned IntWidth = IntTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
5315
5316 // If the RHS value is > SignedMax, fold the comparison. This handles +INF
5317 // and large values.
5318 APFloat SMax(RHS.getSemantics(), APFloat::fcZero, false);
5319 SMax.convertFromAPInt(APInt::getSignedMaxValue(IntWidth), true,
5320 APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven);
5321 if (SMax.compare(RHS) == APFloat::cmpLessThan) { // smax < 13123.0
Chris Lattner393f7eb2008-05-24 04:06:28 +00005322 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE || Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT ||
5323 Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE)
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005324 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
5325 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
5326 }
5327
5328 // See if the RHS value is < SignedMin.
5329 APFloat SMin(RHS.getSemantics(), APFloat::fcZero, false);
5330 SMin.convertFromAPInt(APInt::getSignedMinValue(IntWidth), true,
5331 APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven);
5332 if (SMin.compare(RHS) == APFloat::cmpGreaterThan) { // smin > 12312.0
Chris Lattner393f7eb2008-05-24 04:06:28 +00005333 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE || Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT ||
5334 Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE)
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005335 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
5336 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
5337 }
5338
5339 // Okay, now we know that the FP constant fits in the range [SMIN, SMAX] but
5340 // it may still be fractional. See if it is fractional by casting the FP
5341 // value to the integer value and back, checking for equality. Don't do this
5342 // for zero, because -0.0 is not fractional.
5343 Constant *RHSInt = ConstantExpr::getFPToSI(RHSC, IntTy);
5344 if (!RHS.isZero() &&
5345 ConstantExpr::getSIToFP(RHSInt, RHSC->getType()) != RHSC) {
5346 // If we had a comparison against a fractional value, we have to adjust
5347 // the compare predicate and sometimes the value. RHSC is rounded towards
5348 // zero at this point.
5349 switch (Pred) {
5350 default: assert(0 && "Unexpected integer comparison!");
5351 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (float)int != 4.4 --> true
5352 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
5353 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (float)int == 4.4 --> false
5354 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
5355 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:
5356 // (float)int <= 4.4 --> int <= 4
5357 // (float)int <= -4.4 --> int < -4
5358 if (RHS.isNegative())
5359 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT;
5360 break;
5361 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
5362 // (float)int < -4.4 --> int < -4
5363 // (float)int < 4.4 --> int <= 4
5364 if (!RHS.isNegative())
5365 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE;
5366 break;
5367 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
5368 // (float)int > 4.4 --> int > 4
5369 // (float)int > -4.4 --> int >= -4
5370 if (RHS.isNegative())
5371 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE;
5372 break;
5373 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
5374 // (float)int >= -4.4 --> int >= -4
5375 // (float)int >= 4.4 --> int > 4
5376 if (!RHS.isNegative())
5377 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT;
5378 break;
5379 }
5380 }
5381
5382 // Lower this FP comparison into an appropriate integer version of the
5383 // comparison.
5384 return new ICmpInst(Pred, LHSI->getOperand(0), RHSInt);
5385}
5386
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005387Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFCmpInst(FCmpInst &I) {
5388 bool Changed = SimplifyCompare(I);
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005389 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005390
Chris Lattner58e97462007-01-14 19:42:17 +00005391 // Fold trivial predicates.
5392 if (I.getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_FALSE)
5393 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int1Ty));
5394 if (I.getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_TRUE)
5395 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
5396
5397 // Simplify 'fcmp pred X, X'
5398 if (Op0 == Op1) {
5399 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
5400 default: assert(0 && "Unknown predicate!");
5401 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UEQ: // True if unordered or equal
5402 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGE: // True if unordered, greater than, or equal
5403 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULE: // True if unordered, less than, or equal
5404 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
5405 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGT: // True if ordered and greater than
5406 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLT: // True if ordered and less than
5407 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE: // True if ordered and operands are unequal
5408 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
5409
5410 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO: // True if unordered: isnan(X) | isnan(Y)
5411 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULT: // True if unordered or less than
5412 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGT: // True if unordered or greater than
5413 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNE: // True if unordered or not equal
5414 // Canonicalize these to be 'fcmp uno %X, 0.0'.
5415 I.setPredicate(FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO);
5416 I.setOperand(1, Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
5417 return &I;
5418
5419 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD: // True if ordered (no nans)
5420 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ: // True if ordered and equal
5421 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE: // True if ordered and greater than or equal
5422 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE: // True if ordered and less than or equal
5423 // Canonicalize these to be 'fcmp ord %X, 0.0'.
5424 I.setPredicate(FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD);
5425 I.setOperand(1, Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
5426 return &I;
5427 }
5428 }
5429
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005430 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // fcmp pred X, undef -> undef
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00005431 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, UndefValue::get(Type::Int1Ty));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00005432
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005433 // Handle fcmp with constant RHS
5434 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005435 // If the constant is a nan, see if we can fold the comparison based on it.
5436 if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHSC)) {
5437 if (CFP->getValueAPF().isNaN()) {
5438 if (FCmpInst::isOrdered(I.getPredicate())) // True if ordered and...
5439 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
Chris Lattner85162782008-05-20 03:50:52 +00005440 assert(FCmpInst::isUnordered(I.getPredicate()) &&
5441 "Comparison must be either ordered or unordered!");
5442 // True if unordered.
5443 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005444 }
5445 }
5446
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005447 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
5448 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
5449 case Instruction::PHI:
Chris Lattner7d8ab4e2008-06-08 20:52:11 +00005450 // Only fold fcmp into the PHI if the phi and fcmp are in the same
5451 // block. If in the same block, we're encouraging jump threading. If
5452 // not, we are just pessimizing the code by making an i1 phi.
5453 if (LHSI->getParent() == I.getParent())
5454 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
5455 return NV;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005456 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005457 case Instruction::SIToFP:
5458 case Instruction::UIToFP:
5459 if (Instruction *NV = FoldFCmp_IntToFP_Cst(I, LHSI, RHSC))
5460 return NV;
5461 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005462 case Instruction::Select:
5463 // If either operand of the select is a constant, we can fold the
5464 // comparison into the select arms, which will cause one to be
5465 // constant folded and the select turned into a bitwise or.
5466 Value *Op1 = 0, *Op2 = 0;
5467 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
5468 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
5469 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
5470 Op1 = ConstantExpr::getCompare(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
5471 // Insert a new FCmp of the other select operand.
5472 Op2 = InsertNewInstBefore(new FCmpInst(I.getPredicate(),
5473 LHSI->getOperand(2), RHSC,
5474 I.getName()), I);
5475 } else if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(2))) {
5476 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
5477 Op2 = ConstantExpr::getCompare(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
5478 // Insert a new FCmp of the other select operand.
5479 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(new FCmpInst(I.getPredicate(),
5480 LHSI->getOperand(1), RHSC,
5481 I.getName()), I);
5482 }
5483 }
5484
5485 if (Op1)
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00005486 return SelectInst::Create(LHSI->getOperand(0), Op1, Op2);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005487 break;
5488 }
5489 }
5490
5491 return Changed ? &I : 0;
5492}
5493
5494Instruction *InstCombiner::visitICmpInst(ICmpInst &I) {
5495 bool Changed = SimplifyCompare(I);
5496 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
5497 const Type *Ty = Op0->getType();
5498
5499 // icmp X, X
5500 if (Op0 == Op1)
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00005501 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
Nick Lewyckyfc1efbb2008-05-17 07:33:39 +00005502 I.isTrueWhenEqual()));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005503
5504 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // X icmp undef -> undef
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00005505 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, UndefValue::get(Type::Int1Ty));
Christopher Lamb7a0678c2007-12-18 21:32:20 +00005506
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005507 // icmp <global/alloca*/null>, <global/alloca*/null> - Global/Stack value
Chris Lattner711b3402004-11-14 07:33:16 +00005508 // addresses never equal each other! We already know that Op0 != Op1.
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00005509 if ((isa<GlobalValue>(Op0) || isa<AllocaInst>(Op0) ||
5510 isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op0)) &&
5511 (isa<GlobalValue>(Op1) || isa<AllocaInst>(Op1) ||
Chris Lattner711b3402004-11-14 07:33:16 +00005512 isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op1)))
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00005513 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
Nick Lewyckyfc1efbb2008-05-17 07:33:39 +00005514 !I.isTrueWhenEqual()));
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005515
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005516 // icmp's with boolean values can always be turned into bitwise operations
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00005517 if (Ty == Type::Int1Ty) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005518 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
5519 default: assert(0 && "Invalid icmp instruction!");
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005520 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: { // icmp eq i1 A, B -> ~(A^B)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005521 Instruction *Xor = BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Op0, Op1, I.getName()+"tmp");
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005522 InsertNewInstBefore(Xor, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005523 return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Xor);
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005524 }
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005525 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // icmp eq i1 A, B -> A^B
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005526 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005527
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005528 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005529 std::swap(Op0, Op1); // Change icmp ugt -> icmp ult
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005530 // FALL THROUGH
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005531 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:{ // icmp ult i1 A, B -> ~A & B
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005532 Instruction *Not = BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Op0, I.getName()+"tmp");
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005533 InsertNewInstBefore(Not, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005534 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Not, Op1);
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005535 }
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005536 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
5537 std::swap(Op0, Op1); // Change icmp sgt -> icmp slt
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005538 // FALL THROUGH
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005539 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: { // icmp slt i1 A, B -> A & ~B
5540 Instruction *Not = BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Op1, I.getName()+"tmp");
5541 InsertNewInstBefore(Not, I);
5542 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Not, Op0);
5543 }
5544 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
5545 std::swap(Op0, Op1); // Change icmp uge -> icmp ule
5546 // FALL THROUGH
5547 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE: { // icmp ule i1 A, B -> ~A | B
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005548 Instruction *Not = BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Op0, I.getName()+"tmp");
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005549 InsertNewInstBefore(Not, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005550 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Not, Op1);
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005551 }
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005552 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
5553 std::swap(Op0, Op1); // Change icmp sge -> icmp sle
5554 // FALL THROUGH
5555 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE: { // icmp sle i1 A, B -> A | ~B
5556 Instruction *Not = BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Op1, I.getName()+"tmp");
5557 InsertNewInstBefore(Not, I);
5558 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Not, Op0);
5559 }
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005560 }
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005561 }
5562
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00005563 // See if we are doing a comparison with a constant.
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005564 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnerf2991842008-07-11 04:09:09 +00005565 Value *A, *B;
Christopher Lamb103e1a32007-12-20 07:21:11 +00005566
Chris Lattnerb6566012008-01-05 01:18:20 +00005567 // (icmp ne/eq (sub A B) 0) -> (icmp ne/eq A, B)
5568 if (I.isEquality() && CI->isNullValue() &&
5569 match(Op0, m_Sub(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
5570 // (icmp cond A B) if cond is equality
5571 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A, B);
Owen Andersonf5783f82007-12-28 07:42:12 +00005572 }
Christopher Lamb103e1a32007-12-20 07:21:11 +00005573
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00005574 // If we have an icmp le or icmp ge instruction, turn it into the
5575 // appropriate icmp lt or icmp gt instruction. This allows us to rely on
5576 // them being folded in the code below.
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005577 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
5578 default: break;
5579 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE:
5580 if (CI->isMaxValue(false)) // A <=u MAX -> TRUE
5581 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5582 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Op0, AddOne(CI));
5583 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:
5584 if (CI->isMaxValue(true)) // A <=s MAX -> TRUE
5585 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5586 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, Op0, AddOne(CI));
5587 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
5588 if (CI->isMinValue(false)) // A >=u MIN -> TRUE
5589 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5590 return new ICmpInst( ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, Op0, SubOne(CI));
5591 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
5592 if (CI->isMinValue(true)) // A >=s MIN -> TRUE
5593 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5594 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, Op0, SubOne(CI));
5595 }
5596
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005597 // See if we can fold the comparison based on range information we can get
5598 // by checking whether bits are known to be zero or one in the input.
5599 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(Ty)->getBitWidth();
5600 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
5601
5602 // If this comparison is a normal comparison, it demands all
Chris Lattner4241e4d2007-07-15 20:54:51 +00005603 // bits, if it is a sign bit comparison, it only demands the sign bit.
Chris Lattner4241e4d2007-07-15 20:54:51 +00005604 bool UnusedBit;
5605 bool isSignBit = isSignBitCheck(I.getPredicate(), CI, UnusedBit);
5606
Chris Lattner4241e4d2007-07-15 20:54:51 +00005607 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(Op0,
5608 isSignBit ? APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth)
5609 : APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +00005610 KnownZero, KnownOne, 0))
5611 return &I;
5612
5613 // Given the known and unknown bits, compute a range that the LHS could be
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005614 // in. Compute the Min, Max and RHS values based on the known bits. For the
5615 // EQ and NE we use unsigned values.
5616 APInt Min(BitWidth, 0), Max(BitWidth, 0);
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005617 if (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(I.getPredicate()))
5618 ComputeSignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(Ty, KnownZero, KnownOne, Min, Max);
5619 else
5620 ComputeUnsignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(Ty, KnownZero, KnownOne,Min,Max);
5621
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005622 // If Min and Max are known to be the same, then SimplifyDemandedBits
5623 // figured out that the LHS is a constant. Just constant fold this now so
5624 // that code below can assume that Min != Max.
5625 if (Min == Max)
5626 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantExpr::getICmp(I.getPredicate(),
5627 ConstantInt::get(Min),
5628 CI));
5629
5630 // Based on the range information we know about the LHS, see if we can
5631 // simplify this comparison. For example, (x&4) < 8 is always true.
5632 const APInt &RHSVal = CI->getValue();
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005633 switch (I.getPredicate()) { // LE/GE have been folded already.
5634 default: assert(0 && "Unknown icmp opcode!");
5635 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
5636 if (Max.ult(RHSVal) || Min.ugt(RHSVal))
5637 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
5638 break;
5639 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
5640 if (Max.ult(RHSVal) || Min.ugt(RHSVal))
5641 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5642 break;
5643 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005644 if (Max.ult(RHSVal)) // A <u C -> true iff max(A) < C
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005645 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005646 if (Min.uge(RHSVal)) // A <u C -> false iff min(A) >= C
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005647 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005648 if (RHSVal == Max) // A <u MAX -> A != MAX
5649 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
5650 if (RHSVal == Min+1) // A <u MIN+1 -> A == MIN
5651 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, SubOne(CI));
5652
5653 // (x <u 2147483648) -> (x >s -1) -> true if sign bit clear
5654 if (CI->isMinValue(true))
5655 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, Op0,
5656 ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(Op0->getType()));
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005657 break;
5658 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005659 if (Min.ugt(RHSVal)) // A >u C -> true iff min(A) > C
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005660 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005661 if (Max.ule(RHSVal)) // A >u C -> false iff max(A) <= C
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005662 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005663
5664 if (RHSVal == Min) // A >u MIN -> A != MIN
5665 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
5666 if (RHSVal == Max-1) // A >u MAX-1 -> A == MAX
5667 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, AddOne(CI));
5668
5669 // (x >u 2147483647) -> (x <s 0) -> true if sign bit set
5670 if (CI->isMaxValue(true))
5671 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, Op0,
5672 ConstantInt::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005673 break;
5674 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005675 if (Max.slt(RHSVal)) // A <s C -> true iff max(A) < C
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005676 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattnerd01bee72008-07-11 06:40:29 +00005677 if (Min.sge(RHSVal)) // A <s C -> false iff min(A) >= C
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005678 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005679 if (RHSVal == Max) // A <s MAX -> A != MAX
5680 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattnera8ff4a82008-07-11 06:36:01 +00005681 if (RHSVal == Min+1) // A <s MIN+1 -> A == MIN
Chris Lattnerf9685ac2008-07-11 06:38:16 +00005682 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, SubOne(CI));
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005683 break;
5684 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005685 if (Min.sgt(RHSVal)) // A >s C -> true iff min(A) > C
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005686 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005687 if (Max.sle(RHSVal)) // A >s C -> false iff max(A) <= C
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005688 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005689
5690 if (RHSVal == Min) // A >s MIN -> A != MIN
5691 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
5692 if (RHSVal == Max-1) // A >s MAX-1 -> A == MAX
5693 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, AddOne(CI));
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005694 break;
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +00005695 }
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00005696 }
5697
5698 // Test if the ICmpInst instruction is used exclusively by a select as
5699 // part of a minimum or maximum operation. If so, refrain from doing
5700 // any other folding. This helps out other analyses which understand
5701 // non-obfuscated minimum and maximum idioms, such as ScalarEvolution
5702 // and CodeGen. And in this case, at least one of the comparison
5703 // operands has at least one user besides the compare (the select),
5704 // which would often largely negate the benefit of folding anyway.
5705 if (I.hasOneUse())
5706 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(*I.use_begin()))
5707 if ((SI->getOperand(1) == Op0 && SI->getOperand(2) == Op1) ||
5708 (SI->getOperand(2) == Op0 && SI->getOperand(1) == Op1))
5709 return 0;
5710
5711 // See if we are doing a comparison between a constant and an instruction that
5712 // can be folded into the comparison.
5713 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005714 // Since the RHS is a ConstantInt (CI), if the left hand side is an
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00005715 // instruction, see if that instruction also has constants so that the
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005716 // instruction can be folded into the icmp
Chris Lattner3c6a0d42004-05-25 06:32:08 +00005717 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005718 if (Instruction *Res = visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst(I, LHSI, CI))
5719 return Res;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005720 }
5721
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005722 // Handle icmp with constant (but not simple integer constant) RHS
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005723 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1)) {
5724 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
5725 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattner9fb25db2005-05-01 04:42:15 +00005726 case Instruction::GetElementPtr:
5727 if (RHSC->isNullValue()) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005728 // icmp pred GEP (P, int 0, int 0, int 0), null -> icmp pred P, null
Chris Lattner9fb25db2005-05-01 04:42:15 +00005729 bool isAllZeros = true;
5730 for (unsigned i = 1, e = LHSI->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
5731 if (!isa<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(i)) ||
5732 !cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
5733 isAllZeros = false;
5734 break;
5735 }
5736 if (isAllZeros)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005737 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), LHSI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner9fb25db2005-05-01 04:42:15 +00005738 Constant::getNullValue(LHSI->getOperand(0)->getType()));
5739 }
5740 break;
5741
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005742 case Instruction::PHI:
Chris Lattner7d8ab4e2008-06-08 20:52:11 +00005743 // Only fold icmp into the PHI if the phi and fcmp are in the same
5744 // block. If in the same block, we're encouraging jump threading. If
5745 // not, we are just pessimizing the code by making an i1 phi.
5746 if (LHSI->getParent() == I.getParent())
5747 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
5748 return NV;
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005749 break;
Chris Lattner4802d902007-04-06 18:57:34 +00005750 case Instruction::Select: {
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005751 // If either operand of the select is a constant, we can fold the
5752 // comparison into the select arms, which will cause one to be
5753 // constant folded and the select turned into a bitwise or.
5754 Value *Op1 = 0, *Op2 = 0;
5755 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
5756 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
5757 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005758 Op1 = ConstantExpr::getICmp(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
5759 // Insert a new ICmp of the other select operand.
5760 Op2 = InsertNewInstBefore(new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(),
5761 LHSI->getOperand(2), RHSC,
5762 I.getName()), I);
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005763 } else if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(2))) {
5764 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005765 Op2 = ConstantExpr::getICmp(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
5766 // Insert a new ICmp of the other select operand.
5767 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(),
5768 LHSI->getOperand(1), RHSC,
5769 I.getName()), I);
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005770 }
5771 }
Jeff Cohen9d809302005-04-23 21:38:35 +00005772
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005773 if (Op1)
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00005774 return SelectInst::Create(LHSI->getOperand(0), Op1, Op2);
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005775 break;
5776 }
Chris Lattner4802d902007-04-06 18:57:34 +00005777 case Instruction::Malloc:
5778 // If we have (malloc != null), and if the malloc has a single use, we
5779 // can assume it is successful and remove the malloc.
5780 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() && isa<ConstantPointerNull>(RHSC)) {
5781 AddToWorkList(LHSI);
5782 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
Nick Lewyckyfc1efbb2008-05-17 07:33:39 +00005783 !I.isTrueWhenEqual()));
Chris Lattner4802d902007-04-06 18:57:34 +00005784 }
5785 break;
5786 }
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005787 }
5788
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005789 // If we can optimize a 'icmp GEP, P' or 'icmp P, GEP', do so now.
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005790 if (User *GEP = dyn_castGetElementPtr(Op0))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005791 if (Instruction *NI = FoldGEPICmp(GEP, Op1, I.getPredicate(), I))
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005792 return NI;
5793 if (User *GEP = dyn_castGetElementPtr(Op1))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005794 if (Instruction *NI = FoldGEPICmp(GEP, Op0,
5795 ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(I.getPredicate()), I))
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005796 return NI;
5797
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005798 // Test to see if the operands of the icmp are casted versions of other
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00005799 // values. If the ptr->ptr cast can be stripped off both arguments, we do so
5800 // now.
5801 if (BitCastInst *CI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Op0)) {
5802 if (isa<PointerType>(Op0->getType()) &&
5803 (isa<Constant>(Op1) || isa<BitCastInst>(Op1))) {
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005804 // We keep moving the cast from the left operand over to the right
5805 // operand, where it can often be eliminated completely.
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00005806 Op0 = CI->getOperand(0);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00005807
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00005808 // If operand #1 is a bitcast instruction, it must also be a ptr->ptr cast
5809 // so eliminate it as well.
5810 if (BitCastInst *CI2 = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Op1))
5811 Op1 = CI2->getOperand(0);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00005812
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005813 // If Op1 is a constant, we can fold the cast into the constant.
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00005814 if (Op0->getType() != Op1->getType()) {
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005815 if (Constant *Op1C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00005816 Op1 = ConstantExpr::getBitCast(Op1C, Op0->getType());
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005817 } else {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005818 // Otherwise, cast the RHS right before the icmp
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +00005819 Op1 = InsertBitCastBefore(Op1, Op0->getType(), I);
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005820 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00005821 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005822 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005823 }
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00005824 }
5825
5826 if (isa<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005827 // Handle the special case of: icmp (cast bool to X), <cst>
Chris Lattner68708052003-11-03 05:17:03 +00005828 // This comes up when you have code like
5829 // int X = A < B;
5830 // if (X) ...
5831 // For generality, we handle any zero-extension of any operand comparison
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005832 // with a constant or another cast from the same type.
5833 if (isa<ConstantInt>(Op1) || isa<CastInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005834 if (Instruction *R = visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast(I))
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005835 return R;
Chris Lattner68708052003-11-03 05:17:03 +00005836 }
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005837
Nick Lewycky4bf1e592008-07-11 07:20:53 +00005838 // See if it's the same type of instruction on the left and right.
5839 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
5840 if (BinaryOperator *Op1I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
Nick Lewycky5d52c452008-08-21 05:56:10 +00005841 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Op1I->getOpcode() && Op0I->hasOneUse() &&
5842 Op1I->hasOneUse() && Op0I->getOperand(1) == Op1I->getOperand(1) &&
5843 I.isEquality()) {
Nick Lewycky23c04302008-09-03 06:24:21 +00005844 switch (Op0I->getOpcode()) {
Nick Lewycky4bf1e592008-07-11 07:20:53 +00005845 default: break;
5846 case Instruction::Add:
5847 case Instruction::Sub:
5848 case Instruction::Xor:
Nick Lewycky5d52c452008-08-21 05:56:10 +00005849 // a+x icmp eq/ne b+x --> a icmp b
5850 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), Op0I->getOperand(0),
5851 Op1I->getOperand(0));
Nick Lewycky4bf1e592008-07-11 07:20:53 +00005852 break;
5853 case Instruction::Mul:
Nick Lewycky5d52c452008-08-21 05:56:10 +00005854 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1))) {
5855 // a * Cst icmp eq/ne b * Cst --> a & Mask icmp b & Mask
5856 // Mask = -1 >> count-trailing-zeros(Cst).
5857 if (!CI->isZero() && !CI->isOne()) {
5858 const APInt &AP = CI->getValue();
5859 ConstantInt *Mask = ConstantInt::get(
5860 APInt::getLowBitsSet(AP.getBitWidth(),
5861 AP.getBitWidth() -
Nick Lewycky4bf1e592008-07-11 07:20:53 +00005862 AP.countTrailingZeros()));
Nick Lewycky5d52c452008-08-21 05:56:10 +00005863 Instruction *And1 = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0I->getOperand(0),
5864 Mask);
5865 Instruction *And2 = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op1I->getOperand(0),
5866 Mask);
5867 InsertNewInstBefore(And1, I);
5868 InsertNewInstBefore(And2, I);
5869 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), And1, And2);
Nick Lewycky4bf1e592008-07-11 07:20:53 +00005870 }
5871 }
5872 break;
5873 }
5874 }
5875 }
5876 }
5877
Chris Lattner7d2cbd22008-05-09 05:19:28 +00005878 // ~x < ~y --> y < x
5879 { Value *A, *B;
5880 if (match(Op0, m_Not(m_Value(A))) &&
5881 match(Op1, m_Not(m_Value(B))))
5882 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B, A);
5883 }
5884
Chris Lattner65b72ba2006-09-18 04:22:48 +00005885 if (I.isEquality()) {
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00005886 Value *A, *B, *C, *D;
Chris Lattner7d2cbd22008-05-09 05:19:28 +00005887
5888 // -x == -y --> x == y
5889 if (match(Op0, m_Neg(m_Value(A))) &&
5890 match(Op1, m_Neg(m_Value(B))))
5891 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A, B);
5892
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00005893 if (match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
5894 if (A == Op1 || B == Op1) { // (A^B) == A -> B == 0
5895 Value *OtherVal = A == Op1 ? B : A;
5896 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), OtherVal,
5897 Constant::getNullValue(A->getType()));
5898 }
5899
5900 if (match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
5901 // A^c1 == C^c2 --> A == C^(c1^c2)
5902 if (ConstantInt *C1 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(B))
5903 if (ConstantInt *C2 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(D))
5904 if (Op1->hasOneUse()) {
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00005905 Constant *NC = ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() ^ C2->getValue());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005906 Instruction *Xor = BinaryOperator::CreateXor(C, NC, "tmp");
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00005907 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A,
5908 InsertNewInstBefore(Xor, I));
5909 }
5910
5911 // A^B == A^D -> B == D
5912 if (A == C) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B, D);
5913 if (A == D) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B, C);
5914 if (B == C) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A, D);
5915 if (B == D) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A, C);
5916 }
5917 }
5918
5919 if (match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
5920 (A == Op0 || B == Op0)) {
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005921 // A == (A^B) -> B == 0
5922 Value *OtherVal = A == Op0 ? B : A;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005923 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), OtherVal,
5924 Constant::getNullValue(A->getType()));
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00005925 }
5926 if (match(Op0, m_Sub(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && A == Op1) {
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005927 // (A-B) == A -> B == 0
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005928 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B,
5929 Constant::getNullValue(B->getType()));
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00005930 }
5931 if (match(Op1, m_Sub(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && A == Op0) {
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005932 // A == (A-B) -> B == 0
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005933 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B,
5934 Constant::getNullValue(B->getType()));
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005935 }
Chris Lattner9c2328e2006-11-14 06:06:06 +00005936
Chris Lattner9c2328e2006-11-14 06:06:06 +00005937 // (X&Z) == (Y&Z) -> (X^Y) & Z == 0
5938 if (Op0->hasOneUse() && Op1->hasOneUse() &&
5939 match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
5940 match(Op1, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
5941 Value *X = 0, *Y = 0, *Z = 0;
5942
5943 if (A == C) {
5944 X = B; Y = D; Z = A;
5945 } else if (A == D) {
5946 X = B; Y = C; Z = A;
5947 } else if (B == C) {
5948 X = A; Y = D; Z = B;
5949 } else if (B == D) {
5950 X = A; Y = C; Z = B;
5951 }
5952
5953 if (X) { // Build (X^Y) & Z
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005954 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateXor(X, Y, "tmp"), I);
5955 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op1, Z, "tmp"), I);
Chris Lattner9c2328e2006-11-14 06:06:06 +00005956 I.setOperand(0, Op1);
5957 I.setOperand(1, Constant::getNullValue(Op1->getType()));
5958 return &I;
5959 }
5960 }
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005961 }
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00005962 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005963}
5964
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005965
5966/// FoldICmpDivCst - Fold "icmp pred, ([su]div X, DivRHS), CmpRHS" where DivRHS
5967/// and CmpRHS are both known to be integer constants.
5968Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldICmpDivCst(ICmpInst &ICI, BinaryOperator *DivI,
5969 ConstantInt *DivRHS) {
5970 ConstantInt *CmpRHS = cast<ConstantInt>(ICI.getOperand(1));
5971 const APInt &CmpRHSV = CmpRHS->getValue();
5972
5973 // FIXME: If the operand types don't match the type of the divide
5974 // then don't attempt this transform. The code below doesn't have the
5975 // logic to deal with a signed divide and an unsigned compare (and
5976 // vice versa). This is because (x /s C1) <s C2 produces different
5977 // results than (x /s C1) <u C2 or (x /u C1) <s C2 or even
5978 // (x /u C1) <u C2. Simply casting the operands and result won't
5979 // work. :( The if statement below tests that condition and bails
5980 // if it finds it.
5981 bool DivIsSigned = DivI->getOpcode() == Instruction::SDiv;
5982 if (!ICI.isEquality() && DivIsSigned != ICI.isSignedPredicate())
5983 return 0;
5984 if (DivRHS->isZero())
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005985 return 0; // The ProdOV computation fails on divide by zero.
Chris Lattnera6321b42008-10-11 22:55:00 +00005986 if (DivIsSigned && DivRHS->isAllOnesValue())
5987 return 0; // The overflow computation also screws up here
5988 if (DivRHS->isOne())
5989 return 0; // Not worth bothering, and eliminates some funny cases
5990 // with INT_MIN.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005991
5992 // Compute Prod = CI * DivRHS. We are essentially solving an equation
5993 // of form X/C1=C2. We solve for X by multiplying C1 (DivRHS) and
5994 // C2 (CI). By solving for X we can turn this into a range check
5995 // instead of computing a divide.
5996 ConstantInt *Prod = Multiply(CmpRHS, DivRHS);
5997
5998 // Determine if the product overflows by seeing if the product is
5999 // not equal to the divide. Make sure we do the same kind of divide
6000 // as in the LHS instruction that we're folding.
6001 bool ProdOV = (DivIsSigned ? ConstantExpr::getSDiv(Prod, DivRHS) :
6002 ConstantExpr::getUDiv(Prod, DivRHS)) != CmpRHS;
6003
6004 // Get the ICmp opcode
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006005 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred = ICI.getPredicate();
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006006
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006007 // Figure out the interval that is being checked. For example, a comparison
6008 // like "X /u 5 == 0" is really checking that X is in the interval [0, 5).
6009 // Compute this interval based on the constants involved and the signedness of
6010 // the compare/divide. This computes a half-open interval, keeping track of
6011 // whether either value in the interval overflows. After analysis each
6012 // overflow variable is set to 0 if it's corresponding bound variable is valid
6013 // -1 if overflowed off the bottom end, or +1 if overflowed off the top end.
6014 int LoOverflow = 0, HiOverflow = 0;
6015 ConstantInt *LoBound = 0, *HiBound = 0;
6016
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006017 if (!DivIsSigned) { // udiv
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006018 // e.g. X/5 op 3 --> [15, 20)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006019 LoBound = Prod;
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006020 HiOverflow = LoOverflow = ProdOV;
6021 if (!HiOverflow)
6022 HiOverflow = AddWithOverflow(HiBound, LoBound, DivRHS, false);
Dan Gohman76491272008-02-13 22:09:18 +00006023 } else if (DivRHS->getValue().isStrictlyPositive()) { // Divisor is > 0.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006024 if (CmpRHSV == 0) { // (X / pos) op 0
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006025 // Can't overflow. e.g. X/2 op 0 --> [-1, 2)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006026 LoBound = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(SubOne(DivRHS)));
6027 HiBound = DivRHS;
Dan Gohman76491272008-02-13 22:09:18 +00006028 } else if (CmpRHSV.isStrictlyPositive()) { // (X / pos) op pos
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006029 LoBound = Prod; // e.g. X/5 op 3 --> [15, 20)
6030 HiOverflow = LoOverflow = ProdOV;
6031 if (!HiOverflow)
6032 HiOverflow = AddWithOverflow(HiBound, Prod, DivRHS, true);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006033 } else { // (X / pos) op neg
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006034 // e.g. X/5 op -3 --> [-15-4, -15+1) --> [-19, -14)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006035 HiBound = AddOne(Prod);
Chris Lattnera6321b42008-10-11 22:55:00 +00006036 LoOverflow = HiOverflow = ProdOV ? -1 : 0;
6037 if (!LoOverflow) {
6038 ConstantInt* DivNeg = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(DivRHS));
6039 LoOverflow = AddWithOverflow(LoBound, HiBound, DivNeg,
6040 true) ? -1 : 0;
6041 }
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006042 }
Dan Gohman76491272008-02-13 22:09:18 +00006043 } else if (DivRHS->getValue().isNegative()) { // Divisor is < 0.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006044 if (CmpRHSV == 0) { // (X / neg) op 0
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006045 // e.g. X/-5 op 0 --> [-4, 5)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006046 LoBound = AddOne(DivRHS);
6047 HiBound = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(DivRHS));
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006048 if (HiBound == DivRHS) { // -INTMIN = INTMIN
6049 HiOverflow = 1; // [INTMIN+1, overflow)
6050 HiBound = 0; // e.g. X/INTMIN = 0 --> X > INTMIN
6051 }
Dan Gohman76491272008-02-13 22:09:18 +00006052 } else if (CmpRHSV.isStrictlyPositive()) { // (X / neg) op pos
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006053 // e.g. X/-5 op 3 --> [-19, -14)
Chris Lattnera6321b42008-10-11 22:55:00 +00006054 HiBound = AddOne(Prod);
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006055 HiOverflow = LoOverflow = ProdOV ? -1 : 0;
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006056 if (!LoOverflow)
Chris Lattnera6321b42008-10-11 22:55:00 +00006057 LoOverflow = AddWithOverflow(LoBound, HiBound, DivRHS, true) ? -1 : 0;
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006058 } else { // (X / neg) op neg
Chris Lattnera6321b42008-10-11 22:55:00 +00006059 LoBound = Prod; // e.g. X/-5 op -3 --> [15, 20)
6060 LoOverflow = HiOverflow = ProdOV;
Dan Gohman7f85fbd2008-09-11 00:25:00 +00006061 if (!HiOverflow)
6062 HiOverflow = SubWithOverflow(HiBound, Prod, DivRHS, true);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006063 }
6064
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006065 // Dividing by a negative swaps the condition. LT <-> GT
6066 Pred = ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Pred);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006067 }
6068
6069 Value *X = DivI->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006070 switch (Pred) {
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006071 default: assert(0 && "Unhandled icmp opcode!");
6072 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
6073 if (LoOverflow && HiOverflow)
6074 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
6075 else if (HiOverflow)
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006076 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE :
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006077 ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, X, LoBound);
6078 else if (LoOverflow)
6079 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT :
6080 ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, X, HiBound);
6081 else
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006082 return InsertRangeTest(X, LoBound, HiBound, DivIsSigned, true, ICI);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006083 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
6084 if (LoOverflow && HiOverflow)
6085 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
6086 else if (HiOverflow)
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006087 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT :
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006088 ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, X, LoBound);
6089 else if (LoOverflow)
6090 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE :
6091 ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, X, HiBound);
6092 else
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006093 return InsertRangeTest(X, LoBound, HiBound, DivIsSigned, false, ICI);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006094 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
6095 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006096 if (LoOverflow == +1) // Low bound is greater than input range.
6097 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
6098 if (LoOverflow == -1) // Low bound is less than input range.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006099 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006100 return new ICmpInst(Pred, X, LoBound);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006101 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
6102 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006103 if (HiOverflow == +1) // High bound greater than input range.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006104 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006105 else if (HiOverflow == -1) // High bound less than input range.
6106 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
6107 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006108 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, X, HiBound);
6109 else
6110 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE, X, HiBound);
6111 }
6112}
6113
6114
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006115/// visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst - Handle "icmp (instr, intcst)".
6116///
6117Instruction *InstCombiner::visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst(ICmpInst &ICI,
6118 Instruction *LHSI,
6119 ConstantInt *RHS) {
6120 const APInt &RHSV = RHS->getValue();
6121
6122 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
Duncan Sands0091bf22007-04-04 06:42:45 +00006123 case Instruction::Xor: // (icmp pred (xor X, XorCST), CI)
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006124 if (ConstantInt *XorCST = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
6125 // If this is a comparison that tests the signbit (X < 0) or (x > -1),
6126 // fold the xor.
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00006127 if ((ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && RHSV == 0) ||
6128 (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT && RHSV.isAllOnesValue())) {
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006129 Value *CompareVal = LHSI->getOperand(0);
6130
6131 // If the sign bit of the XorCST is not set, there is no change to
6132 // the operation, just stop using the Xor.
6133 if (!XorCST->getValue().isNegative()) {
6134 ICI.setOperand(0, CompareVal);
6135 AddToWorkList(LHSI);
6136 return &ICI;
6137 }
6138
6139 // Was the old condition true if the operand is positive?
6140 bool isTrueIfPositive = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT;
6141
6142 // If so, the new one isn't.
6143 isTrueIfPositive ^= true;
6144
6145 if (isTrueIfPositive)
6146 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, CompareVal, SubOne(RHS));
6147 else
6148 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, CompareVal, AddOne(RHS));
6149 }
6150 }
6151 break;
6152 case Instruction::And: // (icmp pred (and X, AndCST), RHS)
6153 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() && isa<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1)) &&
6154 LHSI->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
6155 ConstantInt *AndCST = cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
6156
6157 // If the LHS is an AND of a truncating cast, we can widen the
6158 // and/compare to be the input width without changing the value
6159 // produced, eliminating a cast.
6160 if (TruncInst *Cast = dyn_cast<TruncInst>(LHSI->getOperand(0))) {
6161 // We can do this transformation if either the AND constant does not
6162 // have its sign bit set or if it is an equality comparison.
6163 // Extending a relational comparison when we're checking the sign
6164 // bit would not work.
6165 if (Cast->hasOneUse() &&
Anton Korobeynikov4aefd6b2008-02-20 12:07:57 +00006166 (ICI.isEquality() ||
6167 (AndCST->getValue().isNonNegative() && RHSV.isNonNegative()))) {
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006168 uint32_t BitWidth =
6169 cast<IntegerType>(Cast->getOperand(0)->getType())->getBitWidth();
6170 APInt NewCST = AndCST->getValue();
6171 NewCST.zext(BitWidth);
6172 APInt NewCI = RHSV;
6173 NewCI.zext(BitWidth);
6174 Instruction *NewAnd =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006175 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Cast->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006176 ConstantInt::get(NewCST),LHSI->getName());
6177 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAnd, ICI);
6178 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), NewAnd,
6179 ConstantInt::get(NewCI));
6180 }
6181 }
6182
6183 // If this is: (X >> C1) & C2 != C3 (where any shift and any compare
6184 // could exist), turn it into (X & (C2 << C1)) != (C3 << C1). This
6185 // happens a LOT in code produced by the C front-end, for bitfield
6186 // access.
6187 BinaryOperator *Shift = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI->getOperand(0));
6188 if (Shift && !Shift->isShift())
6189 Shift = 0;
6190
6191 ConstantInt *ShAmt;
6192 ShAmt = Shift ? dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Shift->getOperand(1)) : 0;
6193 const Type *Ty = Shift ? Shift->getType() : 0; // Type of the shift.
6194 const Type *AndTy = AndCST->getType(); // Type of the and.
6195
6196 // We can fold this as long as we can't shift unknown bits
6197 // into the mask. This can only happen with signed shift
6198 // rights, as they sign-extend.
6199 if (ShAmt) {
6200 bool CanFold = Shift->isLogicalShift();
6201 if (!CanFold) {
6202 // To test for the bad case of the signed shr, see if any
6203 // of the bits shifted in could be tested after the mask.
6204 uint32_t TyBits = Ty->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6205 int ShAmtVal = TyBits - ShAmt->getLimitedValue(TyBits);
6206
6207 uint32_t BitWidth = AndTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6208 if ((APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-ShAmtVal) &
6209 AndCST->getValue()) == 0)
6210 CanFold = true;
6211 }
6212
6213 if (CanFold) {
6214 Constant *NewCst;
6215 if (Shift->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
6216 NewCst = ConstantExpr::getLShr(RHS, ShAmt);
6217 else
6218 NewCst = ConstantExpr::getShl(RHS, ShAmt);
6219
6220 // Check to see if we are shifting out any of the bits being
6221 // compared.
6222 if (ConstantExpr::get(Shift->getOpcode(), NewCst, ShAmt) != RHS) {
6223 // If we shifted bits out, the fold is not going to work out.
6224 // As a special case, check to see if this means that the
6225 // result is always true or false now.
6226 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
6227 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
6228 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
6229 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
6230 } else {
6231 ICI.setOperand(1, NewCst);
6232 Constant *NewAndCST;
6233 if (Shift->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
6234 NewAndCST = ConstantExpr::getLShr(AndCST, ShAmt);
6235 else
6236 NewAndCST = ConstantExpr::getShl(AndCST, ShAmt);
6237 LHSI->setOperand(1, NewAndCST);
6238 LHSI->setOperand(0, Shift->getOperand(0));
6239 AddToWorkList(Shift); // Shift is dead.
6240 AddUsesToWorkList(ICI);
6241 return &ICI;
6242 }
6243 }
6244 }
6245
6246 // Turn ((X >> Y) & C) == 0 into (X & (C << Y)) == 0. The later is
6247 // preferable because it allows the C<<Y expression to be hoisted out
6248 // of a loop if Y is invariant and X is not.
6249 if (Shift && Shift->hasOneUse() && RHSV == 0 &&
6250 ICI.isEquality() && !Shift->isArithmeticShift() &&
6251 isa<Instruction>(Shift->getOperand(0))) {
6252 // Compute C << Y.
6253 Value *NS;
6254 if (Shift->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006255 NS = BinaryOperator::CreateShl(AndCST,
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006256 Shift->getOperand(1), "tmp");
6257 } else {
6258 // Insert a logical shift.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006259 NS = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(AndCST,
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006260 Shift->getOperand(1), "tmp");
6261 }
6262 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(NS), ICI);
6263
6264 // Compute X & (C << Y).
6265 Instruction *NewAnd =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006266 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift->getOperand(0), NS, LHSI->getName());
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006267 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAnd, ICI);
6268
6269 ICI.setOperand(0, NewAnd);
6270 return &ICI;
6271 }
6272 }
6273 break;
6274
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006275 case Instruction::Shl: { // (icmp pred (shl X, ShAmt), CI)
6276 ConstantInt *ShAmt = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
6277 if (!ShAmt) break;
6278
6279 uint32_t TypeBits = RHSV.getBitWidth();
6280
6281 // Check that the shift amount is in range. If not, don't perform
6282 // undefined shifts. When the shift is visited it will be
6283 // simplified.
6284 if (ShAmt->uge(TypeBits))
6285 break;
6286
6287 if (ICI.isEquality()) {
6288 // If we are comparing against bits always shifted out, the
6289 // comparison cannot succeed.
6290 Constant *Comp =
6291 ConstantExpr::getShl(ConstantExpr::getLShr(RHS, ShAmt), ShAmt);
6292 if (Comp != RHS) {// Comparing against a bit that we know is zero.
6293 bool IsICMP_NE = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
6294 Constant *Cst = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, IsICMP_NE);
6295 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Cst);
6296 }
6297
6298 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
6299 // Otherwise strength reduce the shift into an and.
6300 uint32_t ShAmtVal = (uint32_t)ShAmt->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
6301 Constant *Mask =
6302 ConstantInt::get(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits-ShAmtVal));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006303
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006304 Instruction *AndI =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006305 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(LHSI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006306 Mask, LHSI->getName()+".mask");
6307 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(AndI, ICI);
6308 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), And,
6309 ConstantInt::get(RHSV.lshr(ShAmtVal)));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006310 }
6311 }
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006312
6313 // Otherwise, if this is a comparison of the sign bit, simplify to and/test.
6314 bool TrueIfSigned = false;
6315 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() &&
6316 isSignBitCheck(ICI.getPredicate(), RHS, TrueIfSigned)) {
6317 // (X << 31) <s 0 --> (X&1) != 0
6318 Constant *Mask = ConstantInt::get(APInt(TypeBits, 1) <<
6319 (TypeBits-ShAmt->getZExtValue()-1));
6320 Instruction *AndI =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006321 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(LHSI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006322 Mask, LHSI->getName()+".mask");
6323 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(AndI, ICI);
6324
6325 return new ICmpInst(TrueIfSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_NE : ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ,
6326 And, Constant::getNullValue(And->getType()));
6327 }
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006328 break;
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006329 }
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006330
6331 case Instruction::LShr: // (icmp pred (shr X, ShAmt), CI)
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006332 case Instruction::AShr: {
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006333 // Only handle equality comparisons of shift-by-constant.
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006334 ConstantInt *ShAmt = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006335 if (!ShAmt || !ICI.isEquality()) break;
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006336
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006337 // Check that the shift amount is in range. If not, don't perform
6338 // undefined shifts. When the shift is visited it will be
6339 // simplified.
6340 uint32_t TypeBits = RHSV.getBitWidth();
6341 if (ShAmt->uge(TypeBits))
6342 break;
6343
6344 uint32_t ShAmtVal = (uint32_t)ShAmt->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006345
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006346 // If we are comparing against bits always shifted out, the
6347 // comparison cannot succeed.
6348 APInt Comp = RHSV << ShAmtVal;
6349 if (LHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr)
6350 Comp = Comp.lshr(ShAmtVal);
6351 else
6352 Comp = Comp.ashr(ShAmtVal);
6353
6354 if (Comp != RHSV) { // Comparing against a bit that we know is zero.
6355 bool IsICMP_NE = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
6356 Constant *Cst = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, IsICMP_NE);
6357 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Cst);
6358 }
6359
6360 // Otherwise, check to see if the bits shifted out are known to be zero.
6361 // If so, we can compare against the unshifted value:
6362 // (X & 4) >> 1 == 2 --> (X & 4) == 4.
Evan Chengf30752c2008-04-23 00:38:06 +00006363 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() &&
6364 MaskedValueIsZero(LHSI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006365 APInt::getLowBitsSet(Comp.getBitWidth(), ShAmtVal))) {
6366 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSI->getOperand(0),
6367 ConstantExpr::getShl(RHS, ShAmt));
6368 }
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006369
Evan Chengf30752c2008-04-23 00:38:06 +00006370 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006371 // Otherwise strength reduce the shift into an and.
6372 APInt Val(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShAmtVal));
6373 Constant *Mask = ConstantInt::get(Val);
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006374
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006375 Instruction *AndI =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006376 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(LHSI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006377 Mask, LHSI->getName()+".mask");
6378 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(AndI, ICI);
6379 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), And,
6380 ConstantExpr::getShl(RHS, ShAmt));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006381 }
6382 break;
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006383 }
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006384
6385 case Instruction::SDiv:
6386 case Instruction::UDiv:
6387 // Fold: icmp pred ([us]div X, C1), C2 -> range test
6388 // Fold this div into the comparison, producing a range check.
6389 // Determine, based on the divide type, what the range is being
6390 // checked. If there is an overflow on the low or high side, remember
6391 // it, otherwise compute the range [low, hi) bounding the new value.
6392 // See: InsertRangeTest above for the kinds of replacements possible.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006393 if (ConstantInt *DivRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1)))
6394 if (Instruction *R = FoldICmpDivCst(ICI, cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI),
6395 DivRHS))
6396 return R;
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006397 break;
Nick Lewycky5be29202008-02-03 16:33:09 +00006398
6399 case Instruction::Add:
6400 // Fold: icmp pred (add, X, C1), C2
6401
6402 if (!ICI.isEquality()) {
6403 ConstantInt *LHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
6404 if (!LHSC) break;
6405 const APInt &LHSV = LHSC->getValue();
6406
6407 ConstantRange CR = ICI.makeConstantRange(ICI.getPredicate(), RHSV)
6408 .subtract(LHSV);
6409
6410 if (ICI.isSignedPredicate()) {
6411 if (CR.getLower().isSignBit()) {
6412 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, LHSI->getOperand(0),
6413 ConstantInt::get(CR.getUpper()));
6414 } else if (CR.getUpper().isSignBit()) {
6415 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE, LHSI->getOperand(0),
6416 ConstantInt::get(CR.getLower()));
6417 }
6418 } else {
6419 if (CR.getLower().isMinValue()) {
6420 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, LHSI->getOperand(0),
6421 ConstantInt::get(CR.getUpper()));
6422 } else if (CR.getUpper().isMinValue()) {
6423 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, LHSI->getOperand(0),
6424 ConstantInt::get(CR.getLower()));
6425 }
6426 }
6427 }
6428 break;
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006429 }
6430
6431 // Simplify icmp_eq and icmp_ne instructions with integer constant RHS.
6432 if (ICI.isEquality()) {
6433 bool isICMP_NE = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
6434
6435 // If the first operand is (add|sub|and|or|xor|rem) with a constant, and
6436 // the second operand is a constant, simplify a bit.
6437 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI)) {
6438 switch (BO->getOpcode()) {
6439 case Instruction::SRem:
6440 // If we have a signed (X % (2^c)) == 0, turn it into an unsigned one.
6441 if (RHSV == 0 && isa<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1)) &&BO->hasOneUse()){
6442 const APInt &V = cast<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1))->getValue();
6443 if (V.sgt(APInt(V.getBitWidth(), 1)) && V.isPowerOf2()) {
6444 Instruction *NewRem =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006445 BinaryOperator::CreateURem(BO->getOperand(0), BO->getOperand(1),
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006446 BO->getName());
6447 InsertNewInstBefore(NewRem, ICI);
6448 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), NewRem,
6449 Constant::getNullValue(BO->getType()));
6450 }
6451 }
6452 break;
6453 case Instruction::Add:
6454 // Replace ((add A, B) != C) with (A != C-B) if B & C are constants.
6455 if (ConstantInt *BOp1C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1))) {
6456 if (BO->hasOneUse())
6457 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BO->getOperand(0),
6458 Subtract(RHS, BOp1C));
6459 } else if (RHSV == 0) {
6460 // Replace ((add A, B) != 0) with (A != -B) if A or B is
6461 // efficiently invertible, or if the add has just this one use.
6462 Value *BOp0 = BO->getOperand(0), *BOp1 = BO->getOperand(1);
6463
6464 if (Value *NegVal = dyn_castNegVal(BOp1))
6465 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BOp0, NegVal);
6466 else if (Value *NegVal = dyn_castNegVal(BOp0))
6467 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), NegVal, BOp1);
6468 else if (BO->hasOneUse()) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006469 Instruction *Neg = BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(BOp1);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006470 InsertNewInstBefore(Neg, ICI);
6471 Neg->takeName(BO);
6472 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BOp0, Neg);
6473 }
6474 }
6475 break;
6476 case Instruction::Xor:
6477 // For the xor case, we can xor two constants together, eliminating
6478 // the explicit xor.
6479 if (Constant *BOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(BO->getOperand(1)))
6480 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BO->getOperand(0),
6481 ConstantExpr::getXor(RHS, BOC));
6482
6483 // FALLTHROUGH
6484 case Instruction::Sub:
6485 // Replace (([sub|xor] A, B) != 0) with (A != B)
6486 if (RHSV == 0)
6487 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BO->getOperand(0),
6488 BO->getOperand(1));
6489 break;
6490
6491 case Instruction::Or:
6492 // If bits are being or'd in that are not present in the constant we
6493 // are comparing against, then the comparison could never succeed!
6494 if (Constant *BOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(BO->getOperand(1))) {
6495 Constant *NotCI = ConstantExpr::getNot(RHS);
6496 if (!ConstantExpr::getAnd(BOC, NotCI)->isNullValue())
6497 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
6498 isICMP_NE));
6499 }
6500 break;
6501
6502 case Instruction::And:
6503 if (ConstantInt *BOC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1))) {
6504 // If bits are being compared against that are and'd out, then the
6505 // comparison can never succeed!
6506 if ((RHSV & ~BOC->getValue()) != 0)
6507 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
6508 isICMP_NE));
6509
6510 // If we have ((X & C) == C), turn it into ((X & C) != 0).
6511 if (RHS == BOC && RHSV.isPowerOf2())
6512 return new ICmpInst(isICMP_NE ? ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ :
6513 ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, LHSI,
6514 Constant::getNullValue(RHS->getType()));
6515
6516 // Replace (and X, (1 << size(X)-1) != 0) with x s< 0
Chris Lattner833f25d2008-06-02 01:29:46 +00006517 if (BOC->getValue().isSignBit()) {
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006518 Value *X = BO->getOperand(0);
6519 Constant *Zero = Constant::getNullValue(X->getType());
6520 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = isICMP_NE ?
6521 ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT : ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE;
6522 return new ICmpInst(pred, X, Zero);
6523 }
6524
6525 // ((X & ~7) == 0) --> X < 8
6526 if (RHSV == 0 && isHighOnes(BOC)) {
6527 Value *X = BO->getOperand(0);
6528 Constant *NegX = ConstantExpr::getNeg(BOC);
6529 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = isICMP_NE ?
6530 ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE : ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT;
6531 return new ICmpInst(pred, X, NegX);
6532 }
6533 }
6534 default: break;
6535 }
6536 } else if (IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(LHSI)) {
6537 // Handle icmp {eq|ne} <intrinsic>, intcst.
6538 if (II->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::bswap) {
6539 AddToWorkList(II);
6540 ICI.setOperand(0, II->getOperand(1));
6541 ICI.setOperand(1, ConstantInt::get(RHSV.byteSwap()));
6542 return &ICI;
6543 }
6544 }
6545 } else { // Not a ICMP_EQ/ICMP_NE
Chris Lattnere34e9a22007-04-14 23:32:02 +00006546 // If the LHS is a cast from an integral value of the same size,
6547 // then since we know the RHS is a constant, try to simlify.
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006548 if (CastInst *Cast = dyn_cast<CastInst>(LHSI)) {
6549 Value *CastOp = Cast->getOperand(0);
6550 const Type *SrcTy = CastOp->getType();
6551 uint32_t SrcTySize = SrcTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6552 if (SrcTy->isInteger() &&
6553 SrcTySize == Cast->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) {
6554 // If this is an unsigned comparison, try to make the comparison use
6555 // smaller constant values.
6556 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT && RHSV.isSignBit()) {
6557 // X u< 128 => X s> -1
6558 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, CastOp,
6559 ConstantInt::get(APInt::getAllOnesValue(SrcTySize)));
6560 } else if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT &&
6561 RHSV == APInt::getSignedMaxValue(SrcTySize)) {
6562 // X u> 127 => X s< 0
6563 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, CastOp,
6564 Constant::getNullValue(SrcTy));
6565 }
6566 }
6567 }
6568 }
6569 return 0;
6570}
6571
6572/// visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast - Handle icmp (cast x to y), (cast/cst).
6573/// We only handle extending casts so far.
6574///
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006575Instruction *InstCombiner::visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast(ICmpInst &ICI) {
6576 const CastInst *LHSCI = cast<CastInst>(ICI.getOperand(0));
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006577 Value *LHSCIOp = LHSCI->getOperand(0);
6578 const Type *SrcTy = LHSCIOp->getType();
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006579 const Type *DestTy = LHSCI->getType();
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00006580 Value *RHSCIOp;
6581
Chris Lattner8c756c12007-05-05 22:41:33 +00006582 // Turn icmp (ptrtoint x), (ptrtoint/c) into a compare of the input if the
6583 // integer type is the same size as the pointer type.
6584 if (LHSCI->getOpcode() == Instruction::PtrToInt &&
6585 getTargetData().getPointerSizeInBits() ==
6586 cast<IntegerType>(DestTy)->getBitWidth()) {
6587 Value *RHSOp = 0;
6588 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(ICI.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner6f6f5122007-05-06 07:24:03 +00006589 RHSOp = ConstantExpr::getIntToPtr(RHSC, SrcTy);
Chris Lattner8c756c12007-05-05 22:41:33 +00006590 } else if (PtrToIntInst *RHSC = dyn_cast<PtrToIntInst>(ICI.getOperand(1))) {
6591 RHSOp = RHSC->getOperand(0);
6592 // If the pointer types don't match, insert a bitcast.
6593 if (LHSCIOp->getType() != RHSOp->getType())
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +00006594 RHSOp = InsertBitCastBefore(RHSOp, LHSCIOp->getType(), ICI);
Chris Lattner8c756c12007-05-05 22:41:33 +00006595 }
6596
6597 if (RHSOp)
6598 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, RHSOp);
6599 }
6600
6601 // The code below only handles extension cast instructions, so far.
6602 // Enforce this.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006603 if (LHSCI->getOpcode() != Instruction::ZExt &&
6604 LHSCI->getOpcode() != Instruction::SExt)
Chris Lattnerb352fa52005-01-17 03:20:02 +00006605 return 0;
6606
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006607 bool isSignedExt = LHSCI->getOpcode() == Instruction::SExt;
6608 bool isSignedCmp = ICI.isSignedPredicate();
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00006609
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006610 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(ICI.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00006611 // Not an extension from the same type?
6612 RHSCIOp = CI->getOperand(0);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006613 if (RHSCIOp->getType() != LHSCIOp->getType())
6614 return 0;
Chris Lattnera5c5e772007-01-13 23:11:38 +00006615
Nick Lewycky4189a532008-01-28 03:48:02 +00006616 // If the signedness of the two casts doesn't agree (i.e. one is a sext
Chris Lattnera5c5e772007-01-13 23:11:38 +00006617 // and the other is a zext), then we can't handle this.
6618 if (CI->getOpcode() != LHSCI->getOpcode())
6619 return 0;
6620
Nick Lewycky4189a532008-01-28 03:48:02 +00006621 // Deal with equality cases early.
6622 if (ICI.isEquality())
6623 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, RHSCIOp);
6624
6625 // A signed comparison of sign extended values simplifies into a
6626 // signed comparison.
6627 if (isSignedCmp && isSignedExt)
6628 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, RHSCIOp);
6629
6630 // The other three cases all fold into an unsigned comparison.
6631 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getUnsignedPredicate(), LHSCIOp, RHSCIOp);
Reid Spencer6731d5c2004-11-28 21:31:15 +00006632 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00006633
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006634 // If we aren't dealing with a constant on the RHS, exit early
6635 ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(ICI.getOperand(1));
6636 if (!CI)
6637 return 0;
6638
6639 // Compute the constant that would happen if we truncated to SrcTy then
6640 // reextended to DestTy.
6641 Constant *Res1 = ConstantExpr::getTrunc(CI, SrcTy);
6642 Constant *Res2 = ConstantExpr::getCast(LHSCI->getOpcode(), Res1, DestTy);
6643
6644 // If the re-extended constant didn't change...
6645 if (Res2 == CI) {
6646 // Make sure that sign of the Cmp and the sign of the Cast are the same.
6647 // For example, we might have:
6648 // %A = sext short %X to uint
6649 // %B = icmp ugt uint %A, 1330
6650 // It is incorrect to transform this into
6651 // %B = icmp ugt short %X, 1330
6652 // because %A may have negative value.
6653 //
Chris Lattnerf2991842008-07-11 04:09:09 +00006654 // However, we allow this when the compare is EQ/NE, because they are
6655 // signless.
6656 if (isSignedExt == isSignedCmp || ICI.isEquality())
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006657 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, Res1);
Chris Lattnerf2991842008-07-11 04:09:09 +00006658 return 0;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006659 }
6660
6661 // The re-extended constant changed so the constant cannot be represented
6662 // in the shorter type. Consequently, we cannot emit a simple comparison.
6663
6664 // First, handle some easy cases. We know the result cannot be equal at this
6665 // point so handle the ICI.isEquality() cases
6666 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00006667 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006668 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00006669 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006670
6671 // Evaluate the comparison for LT (we invert for GT below). LE and GE cases
6672 // should have been folded away previously and not enter in here.
6673 Value *Result;
6674 if (isSignedCmp) {
6675 // We're performing a signed comparison.
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00006676 if (cast<ConstantInt>(CI)->getValue().isNegative())
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00006677 Result = ConstantInt::getFalse(); // X < (small) --> false
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006678 else
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00006679 Result = ConstantInt::getTrue(); // X < (large) --> true
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006680 } else {
6681 // We're performing an unsigned comparison.
6682 if (isSignedExt) {
6683 // We're performing an unsigned comp with a sign extended value.
6684 // This is true if the input is >= 0. [aka >s -1]
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00006685 Constant *NegOne = ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(SrcTy);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006686 Result = InsertNewInstBefore(new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, LHSCIOp,
6687 NegOne, ICI.getName()), ICI);
6688 } else {
6689 // Unsigned extend & unsigned compare -> always true.
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00006690 Result = ConstantInt::getTrue();
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006691 }
6692 }
6693
6694 // Finally, return the value computed.
6695 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT ||
Chris Lattnerf2991842008-07-11 04:09:09 +00006696 ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006697 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Result);
Chris Lattnerf2991842008-07-11 04:09:09 +00006698
6699 assert((ICI.getPredicate()==ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT ||
6700 ICI.getPredicate()==ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT) &&
6701 "ICmp should be folded!");
6702 if (Constant *CI = dyn_cast<Constant>(Result))
6703 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantExpr::getNot(CI));
6704 return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Result);
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00006705}
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00006706
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006707Instruction *InstCombiner::visitShl(BinaryOperator &I) {
6708 return commonShiftTransforms(I);
6709}
6710
6711Instruction *InstCombiner::visitLShr(BinaryOperator &I) {
6712 return commonShiftTransforms(I);
6713}
6714
6715Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAShr(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner348f6652007-12-06 01:59:46 +00006716 if (Instruction *R = commonShiftTransforms(I))
6717 return R;
6718
6719 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0);
6720
6721 // ashr int -1, X = -1 (for any arithmetic shift rights of ~0)
6722 if (ConstantInt *CSI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0))
6723 if (CSI->isAllOnesValue())
6724 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, CSI);
6725
6726 // See if we can turn a signed shr into an unsigned shr.
Nate Begeman5bc1ea02008-07-29 15:49:41 +00006727 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType()) &&
6728 MaskedValueIsZero(Op0,
Chris Lattner348f6652007-12-06 01:59:46 +00006729 APInt::getSignBit(I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits())))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006730 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(Op0, I.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner348f6652007-12-06 01:59:46 +00006731
6732 return 0;
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006733}
6734
6735Instruction *InstCombiner::commonShiftTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
6736 assert(I.getOperand(1)->getType() == I.getOperand(0)->getType());
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00006737 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00006738
6739 // shl X, 0 == X and shr X, 0 == X
6740 // shl 0, X == 0 and shr 0, X == 0
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006741 if (Op1 == Constant::getNullValue(Op1->getType()) ||
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00006742 Op0 == Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()))
6743 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattner8d6bbdb2006-02-12 08:07:37 +00006744
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006745 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0)) {
6746 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) // undef >>s X -> undef
Chris Lattner79a564c2004-10-16 23:28:04 +00006747 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006748 else // undef << X -> 0, undef >>u X -> 0
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00006749 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
6750 }
6751 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006752 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) // X >>s undef -> X
6753 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
6754 else // X << undef, X >>u undef -> 0
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00006755 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00006756 }
6757
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00006758 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
6759 if (isa<Constant>(Op0))
6760 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00006761 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00006762 return R;
6763
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00006764 if (ConstantInt *CUI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1))
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00006765 if (Instruction *Res = FoldShiftByConstant(Op0, CUI, I))
6766 return Res;
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006767 return 0;
6768}
6769
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00006770Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldShiftByConstant(Value *Op0, ConstantInt *Op1,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006771 BinaryOperator &I) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006772 bool isLeftShift = I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl;
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006773
Chris Lattner8d6bbdb2006-02-12 08:07:37 +00006774 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
6775 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00006776 uint32_t TypeBits = Op0->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6777 APInt KnownZero(TypeBits, 0), KnownOne(TypeBits, 0);
6778 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(TypeBits),
Chris Lattner8d6bbdb2006-02-12 08:07:37 +00006779 KnownZero, KnownOne))
6780 return &I;
6781
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006782 // shl uint X, 32 = 0 and shr ubyte Y, 9 = 0, ... just don't eliminate shr
6783 // of a signed value.
6784 //
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00006785 if (Op1->uge(TypeBits)) {
Chris Lattner0737c242007-02-02 05:29:55 +00006786 if (I.getOpcode() != Instruction::AShr)
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006787 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
6788 else {
Chris Lattner0737c242007-02-02 05:29:55 +00006789 I.setOperand(1, ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), TypeBits-1));
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006790 return &I;
Chris Lattner8adac752004-02-23 20:30:06 +00006791 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006792 }
6793
6794 // ((X*C1) << C2) == (X * (C1 << C2))
6795 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
6796 if (BO->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul && isLeftShift)
6797 if (Constant *BOOp = dyn_cast<Constant>(BO->getOperand(1)))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006798 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(BO->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006799 ConstantExpr::getShl(BOOp, Op1));
6800
6801 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
6802 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
6803 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
6804 return R;
6805 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
6806 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
6807 return NV;
6808
Chris Lattner8999dd32007-12-22 09:07:47 +00006809 // Fold shift2(trunc(shift1(x,c1)), c2) -> trunc(shift2(shift1(x,c1),c2))
6810 if (TruncInst *TI = dyn_cast<TruncInst>(Op0)) {
6811 Instruction *TrOp = dyn_cast<Instruction>(TI->getOperand(0));
6812 // If 'shift2' is an ashr, we would have to get the sign bit into a funny
6813 // place. Don't try to do this transformation in this case. Also, we
6814 // require that the input operand is a shift-by-constant so that we have
6815 // confidence that the shifts will get folded together. We could do this
6816 // xform in more cases, but it is unlikely to be profitable.
6817 if (TrOp && I.isLogicalShift() && TrOp->isShift() &&
6818 isa<ConstantInt>(TrOp->getOperand(1))) {
6819 // Okay, we'll do this xform. Make the shift of shift.
6820 Constant *ShAmt = ConstantExpr::getZExt(Op1, TrOp->getType());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006821 Instruction *NSh = BinaryOperator::Create(I.getOpcode(), TrOp, ShAmt,
Chris Lattner8999dd32007-12-22 09:07:47 +00006822 I.getName());
6823 InsertNewInstBefore(NSh, I); // (shift2 (shift1 & 0x00FF), c2)
6824
6825 // For logical shifts, the truncation has the effect of making the high
6826 // part of the register be zeros. Emulate this by inserting an AND to
6827 // clear the top bits as needed. This 'and' will usually be zapped by
6828 // other xforms later if dead.
6829 unsigned SrcSize = TrOp->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6830 unsigned DstSize = TI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6831 APInt MaskV(APInt::getLowBitsSet(SrcSize, DstSize));
6832
6833 // The mask we constructed says what the trunc would do if occurring
6834 // between the shifts. We want to know the effect *after* the second
6835 // shift. We know that it is a logical shift by a constant, so adjust the
6836 // mask as appropriate.
6837 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
6838 MaskV <<= Op1->getZExtValue();
6839 else {
6840 assert(I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr && "Unknown logical shift");
6841 MaskV = MaskV.lshr(Op1->getZExtValue());
6842 }
6843
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006844 Instruction *And = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NSh, ConstantInt::get(MaskV),
Chris Lattner8999dd32007-12-22 09:07:47 +00006845 TI->getName());
6846 InsertNewInstBefore(And, I); // shift1 & 0x00FF
6847
6848 // Return the value truncated to the interesting size.
6849 return new TruncInst(And, I.getType());
6850 }
6851 }
6852
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006853 if (Op0->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006854 if (BinaryOperator *Op0BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
6855 // Turn ((X >> C) + Y) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (~0 << C)
6856 Value *V1, *V2;
6857 ConstantInt *CC;
6858 switch (Op0BO->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00006859 default: break;
6860 case Instruction::Add:
6861 case Instruction::And:
6862 case Instruction::Or:
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00006863 case Instruction::Xor: {
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00006864 // These operators commute.
6865 // Turn (Y + (X >> C)) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (~0 << C)
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006866 if (isLeftShift && Op0BO->getOperand(1)->hasOneUse() &&
6867 match(Op0BO->getOperand(1),
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006868 m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_ConstantInt(CC))) && CC == Op1) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006869 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::CreateShl(
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006870 Op0BO->getOperand(0), Op1,
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006871 Op0BO->getName());
6872 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00006873 Instruction *X =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006874 BinaryOperator::Create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), YS, V1,
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00006875 Op0BO->getOperand(1)->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006876 InsertNewInstBefore(X, I); // (X + (Y << C))
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00006877 uint32_t Op1Val = Op1->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006878 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(
Zhou Sheng90b96812007-03-30 05:45:18 +00006879 APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits-Op1Val)));
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006880 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006881
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006882 // Turn (Y + ((X >> C) & CC)) << C -> ((X & (CC << C)) + (Y << C))
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00006883 Value *Op0BOOp1 = Op0BO->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3c698492007-03-05 00:11:19 +00006884 if (isLeftShift && Op0BOOp1->hasOneUse() &&
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00006885 match(Op0BOOp1,
6886 m_And(m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)),m_ConstantInt(CC))) &&
Chris Lattner3c698492007-03-05 00:11:19 +00006887 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0BOOp1)->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() &&
6888 V2 == Op1) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006889 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::CreateShl(
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006890 Op0BO->getOperand(0), Op1,
6891 Op0BO->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006892 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
6893 Instruction *XM =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006894 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V1, ConstantExpr::getShl(CC, Op1),
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006895 V1->getName()+".mask");
6896 InsertNewInstBefore(XM, I); // X & (CC << C)
6897
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006898 return BinaryOperator::Create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), YS, XM);
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006899 }
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00006900 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006901
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00006902 // FALL THROUGH.
6903 case Instruction::Sub: {
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00006904 // Turn ((X >> C) + Y) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (~0 << C)
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006905 if (isLeftShift && Op0BO->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() &&
6906 match(Op0BO->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006907 m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_ConstantInt(CC))) && CC == Op1) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006908 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::CreateShl(
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006909 Op0BO->getOperand(1), Op1,
6910 Op0BO->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006911 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00006912 Instruction *X =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006913 BinaryOperator::Create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), V1, YS,
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00006914 Op0BO->getOperand(0)->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006915 InsertNewInstBefore(X, I); // (X + (Y << C))
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00006916 uint32_t Op1Val = Op1->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006917 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(
Zhou Sheng90b96812007-03-30 05:45:18 +00006918 APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits-Op1Val)));
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006919 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006920
Chris Lattner13d4ab42006-05-31 21:14:00 +00006921 // Turn (((X >> C)&CC) + Y) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (CC << C)
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006922 if (isLeftShift && Op0BO->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() &&
6923 match(Op0BO->getOperand(0),
6924 m_And(m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)),
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006925 m_ConstantInt(CC))) && V2 == Op1 &&
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00006926 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0BO->getOperand(0))
6927 ->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006928 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::CreateShl(
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006929 Op0BO->getOperand(1), Op1,
6930 Op0BO->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006931 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
6932 Instruction *XM =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006933 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V1, ConstantExpr::getShl(CC, Op1),
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006934 V1->getName()+".mask");
6935 InsertNewInstBefore(XM, I); // X & (CC << C)
6936
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006937 return BinaryOperator::Create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), XM, YS);
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006938 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006939
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00006940 break;
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00006941 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006942 }
6943
6944
6945 // If the operand is an bitwise operator with a constant RHS, and the
6946 // shift is the only use, we can pull it out of the shift.
6947 if (ConstantInt *Op0C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0BO->getOperand(1))) {
6948 bool isValid = true; // Valid only for And, Or, Xor
6949 bool highBitSet = false; // Transform if high bit of constant set?
6950
6951 switch (Op0BO->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattnerdf17af12003-08-12 21:53:41 +00006952 default: isValid = false; break; // Do not perform transform!
Chris Lattner1f7e1602004-10-08 03:46:20 +00006953 case Instruction::Add:
6954 isValid = isLeftShift;
6955 break;
Chris Lattnerdf17af12003-08-12 21:53:41 +00006956 case Instruction::Or:
6957 case Instruction::Xor:
6958 highBitSet = false;
6959 break;
6960 case Instruction::And:
6961 highBitSet = true;
6962 break;
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006963 }
6964
6965 // If this is a signed shift right, and the high bit is modified
6966 // by the logical operation, do not perform the transformation.
6967 // The highBitSet boolean indicates the value of the high bit of
6968 // the constant which would cause it to be modified for this
6969 // operation.
6970 //
Chris Lattnerc95ba442007-12-06 06:25:04 +00006971 if (isValid && I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr)
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00006972 isValid = Op0C->getValue()[TypeBits-1] == highBitSet;
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006973
6974 if (isValid) {
6975 Constant *NewRHS = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), Op0C, Op1);
6976
6977 Instruction *NewShift =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006978 BinaryOperator::Create(I.getOpcode(), Op0BO->getOperand(0), Op1);
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006979 InsertNewInstBefore(NewShift, I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00006980 NewShift->takeName(Op0BO);
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006981
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006982 return BinaryOperator::Create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), NewShift,
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006983 NewRHS);
6984 }
6985 }
6986 }
6987 }
6988
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00006989 // Find out if this is a shift of a shift by a constant.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006990 BinaryOperator *ShiftOp = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0);
6991 if (ShiftOp && !ShiftOp->isShift())
6992 ShiftOp = 0;
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00006993
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00006994 if (ShiftOp && isa<ConstantInt>(ShiftOp->getOperand(1))) {
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00006995 ConstantInt *ShiftAmt1C = cast<ConstantInt>(ShiftOp->getOperand(1));
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00006996 uint32_t ShiftAmt1 = ShiftAmt1C->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
6997 uint32_t ShiftAmt2 = Op1->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006998 assert(ShiftAmt2 != 0 && "Should have been simplified earlier");
6999 if (ShiftAmt1 == 0) return 0; // Will be simplified in the future.
7000 Value *X = ShiftOp->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00007001
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00007002 uint32_t AmtSum = ShiftAmt1+ShiftAmt2; // Fold into one big shift.
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00007003 if (AmtSum > TypeBits)
7004 AmtSum = TypeBits;
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007005
7006 const IntegerType *Ty = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType());
7007
7008 // Check for (X << c1) << c2 and (X >> c1) >> c2
Chris Lattner7f3da2d2007-02-03 23:28:07 +00007009 if (I.getOpcode() == ShiftOp->getOpcode()) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007010 return BinaryOperator::Create(I.getOpcode(), X,
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007011 ConstantInt::get(Ty, AmtSum));
7012 } else if (ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr &&
7013 I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) {
7014 // ((X >>u C1) >>s C2) -> (X >>u (C1+C2)) since C1 != 0.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007015 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, AmtSum));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007016 } else if (ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr &&
7017 I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
7018 // ((X >>s C1) >>u C2) -> ((X >>s (C1+C2)) & mask) since C1 != 0.
7019 Instruction *Shift =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007020 BinaryOperator::CreateAShr(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, AmtSum));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007021 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
7022
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00007023 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007024 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00007025 }
7026
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007027 // Okay, if we get here, one shift must be left, and the other shift must be
7028 // right. See if the amounts are equal.
7029 if (ShiftAmt1 == ShiftAmt2) {
7030 // If we have ((X >>? C) << C), turn this into X & (-1 << C).
7031 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
Reid Spencer55702aa2007-03-25 21:11:44 +00007032 APInt Mask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt1));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007033 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007034 }
7035 // If we have ((X << C) >>u C), turn this into X & (-1 >>u C).
7036 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00007037 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt1));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007038 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007039 }
7040 // We can simplify ((X << C) >>s C) into a trunc + sext.
7041 // NOTE: we could do this for any C, but that would make 'unusual' integer
7042 // types. For now, just stick to ones well-supported by the code
7043 // generators.
7044 const Type *SExtType = 0;
7045 switch (Ty->getBitWidth() - ShiftAmt1) {
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00007046 case 1 :
7047 case 8 :
7048 case 16 :
7049 case 32 :
7050 case 64 :
7051 case 128:
7052 SExtType = IntegerType::get(Ty->getBitWidth() - ShiftAmt1);
7053 break;
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007054 default: break;
7055 }
7056 if (SExtType) {
7057 Instruction *NewTrunc = new TruncInst(X, SExtType, "sext");
7058 InsertNewInstBefore(NewTrunc, I);
7059 return new SExtInst(NewTrunc, Ty);
7060 }
7061 // Otherwise, we can't handle it yet.
7062 } else if (ShiftAmt1 < ShiftAmt2) {
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00007063 uint32_t ShiftDiff = ShiftAmt2-ShiftAmt1;
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00007064
Chris Lattnerb0b991a2007-02-05 05:57:49 +00007065 // (X >>? C1) << C2 --> X << (C2-C1) & (-1 << C2)
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007066 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
7067 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr ||
7068 ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr);
Chris Lattnere8d56c52006-01-07 01:32:28 +00007069 Instruction *Shift =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007070 BinaryOperator::CreateShl(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
Chris Lattnere8d56c52006-01-07 01:32:28 +00007071 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
7072
Reid Spencer55702aa2007-03-25 21:11:44 +00007073 APInt Mask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007074 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00007075 }
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007076
Chris Lattnerb0b991a2007-02-05 05:57:49 +00007077 // (X << C1) >>u C2 --> X >>u (C2-C1) & (-1 >> C2)
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007078 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
7079 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl);
7080 Instruction *Shift =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007081 BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007082 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00007083
Reid Spencerd5e30f02007-03-26 17:18:58 +00007084 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007085 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00007086 }
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007087
7088 // We can't handle (X << C1) >>s C2, it shifts arbitrary bits in.
7089 } else {
7090 assert(ShiftAmt2 < ShiftAmt1);
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00007091 uint32_t ShiftDiff = ShiftAmt1-ShiftAmt2;
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007092
Chris Lattnerb0b991a2007-02-05 05:57:49 +00007093 // (X >>? C1) << C2 --> X >>? (C1-C2) & (-1 << C2)
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007094 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
7095 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr ||
7096 ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr);
7097 Instruction *Shift =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007098 BinaryOperator::Create(ShiftOp->getOpcode(), X,
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007099 ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
7100 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
7101
Reid Spencer55702aa2007-03-25 21:11:44 +00007102 APInt Mask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007103 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007104 }
7105
Chris Lattnerb0b991a2007-02-05 05:57:49 +00007106 // (X << C1) >>u C2 --> X << (C1-C2) & (-1 >> C2)
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007107 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
7108 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl);
7109 Instruction *Shift =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007110 BinaryOperator::CreateShl(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007111 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
7112
Reid Spencer68d27cf2007-03-26 23:45:51 +00007113 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007114 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007115 }
7116
7117 // We can't handle (X << C1) >>a C2, it shifts arbitrary bits in.
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00007118 }
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00007119 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00007120 return 0;
7121}
7122
Chris Lattnera1be5662002-05-02 17:06:02 +00007123
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00007124/// DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr - Analyze 'Val', seeing if it is a simple linear
7125/// expression. If so, decompose it, returning some value X, such that Val is
7126/// X*Scale+Offset.
7127///
7128static Value *DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr(Value *Val, unsigned &Scale,
Jeff Cohen86796be2007-04-04 16:58:57 +00007129 int &Offset) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00007130 assert(Val->getType() == Type::Int32Ty && "Unexpected allocation size type!");
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007131 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Val)) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00007132 Offset = CI->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner6a94de22007-10-12 05:30:59 +00007133 Scale = 0;
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00007134 return ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, 0);
Chris Lattner6a94de22007-10-12 05:30:59 +00007135 } else if (BinaryOperator *I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Val)) {
7136 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
7137 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
7138 // This is a value scaled by '1 << the shift amt'.
7139 Scale = 1U << RHS->getZExtValue();
7140 Offset = 0;
7141 return I->getOperand(0);
7142 } else if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul) {
7143 // This value is scaled by 'RHS'.
7144 Scale = RHS->getZExtValue();
7145 Offset = 0;
7146 return I->getOperand(0);
7147 } else if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
7148 // We have X+C. Check to see if we really have (X*C2)+C1,
7149 // where C1 is divisible by C2.
7150 unsigned SubScale;
7151 Value *SubVal =
7152 DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr(I->getOperand(0), SubScale, Offset);
7153 Offset += RHS->getZExtValue();
7154 Scale = SubScale;
7155 return SubVal;
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00007156 }
7157 }
7158 }
7159
7160 // Otherwise, we can't look past this.
7161 Scale = 1;
7162 Offset = 0;
7163 return Val;
7164}
7165
7166
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00007167/// PromoteCastOfAllocation - If we find a cast of an allocation instruction,
7168/// try to eliminate the cast by moving the type information into the alloc.
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007169Instruction *InstCombiner::PromoteCastOfAllocation(BitCastInst &CI,
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00007170 AllocationInst &AI) {
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007171 const PointerType *PTy = cast<PointerType>(CI.getType());
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00007172
Chris Lattnerb53c2382005-10-24 06:22:12 +00007173 // Remove any uses of AI that are dead.
7174 assert(!CI.use_empty() && "Dead instructions should be removed earlier!");
Chris Lattner535014f2007-02-15 22:52:10 +00007175
Chris Lattnerb53c2382005-10-24 06:22:12 +00007176 for (Value::use_iterator UI = AI.use_begin(), E = AI.use_end(); UI != E; ) {
7177 Instruction *User = cast<Instruction>(*UI++);
7178 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(User)) {
7179 while (UI != E && *UI == User)
7180 ++UI; // If this instruction uses AI more than once, don't break UI.
7181
Chris Lattnerb53c2382005-10-24 06:22:12 +00007182 ++NumDeadInst;
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +00007183 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *User;
Chris Lattnerf22a5c62007-03-02 19:59:19 +00007184 EraseInstFromFunction(*User);
Chris Lattnerb53c2382005-10-24 06:22:12 +00007185 }
7186 }
7187
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00007188 // Get the type really allocated and the type casted to.
7189 const Type *AllocElTy = AI.getAllocatedType();
7190 const Type *CastElTy = PTy->getElementType();
7191 if (!AllocElTy->isSized() || !CastElTy->isSized()) return 0;
Chris Lattner18e78bb2005-10-24 06:26:18 +00007192
Chris Lattnerd2b7cec2007-02-14 05:52:17 +00007193 unsigned AllocElTyAlign = TD->getABITypeAlignment(AllocElTy);
7194 unsigned CastElTyAlign = TD->getABITypeAlignment(CastElTy);
Chris Lattner18e78bb2005-10-24 06:26:18 +00007195 if (CastElTyAlign < AllocElTyAlign) return 0;
7196
Chris Lattner39387a52005-10-24 06:35:18 +00007197 // If the allocation has multiple uses, only promote it if we are strictly
7198 // increasing the alignment of the resultant allocation. If we keep it the
7199 // same, we open the door to infinite loops of various kinds.
7200 if (!AI.hasOneUse() && CastElTyAlign == AllocElTyAlign) return 0;
7201
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +00007202 uint64_t AllocElTySize = TD->getABITypeSize(AllocElTy);
7203 uint64_t CastElTySize = TD->getABITypeSize(CastElTy);
Chris Lattner0ddac2a2005-10-27 05:53:56 +00007204 if (CastElTySize == 0 || AllocElTySize == 0) return 0;
Chris Lattner18e78bb2005-10-24 06:26:18 +00007205
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00007206 // See if we can satisfy the modulus by pulling a scale out of the array
7207 // size argument.
Jeff Cohen86796be2007-04-04 16:58:57 +00007208 unsigned ArraySizeScale;
7209 int ArrayOffset;
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00007210 Value *NumElements = // See if the array size is a decomposable linear expr.
7211 DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr(AI.getOperand(0), ArraySizeScale, ArrayOffset);
7212
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00007213 // If we can now satisfy the modulus, by using a non-1 scale, we really can
7214 // do the xform.
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00007215 if ((AllocElTySize*ArraySizeScale) % CastElTySize != 0 ||
7216 (AllocElTySize*ArrayOffset ) % CastElTySize != 0) return 0;
Chris Lattner8142b0a2005-10-27 06:12:00 +00007217
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00007218 unsigned Scale = (AllocElTySize*ArraySizeScale)/CastElTySize;
7219 Value *Amt = 0;
7220 if (Scale == 1) {
7221 Amt = NumElements;
7222 } else {
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007223 // If the allocation size is constant, form a constant mul expression
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00007224 Amt = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Scale);
7225 if (isa<ConstantInt>(NumElements))
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00007226 Amt = Multiply(cast<ConstantInt>(NumElements), cast<ConstantInt>(Amt));
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007227 // otherwise multiply the amount and the number of elements
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00007228 else if (Scale != 1) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007229 Instruction *Tmp = BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Amt, NumElements, "tmp");
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00007230 Amt = InsertNewInstBefore(Tmp, AI);
Chris Lattner8142b0a2005-10-27 06:12:00 +00007231 }
Chris Lattner0ddac2a2005-10-27 05:53:56 +00007232 }
7233
Jeff Cohen86796be2007-04-04 16:58:57 +00007234 if (int Offset = (AllocElTySize*ArrayOffset)/CastElTySize) {
7235 Value *Off = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Offset, true);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007236 Instruction *Tmp = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Amt, Off, "tmp");
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00007237 Amt = InsertNewInstBefore(Tmp, AI);
7238 }
7239
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00007240 AllocationInst *New;
7241 if (isa<MallocInst>(AI))
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00007242 New = new MallocInst(CastElTy, Amt, AI.getAlignment());
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00007243 else
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00007244 New = new AllocaInst(CastElTy, Amt, AI.getAlignment());
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00007245 InsertNewInstBefore(New, AI);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00007246 New->takeName(&AI);
Chris Lattner39387a52005-10-24 06:35:18 +00007247
7248 // If the allocation has multiple uses, insert a cast and change all things
7249 // that used it to use the new cast. This will also hack on CI, but it will
7250 // die soon.
7251 if (!AI.hasOneUse()) {
7252 AddUsesToWorkList(AI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007253 // New is the allocation instruction, pointer typed. AI is the original
7254 // allocation instruction, also pointer typed. Thus, cast to use is BitCast.
7255 CastInst *NewCast = new BitCastInst(New, AI.getType(), "tmpcast");
Chris Lattner39387a52005-10-24 06:35:18 +00007256 InsertNewInstBefore(NewCast, AI);
7257 AI.replaceAllUsesWith(NewCast);
7258 }
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00007259 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, New);
7260}
7261
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007262/// CanEvaluateInDifferentType - Return true if we can take the specified value
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007263/// and return it as type Ty without inserting any new casts and without
7264/// changing the computed value. This is used by code that tries to decide
7265/// whether promoting or shrinking integer operations to wider or smaller types
7266/// will allow us to eliminate a truncate or extend.
7267///
7268/// This is a truncation operation if Ty is smaller than V->getType(), or an
7269/// extension operation if Ty is larger.
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007270///
7271/// If CastOpc is a truncation, then Ty will be a type smaller than V. We
7272/// should return true if trunc(V) can be computed by computing V in the smaller
7273/// type. If V is an instruction, then trunc(inst(x,y)) can be computed as
7274/// inst(trunc(x),trunc(y)), which only makes sense if x and y can be
7275/// efficiently truncated.
7276///
7277/// If CastOpc is a sext or zext, we are asking if the low bits of the value can
7278/// bit computed in a larger type, which is then and'd or sext_in_reg'd to get
7279/// the final result.
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00007280bool InstCombiner::CanEvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const IntegerType *Ty,
7281 unsigned CastOpc,
7282 int &NumCastsRemoved) {
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007283 // We can always evaluate constants in another type.
7284 if (isa<ConstantInt>(V))
7285 return true;
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007286
7287 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007288 if (!I) return false;
7289
7290 const IntegerType *OrigTy = cast<IntegerType>(V->getType());
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007291
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007292 // If this is an extension or truncate, we can often eliminate it.
7293 if (isa<TruncInst>(I) || isa<ZExtInst>(I) || isa<SExtInst>(I)) {
7294 // If this is a cast from the destination type, we can trivially eliminate
7295 // it, and this will remove a cast overall.
7296 if (I->getOperand(0)->getType() == Ty) {
7297 // If the first operand is itself a cast, and is eliminable, do not count
7298 // this as an eliminable cast. We would prefer to eliminate those two
7299 // casts first.
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007300 if (!isa<CastInst>(I->getOperand(0)) && I->hasOneUse())
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007301 ++NumCastsRemoved;
7302 return true;
7303 }
7304 }
7305
7306 // We can't extend or shrink something that has multiple uses: doing so would
7307 // require duplicating the instruction in general, which isn't profitable.
7308 if (!I->hasOneUse()) return false;
7309
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007310 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007311 case Instruction::Add:
7312 case Instruction::Sub:
Nick Lewyckyb8cd6a42008-07-05 21:19:34 +00007313 case Instruction::Mul:
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007314 case Instruction::And:
7315 case Instruction::Or:
7316 case Instruction::Xor:
7317 // These operators can all arbitrarily be extended or truncated.
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007318 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, CastOpc,
7319 NumCastsRemoved) &&
7320 CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(1), Ty, CastOpc,
7321 NumCastsRemoved);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007322
Chris Lattner46b96052006-11-29 07:18:39 +00007323 case Instruction::Shl:
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007324 // If we are truncating the result of this SHL, and if it's a shift of a
7325 // constant amount, we can always perform a SHL in a smaller type.
7326 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00007327 uint32_t BitWidth = Ty->getBitWidth();
7328 if (BitWidth < OrigTy->getBitWidth() &&
7329 CI->getLimitedValue(BitWidth) < BitWidth)
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007330 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, CastOpc,
7331 NumCastsRemoved);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007332 }
7333 break;
7334 case Instruction::LShr:
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007335 // If this is a truncate of a logical shr, we can truncate it to a smaller
7336 // lshr iff we know that the bits we would otherwise be shifting in are
7337 // already zeros.
7338 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00007339 uint32_t OrigBitWidth = OrigTy->getBitWidth();
7340 uint32_t BitWidth = Ty->getBitWidth();
7341 if (BitWidth < OrigBitWidth &&
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007342 MaskedValueIsZero(I->getOperand(0),
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00007343 APInt::getHighBitsSet(OrigBitWidth, OrigBitWidth-BitWidth)) &&
7344 CI->getLimitedValue(BitWidth) < BitWidth) {
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007345 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, CastOpc,
7346 NumCastsRemoved);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007347 }
7348 }
Chris Lattner46b96052006-11-29 07:18:39 +00007349 break;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007350 case Instruction::ZExt:
7351 case Instruction::SExt:
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007352 case Instruction::Trunc:
7353 // If this is the same kind of case as our original (e.g. zext+zext), we
Chris Lattner5543a852007-08-02 17:23:38 +00007354 // can safely replace it. Note that replacing it does not reduce the number
7355 // of casts in the input.
7356 if (I->getOpcode() == CastOpc)
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007357 return true;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007358 break;
Nick Lewyckyb8cd6a42008-07-05 21:19:34 +00007359 case Instruction::Select: {
7360 SelectInst *SI = cast<SelectInst>(I);
7361 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(SI->getTrueValue(), Ty, CastOpc,
7362 NumCastsRemoved) &&
7363 CanEvaluateInDifferentType(SI->getFalseValue(), Ty, CastOpc,
7364 NumCastsRemoved);
7365 }
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007366 case Instruction::PHI: {
7367 // We can change a phi if we can change all operands.
7368 PHINode *PN = cast<PHINode>(I);
7369 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PN->getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i)
7370 if (!CanEvaluateInDifferentType(PN->getIncomingValue(i), Ty, CastOpc,
7371 NumCastsRemoved))
7372 return false;
7373 return true;
7374 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007375 default:
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007376 // TODO: Can handle more cases here.
7377 break;
7378 }
7379
7380 return false;
7381}
7382
7383/// EvaluateInDifferentType - Given an expression that
7384/// CanEvaluateInDifferentType returns true for, actually insert the code to
7385/// evaluate the expression.
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00007386Value *InstCombiner::EvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const Type *Ty,
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007387 bool isSigned) {
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007388 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(V))
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00007389 return ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(C, Ty, isSigned /*Sext or ZExt*/);
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007390
7391 // Otherwise, it must be an instruction.
7392 Instruction *I = cast<Instruction>(V);
Chris Lattner01859e82006-05-20 23:14:03 +00007393 Instruction *Res = 0;
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007394 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007395 case Instruction::Add:
7396 case Instruction::Sub:
Nick Lewyckye6b0c002008-01-22 05:08:48 +00007397 case Instruction::Mul:
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007398 case Instruction::And:
7399 case Instruction::Or:
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007400 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner46b96052006-11-29 07:18:39 +00007401 case Instruction::AShr:
7402 case Instruction::LShr:
7403 case Instruction::Shl: {
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00007404 Value *LHS = EvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, isSigned);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007405 Value *RHS = EvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(1), Ty, isSigned);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007406 Res = BinaryOperator::Create((Instruction::BinaryOps)I->getOpcode(),
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007407 LHS, RHS);
Chris Lattner46b96052006-11-29 07:18:39 +00007408 break;
7409 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007410 case Instruction::Trunc:
7411 case Instruction::ZExt:
7412 case Instruction::SExt:
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007413 // If the source type of the cast is the type we're trying for then we can
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007414 // just return the source. There's no need to insert it because it is not
7415 // new.
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007416 if (I->getOperand(0)->getType() == Ty)
7417 return I->getOperand(0);
7418
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007419 // Otherwise, must be the same type of cast, so just reinsert a new one.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007420 Res = CastInst::Create(cast<CastInst>(I)->getOpcode(), I->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007421 Ty);
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007422 break;
Nick Lewyckyb8cd6a42008-07-05 21:19:34 +00007423 case Instruction::Select: {
7424 Value *True = EvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(1), Ty, isSigned);
7425 Value *False = EvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(2), Ty, isSigned);
7426 Res = SelectInst::Create(I->getOperand(0), True, False);
7427 break;
7428 }
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007429 case Instruction::PHI: {
7430 PHINode *OPN = cast<PHINode>(I);
7431 PHINode *NPN = PHINode::Create(Ty);
7432 for (unsigned i = 0, e = OPN->getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
7433 Value *V =EvaluateInDifferentType(OPN->getIncomingValue(i), Ty, isSigned);
7434 NPN->addIncoming(V, OPN->getIncomingBlock(i));
7435 }
7436 Res = NPN;
7437 break;
7438 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007439 default:
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007440 // TODO: Can handle more cases here.
7441 assert(0 && "Unreachable!");
7442 break;
7443 }
7444
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007445 Res->takeName(I);
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007446 return InsertNewInstBefore(Res, *I);
7447}
7448
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007449/// @brief Implement the transforms common to all CastInst visitors.
7450Instruction *InstCombiner::commonCastTransforms(CastInst &CI) {
Chris Lattner79d35b32003-06-23 21:59:52 +00007451 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
7452
Dan Gohman23d9d272007-05-11 21:10:54 +00007453 // Many cases of "cast of a cast" are eliminable. If it's eliminable we just
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007454 // eliminate it now.
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00007455 if (CastInst *CSrc = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Src)) { // A->B->C cast
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007456 if (Instruction::CastOps opc =
7457 isEliminableCastPair(CSrc, CI.getOpcode(), CI.getType(), TD)) {
7458 // The first cast (CSrc) is eliminable so we need to fix up or replace
7459 // the second cast (CI). CSrc will then have a good chance of being dead.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007460 return CastInst::Create(opc, CSrc->getOperand(0), CI.getType());
Chris Lattner8fd217c2002-08-02 20:00:25 +00007461 }
7462 }
Chris Lattnera710ddc2004-05-25 04:29:21 +00007463
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007464 // If we are casting a select then fold the cast into the select
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00007465 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Src))
7466 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoSelect(CI, SI, this))
7467 return NV;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007468
7469 // If we are casting a PHI then fold the cast into the PHI
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00007470 if (isa<PHINode>(Src))
7471 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(CI))
7472 return NV;
Chris Lattner9fb92132006-04-12 18:09:35 +00007473
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007474 return 0;
7475}
7476
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007477/// @brief Implement the transforms for cast of pointer (bitcast/ptrtoint)
7478Instruction *InstCombiner::commonPointerCastTransforms(CastInst &CI) {
7479 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
7480
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007481 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEP = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Src)) {
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007482 // If casting the result of a getelementptr instruction with no offset, turn
7483 // this into a cast of the original pointer!
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007484 if (GEP->hasAllZeroIndices()) {
7485 // Changing the cast operand is usually not a good idea but it is safe
7486 // here because the pointer operand is being replaced with another
7487 // pointer operand so the opcode doesn't need to change.
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007488 AddToWorkList(GEP);
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007489 CI.setOperand(0, GEP->getOperand(0));
7490 return &CI;
7491 }
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007492
7493 // If the GEP has a single use, and the base pointer is a bitcast, and the
7494 // GEP computes a constant offset, see if we can convert these three
7495 // instructions into fewer. This typically happens with unions and other
7496 // non-type-safe code.
7497 if (GEP->hasOneUse() && isa<BitCastInst>(GEP->getOperand(0))) {
7498 if (GEP->hasAllConstantIndices()) {
7499 // We are guaranteed to get a constant from EmitGEPOffset.
7500 ConstantInt *OffsetV = cast<ConstantInt>(EmitGEPOffset(GEP, CI, *this));
7501 int64_t Offset = OffsetV->getSExtValue();
7502
7503 // Get the base pointer input of the bitcast, and the type it points to.
7504 Value *OrigBase = cast<BitCastInst>(GEP->getOperand(0))->getOperand(0);
7505 const Type *GEPIdxTy =
7506 cast<PointerType>(OrigBase->getType())->getElementType();
7507 if (GEPIdxTy->isSized()) {
7508 SmallVector<Value*, 8> NewIndices;
7509
Chris Lattnerc42e2262007-05-05 01:59:31 +00007510 // Start with the index over the outer type. Note that the type size
7511 // might be zero (even if the offset isn't zero) if the indexed type
7512 // is something like [0 x {int, int}]
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007513 const Type *IntPtrTy = TD->getIntPtrType();
Chris Lattnerc42e2262007-05-05 01:59:31 +00007514 int64_t FirstIdx = 0;
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +00007515 if (int64_t TySize = TD->getABITypeSize(GEPIdxTy)) {
Chris Lattnerc42e2262007-05-05 01:59:31 +00007516 FirstIdx = Offset/TySize;
7517 Offset %= TySize;
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007518
Chris Lattnerc42e2262007-05-05 01:59:31 +00007519 // Handle silly modulus not returning values values [0..TySize).
7520 if (Offset < 0) {
7521 --FirstIdx;
7522 Offset += TySize;
7523 assert(Offset >= 0);
7524 }
Chris Lattnerd717c182007-05-05 22:32:24 +00007525 assert((uint64_t)Offset < (uint64_t)TySize &&"Out of range offset");
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007526 }
7527
7528 NewIndices.push_back(ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, FirstIdx));
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007529
7530 // Index into the types. If we fail, set OrigBase to null.
7531 while (Offset) {
7532 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(GEPIdxTy)) {
7533 const StructLayout *SL = TD->getStructLayout(STy);
Chris Lattner6b6aef82007-05-15 00:16:00 +00007534 if (Offset < (int64_t)SL->getSizeInBytes()) {
7535 unsigned Elt = SL->getElementContainingOffset(Offset);
7536 NewIndices.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Elt));
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007537
Chris Lattner6b6aef82007-05-15 00:16:00 +00007538 Offset -= SL->getElementOffset(Elt);
7539 GEPIdxTy = STy->getElementType(Elt);
7540 } else {
7541 // Otherwise, we can't index into this, bail out.
7542 Offset = 0;
7543 OrigBase = 0;
7544 }
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007545 } else if (isa<ArrayType>(GEPIdxTy) || isa<VectorType>(GEPIdxTy)) {
7546 const SequentialType *STy = cast<SequentialType>(GEPIdxTy);
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +00007547 if (uint64_t EltSize = TD->getABITypeSize(STy->getElementType())){
Chris Lattner6b6aef82007-05-15 00:16:00 +00007548 NewIndices.push_back(ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy,Offset/EltSize));
7549 Offset %= EltSize;
7550 } else {
7551 NewIndices.push_back(ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, 0));
7552 }
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007553 GEPIdxTy = STy->getElementType();
7554 } else {
7555 // Otherwise, we can't index into this, bail out.
7556 Offset = 0;
7557 OrigBase = 0;
7558 }
7559 }
7560 if (OrigBase) {
7561 // If we were able to index down into an element, create the GEP
7562 // and bitcast the result. This eliminates one bitcast, potentially
7563 // two.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00007564 Instruction *NGEP = GetElementPtrInst::Create(OrigBase,
7565 NewIndices.begin(),
7566 NewIndices.end(), "");
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007567 InsertNewInstBefore(NGEP, CI);
7568 NGEP->takeName(GEP);
7569
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007570 if (isa<BitCastInst>(CI))
7571 return new BitCastInst(NGEP, CI.getType());
7572 assert(isa<PtrToIntInst>(CI));
7573 return new PtrToIntInst(NGEP, CI.getType());
7574 }
7575 }
7576 }
7577 }
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007578 }
7579
7580 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
7581}
7582
7583
7584
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007585/// Only the TRUNC, ZEXT, SEXT, and BITCAST can both operand and result as
7586/// integer types. This function implements the common transforms for all those
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007587/// cases.
7588/// @brief Implement the transforms common to CastInst with integer operands
7589Instruction *InstCombiner::commonIntCastTransforms(CastInst &CI) {
7590 if (Instruction *Result = commonCastTransforms(CI))
7591 return Result;
7592
7593 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
7594 const Type *SrcTy = Src->getType();
7595 const Type *DestTy = CI.getType();
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00007596 uint32_t SrcBitSize = SrcTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
7597 uint32_t DestBitSize = DestTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007598
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007599 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the LHS whose sole
7600 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Reid Spencerad6676e2007-03-22 20:56:53 +00007601 APInt KnownZero(DestBitSize, 0), KnownOne(DestBitSize, 0);
7602 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&CI, APInt::getAllOnesValue(DestBitSize),
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007603 KnownZero, KnownOne))
7604 return &CI;
7605
7606 // If the source isn't an instruction or has more than one use then we
7607 // can't do anything more.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007608 Instruction *SrcI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Src);
7609 if (!SrcI || !Src->hasOneUse())
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007610 return 0;
7611
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007612 // Attempt to propagate the cast into the instruction for int->int casts.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007613 int NumCastsRemoved = 0;
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007614 if (!isa<BitCastInst>(CI) &&
7615 CanEvaluateInDifferentType(SrcI, cast<IntegerType>(DestTy),
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007616 CI.getOpcode(), NumCastsRemoved)) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007617 // If this cast is a truncate, evaluting in a different type always
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007618 // eliminates the cast, so it is always a win. If this is a zero-extension,
7619 // we need to do an AND to maintain the clear top-part of the computation,
7620 // so we require that the input have eliminated at least one cast. If this
7621 // is a sign extension, we insert two new casts (to do the extension) so we
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007622 // require that two casts have been eliminated.
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007623 bool DoXForm;
7624 switch (CI.getOpcode()) {
7625 default:
7626 // All the others use floating point so we shouldn't actually
7627 // get here because of the check above.
7628 assert(0 && "Unknown cast type");
7629 case Instruction::Trunc:
7630 DoXForm = true;
7631 break;
7632 case Instruction::ZExt:
7633 DoXForm = NumCastsRemoved >= 1;
7634 break;
7635 case Instruction::SExt:
7636 DoXForm = NumCastsRemoved >= 2;
7637 break;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007638 }
7639
7640 if (DoXForm) {
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00007641 Value *Res = EvaluateInDifferentType(SrcI, DestTy,
7642 CI.getOpcode() == Instruction::SExt);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007643 assert(Res->getType() == DestTy);
7644 switch (CI.getOpcode()) {
7645 default: assert(0 && "Unknown cast type!");
7646 case Instruction::Trunc:
7647 case Instruction::BitCast:
7648 // Just replace this cast with the result.
7649 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Res);
7650 case Instruction::ZExt: {
7651 // We need to emit an AND to clear the high bits.
7652 assert(SrcBitSize < DestBitSize && "Not a zext?");
Chris Lattnercd1d6d52007-04-02 05:48:58 +00007653 Constant *C = ConstantInt::get(APInt::getLowBitsSet(DestBitSize,
7654 SrcBitSize));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007655 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Res, C);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007656 }
7657 case Instruction::SExt:
7658 // We need to emit a cast to truncate, then a cast to sext.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007659 return CastInst::Create(Instruction::SExt,
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007660 InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, Res, Src->getType(),
7661 CI), DestTy);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007662 }
7663 }
7664 }
7665
7666 Value *Op0 = SrcI->getNumOperands() > 0 ? SrcI->getOperand(0) : 0;
7667 Value *Op1 = SrcI->getNumOperands() > 1 ? SrcI->getOperand(1) : 0;
7668
7669 switch (SrcI->getOpcode()) {
7670 case Instruction::Add:
7671 case Instruction::Mul:
7672 case Instruction::And:
7673 case Instruction::Or:
7674 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007675 // If we are discarding information, rewrite.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007676 if (DestBitSize <= SrcBitSize && DestBitSize != 1) {
7677 // Don't insert two casts if they cannot be eliminated. We allow
7678 // two casts to be inserted if the sizes are the same. This could
7679 // only be converting signedness, which is a noop.
7680 if (DestBitSize == SrcBitSize ||
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007681 !ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op1, DestTy,TD) ||
7682 !ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op0, DestTy, TD)) {
Reid Spencer7eb76382006-12-13 17:19:09 +00007683 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CI.getOpcode();
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007684 Value *Op0c = InsertOperandCastBefore(opcode, Op0, DestTy, SrcI);
7685 Value *Op1c = InsertOperandCastBefore(opcode, Op1, DestTy, SrcI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007686 return BinaryOperator::Create(
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007687 cast<BinaryOperator>(SrcI)->getOpcode(), Op0c, Op1c);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007688 }
7689 }
7690
7691 // cast (xor bool X, true) to int --> xor (cast bool X to int), 1
7692 if (isa<ZExtInst>(CI) && SrcBitSize == 1 &&
7693 SrcI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Xor &&
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00007694 Op1 == ConstantInt::getTrue() &&
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007695 (!Op0->hasOneUse() || !isa<CmpInst>(Op0))) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007696 Value *New = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::ZExt, Op0, DestTy, &CI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007697 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(New, ConstantInt::get(CI.getType(), 1));
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007698 }
7699 break;
7700 case Instruction::SDiv:
7701 case Instruction::UDiv:
7702 case Instruction::SRem:
7703 case Instruction::URem:
7704 // If we are just changing the sign, rewrite.
7705 if (DestBitSize == SrcBitSize) {
7706 // Don't insert two casts if they cannot be eliminated. We allow
7707 // two casts to be inserted if the sizes are the same. This could
7708 // only be converting signedness, which is a noop.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007709 if (!ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op1, DestTy, TD) ||
7710 !ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op0, DestTy, TD)) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007711 Value *Op0c = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
7712 Op0, DestTy, SrcI);
7713 Value *Op1c = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
7714 Op1, DestTy, SrcI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007715 return BinaryOperator::Create(
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007716 cast<BinaryOperator>(SrcI)->getOpcode(), Op0c, Op1c);
7717 }
7718 }
7719 break;
7720
7721 case Instruction::Shl:
7722 // Allow changing the sign of the source operand. Do not allow
7723 // changing the size of the shift, UNLESS the shift amount is a
7724 // constant. We must not change variable sized shifts to a smaller
7725 // size, because it is undefined to shift more bits out than exist
7726 // in the value.
7727 if (DestBitSize == SrcBitSize ||
7728 (DestBitSize < SrcBitSize && isa<Constant>(Op1))) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007729 Instruction::CastOps opcode = (DestBitSize == SrcBitSize ?
7730 Instruction::BitCast : Instruction::Trunc);
7731 Value *Op0c = InsertOperandCastBefore(opcode, Op0, DestTy, SrcI);
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007732 Value *Op1c = InsertOperandCastBefore(opcode, Op1, DestTy, SrcI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007733 return BinaryOperator::CreateShl(Op0c, Op1c);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007734 }
7735 break;
7736 case Instruction::AShr:
7737 // If this is a signed shr, and if all bits shifted in are about to be
7738 // truncated off, turn it into an unsigned shr to allow greater
7739 // simplifications.
7740 if (DestBitSize < SrcBitSize &&
7741 isa<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00007742 uint32_t ShiftAmt = cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)->getLimitedValue(SrcBitSize);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007743 if (SrcBitSize > ShiftAmt && SrcBitSize-ShiftAmt >= DestBitSize) {
7744 // Insert the new logical shift right.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007745 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(Op0, Op1);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007746 }
7747 }
7748 break;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007749 }
7750 return 0;
7751}
7752
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00007753Instruction *InstCombiner::visitTrunc(TruncInst &CI) {
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00007754 if (Instruction *Result = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
7755 return Result;
7756
7757 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
7758 const Type *Ty = CI.getType();
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00007759 uint32_t DestBitWidth = Ty->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
7760 uint32_t SrcBitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(Src->getType())->getBitWidth();
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00007761
7762 if (Instruction *SrcI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Src)) {
7763 switch (SrcI->getOpcode()) {
7764 default: break;
7765 case Instruction::LShr:
7766 // We can shrink lshr to something smaller if we know the bits shifted in
7767 // are already zeros.
7768 if (ConstantInt *ShAmtV = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SrcI->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00007769 uint32_t ShAmt = ShAmtV->getLimitedValue(SrcBitWidth);
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00007770
7771 // Get a mask for the bits shifting in.
Zhou Shenge82fca02007-03-28 09:19:01 +00007772 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(SrcBitWidth, ShAmt).shl(DestBitWidth));
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007773 Value* SrcIOp0 = SrcI->getOperand(0);
7774 if (SrcI->hasOneUse() && MaskedValueIsZero(SrcIOp0, Mask)) {
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00007775 if (ShAmt >= DestBitWidth) // All zeros.
7776 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Constant::getNullValue(Ty));
7777
7778 // Okay, we can shrink this. Truncate the input, then return a new
7779 // shift.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007780 Value *V1 = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, SrcIOp0, Ty, CI);
7781 Value *V2 = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, SrcI->getOperand(1),
7782 Ty, CI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007783 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(V1, V2);
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00007784 }
Chris Lattnere13ab2a2006-12-05 01:26:29 +00007785 } else { // This is a variable shr.
7786
7787 // Turn 'trunc (lshr X, Y) to bool' into '(X & (1 << Y)) != 0'. This is
7788 // more LLVM instructions, but allows '1 << Y' to be hoisted if
7789 // loop-invariant and CSE'd.
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00007790 if (CI.getType() == Type::Int1Ty && SrcI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnere13ab2a2006-12-05 01:26:29 +00007791 Value *One = ConstantInt::get(SrcI->getType(), 1);
7792
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007793 Value *V = InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007794 BinaryOperator::CreateShl(One, SrcI->getOperand(1),
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007795 "tmp"), CI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007796 V = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V,
Chris Lattnere13ab2a2006-12-05 01:26:29 +00007797 SrcI->getOperand(0),
7798 "tmp"), CI);
7799 Value *Zero = Constant::getNullValue(V->getType());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007800 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, V, Zero);
Chris Lattnere13ab2a2006-12-05 01:26:29 +00007801 }
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00007802 }
7803 break;
7804 }
7805 }
7806
7807 return 0;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007808}
7809
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007810/// transformZExtICmp - Transform (zext icmp) to bitwise / integer operations
7811/// in order to eliminate the icmp.
7812Instruction *InstCombiner::transformZExtICmp(ICmpInst *ICI, Instruction &CI,
7813 bool DoXform) {
7814 // If we are just checking for a icmp eq of a single bit and zext'ing it
7815 // to an integer, then shift the bit to the appropriate place and then
7816 // cast to integer to avoid the comparison.
7817 if (ConstantInt *Op1C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(ICI->getOperand(1))) {
7818 const APInt &Op1CV = Op1C->getValue();
7819
7820 // zext (x <s 0) to i32 --> x>>u31 true if signbit set.
7821 // zext (x >s -1) to i32 --> (x>>u31)^1 true if signbit clear.
7822 if ((ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && Op1CV == 0) ||
7823 (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT &&Op1CV.isAllOnesValue())) {
7824 if (!DoXform) return ICI;
7825
7826 Value *In = ICI->getOperand(0);
7827 Value *Sh = ConstantInt::get(In->getType(),
7828 In->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007829 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(In, Sh,
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007830 In->getName()+".lobit"),
7831 CI);
7832 if (In->getType() != CI.getType())
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007833 In = CastInst::CreateIntegerCast(In, CI.getType(),
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007834 false/*ZExt*/, "tmp", &CI);
7835
7836 if (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT) {
7837 Constant *One = ConstantInt::get(In->getType(), 1);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007838 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateXor(In, One,
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007839 In->getName()+".not"),
7840 CI);
7841 }
7842
7843 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, In);
7844 }
7845
7846
7847
7848 // zext (X == 0) to i32 --> X^1 iff X has only the low bit set.
7849 // zext (X == 0) to i32 --> (X>>1)^1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
7850 // zext (X == 1) to i32 --> X iff X has only the low bit set.
7851 // zext (X == 2) to i32 --> X>>1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
7852 // zext (X != 0) to i32 --> X iff X has only the low bit set.
7853 // zext (X != 0) to i32 --> X>>1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
7854 // zext (X != 1) to i32 --> X^1 iff X has only the low bit set.
7855 // zext (X != 2) to i32 --> (X>>1)^1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
7856 if ((Op1CV == 0 || Op1CV.isPowerOf2()) &&
7857 // This only works for EQ and NE
7858 ICI->isEquality()) {
7859 // If Op1C some other power of two, convert:
7860 uint32_t BitWidth = Op1C->getType()->getBitWidth();
7861 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
7862 APInt TypeMask(APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth));
7863 ComputeMaskedBits(ICI->getOperand(0), TypeMask, KnownZero, KnownOne);
7864
7865 APInt KnownZeroMask(~KnownZero);
7866 if (KnownZeroMask.isPowerOf2()) { // Exactly 1 possible 1?
7867 if (!DoXform) return ICI;
7868
7869 bool isNE = ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
7870 if (Op1CV != 0 && (Op1CV != KnownZeroMask)) {
7871 // (X&4) == 2 --> false
7872 // (X&4) != 2 --> true
7873 Constant *Res = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, isNE);
7874 Res = ConstantExpr::getZExt(Res, CI.getType());
7875 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Res);
7876 }
7877
7878 uint32_t ShiftAmt = KnownZeroMask.logBase2();
7879 Value *In = ICI->getOperand(0);
7880 if (ShiftAmt) {
7881 // Perform a logical shr by shiftamt.
7882 // Insert the shift to put the result in the low bit.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007883 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(In,
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007884 ConstantInt::get(In->getType(), ShiftAmt),
7885 In->getName()+".lobit"), CI);
7886 }
7887
7888 if ((Op1CV != 0) == isNE) { // Toggle the low bit.
7889 Constant *One = ConstantInt::get(In->getType(), 1);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007890 In = BinaryOperator::CreateXor(In, One, "tmp");
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007891 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(In), CI);
7892 }
7893
7894 if (CI.getType() == In->getType())
7895 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, In);
7896 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007897 return CastInst::CreateIntegerCast(In, CI.getType(), false/*ZExt*/);
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007898 }
7899 }
7900 }
7901
7902 return 0;
7903}
7904
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00007905Instruction *InstCombiner::visitZExt(ZExtInst &CI) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007906 // If one of the common conversion will work ..
7907 if (Instruction *Result = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
7908 return Result;
7909
7910 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
7911
7912 // If this is a cast of a cast
7913 if (CastInst *CSrc = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Src)) { // A->B->C cast
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007914 // If this is a TRUNC followed by a ZEXT then we are dealing with integral
7915 // types and if the sizes are just right we can convert this into a logical
7916 // 'and' which will be much cheaper than the pair of casts.
7917 if (isa<TruncInst>(CSrc)) {
7918 // Get the sizes of the types involved
7919 Value *A = CSrc->getOperand(0);
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00007920 uint32_t SrcSize = A->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
7921 uint32_t MidSize = CSrc->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
7922 uint32_t DstSize = CI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007923 // If we're actually extending zero bits and the trunc is a no-op
7924 if (MidSize < DstSize && SrcSize == DstSize) {
7925 // Replace both of the casts with an And of the type mask.
Zhou Shenge82fca02007-03-28 09:19:01 +00007926 APInt AndValue(APInt::getLowBitsSet(SrcSize, MidSize));
Reid Spencerad6676e2007-03-22 20:56:53 +00007927 Constant *AndConst = ConstantInt::get(AndValue);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007928 Instruction *And =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007929 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(CSrc->getOperand(0), AndConst);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007930 // Unfortunately, if the type changed, we need to cast it back.
7931 if (And->getType() != CI.getType()) {
7932 And->setName(CSrc->getName()+".mask");
7933 InsertNewInstBefore(And, CI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007934 And = CastInst::CreateIntegerCast(And, CI.getType(), false/*ZExt*/);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007935 }
7936 return And;
7937 }
7938 }
7939 }
7940
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007941 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Src))
7942 return transformZExtICmp(ICI, CI);
Chris Lattnera2e2c9b2007-04-11 06:53:04 +00007943
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007944 BinaryOperator *SrcI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Src);
7945 if (SrcI && SrcI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
7946 // zext (or icmp, icmp) --> or (zext icmp), (zext icmp) if at least one
7947 // of the (zext icmp) will be transformed.
7948 ICmpInst *LHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(SrcI->getOperand(0));
7949 ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(SrcI->getOperand(1));
7950 if (LHS && RHS && LHS->hasOneUse() && RHS->hasOneUse() &&
7951 (transformZExtICmp(LHS, CI, false) ||
7952 transformZExtICmp(RHS, CI, false))) {
7953 Value *LCast = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::ZExt, LHS, CI.getType(), CI);
7954 Value *RCast = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::ZExt, RHS, CI.getType(), CI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007955 return BinaryOperator::Create(Instruction::Or, LCast, RCast);
Chris Lattner66bc3252007-04-11 05:45:39 +00007956 }
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007957 }
7958
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007959 return 0;
7960}
7961
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00007962Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSExt(SExtInst &CI) {
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00007963 if (Instruction *I = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
7964 return I;
7965
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00007966 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
7967
7968 // sext (x <s 0) -> ashr x, 31 -> all ones if signed
7969 // sext (x >s -1) -> ashr x, 31 -> all ones if not signed
7970 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Src)) {
7971 // If we are just checking for a icmp eq of a single bit and zext'ing it
7972 // to an integer, then shift the bit to the appropriate place and then
7973 // cast to integer to avoid the comparison.
7974 if (ConstantInt *Op1C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(ICI->getOperand(1))) {
7975 const APInt &Op1CV = Op1C->getValue();
7976
7977 // sext (x <s 0) to i32 --> x>>s31 true if signbit set.
7978 // sext (x >s -1) to i32 --> (x>>s31)^-1 true if signbit clear.
7979 if ((ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && Op1CV == 0) ||
7980 (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT &&Op1CV.isAllOnesValue())){
7981 Value *In = ICI->getOperand(0);
7982 Value *Sh = ConstantInt::get(In->getType(),
7983 In->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007984 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAShr(In, Sh,
Chris Lattnere34e9a22007-04-14 23:32:02 +00007985 In->getName()+".lobit"),
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00007986 CI);
7987 if (In->getType() != CI.getType())
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007988 In = CastInst::CreateIntegerCast(In, CI.getType(),
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00007989 true/*SExt*/, "tmp", &CI);
7990
7991 if (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007992 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(In,
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00007993 In->getName()+".not"), CI);
7994
7995 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, In);
7996 }
7997 }
7998 }
Dan Gohmanf35c8822008-05-20 21:01:12 +00007999
8000 // See if the value being truncated is already sign extended. If so, just
8001 // eliminate the trunc/sext pair.
8002 if (getOpcode(Src) == Instruction::Trunc) {
8003 Value *Op = cast<User>(Src)->getOperand(0);
8004 unsigned OpBits = cast<IntegerType>(Op->getType())->getBitWidth();
8005 unsigned MidBits = cast<IntegerType>(Src->getType())->getBitWidth();
8006 unsigned DestBits = cast<IntegerType>(CI.getType())->getBitWidth();
8007 unsigned NumSignBits = ComputeNumSignBits(Op);
8008
8009 if (OpBits == DestBits) {
8010 // Op is i32, Mid is i8, and Dest is i32. If Op has more than 24 sign
8011 // bits, it is already ready.
8012 if (NumSignBits > DestBits-MidBits)
8013 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Op);
8014 } else if (OpBits < DestBits) {
8015 // Op is i32, Mid is i8, and Dest is i64. If Op has more than 24 sign
8016 // bits, just sext from i32.
8017 if (NumSignBits > OpBits-MidBits)
8018 return new SExtInst(Op, CI.getType(), "tmp");
8019 } else {
8020 // Op is i64, Mid is i8, and Dest is i32. If Op has more than 56 sign
8021 // bits, just truncate to i32.
8022 if (NumSignBits > OpBits-MidBits)
8023 return new TruncInst(Op, CI.getType(), "tmp");
8024 }
8025 }
Chris Lattner46bbad22008-08-06 07:35:52 +00008026
8027 // If the input is a shl/ashr pair of a same constant, then this is a sign
8028 // extension from a smaller value. If we could trust arbitrary bitwidth
8029 // integers, we could turn this into a truncate to the smaller bit and then
8030 // use a sext for the whole extension. Since we don't, look deeper and check
8031 // for a truncate. If the source and dest are the same type, eliminate the
8032 // trunc and extend and just do shifts. For example, turn:
8033 // %a = trunc i32 %i to i8
8034 // %b = shl i8 %a, 6
8035 // %c = ashr i8 %b, 6
8036 // %d = sext i8 %c to i32
8037 // into:
8038 // %a = shl i32 %i, 30
8039 // %d = ashr i32 %a, 30
8040 Value *A = 0;
8041 ConstantInt *BA = 0, *CA = 0;
8042 if (match(Src, m_AShr(m_Shl(m_Value(A), m_ConstantInt(BA)),
8043 m_ConstantInt(CA))) &&
8044 BA == CA && isa<TruncInst>(A)) {
8045 Value *I = cast<TruncInst>(A)->getOperand(0);
8046 if (I->getType() == CI.getType()) {
8047 unsigned MidSize = Src->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
8048 unsigned SrcDstSize = CI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
8049 unsigned ShAmt = CA->getZExtValue()+SrcDstSize-MidSize;
8050 Constant *ShAmtV = ConstantInt::get(CI.getType(), ShAmt);
8051 I = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateShl(I, ShAmtV,
8052 CI.getName()), CI);
8053 return BinaryOperator::CreateAShr(I, ShAmtV);
8054 }
8055 }
8056
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00008057 return 0;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008058}
8059
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008060/// FitsInFPType - Return a Constant* for the specified FP constant if it fits
8061/// in the specified FP type without changing its value.
Chris Lattner02a260a2008-04-20 00:41:09 +00008062static Constant *FitsInFPType(ConstantFP *CFP, const fltSemantics &Sem) {
Dale Johannesen23a98552008-10-09 23:00:39 +00008063 bool losesInfo;
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008064 APFloat F = CFP->getValueAPF();
Dale Johannesen23a98552008-10-09 23:00:39 +00008065 (void)F.convert(Sem, APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven, &losesInfo);
8066 if (!losesInfo)
Chris Lattner02a260a2008-04-20 00:41:09 +00008067 return ConstantFP::get(F);
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008068 return 0;
8069}
8070
8071/// LookThroughFPExtensions - If this is an fp extension instruction, look
8072/// through it until we get the source value.
8073static Value *LookThroughFPExtensions(Value *V) {
8074 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V))
8075 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::FPExt)
8076 return LookThroughFPExtensions(I->getOperand(0));
8077
8078 // If this value is a constant, return the constant in the smallest FP type
8079 // that can accurately represent it. This allows us to turn
8080 // (float)((double)X+2.0) into x+2.0f.
8081 if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(V)) {
8082 if (CFP->getType() == Type::PPC_FP128Ty)
8083 return V; // No constant folding of this.
8084 // See if the value can be truncated to float and then reextended.
Chris Lattner02a260a2008-04-20 00:41:09 +00008085 if (Value *V = FitsInFPType(CFP, APFloat::IEEEsingle))
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008086 return V;
8087 if (CFP->getType() == Type::DoubleTy)
8088 return V; // Won't shrink.
Chris Lattner02a260a2008-04-20 00:41:09 +00008089 if (Value *V = FitsInFPType(CFP, APFloat::IEEEdouble))
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008090 return V;
8091 // Don't try to shrink to various long double types.
8092 }
8093
8094 return V;
8095}
8096
8097Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPTrunc(FPTruncInst &CI) {
8098 if (Instruction *I = commonCastTransforms(CI))
8099 return I;
8100
8101 // If we have fptrunc(add (fpextend x), (fpextend y)), where x and y are
8102 // smaller than the destination type, we can eliminate the truncate by doing
8103 // the add as the smaller type. This applies to add/sub/mul/div as well as
8104 // many builtins (sqrt, etc).
8105 BinaryOperator *OpI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(CI.getOperand(0));
8106 if (OpI && OpI->hasOneUse()) {
8107 switch (OpI->getOpcode()) {
8108 default: break;
8109 case Instruction::Add:
8110 case Instruction::Sub:
8111 case Instruction::Mul:
8112 case Instruction::FDiv:
8113 case Instruction::FRem:
8114 const Type *SrcTy = OpI->getType();
8115 Value *LHSTrunc = LookThroughFPExtensions(OpI->getOperand(0));
8116 Value *RHSTrunc = LookThroughFPExtensions(OpI->getOperand(1));
8117 if (LHSTrunc->getType() != SrcTy &&
8118 RHSTrunc->getType() != SrcTy) {
8119 unsigned DstSize = CI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
8120 // If the source types were both smaller than the destination type of
8121 // the cast, do this xform.
8122 if (LHSTrunc->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() <= DstSize &&
8123 RHSTrunc->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() <= DstSize) {
8124 LHSTrunc = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::FPExt, LHSTrunc,
8125 CI.getType(), CI);
8126 RHSTrunc = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::FPExt, RHSTrunc,
8127 CI.getType(), CI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008128 return BinaryOperator::Create(OpI->getOpcode(), LHSTrunc, RHSTrunc);
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008129 }
8130 }
8131 break;
8132 }
8133 }
8134 return 0;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008135}
8136
8137Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPExt(CastInst &CI) {
8138 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
8139}
8140
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +00008141Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPToUI(FPToUIInst &FI) {
Chris Lattner5af5f462008-08-06 05:13:06 +00008142 Instruction *OpI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(FI.getOperand(0));
8143 if (OpI == 0)
8144 return commonCastTransforms(FI);
8145
8146 // fptoui(uitofp(X)) --> X
8147 // fptoui(sitofp(X)) --> X
8148 // This is safe if the intermediate type has enough bits in its mantissa to
8149 // accurately represent all values of X. For example, do not do this with
8150 // i64->float->i64. This is also safe for sitofp case, because any negative
8151 // 'X' value would cause an undefined result for the fptoui.
8152 if ((isa<UIToFPInst>(OpI) || isa<SIToFPInst>(OpI)) &&
8153 OpI->getOperand(0)->getType() == FI.getType() &&
8154 (int)FI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() < /*extra bit for sign */
8155 OpI->getType()->getFPMantissaWidth())
8156 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(FI, OpI->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +00008157
8158 return commonCastTransforms(FI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008159}
8160
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +00008161Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPToSI(FPToSIInst &FI) {
Chris Lattner5af5f462008-08-06 05:13:06 +00008162 Instruction *OpI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(FI.getOperand(0));
8163 if (OpI == 0)
8164 return commonCastTransforms(FI);
8165
8166 // fptosi(sitofp(X)) --> X
8167 // fptosi(uitofp(X)) --> X
8168 // This is safe if the intermediate type has enough bits in its mantissa to
8169 // accurately represent all values of X. For example, do not do this with
8170 // i64->float->i64. This is also safe for sitofp case, because any negative
8171 // 'X' value would cause an undefined result for the fptoui.
8172 if ((isa<UIToFPInst>(OpI) || isa<SIToFPInst>(OpI)) &&
8173 OpI->getOperand(0)->getType() == FI.getType() &&
8174 (int)FI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() <=
8175 OpI->getType()->getFPMantissaWidth())
8176 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(FI, OpI->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +00008177
8178 return commonCastTransforms(FI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008179}
8180
8181Instruction *InstCombiner::visitUIToFP(CastInst &CI) {
8182 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
8183}
8184
8185Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSIToFP(CastInst &CI) {
8186 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
8187}
8188
8189Instruction *InstCombiner::visitPtrToInt(CastInst &CI) {
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008190 return commonPointerCastTransforms(CI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008191}
8192
Chris Lattnerf9d9e452008-01-08 07:23:51 +00008193Instruction *InstCombiner::visitIntToPtr(IntToPtrInst &CI) {
8194 if (Instruction *I = commonCastTransforms(CI))
8195 return I;
8196
8197 const Type *DestPointee = cast<PointerType>(CI.getType())->getElementType();
8198 if (!DestPointee->isSized()) return 0;
8199
8200 // If this is inttoptr(add (ptrtoint x), cst), try to turn this into a GEP.
8201 ConstantInt *Cst;
8202 Value *X;
8203 if (match(CI.getOperand(0), m_Add(m_Cast<PtrToIntInst>(m_Value(X)),
8204 m_ConstantInt(Cst)))) {
8205 // If the source and destination operands have the same type, see if this
8206 // is a single-index GEP.
8207 if (X->getType() == CI.getType()) {
8208 // Get the size of the pointee type.
Bill Wendlingb9d4f8d2008-03-14 05:12:19 +00008209 uint64_t Size = TD->getABITypeSize(DestPointee);
Chris Lattnerf9d9e452008-01-08 07:23:51 +00008210
8211 // Convert the constant to intptr type.
8212 APInt Offset = Cst->getValue();
8213 Offset.sextOrTrunc(TD->getPointerSizeInBits());
8214
8215 // If Offset is evenly divisible by Size, we can do this xform.
8216 if (Size && !APIntOps::srem(Offset, APInt(Offset.getBitWidth(), Size))){
8217 Offset = APIntOps::sdiv(Offset, APInt(Offset.getBitWidth(), Size));
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00008218 return GetElementPtrInst::Create(X, ConstantInt::get(Offset));
Chris Lattnerf9d9e452008-01-08 07:23:51 +00008219 }
8220 }
8221 // TODO: Could handle other cases, e.g. where add is indexing into field of
8222 // struct etc.
8223 } else if (CI.getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() &&
8224 match(CI.getOperand(0), m_Add(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(Cst)))) {
8225 // Otherwise, if this is inttoptr(add x, cst), try to turn this into an
8226 // "inttoptr+GEP" instead of "add+intptr".
8227
8228 // Get the size of the pointee type.
8229 uint64_t Size = TD->getABITypeSize(DestPointee);
8230
8231 // Convert the constant to intptr type.
8232 APInt Offset = Cst->getValue();
8233 Offset.sextOrTrunc(TD->getPointerSizeInBits());
8234
8235 // If Offset is evenly divisible by Size, we can do this xform.
8236 if (Size && !APIntOps::srem(Offset, APInt(Offset.getBitWidth(), Size))){
8237 Offset = APIntOps::sdiv(Offset, APInt(Offset.getBitWidth(), Size));
8238
8239 Instruction *P = InsertNewInstBefore(new IntToPtrInst(X, CI.getType(),
8240 "tmp"), CI);
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00008241 return GetElementPtrInst::Create(P, ConstantInt::get(Offset), "tmp");
Chris Lattnerf9d9e452008-01-08 07:23:51 +00008242 }
8243 }
8244 return 0;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008245}
8246
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008247Instruction *InstCombiner::visitBitCast(BitCastInst &CI) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008248 // If the operands are integer typed then apply the integer transforms,
8249 // otherwise just apply the common ones.
8250 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
8251 const Type *SrcTy = Src->getType();
8252 const Type *DestTy = CI.getType();
8253
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00008254 if (SrcTy->isInteger() && DestTy->isInteger()) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008255 if (Instruction *Result = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
8256 return Result;
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008257 } else if (isa<PointerType>(SrcTy)) {
8258 if (Instruction *I = commonPointerCastTransforms(CI))
8259 return I;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008260 } else {
8261 if (Instruction *Result = commonCastTransforms(CI))
8262 return Result;
8263 }
8264
8265
8266 // Get rid of casts from one type to the same type. These are useless and can
8267 // be replaced by the operand.
8268 if (DestTy == Src->getType())
8269 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Src);
8270
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008271 if (const PointerType *DstPTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(DestTy)) {
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008272 const PointerType *SrcPTy = cast<PointerType>(SrcTy);
8273 const Type *DstElTy = DstPTy->getElementType();
8274 const Type *SrcElTy = SrcPTy->getElementType();
8275
Nate Begeman83ad90a2008-03-31 00:22:16 +00008276 // If the address spaces don't match, don't eliminate the bitcast, which is
8277 // required for changing types.
8278 if (SrcPTy->getAddressSpace() != DstPTy->getAddressSpace())
8279 return 0;
8280
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008281 // If we are casting a malloc or alloca to a pointer to a type of the same
8282 // size, rewrite the allocation instruction to allocate the "right" type.
8283 if (AllocationInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocationInst>(Src))
8284 if (Instruction *V = PromoteCastOfAllocation(CI, *AI))
8285 return V;
8286
Chris Lattnerd717c182007-05-05 22:32:24 +00008287 // If the source and destination are pointers, and this cast is equivalent
8288 // to a getelementptr X, 0, 0, 0... turn it into the appropriate gep.
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008289 // This can enhance SROA and other transforms that want type-safe pointers.
8290 Constant *ZeroUInt = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
8291 unsigned NumZeros = 0;
8292 while (SrcElTy != DstElTy &&
8293 isa<CompositeType>(SrcElTy) && !isa<PointerType>(SrcElTy) &&
8294 SrcElTy->getNumContainedTypes() /* not "{}" */) {
8295 SrcElTy = cast<CompositeType>(SrcElTy)->getTypeAtIndex(ZeroUInt);
8296 ++NumZeros;
8297 }
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00008298
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008299 // If we found a path from the src to dest, create the getelementptr now.
8300 if (SrcElTy == DstElTy) {
8301 SmallVector<Value*, 8> Idxs(NumZeros+1, ZeroUInt);
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00008302 return GetElementPtrInst::Create(Src, Idxs.begin(), Idxs.end(), "",
8303 ((Instruction*) NULL));
Chris Lattner9fb92132006-04-12 18:09:35 +00008304 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008305 }
Chris Lattner24c8e382003-07-24 17:35:25 +00008306
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008307 if (ShuffleVectorInst *SVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(Src)) {
8308 if (SVI->hasOneUse()) {
8309 // Okay, we have (bitconvert (shuffle ..)). Check to see if this is
8310 // a bitconvert to a vector with the same # elts.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00008311 if (isa<VectorType>(DestTy) &&
8312 cast<VectorType>(DestTy)->getNumElements() ==
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008313 SVI->getType()->getNumElements()) {
8314 CastInst *Tmp;
8315 // If either of the operands is a cast from CI.getType(), then
8316 // evaluating the shuffle in the casted destination's type will allow
8317 // us to eliminate at least one cast.
8318 if (((Tmp = dyn_cast<CastInst>(SVI->getOperand(0))) &&
8319 Tmp->getOperand(0)->getType() == DestTy) ||
8320 ((Tmp = dyn_cast<CastInst>(SVI->getOperand(1))) &&
8321 Tmp->getOperand(0)->getType() == DestTy)) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00008322 Value *LHS = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
8323 SVI->getOperand(0), DestTy, &CI);
8324 Value *RHS = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
8325 SVI->getOperand(1), DestTy, &CI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008326 // Return a new shuffle vector. Use the same element ID's, as we
8327 // know the vector types match #elts.
8328 return new ShuffleVectorInst(LHS, RHS, SVI->getOperand(2));
Chris Lattner01575b72006-05-25 23:24:33 +00008329 }
8330 }
8331 }
8332 }
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00008333 return 0;
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +00008334}
8335
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008336/// GetSelectFoldableOperands - We want to turn code that looks like this:
8337/// %C = or %A, %B
8338/// %D = select %cond, %C, %A
8339/// into:
8340/// %C = select %cond, %B, 0
8341/// %D = or %A, %C
8342///
8343/// Assuming that the specified instruction is an operand to the select, return
8344/// a bitmask indicating which operands of this instruction are foldable if they
8345/// equal the other incoming value of the select.
8346///
8347static unsigned GetSelectFoldableOperands(Instruction *I) {
8348 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
8349 case Instruction::Add:
8350 case Instruction::Mul:
8351 case Instruction::And:
8352 case Instruction::Or:
8353 case Instruction::Xor:
8354 return 3; // Can fold through either operand.
8355 case Instruction::Sub: // Can only fold on the amount subtracted.
8356 case Instruction::Shl: // Can only fold on the shift amount.
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00008357 case Instruction::LShr:
8358 case Instruction::AShr:
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008359 return 1;
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008360 default:
8361 return 0; // Cannot fold
8362 }
8363}
8364
8365/// GetSelectFoldableConstant - For the same transformation as the previous
8366/// function, return the identity constant that goes into the select.
8367static Constant *GetSelectFoldableConstant(Instruction *I) {
8368 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
8369 default: assert(0 && "This cannot happen!"); abort();
8370 case Instruction::Add:
8371 case Instruction::Sub:
8372 case Instruction::Or:
8373 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008374 case Instruction::Shl:
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00008375 case Instruction::LShr:
8376 case Instruction::AShr:
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00008377 return Constant::getNullValue(I->getType());
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008378 case Instruction::And:
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00008379 return Constant::getAllOnesValue(I->getType());
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008380 case Instruction::Mul:
8381 return ConstantInt::get(I->getType(), 1);
8382 }
8383}
8384
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008385/// FoldSelectOpOp - Here we have (select c, TI, FI), and we know that TI and FI
8386/// have the same opcode and only one use each. Try to simplify this.
8387Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldSelectOpOp(SelectInst &SI, Instruction *TI,
8388 Instruction *FI) {
8389 if (TI->getNumOperands() == 1) {
8390 // If this is a non-volatile load or a cast from the same type,
8391 // merge.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008392 if (TI->isCast()) {
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008393 if (TI->getOperand(0)->getType() != FI->getOperand(0)->getType())
8394 return 0;
8395 } else {
8396 return 0; // unknown unary op.
8397 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008398
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008399 // Fold this by inserting a select from the input values.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00008400 SelectInst *NewSI = SelectInst::Create(SI.getCondition(), TI->getOperand(0),
8401 FI->getOperand(0), SI.getName()+".v");
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008402 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSI, SI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008403 return CastInst::Create(Instruction::CastOps(TI->getOpcode()), NewSI,
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008404 TI->getType());
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008405 }
8406
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00008407 // Only handle binary operators here.
8408 if (!isa<BinaryOperator>(TI))
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008409 return 0;
8410
8411 // Figure out if the operations have any operands in common.
8412 Value *MatchOp, *OtherOpT, *OtherOpF;
8413 bool MatchIsOpZero;
8414 if (TI->getOperand(0) == FI->getOperand(0)) {
8415 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(0);
8416 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(1);
8417 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(1);
8418 MatchIsOpZero = true;
8419 } else if (TI->getOperand(1) == FI->getOperand(1)) {
8420 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(1);
8421 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(0);
8422 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(0);
8423 MatchIsOpZero = false;
8424 } else if (!TI->isCommutative()) {
8425 return 0;
8426 } else if (TI->getOperand(0) == FI->getOperand(1)) {
8427 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(0);
8428 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(1);
8429 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(0);
8430 MatchIsOpZero = true;
8431 } else if (TI->getOperand(1) == FI->getOperand(0)) {
8432 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(1);
8433 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(0);
8434 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(1);
8435 MatchIsOpZero = true;
8436 } else {
8437 return 0;
8438 }
8439
8440 // If we reach here, they do have operations in common.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00008441 SelectInst *NewSI = SelectInst::Create(SI.getCondition(), OtherOpT,
8442 OtherOpF, SI.getName()+".v");
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008443 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSI, SI);
8444
8445 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(TI)) {
8446 if (MatchIsOpZero)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008447 return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), MatchOp, NewSI);
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008448 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008449 return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), NewSI, MatchOp);
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008450 }
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00008451 assert(0 && "Shouldn't get here");
8452 return 0;
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008453}
8454
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00008455/// visitSelectInstWithICmp - Visit a SelectInst that has an
8456/// ICmpInst as its first operand.
8457///
8458Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSelectInstWithICmp(SelectInst &SI,
8459 ICmpInst *ICI) {
8460 bool Changed = false;
8461 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred = ICI->getPredicate();
8462 Value *CmpLHS = ICI->getOperand(0);
8463 Value *CmpRHS = ICI->getOperand(1);
8464 Value *TrueVal = SI.getTrueValue();
8465 Value *FalseVal = SI.getFalseValue();
8466
8467 // Check cases where the comparison is with a constant that
8468 // can be adjusted to fit the min/max idiom. We may edit ICI in
8469 // place here, so make sure the select is the only user.
8470 if (ICI->hasOneUse())
8471 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(CmpRHS))
8472 switch (Pred) {
8473 default: break;
8474 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
8475 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: {
8476 // X < MIN ? T : F --> F
8477 if (CI->isMinValue(Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT))
8478 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
8479 // X < C ? X : C-1 --> X > C-1 ? C-1 : X
8480 Constant *AdjustedRHS = SubOne(CI);
8481 if ((CmpLHS == TrueVal && AdjustedRHS == FalseVal) ||
8482 (CmpLHS == FalseVal && AdjustedRHS == TrueVal)) {
8483 Pred = ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Pred);
8484 CmpRHS = AdjustedRHS;
8485 std::swap(FalseVal, TrueVal);
8486 ICI->setPredicate(Pred);
8487 ICI->setOperand(1, CmpRHS);
8488 SI.setOperand(1, TrueVal);
8489 SI.setOperand(2, FalseVal);
8490 Changed = true;
8491 }
8492 break;
8493 }
8494 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
8495 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: {
8496 // X > MAX ? T : F --> F
8497 if (CI->isMaxValue(Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT))
8498 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
8499 // X > C ? X : C+1 --> X < C+1 ? C+1 : X
8500 Constant *AdjustedRHS = AddOne(CI);
8501 if ((CmpLHS == TrueVal && AdjustedRHS == FalseVal) ||
8502 (CmpLHS == FalseVal && AdjustedRHS == TrueVal)) {
8503 Pred = ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Pred);
8504 CmpRHS = AdjustedRHS;
8505 std::swap(FalseVal, TrueVal);
8506 ICI->setPredicate(Pred);
8507 ICI->setOperand(1, CmpRHS);
8508 SI.setOperand(1, TrueVal);
8509 SI.setOperand(2, FalseVal);
8510 Changed = true;
8511 }
8512 break;
8513 }
8514 }
8515
8516 if (CmpLHS == TrueVal && CmpRHS == FalseVal) {
8517 // Transform (X == Y) ? X : Y -> Y
8518 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
8519 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
8520 // Transform (X != Y) ? X : Y -> X
8521 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
8522 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
8523 /// NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect integer MIN/MAX
8524
8525 } else if (CmpLHS == FalseVal && CmpRHS == TrueVal) {
8526 // Transform (X == Y) ? Y : X -> X
8527 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
8528 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
8529 // Transform (X != Y) ? Y : X -> Y
8530 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
8531 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
8532 /// NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect integer MIN/MAX
8533 }
8534
8535 /// NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect integer ABS
8536
8537 return Changed ? &SI : 0;
8538}
8539
Chris Lattner3d69f462004-03-12 05:52:32 +00008540Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSelectInst(SelectInst &SI) {
Chris Lattnerc32b30a2004-03-30 19:37:13 +00008541 Value *CondVal = SI.getCondition();
8542 Value *TrueVal = SI.getTrueValue();
8543 Value *FalseVal = SI.getFalseValue();
8544
8545 // select true, X, Y -> X
8546 // select false, X, Y -> Y
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00008547 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(CondVal))
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00008548 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, C->getZExtValue() ? TrueVal : FalseVal);
Chris Lattnerc32b30a2004-03-30 19:37:13 +00008549
8550 // select C, X, X -> X
8551 if (TrueVal == FalseVal)
8552 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
8553
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00008554 if (isa<UndefValue>(TrueVal)) // select C, undef, X -> X
8555 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
8556 if (isa<UndefValue>(FalseVal)) // select C, X, undef -> X
8557 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
8558 if (isa<UndefValue>(CondVal)) { // select undef, X, Y -> X or Y
8559 if (isa<Constant>(TrueVal))
8560 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
8561 else
8562 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
8563 }
8564
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00008565 if (SI.getType() == Type::Int1Ty) {
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +00008566 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(TrueVal)) {
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00008567 if (C->getZExtValue()) {
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008568 // Change: A = select B, true, C --> A = or B, C
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008569 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(CondVal, FalseVal);
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008570 } else {
8571 // Change: A = select B, false, C --> A = and !B, C
8572 Value *NotCond =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008573 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(CondVal,
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008574 "not."+CondVal->getName()), SI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008575 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NotCond, FalseVal);
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008576 }
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +00008577 } else if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(FalseVal)) {
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00008578 if (C->getZExtValue() == false) {
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008579 // Change: A = select B, C, false --> A = and B, C
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008580 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(CondVal, TrueVal);
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008581 } else {
8582 // Change: A = select B, C, true --> A = or !B, C
8583 Value *NotCond =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008584 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(CondVal,
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008585 "not."+CondVal->getName()), SI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008586 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(NotCond, TrueVal);
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008587 }
8588 }
Chris Lattnercfa59752007-11-25 21:27:53 +00008589
8590 // select a, b, a -> a&b
8591 // select a, a, b -> a|b
8592 if (CondVal == TrueVal)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008593 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(CondVal, FalseVal);
Chris Lattnercfa59752007-11-25 21:27:53 +00008594 else if (CondVal == FalseVal)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008595 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(CondVal, TrueVal);
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00008596 }
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008597
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00008598 // Selecting between two integer constants?
8599 if (ConstantInt *TrueValC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(TrueVal))
8600 if (ConstantInt *FalseValC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(FalseVal)) {
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00008601 // select C, 1, 0 -> zext C to int
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00008602 if (FalseValC->isZero() && TrueValC->getValue() == 1) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008603 return CastInst::Create(Instruction::ZExt, CondVal, SI.getType());
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00008604 } else if (TrueValC->isZero() && FalseValC->getValue() == 1) {
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00008605 // select C, 0, 1 -> zext !C to int
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00008606 Value *NotCond =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008607 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(CondVal,
Chris Lattner82e14fe2004-04-09 18:19:44 +00008608 "not."+CondVal->getName()), SI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008609 return CastInst::Create(Instruction::ZExt, NotCond, SI.getType());
Chris Lattner82e14fe2004-04-09 18:19:44 +00008610 }
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00008611
8612 // FIXME: Turn select 0/-1 and -1/0 into sext from condition!
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00008613
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008614 if (ICmpInst *IC = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(SI.getCondition())) {
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008615
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008616 // (x <s 0) ? -1 : 0 -> ashr x, 31
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00008617 if (TrueValC->isAllOnesValue() && FalseValC->isZero())
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008618 if (ConstantInt *CmpCst = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(IC->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00008619 if (IC->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && CmpCst->isZero()) {
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008620 // The comparison constant and the result are not neccessarily the
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008621 // same width. Make an all-ones value by inserting a AShr.
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008622 Value *X = IC->getOperand(0);
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00008623 uint32_t Bits = X->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00008624 Constant *ShAmt = ConstantInt::get(X->getType(), Bits-1);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008625 Instruction *SRA = BinaryOperator::Create(Instruction::AShr, X,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00008626 ShAmt, "ones");
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008627 InsertNewInstBefore(SRA, SI);
8628
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008629 // Finally, convert to the type of the select RHS. We figure out
8630 // if this requires a SExt, Trunc or BitCast based on the sizes.
8631 Instruction::CastOps opc = Instruction::BitCast;
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00008632 uint32_t SRASize = SRA->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
8633 uint32_t SISize = SI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008634 if (SRASize < SISize)
8635 opc = Instruction::SExt;
8636 else if (SRASize > SISize)
8637 opc = Instruction::Trunc;
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008638 return CastInst::Create(opc, SRA, SI.getType());
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008639 }
8640 }
8641
8642
8643 // If one of the constants is zero (we know they can't both be) and we
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00008644 // have an icmp instruction with zero, and we have an 'and' with the
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008645 // non-constant value, eliminate this whole mess. This corresponds to
8646 // cases like this: ((X & 27) ? 27 : 0)
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00008647 if (TrueValC->isZero() || FalseValC->isZero())
Chris Lattner65b72ba2006-09-18 04:22:48 +00008648 if (IC->isEquality() && isa<ConstantInt>(IC->getOperand(1)) &&
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00008649 cast<Constant>(IC->getOperand(1))->isNullValue())
8650 if (Instruction *ICA = dyn_cast<Instruction>(IC->getOperand(0)))
8651 if (ICA->getOpcode() == Instruction::And &&
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008652 isa<ConstantInt>(ICA->getOperand(1)) &&
8653 (ICA->getOperand(1) == TrueValC ||
8654 ICA->getOperand(1) == FalseValC) &&
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00008655 isOneBitSet(cast<ConstantInt>(ICA->getOperand(1)))) {
8656 // Okay, now we know that everything is set up, we just don't
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008657 // know whether we have a icmp_ne or icmp_eq and whether the
8658 // true or false val is the zero.
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00008659 bool ShouldNotVal = !TrueValC->isZero();
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008660 ShouldNotVal ^= IC->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00008661 Value *V = ICA;
8662 if (ShouldNotVal)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008663 V = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::Create(
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00008664 Instruction::Xor, V, ICA->getOperand(1)), SI);
8665 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, V);
8666 }
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008667 }
Chris Lattnerc32b30a2004-03-30 19:37:13 +00008668 }
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008669
8670 // See if we are selecting two values based on a comparison of the two values.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008671 if (FCmpInst *FCI = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(CondVal)) {
8672 if (FCI->getOperand(0) == TrueVal && FCI->getOperand(1) == FalseVal) {
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008673 // Transform (X == Y) ? X : Y -> Y
Dale Johannesen5a2174f2007-10-03 17:45:27 +00008674 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ) {
8675 // This is not safe in general for floating point:
8676 // consider X== -0, Y== +0.
8677 // It becomes safe if either operand is a nonzero constant.
8678 ConstantFP *CFPt, *CFPf;
8679 if (((CFPt = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(TrueVal)) &&
8680 !CFPt->getValueAPF().isZero()) ||
8681 ((CFPf = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(FalseVal)) &&
8682 !CFPf->getValueAPF().isZero()))
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008683 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
Dale Johannesen5a2174f2007-10-03 17:45:27 +00008684 }
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008685 // Transform (X != Y) ? X : Y -> X
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008686 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE)
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008687 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00008688 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect MIN/MAX
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008689
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008690 } else if (FCI->getOperand(0) == FalseVal && FCI->getOperand(1) == TrueVal){
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008691 // Transform (X == Y) ? Y : X -> X
Dale Johannesen5a2174f2007-10-03 17:45:27 +00008692 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ) {
8693 // This is not safe in general for floating point:
8694 // consider X== -0, Y== +0.
8695 // It becomes safe if either operand is a nonzero constant.
8696 ConstantFP *CFPt, *CFPf;
8697 if (((CFPt = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(TrueVal)) &&
8698 !CFPt->getValueAPF().isZero()) ||
8699 ((CFPf = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(FalseVal)) &&
8700 !CFPf->getValueAPF().isZero()))
8701 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
8702 }
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008703 // Transform (X != Y) ? Y : X -> Y
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008704 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE)
8705 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00008706 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect MIN/MAX
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008707 }
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00008708 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect ABS
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008709 }
8710
8711 // See if we are selecting two values based on a comparison of the two values.
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00008712 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(CondVal))
8713 if (Instruction *Result = visitSelectInstWithICmp(SI, ICI))
8714 return Result;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008715
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00008716 if (Instruction *TI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(TrueVal))
8717 if (Instruction *FI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(FalseVal))
8718 if (TI->hasOneUse() && FI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00008719 Instruction *AddOp = 0, *SubOp = 0;
8720
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008721 // Turn (select C, (op X, Y), (op X, Z)) -> (op X, (select C, Y, Z))
8722 if (TI->getOpcode() == FI->getOpcode())
8723 if (Instruction *IV = FoldSelectOpOp(SI, TI, FI))
8724 return IV;
8725
8726 // Turn select C, (X+Y), (X-Y) --> (X+(select C, Y, (-Y))). This is
8727 // even legal for FP.
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00008728 if (TI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub &&
8729 FI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
8730 AddOp = FI; SubOp = TI;
8731 } else if (FI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub &&
8732 TI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
8733 AddOp = TI; SubOp = FI;
8734 }
8735
8736 if (AddOp) {
8737 Value *OtherAddOp = 0;
8738 if (SubOp->getOperand(0) == AddOp->getOperand(0)) {
8739 OtherAddOp = AddOp->getOperand(1);
8740 } else if (SubOp->getOperand(0) == AddOp->getOperand(1)) {
8741 OtherAddOp = AddOp->getOperand(0);
8742 }
8743
8744 if (OtherAddOp) {
Chris Lattner97f37a42006-02-24 18:05:58 +00008745 // So at this point we know we have (Y -> OtherAddOp):
8746 // select C, (add X, Y), (sub X, Z)
8747 Value *NegVal; // Compute -Z
8748 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SubOp->getOperand(1))) {
8749 NegVal = ConstantExpr::getNeg(C);
8750 } else {
8751 NegVal = InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008752 BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(SubOp->getOperand(1), "tmp"), SI);
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00008753 }
Chris Lattner97f37a42006-02-24 18:05:58 +00008754
8755 Value *NewTrueOp = OtherAddOp;
8756 Value *NewFalseOp = NegVal;
8757 if (AddOp != TI)
8758 std::swap(NewTrueOp, NewFalseOp);
8759 Instruction *NewSel =
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +00008760 SelectInst::Create(CondVal, NewTrueOp,
8761 NewFalseOp, SI.getName() + ".p");
Chris Lattner97f37a42006-02-24 18:05:58 +00008762
8763 NewSel = InsertNewInstBefore(NewSel, SI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008764 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(SubOp->getOperand(0), NewSel);
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00008765 }
8766 }
8767 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008768
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008769 // See if we can fold the select into one of our operands.
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00008770 if (SI.getType()->isInteger()) {
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008771 // See the comment above GetSelectFoldableOperands for a description of the
8772 // transformation we are doing here.
8773 if (Instruction *TVI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(TrueVal))
8774 if (TVI->hasOneUse() && TVI->getNumOperands() == 2 &&
8775 !isa<Constant>(FalseVal))
8776 if (unsigned SFO = GetSelectFoldableOperands(TVI)) {
8777 unsigned OpToFold = 0;
8778 if ((SFO & 1) && FalseVal == TVI->getOperand(0)) {
8779 OpToFold = 1;
8780 } else if ((SFO & 2) && FalseVal == TVI->getOperand(1)) {
8781 OpToFold = 2;
8782 }
8783
8784 if (OpToFold) {
8785 Constant *C = GetSelectFoldableConstant(TVI);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008786 Instruction *NewSel =
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +00008787 SelectInst::Create(SI.getCondition(),
8788 TVI->getOperand(2-OpToFold), C);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008789 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSel, SI);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00008790 NewSel->takeName(TVI);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008791 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(TVI))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008792 return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), FalseVal, NewSel);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008793 else {
8794 assert(0 && "Unknown instruction!!");
8795 }
8796 }
8797 }
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00008798
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008799 if (Instruction *FVI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(FalseVal))
8800 if (FVI->hasOneUse() && FVI->getNumOperands() == 2 &&
8801 !isa<Constant>(TrueVal))
8802 if (unsigned SFO = GetSelectFoldableOperands(FVI)) {
8803 unsigned OpToFold = 0;
8804 if ((SFO & 1) && TrueVal == FVI->getOperand(0)) {
8805 OpToFold = 1;
8806 } else if ((SFO & 2) && TrueVal == FVI->getOperand(1)) {
8807 OpToFold = 2;
8808 }
8809
8810 if (OpToFold) {
8811 Constant *C = GetSelectFoldableConstant(FVI);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008812 Instruction *NewSel =
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +00008813 SelectInst::Create(SI.getCondition(), C,
8814 FVI->getOperand(2-OpToFold));
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008815 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSel, SI);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00008816 NewSel->takeName(FVI);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008817 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(FVI))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008818 return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), TrueVal, NewSel);
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00008819 else
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008820 assert(0 && "Unknown instruction!!");
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008821 }
8822 }
8823 }
Chris Lattnera1df33c2005-04-24 07:30:14 +00008824
8825 if (BinaryOperator::isNot(CondVal)) {
8826 SI.setOperand(0, BinaryOperator::getNotArgument(CondVal));
8827 SI.setOperand(1, FalseVal);
8828 SI.setOperand(2, TrueVal);
8829 return &SI;
8830 }
8831
Chris Lattner3d69f462004-03-12 05:52:32 +00008832 return 0;
8833}
8834
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00008835/// EnforceKnownAlignment - If the specified pointer points to an object that
8836/// we control, modify the object's alignment to PrefAlign. This isn't
8837/// often possible though. If alignment is important, a more reliable approach
8838/// is to simply align all global variables and allocation instructions to
8839/// their preferred alignment from the beginning.
8840///
8841static unsigned EnforceKnownAlignment(Value *V,
8842 unsigned Align, unsigned PrefAlign) {
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00008843
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00008844 User *U = dyn_cast<User>(V);
8845 if (!U) return Align;
8846
8847 switch (getOpcode(U)) {
8848 default: break;
8849 case Instruction::BitCast:
8850 return EnforceKnownAlignment(U->getOperand(0), Align, PrefAlign);
8851 case Instruction::GetElementPtr: {
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00008852 // If all indexes are zero, it is just the alignment of the base pointer.
8853 bool AllZeroOperands = true;
Gabor Greif52ed3632008-06-12 21:51:29 +00008854 for (User::op_iterator i = U->op_begin() + 1, e = U->op_end(); i != e; ++i)
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +00008855 if (!isa<Constant>(*i) ||
8856 !cast<Constant>(*i)->isNullValue()) {
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00008857 AllZeroOperands = false;
8858 break;
8859 }
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00008860
8861 if (AllZeroOperands) {
8862 // Treat this like a bitcast.
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00008863 return EnforceKnownAlignment(U->getOperand(0), Align, PrefAlign);
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00008864 }
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00008865 break;
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00008866 }
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00008867 }
8868
8869 if (GlobalValue *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalValue>(V)) {
8870 // If there is a large requested alignment and we can, bump up the alignment
8871 // of the global.
8872 if (!GV->isDeclaration()) {
8873 GV->setAlignment(PrefAlign);
8874 Align = PrefAlign;
8875 }
8876 } else if (AllocationInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocationInst>(V)) {
8877 // If there is a requested alignment and if this is an alloca, round up. We
8878 // don't do this for malloc, because some systems can't respect the request.
8879 if (isa<AllocaInst>(AI)) {
8880 AI->setAlignment(PrefAlign);
8881 Align = PrefAlign;
8882 }
8883 }
8884
8885 return Align;
8886}
8887
8888/// GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment - If the specified pointer has an alignment that
8889/// we can determine, return it, otherwise return 0. If PrefAlign is specified,
8890/// and it is more than the alignment of the ultimate object, see if we can
8891/// increase the alignment of the ultimate object, making this check succeed.
8892unsigned InstCombiner::GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(Value *V,
8893 unsigned PrefAlign) {
8894 unsigned BitWidth = TD ? TD->getTypeSizeInBits(V->getType()) :
8895 sizeof(PrefAlign) * CHAR_BIT;
8896 APInt Mask = APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth);
8897 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
8898 ComputeMaskedBits(V, Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne);
8899 unsigned TrailZ = KnownZero.countTrailingOnes();
8900 unsigned Align = 1u << std::min(BitWidth - 1, TrailZ);
8901
8902 if (PrefAlign > Align)
8903 Align = EnforceKnownAlignment(V, Align, PrefAlign);
8904
8905 // We don't need to make any adjustment.
8906 return Align;
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00008907}
8908
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00008909Instruction *InstCombiner::SimplifyMemTransfer(MemIntrinsic *MI) {
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00008910 unsigned DstAlign = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(MI->getOperand(1));
8911 unsigned SrcAlign = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(MI->getOperand(2));
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00008912 unsigned MinAlign = std::min(DstAlign, SrcAlign);
8913 unsigned CopyAlign = MI->getAlignment()->getZExtValue();
8914
8915 if (CopyAlign < MinAlign) {
8916 MI->setAlignment(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, MinAlign));
8917 return MI;
8918 }
8919
8920 // If MemCpyInst length is 1/2/4/8 bytes then replace memcpy with
8921 // load/store.
8922 ConstantInt *MemOpLength = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(MI->getOperand(3));
8923 if (MemOpLength == 0) return 0;
8924
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00008925 // Source and destination pointer types are always "i8*" for intrinsic. See
8926 // if the size is something we can handle with a single primitive load/store.
8927 // A single load+store correctly handles overlapping memory in the memmove
8928 // case.
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00008929 unsigned Size = MemOpLength->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +00008930 if (Size == 0) return MI; // Delete this mem transfer.
8931
8932 if (Size > 8 || (Size&(Size-1)))
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00008933 return 0; // If not 1/2/4/8 bytes, exit.
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00008934
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00008935 // Use an integer load+store unless we can find something better.
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00008936 Type *NewPtrTy = PointerType::getUnqual(IntegerType::get(Size<<3));
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00008937
8938 // Memcpy forces the use of i8* for the source and destination. That means
8939 // that if you're using memcpy to move one double around, you'll get a cast
8940 // from double* to i8*. We'd much rather use a double load+store rather than
8941 // an i64 load+store, here because this improves the odds that the source or
8942 // dest address will be promotable. See if we can find a better type than the
8943 // integer datatype.
8944 if (Value *Op = getBitCastOperand(MI->getOperand(1))) {
8945 const Type *SrcETy = cast<PointerType>(Op->getType())->getElementType();
8946 if (SrcETy->isSized() && TD->getTypeStoreSize(SrcETy) == Size) {
8947 // The SrcETy might be something like {{{double}}} or [1 x double]. Rip
8948 // down through these levels if so.
Dan Gohman8f8e2692008-05-23 01:52:21 +00008949 while (!SrcETy->isSingleValueType()) {
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00008950 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(SrcETy)) {
8951 if (STy->getNumElements() == 1)
8952 SrcETy = STy->getElementType(0);
8953 else
8954 break;
8955 } else if (const ArrayType *ATy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(SrcETy)) {
8956 if (ATy->getNumElements() == 1)
8957 SrcETy = ATy->getElementType();
8958 else
8959 break;
8960 } else
8961 break;
8962 }
8963
Dan Gohman8f8e2692008-05-23 01:52:21 +00008964 if (SrcETy->isSingleValueType())
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00008965 NewPtrTy = PointerType::getUnqual(SrcETy);
8966 }
8967 }
8968
8969
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00008970 // If the memcpy/memmove provides better alignment info than we can
8971 // infer, use it.
8972 SrcAlign = std::max(SrcAlign, CopyAlign);
8973 DstAlign = std::max(DstAlign, CopyAlign);
8974
8975 Value *Src = InsertBitCastBefore(MI->getOperand(2), NewPtrTy, *MI);
8976 Value *Dest = InsertBitCastBefore(MI->getOperand(1), NewPtrTy, *MI);
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00008977 Instruction *L = new LoadInst(Src, "tmp", false, SrcAlign);
8978 InsertNewInstBefore(L, *MI);
8979 InsertNewInstBefore(new StoreInst(L, Dest, false, DstAlign), *MI);
8980
8981 // Set the size of the copy to 0, it will be deleted on the next iteration.
8982 MI->setOperand(3, Constant::getNullValue(MemOpLength->getType()));
8983 return MI;
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00008984}
Chris Lattner3d69f462004-03-12 05:52:32 +00008985
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +00008986Instruction *InstCombiner::SimplifyMemSet(MemSetInst *MI) {
8987 unsigned Alignment = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(MI->getDest());
8988 if (MI->getAlignment()->getZExtValue() < Alignment) {
8989 MI->setAlignment(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Alignment));
8990 return MI;
8991 }
8992
8993 // Extract the length and alignment and fill if they are constant.
8994 ConstantInt *LenC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(MI->getLength());
8995 ConstantInt *FillC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(MI->getValue());
8996 if (!LenC || !FillC || FillC->getType() != Type::Int8Ty)
8997 return 0;
8998 uint64_t Len = LenC->getZExtValue();
8999 Alignment = MI->getAlignment()->getZExtValue();
9000
9001 // If the length is zero, this is a no-op
9002 if (Len == 0) return MI; // memset(d,c,0,a) -> noop
9003
9004 // memset(s,c,n) -> store s, c (for n=1,2,4,8)
9005 if (Len <= 8 && isPowerOf2_32((uint32_t)Len)) {
9006 const Type *ITy = IntegerType::get(Len*8); // n=1 -> i8.
9007
9008 Value *Dest = MI->getDest();
9009 Dest = InsertBitCastBefore(Dest, PointerType::getUnqual(ITy), *MI);
9010
9011 // Alignment 0 is identity for alignment 1 for memset, but not store.
9012 if (Alignment == 0) Alignment = 1;
9013
9014 // Extract the fill value and store.
9015 uint64_t Fill = FillC->getZExtValue()*0x0101010101010101ULL;
9016 InsertNewInstBefore(new StoreInst(ConstantInt::get(ITy, Fill), Dest, false,
9017 Alignment), *MI);
9018
9019 // Set the size of the copy to 0, it will be deleted on the next iteration.
9020 MI->setLength(Constant::getNullValue(LenC->getType()));
9021 return MI;
9022 }
9023
9024 return 0;
9025}
9026
9027
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00009028/// visitCallInst - CallInst simplification. This mostly only handles folding
9029/// of intrinsic instructions. For normal calls, it allows visitCallSite to do
9030/// the heavy lifting.
9031///
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009032Instruction *InstCombiner::visitCallInst(CallInst &CI) {
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00009033 IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(&CI);
9034 if (!II) return visitCallSite(&CI);
9035
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +00009036 // Intrinsics cannot occur in an invoke, so handle them here instead of in
9037 // visitCallSite.
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00009038 if (MemIntrinsic *MI = dyn_cast<MemIntrinsic>(II)) {
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00009039 bool Changed = false;
9040
9041 // memmove/cpy/set of zero bytes is a noop.
9042 if (Constant *NumBytes = dyn_cast<Constant>(MI->getLength())) {
9043 if (NumBytes->isNullValue()) return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
9044
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00009045 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(NumBytes))
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00009046 if (CI->getZExtValue() == 1) {
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00009047 // Replace the instruction with just byte operations. We would
9048 // transform other cases to loads/stores, but we don't know if
9049 // alignment is sufficient.
9050 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +00009051 }
9052
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00009053 // If we have a memmove and the source operation is a constant global,
9054 // then the source and dest pointers can't alias, so we can change this
9055 // into a call to memcpy.
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009056 if (MemMoveInst *MMI = dyn_cast<MemMoveInst>(MI)) {
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00009057 if (GlobalVariable *GVSrc = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(MMI->getSource()))
9058 if (GVSrc->isConstant()) {
9059 Module *M = CI.getParent()->getParent()->getParent();
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +00009060 Intrinsic::ID MemCpyID;
9061 if (CI.getOperand(3)->getType() == Type::Int32Ty)
9062 MemCpyID = Intrinsic::memcpy_i32;
Chris Lattner21959392006-03-03 01:34:17 +00009063 else
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +00009064 MemCpyID = Intrinsic::memcpy_i64;
9065 CI.setOperand(0, Intrinsic::getDeclaration(M, MemCpyID));
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00009066 Changed = true;
9067 }
Chris Lattnera935db82008-05-28 05:30:41 +00009068
9069 // memmove(x,x,size) -> noop.
9070 if (MMI->getSource() == MMI->getDest())
9071 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00009072 }
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00009073
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00009074 // If we can determine a pointer alignment that is bigger than currently
9075 // set, update the alignment.
9076 if (isa<MemCpyInst>(MI) || isa<MemMoveInst>(MI)) {
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009077 if (Instruction *I = SimplifyMemTransfer(MI))
9078 return I;
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +00009079 } else if (MemSetInst *MSI = dyn_cast<MemSetInst>(MI)) {
9080 if (Instruction *I = SimplifyMemSet(MSI))
9081 return I;
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00009082 }
9083
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00009084 if (Changed) return II;
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009085 }
9086
9087 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
9088 default: break;
9089 case Intrinsic::bswap:
9090 // bswap(bswap(x)) -> x
9091 if (IntrinsicInst *Operand = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(II->getOperand(1)))
9092 if (Operand->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::bswap)
9093 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Operand->getOperand(1));
9094 break;
9095 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_lvx:
9096 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_lvxl:
9097 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_loadu_ps:
9098 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_loadu_pd:
9099 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_loadu_dq:
9100 // Turn PPC lvx -> load if the pointer is known aligned.
9101 // Turn X86 loadups -> load if the pointer is known aligned.
9102 if (GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(II->getOperand(1), 16) >= 16) {
9103 Value *Ptr = InsertBitCastBefore(II->getOperand(1),
9104 PointerType::getUnqual(II->getType()),
9105 CI);
9106 return new LoadInst(Ptr);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00009107 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009108 break;
9109 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_stvx:
9110 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_stvxl:
9111 // Turn stvx -> store if the pointer is known aligned.
9112 if (GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(II->getOperand(2), 16) >= 16) {
9113 const Type *OpPtrTy =
9114 PointerType::getUnqual(II->getOperand(1)->getType());
9115 Value *Ptr = InsertBitCastBefore(II->getOperand(2), OpPtrTy, CI);
9116 return new StoreInst(II->getOperand(1), Ptr);
9117 }
9118 break;
9119 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_storeu_ps:
9120 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_storeu_pd:
9121 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_storeu_dq:
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009122 // Turn X86 storeu -> store if the pointer is known aligned.
9123 if (GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(II->getOperand(1), 16) >= 16) {
9124 const Type *OpPtrTy =
9125 PointerType::getUnqual(II->getOperand(2)->getType());
9126 Value *Ptr = InsertBitCastBefore(II->getOperand(1), OpPtrTy, CI);
9127 return new StoreInst(II->getOperand(2), Ptr);
9128 }
9129 break;
9130
9131 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_cvttss2si: {
9132 // These intrinsics only demands the 0th element of its input vector. If
9133 // we can simplify the input based on that, do so now.
9134 uint64_t UndefElts;
9135 if (Value *V = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(II->getOperand(1), 1,
9136 UndefElts)) {
9137 II->setOperand(1, V);
9138 return II;
9139 }
9140 break;
9141 }
9142
9143 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_vperm:
9144 // Turn vperm(V1,V2,mask) -> shuffle(V1,V2,mask) if mask is a constant.
9145 if (ConstantVector *Mask = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(II->getOperand(3))) {
9146 assert(Mask->getNumOperands() == 16 && "Bad type for intrinsic!");
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00009147
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009148 // Check that all of the elements are integer constants or undefs.
9149 bool AllEltsOk = true;
9150 for (unsigned i = 0; i != 16; ++i) {
9151 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(Mask->getOperand(i)) &&
9152 !isa<UndefValue>(Mask->getOperand(i))) {
9153 AllEltsOk = false;
9154 break;
9155 }
9156 }
9157
9158 if (AllEltsOk) {
9159 // Cast the input vectors to byte vectors.
9160 Value *Op0 =InsertBitCastBefore(II->getOperand(1),Mask->getType(),CI);
9161 Value *Op1 =InsertBitCastBefore(II->getOperand(2),Mask->getType(),CI);
9162 Value *Result = UndefValue::get(Op0->getType());
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00009163
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009164 // Only extract each element once.
9165 Value *ExtractedElts[32];
9166 memset(ExtractedElts, 0, sizeof(ExtractedElts));
9167
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00009168 for (unsigned i = 0; i != 16; ++i) {
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009169 if (isa<UndefValue>(Mask->getOperand(i)))
9170 continue;
9171 unsigned Idx=cast<ConstantInt>(Mask->getOperand(i))->getZExtValue();
9172 Idx &= 31; // Match the hardware behavior.
9173
9174 if (ExtractedElts[Idx] == 0) {
9175 Instruction *Elt =
9176 new ExtractElementInst(Idx < 16 ? Op0 : Op1, Idx&15, "tmp");
9177 InsertNewInstBefore(Elt, CI);
9178 ExtractedElts[Idx] = Elt;
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00009179 }
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00009180
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009181 // Insert this value into the result vector.
9182 Result = InsertElementInst::Create(Result, ExtractedElts[Idx],
9183 i, "tmp");
9184 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(Result), CI);
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00009185 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009186 return CastInst::Create(Instruction::BitCast, Result, CI.getType());
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00009187 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009188 }
9189 break;
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00009190
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009191 case Intrinsic::stackrestore: {
9192 // If the save is right next to the restore, remove the restore. This can
9193 // happen when variable allocas are DCE'd.
9194 if (IntrinsicInst *SS = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(II->getOperand(1))) {
9195 if (SS->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::stacksave) {
9196 BasicBlock::iterator BI = SS;
9197 if (&*++BI == II)
9198 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
Chris Lattnera728ddc2006-01-13 21:28:09 +00009199 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009200 }
9201
9202 // Scan down this block to see if there is another stack restore in the
9203 // same block without an intervening call/alloca.
9204 BasicBlock::iterator BI = II;
9205 TerminatorInst *TI = II->getParent()->getTerminator();
9206 bool CannotRemove = false;
9207 for (++BI; &*BI != TI; ++BI) {
9208 if (isa<AllocaInst>(BI)) {
9209 CannotRemove = true;
9210 break;
9211 }
Chris Lattneraa0bf522008-06-25 05:59:28 +00009212 if (CallInst *BCI = dyn_cast<CallInst>(BI)) {
9213 if (IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(BCI)) {
9214 // If there is a stackrestore below this one, remove this one.
9215 if (II->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::stackrestore)
9216 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
9217 // Otherwise, ignore the intrinsic.
9218 } else {
9219 // If we found a non-intrinsic call, we can't remove the stack
9220 // restore.
Chris Lattnerbf1d8a72008-02-18 06:12:38 +00009221 CannotRemove = true;
9222 break;
9223 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009224 }
Chris Lattnera728ddc2006-01-13 21:28:09 +00009225 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009226
9227 // If the stack restore is in a return/unwind block and if there are no
9228 // allocas or calls between the restore and the return, nuke the restore.
9229 if (!CannotRemove && (isa<ReturnInst>(TI) || isa<UnwindInst>(TI)))
9230 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
9231 break;
9232 }
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00009233 }
9234
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00009235 return visitCallSite(II);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009236}
9237
9238// InvokeInst simplification
9239//
9240Instruction *InstCombiner::visitInvokeInst(InvokeInst &II) {
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +00009241 return visitCallSite(&II);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009242}
9243
Dale Johannesenda30ccb2008-04-25 21:16:07 +00009244/// isSafeToEliminateVarargsCast - If this cast does not affect the value
9245/// passed through the varargs area, we can eliminate the use of the cast.
Dale Johannesen1f530a52008-04-23 18:34:37 +00009246static bool isSafeToEliminateVarargsCast(const CallSite CS,
9247 const CastInst * const CI,
9248 const TargetData * const TD,
9249 const int ix) {
9250 if (!CI->isLosslessCast())
9251 return false;
9252
9253 // The size of ByVal arguments is derived from the type, so we
9254 // can't change to a type with a different size. If the size were
9255 // passed explicitly we could avoid this check.
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009256 if (!CS.paramHasAttr(ix, Attribute::ByVal))
Dale Johannesen1f530a52008-04-23 18:34:37 +00009257 return true;
9258
9259 const Type* SrcTy =
9260 cast<PointerType>(CI->getOperand(0)->getType())->getElementType();
9261 const Type* DstTy = cast<PointerType>(CI->getType())->getElementType();
9262 if (!SrcTy->isSized() || !DstTy->isSized())
9263 return false;
9264 if (TD->getABITypeSize(SrcTy) != TD->getABITypeSize(DstTy))
9265 return false;
9266 return true;
9267}
9268
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +00009269// visitCallSite - Improvements for call and invoke instructions.
9270//
9271Instruction *InstCombiner::visitCallSite(CallSite CS) {
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00009272 bool Changed = false;
9273
9274 // If the callee is a constexpr cast of a function, attempt to move the cast
9275 // to the arguments of the call/invoke.
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +00009276 if (transformConstExprCastCall(CS)) return 0;
9277
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00009278 Value *Callee = CS.getCalledValue();
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00009279
Chris Lattner08b22ec2005-05-13 07:09:09 +00009280 if (Function *CalleeF = dyn_cast<Function>(Callee))
9281 if (CalleeF->getCallingConv() != CS.getCallingConv()) {
9282 Instruction *OldCall = CS.getInstruction();
9283 // If the call and callee calling conventions don't match, this call must
9284 // be unreachable, as the call is undefined.
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00009285 new StoreInst(ConstantInt::getTrue(),
Christopher Lamb43ad6b32007-12-17 01:12:55 +00009286 UndefValue::get(PointerType::getUnqual(Type::Int1Ty)),
9287 OldCall);
Chris Lattner08b22ec2005-05-13 07:09:09 +00009288 if (!OldCall->use_empty())
9289 OldCall->replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(OldCall->getType()));
9290 if (isa<CallInst>(OldCall)) // Not worth removing an invoke here.
9291 return EraseInstFromFunction(*OldCall);
9292 return 0;
9293 }
9294
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +00009295 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Callee) || isa<UndefValue>(Callee)) {
9296 // This instruction is not reachable, just remove it. We insert a store to
9297 // undef so that we know that this code is not reachable, despite the fact
9298 // that we can't modify the CFG here.
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00009299 new StoreInst(ConstantInt::getTrue(),
Christopher Lamb43ad6b32007-12-17 01:12:55 +00009300 UndefValue::get(PointerType::getUnqual(Type::Int1Ty)),
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +00009301 CS.getInstruction());
9302
9303 if (!CS.getInstruction()->use_empty())
9304 CS.getInstruction()->
9305 replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(CS.getInstruction()->getType()));
9306
9307 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(CS.getInstruction())) {
9308 // Don't break the CFG, insert a dummy cond branch.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009309 BranchInst::Create(II->getNormalDest(), II->getUnwindDest(),
9310 ConstantInt::getTrue(), II);
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00009311 }
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +00009312 return EraseInstFromFunction(*CS.getInstruction());
9313 }
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00009314
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009315 if (BitCastInst *BC = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Callee))
9316 if (IntrinsicInst *In = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(BC->getOperand(0)))
9317 if (In->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::init_trampoline)
9318 return transformCallThroughTrampoline(CS);
9319
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00009320 const PointerType *PTy = cast<PointerType>(Callee->getType());
9321 const FunctionType *FTy = cast<FunctionType>(PTy->getElementType());
9322 if (FTy->isVarArg()) {
Dale Johannesen63e7eb42008-04-23 01:03:05 +00009323 int ix = FTy->getNumParams() + (isa<InvokeInst>(Callee) ? 3 : 1);
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00009324 // See if we can optimize any arguments passed through the varargs area of
9325 // the call.
9326 for (CallSite::arg_iterator I = CS.arg_begin()+FTy->getNumParams(),
Dale Johannesen1f530a52008-04-23 18:34:37 +00009327 E = CS.arg_end(); I != E; ++I, ++ix) {
9328 CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(*I);
9329 if (CI && isSafeToEliminateVarargsCast(CS, CI, TD, ix)) {
9330 *I = CI->getOperand(0);
9331 Changed = true;
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00009332 }
Dale Johannesen1f530a52008-04-23 18:34:37 +00009333 }
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00009334 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009335
Duncan Sandsf0c33542007-12-19 21:13:37 +00009336 if (isa<InlineAsm>(Callee) && !CS.doesNotThrow()) {
Duncan Sandsece2c042007-12-16 15:51:49 +00009337 // Inline asm calls cannot throw - mark them 'nounwind'.
Duncan Sandsf0c33542007-12-19 21:13:37 +00009338 CS.setDoesNotThrow();
Duncan Sandsece2c042007-12-16 15:51:49 +00009339 Changed = true;
9340 }
9341
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00009342 return Changed ? CS.getInstruction() : 0;
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +00009343}
9344
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009345// transformConstExprCastCall - If the callee is a constexpr cast of a function,
9346// attempt to move the cast to the arguments of the call/invoke.
9347//
9348bool InstCombiner::transformConstExprCastCall(CallSite CS) {
9349 if (!isa<ConstantExpr>(CS.getCalledValue())) return false;
9350 ConstantExpr *CE = cast<ConstantExpr>(CS.getCalledValue());
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00009351 if (CE->getOpcode() != Instruction::BitCast ||
9352 !isa<Function>(CE->getOperand(0)))
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009353 return false;
Reid Spencer8863f182004-07-18 00:38:32 +00009354 Function *Callee = cast<Function>(CE->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009355 Instruction *Caller = CS.getInstruction();
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009356 const AttrListPtr &CallerPAL = CS.getAttributes();
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009357
9358 // Okay, this is a cast from a function to a different type. Unless doing so
9359 // would cause a type conversion of one of our arguments, change this call to
9360 // be a direct call with arguments casted to the appropriate types.
9361 //
9362 const FunctionType *FT = Callee->getFunctionType();
9363 const Type *OldRetTy = Caller->getType();
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00009364 const Type *NewRetTy = FT->getReturnType();
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009365
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00009366 if (isa<StructType>(NewRetTy))
Devang Patel75e6f022008-03-11 18:04:06 +00009367 return false; // TODO: Handle multiple return values.
9368
Chris Lattnerf78616b2004-01-14 06:06:08 +00009369 // Check to see if we are changing the return type...
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00009370 if (OldRetTy != NewRetTy) {
Bill Wendlinga6c31122008-05-14 22:45:20 +00009371 if (Callee->isDeclaration() &&
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00009372 // Conversion is ok if changing from one pointer type to another or from
9373 // a pointer to an integer of the same size.
9374 !((isa<PointerType>(OldRetTy) || OldRetTy == TD->getIntPtrType()) &&
Duncan Sands34b176a2008-06-17 15:55:30 +00009375 (isa<PointerType>(NewRetTy) || NewRetTy == TD->getIntPtrType())))
Chris Lattnerec479922007-01-06 02:09:32 +00009376 return false; // Cannot transform this return value.
Chris Lattnerf78616b2004-01-14 06:06:08 +00009377
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +00009378 if (!Caller->use_empty() &&
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +00009379 // void -> non-void is handled specially
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00009380 NewRetTy != Type::VoidTy && !CastInst::isCastable(NewRetTy, OldRetTy))
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +00009381 return false; // Cannot transform this return value.
9382
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009383 if (!CallerPAL.isEmpty() && !Caller->use_empty()) {
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +00009384 Attributes RAttrs = CallerPAL.getRetAttributes();
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009385 if (RAttrs & Attribute::typeIncompatible(NewRetTy))
Duncan Sands6c3470e2008-01-07 17:16:06 +00009386 return false; // Attribute not compatible with transformed value.
9387 }
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009388
Chris Lattnerf78616b2004-01-14 06:06:08 +00009389 // If the callsite is an invoke instruction, and the return value is used by
9390 // a PHI node in a successor, we cannot change the return type of the call
9391 // because there is no place to put the cast instruction (without breaking
9392 // the critical edge). Bail out in this case.
9393 if (!Caller->use_empty())
9394 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller))
9395 for (Value::use_iterator UI = II->use_begin(), E = II->use_end();
9396 UI != E; ++UI)
9397 if (PHINode *PN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(*UI))
9398 if (PN->getParent() == II->getNormalDest() ||
Chris Lattneraeb2a1d2004-02-08 21:44:31 +00009399 PN->getParent() == II->getUnwindDest())
Chris Lattnerf78616b2004-01-14 06:06:08 +00009400 return false;
9401 }
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009402
9403 unsigned NumActualArgs = unsigned(CS.arg_end()-CS.arg_begin());
9404 unsigned NumCommonArgs = std::min(FT->getNumParams(), NumActualArgs);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009405
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009406 CallSite::arg_iterator AI = CS.arg_begin();
9407 for (unsigned i = 0, e = NumCommonArgs; i != e; ++i, ++AI) {
9408 const Type *ParamTy = FT->getParamType(i);
Andrew Lenharthb8e604c2006-06-28 01:01:52 +00009409 const Type *ActTy = (*AI)->getType();
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +00009410
9411 if (!CastInst::isCastable(ActTy, ParamTy))
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009412 return false; // Cannot transform this parameter value.
9413
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +00009414 if (CallerPAL.getParamAttributes(i + 1)
9415 & Attribute::typeIncompatible(ParamTy))
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009416 return false; // Attribute not compatible with transformed value.
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +00009417
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00009418 // Converting from one pointer type to another or between a pointer and an
9419 // integer of the same size is safe even if we do not have a body.
Chris Lattnerec479922007-01-06 02:09:32 +00009420 bool isConvertible = ActTy == ParamTy ||
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00009421 ((isa<PointerType>(ParamTy) || ParamTy == TD->getIntPtrType()) &&
9422 (isa<PointerType>(ActTy) || ActTy == TD->getIntPtrType()));
Reid Spencer5cbf9852007-01-30 20:08:39 +00009423 if (Callee->isDeclaration() && !isConvertible) return false;
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009424 }
9425
9426 if (FT->getNumParams() < NumActualArgs && !FT->isVarArg() &&
Reid Spencer5cbf9852007-01-30 20:08:39 +00009427 Callee->isDeclaration())
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009428 return false; // Do not delete arguments unless we have a function body.
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009429
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009430 if (FT->getNumParams() < NumActualArgs && FT->isVarArg() &&
9431 !CallerPAL.isEmpty())
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009432 // In this case we have more arguments than the new function type, but we
Duncan Sandse1e520f2008-01-13 08:02:44 +00009433 // won't be dropping them. Check that these extra arguments have attributes
9434 // that are compatible with being a vararg call argument.
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009435 for (unsigned i = CallerPAL.getNumSlots(); i; --i) {
9436 if (CallerPAL.getSlot(i - 1).Index <= FT->getNumParams())
Duncan Sandse1e520f2008-01-13 08:02:44 +00009437 break;
Devang Pateleaf42ab2008-09-23 23:03:40 +00009438 Attributes PAttrs = CallerPAL.getSlot(i - 1).Attrs;
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009439 if (PAttrs & Attribute::VarArgsIncompatible)
Duncan Sandse1e520f2008-01-13 08:02:44 +00009440 return false;
9441 }
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009442
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009443 // Okay, we decided that this is a safe thing to do: go ahead and start
9444 // inserting cast instructions as necessary...
9445 std::vector<Value*> Args;
9446 Args.reserve(NumActualArgs);
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009447 SmallVector<AttributeWithIndex, 8> attrVec;
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009448 attrVec.reserve(NumCommonArgs);
9449
9450 // Get any return attributes.
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +00009451 Attributes RAttrs = CallerPAL.getRetAttributes();
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009452
9453 // If the return value is not being used, the type may not be compatible
9454 // with the existing attributes. Wipe out any problematic attributes.
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009455 RAttrs &= ~Attribute::typeIncompatible(NewRetTy);
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009456
9457 // Add the new return attributes.
9458 if (RAttrs)
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009459 attrVec.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(0, RAttrs));
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009460
9461 AI = CS.arg_begin();
9462 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumCommonArgs; ++i, ++AI) {
9463 const Type *ParamTy = FT->getParamType(i);
9464 if ((*AI)->getType() == ParamTy) {
9465 Args.push_back(*AI);
9466 } else {
Reid Spencer8a903db2006-12-18 08:47:13 +00009467 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CastInst::getCastOpcode(*AI,
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009468 false, ParamTy, false);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009469 CastInst *NewCast = CastInst::Create(opcode, *AI, ParamTy, "tmp");
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00009470 Args.push_back(InsertNewInstBefore(NewCast, *Caller));
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009471 }
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009472
9473 // Add any parameter attributes.
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +00009474 if (Attributes PAttrs = CallerPAL.getParamAttributes(i + 1))
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009475 attrVec.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(i + 1, PAttrs));
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009476 }
9477
9478 // If the function takes more arguments than the call was taking, add them
9479 // now...
9480 for (unsigned i = NumCommonArgs; i != FT->getNumParams(); ++i)
9481 Args.push_back(Constant::getNullValue(FT->getParamType(i)));
9482
9483 // If we are removing arguments to the function, emit an obnoxious warning...
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00009484 if (FT->getNumParams() < NumActualArgs) {
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009485 if (!FT->isVarArg()) {
Bill Wendlinge8156192006-12-07 01:30:32 +00009486 cerr << "WARNING: While resolving call to function '"
9487 << Callee->getName() << "' arguments were dropped!\n";
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009488 } else {
9489 // Add all of the arguments in their promoted form to the arg list...
9490 for (unsigned i = FT->getNumParams(); i != NumActualArgs; ++i, ++AI) {
9491 const Type *PTy = getPromotedType((*AI)->getType());
9492 if (PTy != (*AI)->getType()) {
9493 // Must promote to pass through va_arg area!
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009494 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CastInst::getCastOpcode(*AI, false,
9495 PTy, false);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009496 Instruction *Cast = CastInst::Create(opcode, *AI, PTy, "tmp");
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009497 InsertNewInstBefore(Cast, *Caller);
9498 Args.push_back(Cast);
9499 } else {
9500 Args.push_back(*AI);
9501 }
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009502
Duncan Sandse1e520f2008-01-13 08:02:44 +00009503 // Add any parameter attributes.
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +00009504 if (Attributes PAttrs = CallerPAL.getParamAttributes(i + 1))
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009505 attrVec.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(i + 1, PAttrs));
Duncan Sandse1e520f2008-01-13 08:02:44 +00009506 }
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009507 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00009508 }
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009509
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +00009510 if (Attributes FnAttrs = CallerPAL.getFnAttributes())
9511 attrVec.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(~0, FnAttrs));
9512
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00009513 if (NewRetTy == Type::VoidTy)
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00009514 Caller->setName(""); // Void type should not have a name.
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009515
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009516 const AttrListPtr &NewCallerPAL = AttrListPtr::get(attrVec.begin(),attrVec.end());
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009517
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009518 Instruction *NC;
9519 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller)) {
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009520 NC = InvokeInst::Create(Callee, II->getNormalDest(), II->getUnwindDest(),
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +00009521 Args.begin(), Args.end(),
9522 Caller->getName(), Caller);
Reid Spencered3fa852007-07-30 19:53:57 +00009523 cast<InvokeInst>(NC)->setCallingConv(II->getCallingConv());
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009524 cast<InvokeInst>(NC)->setAttributes(NewCallerPAL);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009525 } else {
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009526 NC = CallInst::Create(Callee, Args.begin(), Args.end(),
9527 Caller->getName(), Caller);
Duncan Sandsdc024672007-11-27 13:23:08 +00009528 CallInst *CI = cast<CallInst>(Caller);
9529 if (CI->isTailCall())
Chris Lattnera9e92112005-05-06 06:48:21 +00009530 cast<CallInst>(NC)->setTailCall();
Duncan Sandsdc024672007-11-27 13:23:08 +00009531 cast<CallInst>(NC)->setCallingConv(CI->getCallingConv());
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009532 cast<CallInst>(NC)->setAttributes(NewCallerPAL);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009533 }
9534
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00009535 // Insert a cast of the return type as necessary.
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009536 Value *NV = NC;
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +00009537 if (OldRetTy != NV->getType() && !Caller->use_empty()) {
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009538 if (NV->getType() != Type::VoidTy) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009539 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CastInst::getCastOpcode(NC, false,
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +00009540 OldRetTy, false);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009541 NV = NC = CastInst::Create(opcode, NC, OldRetTy, "tmp");
Chris Lattnerbb609042003-10-30 00:46:41 +00009542
9543 // If this is an invoke instruction, we should insert it after the first
9544 // non-phi, instruction in the normal successor block.
9545 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller)) {
Dan Gohman02dea8b2008-05-23 21:05:58 +00009546 BasicBlock::iterator I = II->getNormalDest()->getFirstNonPHI();
Chris Lattnerbb609042003-10-30 00:46:41 +00009547 InsertNewInstBefore(NC, *I);
9548 } else {
9549 // Otherwise, it's a call, just insert cast right after the call instr
9550 InsertNewInstBefore(NC, *Caller);
9551 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +00009552 AddUsersToWorkList(*Caller);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009553 } else {
Chris Lattnerc30bda72004-10-17 21:22:38 +00009554 NV = UndefValue::get(Caller->getType());
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009555 }
9556 }
9557
9558 if (Caller->getType() != Type::VoidTy && !Caller->use_empty())
9559 Caller->replaceAllUsesWith(NV);
Chris Lattnerf22a5c62007-03-02 19:59:19 +00009560 Caller->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00009561 RemoveFromWorkList(Caller);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009562 return true;
9563}
9564
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009565// transformCallThroughTrampoline - Turn a call to a function created by the
9566// init_trampoline intrinsic into a direct call to the underlying function.
9567//
9568Instruction *InstCombiner::transformCallThroughTrampoline(CallSite CS) {
9569 Value *Callee = CS.getCalledValue();
9570 const PointerType *PTy = cast<PointerType>(Callee->getType());
9571 const FunctionType *FTy = cast<FunctionType>(PTy->getElementType());
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009572 const AttrListPtr &Attrs = CS.getAttributes();
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009573
9574 // If the call already has the 'nest' attribute somewhere then give up -
9575 // otherwise 'nest' would occur twice after splicing in the chain.
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009576 if (Attrs.hasAttrSomewhere(Attribute::Nest))
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009577 return 0;
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009578
9579 IntrinsicInst *Tramp =
9580 cast<IntrinsicInst>(cast<BitCastInst>(Callee)->getOperand(0));
9581
Anton Korobeynikov0b12ecf2008-05-07 22:54:15 +00009582 Function *NestF = cast<Function>(Tramp->getOperand(2)->stripPointerCasts());
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009583 const PointerType *NestFPTy = cast<PointerType>(NestF->getType());
9584 const FunctionType *NestFTy = cast<FunctionType>(NestFPTy->getElementType());
9585
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009586 const AttrListPtr &NestAttrs = NestF->getAttributes();
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009587 if (!NestAttrs.isEmpty()) {
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009588 unsigned NestIdx = 1;
9589 const Type *NestTy = 0;
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009590 Attributes NestAttr = Attribute::None;
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009591
9592 // Look for a parameter marked with the 'nest' attribute.
9593 for (FunctionType::param_iterator I = NestFTy->param_begin(),
9594 E = NestFTy->param_end(); I != E; ++NestIdx, ++I)
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009595 if (NestAttrs.paramHasAttr(NestIdx, Attribute::Nest)) {
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009596 // Record the parameter type and any other attributes.
9597 NestTy = *I;
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +00009598 NestAttr = NestAttrs.getParamAttributes(NestIdx);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009599 break;
9600 }
9601
9602 if (NestTy) {
9603 Instruction *Caller = CS.getInstruction();
9604 std::vector<Value*> NewArgs;
9605 NewArgs.reserve(unsigned(CS.arg_end()-CS.arg_begin())+1);
9606
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009607 SmallVector<AttributeWithIndex, 8> NewAttrs;
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009608 NewAttrs.reserve(Attrs.getNumSlots() + 1);
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009609
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009610 // Insert the nest argument into the call argument list, which may
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009611 // mean appending it. Likewise for attributes.
9612
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +00009613 // Add any result attributes.
9614 if (Attributes Attr = Attrs.getRetAttributes())
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009615 NewAttrs.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(0, Attr));
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009616
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009617 {
9618 unsigned Idx = 1;
9619 CallSite::arg_iterator I = CS.arg_begin(), E = CS.arg_end();
9620 do {
9621 if (Idx == NestIdx) {
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009622 // Add the chain argument and attributes.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009623 Value *NestVal = Tramp->getOperand(3);
9624 if (NestVal->getType() != NestTy)
9625 NestVal = new BitCastInst(NestVal, NestTy, "nest", Caller);
9626 NewArgs.push_back(NestVal);
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009627 NewAttrs.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(NestIdx, NestAttr));
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009628 }
9629
9630 if (I == E)
9631 break;
9632
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009633 // Add the original argument and attributes.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009634 NewArgs.push_back(*I);
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +00009635 if (Attributes Attr = Attrs.getParamAttributes(Idx))
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009636 NewAttrs.push_back
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009637 (AttributeWithIndex::get(Idx + (Idx >= NestIdx), Attr));
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009638
9639 ++Idx, ++I;
9640 } while (1);
9641 }
9642
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +00009643 // Add any function attributes.
9644 if (Attributes Attr = Attrs.getFnAttributes())
9645 NewAttrs.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(~0, Attr));
9646
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009647 // The trampoline may have been bitcast to a bogus type (FTy).
9648 // Handle this by synthesizing a new function type, equal to FTy
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009649 // with the chain parameter inserted.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009650
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009651 std::vector<const Type*> NewTypes;
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009652 NewTypes.reserve(FTy->getNumParams()+1);
9653
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009654 // Insert the chain's type into the list of parameter types, which may
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009655 // mean appending it.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009656 {
9657 unsigned Idx = 1;
9658 FunctionType::param_iterator I = FTy->param_begin(),
9659 E = FTy->param_end();
9660
9661 do {
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009662 if (Idx == NestIdx)
9663 // Add the chain's type.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009664 NewTypes.push_back(NestTy);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009665
9666 if (I == E)
9667 break;
9668
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009669 // Add the original type.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009670 NewTypes.push_back(*I);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009671
9672 ++Idx, ++I;
9673 } while (1);
9674 }
9675
9676 // Replace the trampoline call with a direct call. Let the generic
9677 // code sort out any function type mismatches.
9678 FunctionType *NewFTy =
Duncan Sandsdc024672007-11-27 13:23:08 +00009679 FunctionType::get(FTy->getReturnType(), NewTypes, FTy->isVarArg());
Christopher Lamb43ad6b32007-12-17 01:12:55 +00009680 Constant *NewCallee = NestF->getType() == PointerType::getUnqual(NewFTy) ?
9681 NestF : ConstantExpr::getBitCast(NestF, PointerType::getUnqual(NewFTy));
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009682 const AttrListPtr &NewPAL = AttrListPtr::get(NewAttrs.begin(),NewAttrs.end());
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009683
9684 Instruction *NewCaller;
9685 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller)) {
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009686 NewCaller = InvokeInst::Create(NewCallee,
9687 II->getNormalDest(), II->getUnwindDest(),
9688 NewArgs.begin(), NewArgs.end(),
9689 Caller->getName(), Caller);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009690 cast<InvokeInst>(NewCaller)->setCallingConv(II->getCallingConv());
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009691 cast<InvokeInst>(NewCaller)->setAttributes(NewPAL);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009692 } else {
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009693 NewCaller = CallInst::Create(NewCallee, NewArgs.begin(), NewArgs.end(),
9694 Caller->getName(), Caller);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009695 if (cast<CallInst>(Caller)->isTailCall())
9696 cast<CallInst>(NewCaller)->setTailCall();
9697 cast<CallInst>(NewCaller)->
9698 setCallingConv(cast<CallInst>(Caller)->getCallingConv());
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009699 cast<CallInst>(NewCaller)->setAttributes(NewPAL);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009700 }
9701 if (Caller->getType() != Type::VoidTy && !Caller->use_empty())
9702 Caller->replaceAllUsesWith(NewCaller);
9703 Caller->eraseFromParent();
9704 RemoveFromWorkList(Caller);
9705 return 0;
9706 }
9707 }
9708
9709 // Replace the trampoline call with a direct call. Since there is no 'nest'
9710 // parameter, there is no need to adjust the argument list. Let the generic
9711 // code sort out any function type mismatches.
9712 Constant *NewCallee =
9713 NestF->getType() == PTy ? NestF : ConstantExpr::getBitCast(NestF, PTy);
9714 CS.setCalledFunction(NewCallee);
9715 return CS.getInstruction();
9716}
9717
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009718/// FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI - If we have something like phi [add (a,b), add(c,d)]
9719/// and if a/b/c/d and the add's all have a single use, turn this into two phi's
9720/// and a single binop.
9721Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN) {
9722 Instruction *FirstInst = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0));
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00009723 assert(isa<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst) || isa<GetElementPtrInst>(FirstInst) ||
9724 isa<CmpInst>(FirstInst));
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009725 unsigned Opc = FirstInst->getOpcode();
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00009726 Value *LHSVal = FirstInst->getOperand(0);
9727 Value *RHSVal = FirstInst->getOperand(1);
9728
9729 const Type *LHSType = LHSVal->getType();
9730 const Type *RHSType = RHSVal->getType();
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009731
9732 // Scan to see if all operands are the same opcode, all have one use, and all
9733 // kill their operands (i.e. the operands have one use).
Chris Lattnera90a24c2006-11-01 04:55:47 +00009734 for (unsigned i = 0; i != PN.getNumIncomingValues(); ++i) {
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009735 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i));
Chris Lattnera90a24c2006-11-01 04:55:47 +00009736 if (!I || I->getOpcode() != Opc || !I->hasOneUse() ||
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009737 // Verify type of the LHS matches so we don't fold cmp's of different
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00009738 // types or GEP's with different index types.
9739 I->getOperand(0)->getType() != LHSType ||
9740 I->getOperand(1)->getType() != RHSType)
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009741 return 0;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009742
9743 // If they are CmpInst instructions, check their predicates
9744 if (Opc == Instruction::ICmp || Opc == Instruction::FCmp)
9745 if (cast<CmpInst>(I)->getPredicate() !=
9746 cast<CmpInst>(FirstInst)->getPredicate())
9747 return 0;
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00009748
9749 // Keep track of which operand needs a phi node.
9750 if (I->getOperand(0) != LHSVal) LHSVal = 0;
9751 if (I->getOperand(1) != RHSVal) RHSVal = 0;
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009752 }
9753
Chris Lattner53738a42006-11-08 19:42:28 +00009754 // Otherwise, this is safe to transform, determine if it is profitable.
9755
9756 // If this is a GEP, and if the index (not the pointer) needs a PHI, bail out.
9757 // Indexes are often folded into load/store instructions, so we don't want to
9758 // hide them behind a phi.
9759 if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(FirstInst) && RHSVal == 0)
9760 return 0;
9761
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009762 Value *InLHS = FirstInst->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009763 Value *InRHS = FirstInst->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner53738a42006-11-08 19:42:28 +00009764 PHINode *NewLHS = 0, *NewRHS = 0;
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00009765 if (LHSVal == 0) {
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +00009766 NewLHS = PHINode::Create(LHSType,
9767 FirstInst->getOperand(0)->getName() + ".pn");
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00009768 NewLHS->reserveOperandSpace(PN.getNumOperands()/2);
9769 NewLHS->addIncoming(InLHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00009770 InsertNewInstBefore(NewLHS, PN);
9771 LHSVal = NewLHS;
9772 }
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00009773
9774 if (RHSVal == 0) {
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +00009775 NewRHS = PHINode::Create(RHSType,
9776 FirstInst->getOperand(1)->getName() + ".pn");
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00009777 NewRHS->reserveOperandSpace(PN.getNumOperands()/2);
9778 NewRHS->addIncoming(InRHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00009779 InsertNewInstBefore(NewRHS, PN);
9780 RHSVal = NewRHS;
9781 }
9782
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00009783 // Add all operands to the new PHIs.
9784 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
9785 if (NewLHS) {
9786 Value *NewInLHS =cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))->getOperand(0);
9787 NewLHS->addIncoming(NewInLHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(i));
9788 }
9789 if (NewRHS) {
9790 Value *NewInRHS =cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))->getOperand(1);
9791 NewRHS->addIncoming(NewInRHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(i));
9792 }
9793 }
9794
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009795 if (BinaryOperator *BinOp = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009796 return BinaryOperator::Create(BinOp->getOpcode(), LHSVal, RHSVal);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009797 else if (CmpInst *CIOp = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(FirstInst))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009798 return CmpInst::Create(CIOp->getOpcode(), CIOp->getPredicate(), LHSVal,
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009799 RHSVal);
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00009800 else {
9801 assert(isa<GetElementPtrInst>(FirstInst));
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009802 return GetElementPtrInst::Create(LHSVal, RHSVal);
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00009803 }
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009804}
9805
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00009806/// isSafeToSinkLoad - Return true if we know that it is safe sink the load out
9807/// of the block that defines it. This means that it must be obvious the value
9808/// of the load is not changed from the point of the load to the end of the
9809/// block it is in.
Chris Lattnerfd905ca2007-02-01 22:30:07 +00009810///
9811/// Finally, it is safe, but not profitable, to sink a load targetting a
9812/// non-address-taken alloca. Doing so will cause us to not promote the alloca
9813/// to a register.
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00009814static bool isSafeToSinkLoad(LoadInst *L) {
9815 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = L, E = L->getParent()->end();
9816
9817 for (++BBI; BBI != E; ++BBI)
9818 if (BBI->mayWriteToMemory())
9819 return false;
Chris Lattnerfd905ca2007-02-01 22:30:07 +00009820
9821 // Check for non-address taken alloca. If not address-taken already, it isn't
9822 // profitable to do this xform.
9823 if (AllocaInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocaInst>(L->getOperand(0))) {
9824 bool isAddressTaken = false;
9825 for (Value::use_iterator UI = AI->use_begin(), E = AI->use_end();
9826 UI != E; ++UI) {
9827 if (isa<LoadInst>(UI)) continue;
9828 if (StoreInst *SI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(*UI)) {
9829 // If storing TO the alloca, then the address isn't taken.
9830 if (SI->getOperand(1) == AI) continue;
9831 }
9832 isAddressTaken = true;
9833 break;
9834 }
9835
9836 if (!isAddressTaken)
9837 return false;
9838 }
9839
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00009840 return true;
9841}
9842
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009843
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00009844// FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI - If all operands to a PHI node are the same "unary"
9845// operator and they all are only used by the PHI, PHI together their
9846// inputs, and do the operation once, to the result of the PHI.
9847Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN) {
9848 Instruction *FirstInst = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0));
9849
9850 // Scan the instruction, looking for input operations that can be folded away.
9851 // If all input operands to the phi are the same instruction (e.g. a cast from
9852 // the same type or "+42") we can pull the operation through the PHI, reducing
9853 // code size and simplifying code.
9854 Constant *ConstantOp = 0;
9855 const Type *CastSrcTy = 0;
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00009856 bool isVolatile = false;
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00009857 if (isa<CastInst>(FirstInst)) {
9858 CastSrcTy = FirstInst->getOperand(0)->getType();
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00009859 } else if (isa<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst) || isa<CmpInst>(FirstInst)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009860 // Can fold binop, compare or shift here if the RHS is a constant,
9861 // otherwise call FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI.
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00009862 ConstantOp = dyn_cast<Constant>(FirstInst->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009863 if (ConstantOp == 0)
9864 return FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PN);
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00009865 } else if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(FirstInst)) {
9866 isVolatile = LI->isVolatile();
9867 // We can't sink the load if the loaded value could be modified between the
9868 // load and the PHI.
9869 if (LI->getParent() != PN.getIncomingBlock(0) ||
9870 !isSafeToSinkLoad(LI))
9871 return 0;
Chris Lattner71042962008-07-08 17:18:32 +00009872
9873 // If the PHI is of volatile loads and the load block has multiple
9874 // successors, sinking it would remove a load of the volatile value from
9875 // the path through the other successor.
9876 if (isVolatile &&
9877 LI->getParent()->getTerminator()->getNumSuccessors() != 1)
9878 return 0;
9879
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00009880 } else if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(FirstInst)) {
Chris Lattner53738a42006-11-08 19:42:28 +00009881 if (FirstInst->getNumOperands() == 2)
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00009882 return FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PN);
9883 // Can't handle general GEPs yet.
9884 return 0;
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00009885 } else {
9886 return 0; // Cannot fold this operation.
9887 }
9888
9889 // Check to see if all arguments are the same operation.
9890 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
9891 if (!isa<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))) return 0;
9892 Instruction *I = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009893 if (!I->hasOneUse() || !I->isSameOperationAs(FirstInst))
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00009894 return 0;
9895 if (CastSrcTy) {
9896 if (I->getOperand(0)->getType() != CastSrcTy)
9897 return 0; // Cast operation must match.
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00009898 } else if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(I)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009899 // We can't sink the load if the loaded value could be modified between
9900 // the load and the PHI.
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00009901 if (LI->isVolatile() != isVolatile ||
9902 LI->getParent() != PN.getIncomingBlock(i) ||
9903 !isSafeToSinkLoad(LI))
9904 return 0;
Chris Lattner40700fe2008-04-29 17:28:22 +00009905
Chris Lattner71042962008-07-08 17:18:32 +00009906 // If the PHI is of volatile loads and the load block has multiple
9907 // successors, sinking it would remove a load of the volatile value from
9908 // the path through the other successor.
Chris Lattner40700fe2008-04-29 17:28:22 +00009909 if (isVolatile &&
9910 LI->getParent()->getTerminator()->getNumSuccessors() != 1)
9911 return 0;
9912
9913
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00009914 } else if (I->getOperand(1) != ConstantOp) {
9915 return 0;
9916 }
9917 }
9918
9919 // Okay, they are all the same operation. Create a new PHI node of the
9920 // correct type, and PHI together all of the LHS's of the instructions.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009921 PHINode *NewPN = PHINode::Create(FirstInst->getOperand(0)->getType(),
9922 PN.getName()+".in");
Chris Lattner55517062005-01-29 00:39:08 +00009923 NewPN->reserveOperandSpace(PN.getNumOperands()/2);
Chris Lattnerb5893442004-11-14 19:29:34 +00009924
9925 Value *InVal = FirstInst->getOperand(0);
9926 NewPN->addIncoming(InVal, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00009927
9928 // Add all operands to the new PHI.
Chris Lattnerb5893442004-11-14 19:29:34 +00009929 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
9930 Value *NewInVal = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))->getOperand(0);
9931 if (NewInVal != InVal)
9932 InVal = 0;
9933 NewPN->addIncoming(NewInVal, PN.getIncomingBlock(i));
9934 }
9935
9936 Value *PhiVal;
9937 if (InVal) {
9938 // The new PHI unions all of the same values together. This is really
9939 // common, so we handle it intelligently here for compile-time speed.
9940 PhiVal = InVal;
9941 delete NewPN;
9942 } else {
9943 InsertNewInstBefore(NewPN, PN);
9944 PhiVal = NewPN;
9945 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009946
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00009947 // Insert and return the new operation.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00009948 if (CastInst* FirstCI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(FirstInst))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009949 return CastInst::Create(FirstCI->getOpcode(), PhiVal, PN.getType());
Chris Lattner54545ac2008-04-29 17:13:43 +00009950 if (BinaryOperator *BinOp = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009951 return BinaryOperator::Create(BinOp->getOpcode(), PhiVal, ConstantOp);
Chris Lattner54545ac2008-04-29 17:13:43 +00009952 if (CmpInst *CIOp = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(FirstInst))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009953 return CmpInst::Create(CIOp->getOpcode(), CIOp->getPredicate(),
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009954 PhiVal, ConstantOp);
Chris Lattner54545ac2008-04-29 17:13:43 +00009955 assert(isa<LoadInst>(FirstInst) && "Unknown operation");
9956
9957 // If this was a volatile load that we are merging, make sure to loop through
9958 // and mark all the input loads as non-volatile. If we don't do this, we will
9959 // insert a new volatile load and the old ones will not be deletable.
9960 if (isVolatile)
9961 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i)
9962 cast<LoadInst>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))->setVolatile(false);
9963
9964 return new LoadInst(PhiVal, "", isVolatile);
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00009965}
Chris Lattnera1be5662002-05-02 17:06:02 +00009966
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +00009967/// DeadPHICycle - Return true if this PHI node is only used by a PHI node cycle
9968/// that is dead.
Chris Lattner0e5444b2007-03-26 20:40:50 +00009969static bool DeadPHICycle(PHINode *PN,
9970 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> &PotentiallyDeadPHIs) {
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +00009971 if (PN->use_empty()) return true;
9972 if (!PN->hasOneUse()) return false;
9973
9974 // Remember this node, and if we find the cycle, return.
Chris Lattner0e5444b2007-03-26 20:40:50 +00009975 if (!PotentiallyDeadPHIs.insert(PN))
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +00009976 return true;
Chris Lattner92103de2007-08-28 04:23:55 +00009977
9978 // Don't scan crazily complex things.
9979 if (PotentiallyDeadPHIs.size() == 16)
9980 return false;
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +00009981
9982 if (PHINode *PU = dyn_cast<PHINode>(PN->use_back()))
9983 return DeadPHICycle(PU, PotentiallyDeadPHIs);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009984
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +00009985 return false;
9986}
9987
Chris Lattnercf5008a2007-11-06 21:52:06 +00009988/// PHIsEqualValue - Return true if this phi node is always equal to
9989/// NonPhiInVal. This happens with mutually cyclic phi nodes like:
9990/// z = some value; x = phi (y, z); y = phi (x, z)
9991static bool PHIsEqualValue(PHINode *PN, Value *NonPhiInVal,
9992 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> &ValueEqualPHIs) {
9993 // See if we already saw this PHI node.
9994 if (!ValueEqualPHIs.insert(PN))
9995 return true;
9996
9997 // Don't scan crazily complex things.
9998 if (ValueEqualPHIs.size() == 16)
9999 return false;
10000
10001 // Scan the operands to see if they are either phi nodes or are equal to
10002 // the value.
10003 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PN->getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
10004 Value *Op = PN->getIncomingValue(i);
10005 if (PHINode *OpPN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(Op)) {
10006 if (!PHIsEqualValue(OpPN, NonPhiInVal, ValueEqualPHIs))
10007 return false;
10008 } else if (Op != NonPhiInVal)
10009 return false;
10010 }
10011
10012 return true;
10013}
10014
10015
Chris Lattner473945d2002-05-06 18:06:38 +000010016// PHINode simplification
10017//
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +000010018Instruction *InstCombiner::visitPHINode(PHINode &PN) {
Owen Andersonb64ab872006-07-10 22:15:25 +000010019 // If LCSSA is around, don't mess with Phi nodes
Chris Lattnerf964f322007-03-04 04:27:24 +000010020 if (MustPreserveLCSSA) return 0;
Owen Andersond1b78a12006-07-10 19:03:49 +000010021
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +000010022 if (Value *V = PN.hasConstantValue())
10023 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, V);
10024
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +000010025 // If all PHI operands are the same operation, pull them through the PHI,
10026 // reducing code size.
10027 if (isa<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0)) &&
10028 PN.getIncomingValue(0)->hasOneUse())
10029 if (Instruction *Result = FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI(PN))
10030 return Result;
10031
10032 // If this is a trivial cycle in the PHI node graph, remove it. Basically, if
10033 // this PHI only has a single use (a PHI), and if that PHI only has one use (a
10034 // PHI)... break the cycle.
Chris Lattnerff9f13a2007-01-15 07:30:06 +000010035 if (PN.hasOneUse()) {
10036 Instruction *PHIUser = cast<Instruction>(PN.use_back());
10037 if (PHINode *PU = dyn_cast<PHINode>(PHIUser)) {
Chris Lattner0e5444b2007-03-26 20:40:50 +000010038 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> PotentiallyDeadPHIs;
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +000010039 PotentiallyDeadPHIs.insert(&PN);
10040 if (DeadPHICycle(PU, PotentiallyDeadPHIs))
10041 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, UndefValue::get(PN.getType()));
10042 }
Chris Lattnerff9f13a2007-01-15 07:30:06 +000010043
10044 // If this phi has a single use, and if that use just computes a value for
10045 // the next iteration of a loop, delete the phi. This occurs with unused
10046 // induction variables, e.g. "for (int j = 0; ; ++j);". Detecting this
10047 // common case here is good because the only other things that catch this
10048 // are induction variable analysis (sometimes) and ADCE, which is only run
10049 // late.
10050 if (PHIUser->hasOneUse() &&
10051 (isa<BinaryOperator>(PHIUser) || isa<GetElementPtrInst>(PHIUser)) &&
10052 PHIUser->use_back() == &PN) {
10053 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, UndefValue::get(PN.getType()));
10054 }
10055 }
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +000010056
Chris Lattnercf5008a2007-11-06 21:52:06 +000010057 // We sometimes end up with phi cycles that non-obviously end up being the
10058 // same value, for example:
10059 // z = some value; x = phi (y, z); y = phi (x, z)
10060 // where the phi nodes don't necessarily need to be in the same block. Do a
10061 // quick check to see if the PHI node only contains a single non-phi value, if
10062 // so, scan to see if the phi cycle is actually equal to that value.
10063 {
10064 unsigned InValNo = 0, NumOperandVals = PN.getNumIncomingValues();
10065 // Scan for the first non-phi operand.
10066 while (InValNo != NumOperandVals &&
10067 isa<PHINode>(PN.getIncomingValue(InValNo)))
10068 ++InValNo;
10069
10070 if (InValNo != NumOperandVals) {
10071 Value *NonPhiInVal = PN.getOperand(InValNo);
10072
10073 // Scan the rest of the operands to see if there are any conflicts, if so
10074 // there is no need to recursively scan other phis.
10075 for (++InValNo; InValNo != NumOperandVals; ++InValNo) {
10076 Value *OpVal = PN.getIncomingValue(InValNo);
10077 if (OpVal != NonPhiInVal && !isa<PHINode>(OpVal))
10078 break;
10079 }
10080
10081 // If we scanned over all operands, then we have one unique value plus
10082 // phi values. Scan PHI nodes to see if they all merge in each other or
10083 // the value.
10084 if (InValNo == NumOperandVals) {
10085 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> ValueEqualPHIs;
10086 if (PHIsEqualValue(&PN, NonPhiInVal, ValueEqualPHIs))
10087 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, NonPhiInVal);
10088 }
10089 }
10090 }
Chris Lattner60921c92003-12-19 05:58:40 +000010091 return 0;
Chris Lattner473945d2002-05-06 18:06:38 +000010092}
10093
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +000010094static Value *InsertCastToIntPtrTy(Value *V, const Type *DTy,
10095 Instruction *InsertPoint,
10096 InstCombiner *IC) {
Reid Spencerabaa8ca2007-01-08 16:32:00 +000010097 unsigned PtrSize = DTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
10098 unsigned VTySize = V->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +000010099 // We must cast correctly to the pointer type. Ensure that we
10100 // sign extend the integer value if it is smaller as this is
10101 // used for address computation.
10102 Instruction::CastOps opcode =
10103 (VTySize < PtrSize ? Instruction::SExt :
10104 (VTySize == PtrSize ? Instruction::BitCast : Instruction::Trunc));
10105 return IC->InsertCastBefore(opcode, V, DTy, *InsertPoint);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010106}
10107
Chris Lattnera1be5662002-05-02 17:06:02 +000010108
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +000010109Instruction *InstCombiner::visitGetElementPtrInst(GetElementPtrInst &GEP) {
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010110 Value *PtrOp = GEP.getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +000010111 // Is it 'getelementptr %P, i32 0' or 'getelementptr %P'
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +000010112 // If so, eliminate the noop.
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +000010113 if (GEP.getNumOperands() == 1)
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010114 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, PtrOp);
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +000010115
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010116 if (isa<UndefValue>(GEP.getOperand(0)))
10117 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, UndefValue::get(GEP.getType()));
10118
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +000010119 bool HasZeroPointerIndex = false;
10120 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(GEP.getOperand(1)))
10121 HasZeroPointerIndex = C->isNullValue();
10122
10123 if (GEP.getNumOperands() == 2 && HasZeroPointerIndex)
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010124 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, PtrOp);
Chris Lattnera1be5662002-05-02 17:06:02 +000010125
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010126 // Eliminate unneeded casts for indices.
10127 bool MadeChange = false;
Chris Lattnerdb9654e2007-03-25 20:43:09 +000010128
Chris Lattnercb69a4e2004-04-07 18:38:20 +000010129 gep_type_iterator GTI = gep_type_begin(GEP);
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +000010130 for (User::op_iterator i = GEP.op_begin() + 1, e = GEP.op_end();
10131 i != e; ++i, ++GTI) {
Chris Lattnercb69a4e2004-04-07 18:38:20 +000010132 if (isa<SequentialType>(*GTI)) {
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +000010133 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(*i)) {
Chris Lattner76b7a062007-01-15 07:02:54 +000010134 if (CI->getOpcode() == Instruction::ZExt ||
10135 CI->getOpcode() == Instruction::SExt) {
10136 const Type *SrcTy = CI->getOperand(0)->getType();
10137 // We can eliminate a cast from i32 to i64 iff the target
10138 // is a 32-bit pointer target.
10139 if (SrcTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() >= TD->getPointerSizeInBits()) {
10140 MadeChange = true;
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +000010141 *i = CI->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010142 }
10143 }
10144 }
Chris Lattnercb69a4e2004-04-07 18:38:20 +000010145 // If we are using a wider index than needed for this platform, shrink it
Dan Gohman4f833d42008-09-11 23:06:38 +000010146 // to what we need. If narrower, sign-extend it to what we need.
10147 // If the incoming value needs a cast instruction,
Chris Lattnercb69a4e2004-04-07 18:38:20 +000010148 // insert it. This explicit cast can make subsequent optimizations more
10149 // obvious.
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +000010150 Value *Op = *i;
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +000010151 if (TD->getTypeSizeInBits(Op->getType()) > TD->getPointerSizeInBits()) {
Chris Lattner4f1134e2004-04-17 18:16:10 +000010152 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op)) {
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +000010153 *i = ConstantExpr::getTrunc(C, TD->getIntPtrType());
Chris Lattner4f1134e2004-04-17 18:16:10 +000010154 MadeChange = true;
10155 } else {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +000010156 Op = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, Op, TD->getIntPtrType(),
10157 GEP);
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +000010158 *i = Op;
Chris Lattnercb69a4e2004-04-07 18:38:20 +000010159 MadeChange = true;
10160 }
Dan Gohman4f833d42008-09-11 23:06:38 +000010161 } else if (TD->getTypeSizeInBits(Op->getType()) < TD->getPointerSizeInBits()) {
10162 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op)) {
10163 *i = ConstantExpr::getSExt(C, TD->getIntPtrType());
10164 MadeChange = true;
10165 } else {
10166 Op = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::SExt, Op, TD->getIntPtrType(),
10167 GEP);
10168 *i = Op;
10169 MadeChange = true;
10170 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +000010171 }
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010172 }
Chris Lattnerdb9654e2007-03-25 20:43:09 +000010173 }
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010174 if (MadeChange) return &GEP;
10175
Chris Lattnerdb9654e2007-03-25 20:43:09 +000010176 // If this GEP instruction doesn't move the pointer, and if the input operand
10177 // is a bitcast of another pointer, just replace the GEP with a bitcast of the
10178 // real input to the dest type.
Chris Lattner6a94de22007-10-12 05:30:59 +000010179 if (GEP.hasAllZeroIndices()) {
10180 if (BitCastInst *BCI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(GEP.getOperand(0))) {
10181 // If the bitcast is of an allocation, and the allocation will be
10182 // converted to match the type of the cast, don't touch this.
10183 if (isa<AllocationInst>(BCI->getOperand(0))) {
10184 // See if the bitcast simplifies, if so, don't nuke this GEP yet.
Chris Lattnera79dd432007-10-12 18:05:47 +000010185 if (Instruction *I = visitBitCast(*BCI)) {
10186 if (I != BCI) {
10187 I->takeName(BCI);
10188 BCI->getParent()->getInstList().insert(BCI, I);
10189 ReplaceInstUsesWith(*BCI, I);
10190 }
Chris Lattner6a94de22007-10-12 05:30:59 +000010191 return &GEP;
Chris Lattnera79dd432007-10-12 18:05:47 +000010192 }
Chris Lattner6a94de22007-10-12 05:30:59 +000010193 }
10194 return new BitCastInst(BCI->getOperand(0), GEP.getType());
10195 }
10196 }
10197
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000010198 // Combine Indices - If the source pointer to this getelementptr instruction
10199 // is a getelementptr instruction, combine the indices of the two
10200 // getelementptr instructions into a single instruction.
10201 //
Chris Lattner72588fc2007-02-15 22:48:32 +000010202 SmallVector<Value*, 8> SrcGEPOperands;
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +000010203 if (User *Src = dyn_castGetElementPtr(PtrOp))
Chris Lattner72588fc2007-02-15 22:48:32 +000010204 SrcGEPOperands.append(Src->op_begin(), Src->op_end());
Chris Lattnerebd985c2004-03-25 22:59:29 +000010205
10206 if (!SrcGEPOperands.empty()) {
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010207 // Note that if our source is a gep chain itself that we wait for that
10208 // chain to be resolved before we perform this transformation. This
10209 // avoids us creating a TON of code in some cases.
10210 //
10211 if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(SrcGEPOperands[0]) &&
10212 cast<Instruction>(SrcGEPOperands[0])->getNumOperands() == 2)
10213 return 0; // Wait until our source is folded to completion.
10214
Chris Lattner72588fc2007-02-15 22:48:32 +000010215 SmallVector<Value*, 8> Indices;
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010216
10217 // Find out whether the last index in the source GEP is a sequential idx.
10218 bool EndsWithSequential = false;
10219 for (gep_type_iterator I = gep_type_begin(*cast<User>(PtrOp)),
10220 E = gep_type_end(*cast<User>(PtrOp)); I != E; ++I)
Chris Lattnerbe97b4e2004-05-08 22:41:42 +000010221 EndsWithSequential = !isa<StructType>(*I);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010222
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000010223 // Can we combine the two pointer arithmetics offsets?
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010224 if (EndsWithSequential) {
Chris Lattnerdecd0812003-03-05 22:33:14 +000010225 // Replace: gep (gep %P, long B), long A, ...
10226 // With: T = long A+B; gep %P, T, ...
10227 //
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010228 Value *Sum, *SO1 = SrcGEPOperands.back(), *GO1 = GEP.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010229 if (SO1 == Constant::getNullValue(SO1->getType())) {
10230 Sum = GO1;
10231 } else if (GO1 == Constant::getNullValue(GO1->getType())) {
10232 Sum = SO1;
10233 } else {
10234 // If they aren't the same type, convert both to an integer of the
10235 // target's pointer size.
10236 if (SO1->getType() != GO1->getType()) {
10237 if (Constant *SO1C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SO1)) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +000010238 SO1 = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(SO1C, GO1->getType(), true);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010239 } else if (Constant *GO1C = dyn_cast<Constant>(GO1)) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +000010240 GO1 = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(GO1C, SO1->getType(), true);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010241 } else {
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +000010242 unsigned PS = TD->getPointerSizeInBits();
10243 if (TD->getTypeSizeInBits(SO1->getType()) == PS) {
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010244 // Convert GO1 to SO1's type.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +000010245 GO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(GO1, SO1->getType(), &GEP, this);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010246
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +000010247 } else if (TD->getTypeSizeInBits(GO1->getType()) == PS) {
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010248 // Convert SO1 to GO1's type.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +000010249 SO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(SO1, GO1->getType(), &GEP, this);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010250 } else {
10251 const Type *PT = TD->getIntPtrType();
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +000010252 SO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(SO1, PT, &GEP, this);
10253 GO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(GO1, PT, &GEP, this);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010254 }
10255 }
10256 }
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010257 if (isa<Constant>(SO1) && isa<Constant>(GO1))
10258 Sum = ConstantExpr::getAdd(cast<Constant>(SO1), cast<Constant>(GO1));
10259 else {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +000010260 Sum = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(SO1, GO1, PtrOp->getName()+".sum");
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +000010261 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(Sum), GEP);
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010262 }
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010263 }
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010264
10265 // Recycle the GEP we already have if possible.
10266 if (SrcGEPOperands.size() == 2) {
10267 GEP.setOperand(0, SrcGEPOperands[0]);
10268 GEP.setOperand(1, Sum);
10269 return &GEP;
10270 } else {
10271 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), SrcGEPOperands.begin()+1,
10272 SrcGEPOperands.end()-1);
10273 Indices.push_back(Sum);
10274 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), GEP.op_begin()+2, GEP.op_end());
10275 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010276 } else if (isa<Constant>(*GEP.idx_begin()) &&
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010277 cast<Constant>(*GEP.idx_begin())->isNullValue() &&
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010278 SrcGEPOperands.size() != 1) {
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000010279 // Otherwise we can do the fold if the first index of the GEP is a zero
Chris Lattnerebd985c2004-03-25 22:59:29 +000010280 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), SrcGEPOperands.begin()+1,
10281 SrcGEPOperands.end());
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000010282 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), GEP.idx_begin()+1, GEP.idx_end());
10283 }
10284
10285 if (!Indices.empty())
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000010286 return GetElementPtrInst::Create(SrcGEPOperands[0], Indices.begin(),
10287 Indices.end(), GEP.getName());
Chris Lattner9b761232002-08-17 22:21:59 +000010288
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010289 } else if (GlobalValue *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalValue>(PtrOp)) {
Chris Lattner9b761232002-08-17 22:21:59 +000010290 // GEP of global variable. If all of the indices for this GEP are
10291 // constants, we can promote this to a constexpr instead of an instruction.
10292
10293 // Scan for nonconstants...
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +000010294 SmallVector<Constant*, 8> Indices;
Chris Lattner9b761232002-08-17 22:21:59 +000010295 User::op_iterator I = GEP.idx_begin(), E = GEP.idx_end();
10296 for (; I != E && isa<Constant>(*I); ++I)
10297 Indices.push_back(cast<Constant>(*I));
10298
10299 if (I == E) { // If they are all constants...
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +000010300 Constant *CE = ConstantExpr::getGetElementPtr(GV,
10301 &Indices[0],Indices.size());
Chris Lattner9b761232002-08-17 22:21:59 +000010302
10303 // Replace all uses of the GEP with the new constexpr...
10304 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, CE);
10305 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000010306 } else if (Value *X = getBitCastOperand(PtrOp)) { // Is the operand a cast?
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +000010307 if (!isa<PointerType>(X->getType())) {
10308 // Not interesting. Source pointer must be a cast from pointer.
10309 } else if (HasZeroPointerIndex) {
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000010310 // transform: GEP (bitcast [10 x i8]* X to [0 x i8]*), i32 0, ...
10311 // into : GEP [10 x i8]* X, i32 0, ...
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +000010312 //
10313 // This occurs when the program declares an array extern like "int X[];"
10314 //
10315 const PointerType *CPTy = cast<PointerType>(PtrOp->getType());
10316 const PointerType *XTy = cast<PointerType>(X->getType());
10317 if (const ArrayType *XATy =
10318 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(XTy->getElementType()))
10319 if (const ArrayType *CATy =
10320 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(CPTy->getElementType()))
10321 if (CATy->getElementType() == XATy->getElementType()) {
10322 // At this point, we know that the cast source type is a pointer
10323 // to an array of the same type as the destination pointer
10324 // array. Because the array type is never stepped over (there
10325 // is a leading zero) we can fold the cast into this GEP.
10326 GEP.setOperand(0, X);
10327 return &GEP;
10328 }
10329 } else if (GEP.getNumOperands() == 2) {
10330 // Transform things like:
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000010331 // %t = getelementptr i32* bitcast ([2 x i32]* %str to i32*), i32 %V
10332 // into: %t1 = getelementptr [2 x i32]* %str, i32 0, i32 %V; bitcast
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +000010333 const Type *SrcElTy = cast<PointerType>(X->getType())->getElementType();
10334 const Type *ResElTy=cast<PointerType>(PtrOp->getType())->getElementType();
10335 if (isa<ArrayType>(SrcElTy) &&
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +000010336 TD->getABITypeSize(cast<ArrayType>(SrcElTy)->getElementType()) ==
10337 TD->getABITypeSize(ResElTy)) {
David Greeneb8f74792007-09-04 15:46:09 +000010338 Value *Idx[2];
10339 Idx[0] = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
10340 Idx[1] = GEP.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +000010341 Value *V = InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000010342 GetElementPtrInst::Create(X, Idx, Idx + 2, GEP.getName()), GEP);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000010343 // V and GEP are both pointer types --> BitCast
10344 return new BitCastInst(V, GEP.getType());
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +000010345 }
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000010346
10347 // Transform things like:
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000010348 // getelementptr i8* bitcast ([100 x double]* X to i8*), i32 %tmp
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000010349 // (where tmp = 8*tmp2) into:
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000010350 // getelementptr [100 x double]* %arr, i32 0, i32 %tmp2; bitcast
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000010351
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000010352 if (isa<ArrayType>(SrcElTy) && ResElTy == Type::Int8Ty) {
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000010353 uint64_t ArrayEltSize =
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +000010354 TD->getABITypeSize(cast<ArrayType>(SrcElTy)->getElementType());
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000010355
10356 // Check to see if "tmp" is a scale by a multiple of ArrayEltSize. We
10357 // allow either a mul, shift, or constant here.
10358 Value *NewIdx = 0;
10359 ConstantInt *Scale = 0;
10360 if (ArrayEltSize == 1) {
10361 NewIdx = GEP.getOperand(1);
10362 Scale = ConstantInt::get(NewIdx->getType(), 1);
10363 } else if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(GEP.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner6e2f8432005-09-14 17:32:56 +000010364 NewIdx = ConstantInt::get(CI->getType(), 1);
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000010365 Scale = CI;
10366 } else if (Instruction *Inst =dyn_cast<Instruction>(GEP.getOperand(1))){
10367 if (Inst->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl &&
10368 isa<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +000010369 ConstantInt *ShAmt = cast<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1));
10370 uint32_t ShAmtVal = ShAmt->getLimitedValue(64);
10371 Scale = ConstantInt::get(Inst->getType(), 1ULL << ShAmtVal);
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000010372 NewIdx = Inst->getOperand(0);
10373 } else if (Inst->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul &&
10374 isa<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1))) {
10375 Scale = cast<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1));
10376 NewIdx = Inst->getOperand(0);
10377 }
10378 }
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000010379
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000010380 // If the index will be to exactly the right offset with the scale taken
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000010381 // out, perform the transformation. Note, we don't know whether Scale is
10382 // signed or not. We'll use unsigned version of division/modulo
10383 // operation after making sure Scale doesn't have the sign bit set.
10384 if (Scale && Scale->getSExtValue() >= 0LL &&
10385 Scale->getZExtValue() % ArrayEltSize == 0) {
10386 Scale = ConstantInt::get(Scale->getType(),
10387 Scale->getZExtValue() / ArrayEltSize);
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000010388 if (Scale->getZExtValue() != 1) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +000010389 Constant *C = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(Scale, NewIdx->getType(),
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000010390 false /*ZExt*/);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +000010391 Instruction *Sc = BinaryOperator::CreateMul(NewIdx, C, "idxscale");
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000010392 NewIdx = InsertNewInstBefore(Sc, GEP);
10393 }
10394
10395 // Insert the new GEP instruction.
David Greeneb8f74792007-09-04 15:46:09 +000010396 Value *Idx[2];
10397 Idx[0] = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
10398 Idx[1] = NewIdx;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000010399 Instruction *NewGEP =
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000010400 GetElementPtrInst::Create(X, Idx, Idx + 2, GEP.getName());
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000010401 NewGEP = InsertNewInstBefore(NewGEP, GEP);
10402 // The NewGEP must be pointer typed, so must the old one -> BitCast
10403 return new BitCastInst(NewGEP, GEP.getType());
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000010404 }
10405 }
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +000010406 }
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000010407 }
10408
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000010409 return 0;
10410}
10411
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000010412Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAllocationInst(AllocationInst &AI) {
10413 // Convert: malloc Ty, C - where C is a constant != 1 into: malloc [C x Ty], 1
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +000010414 if (AI.isArrayAllocation()) { // Check C != 1
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000010415 if (const ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(AI.getArraySize())) {
10416 const Type *NewTy =
10417 ArrayType::get(AI.getAllocatedType(), C->getZExtValue());
Chris Lattner0006bd72002-11-09 00:49:43 +000010418 AllocationInst *New = 0;
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000010419
10420 // Create and insert the replacement instruction...
10421 if (isa<MallocInst>(AI))
Nate Begeman14b05292005-11-05 09:21:28 +000010422 New = new MallocInst(NewTy, 0, AI.getAlignment(), AI.getName());
Chris Lattner0006bd72002-11-09 00:49:43 +000010423 else {
10424 assert(isa<AllocaInst>(AI) && "Unknown type of allocation inst!");
Nate Begeman14b05292005-11-05 09:21:28 +000010425 New = new AllocaInst(NewTy, 0, AI.getAlignment(), AI.getName());
Chris Lattner0006bd72002-11-09 00:49:43 +000010426 }
Chris Lattner7c881df2004-03-19 06:08:10 +000010427
10428 InsertNewInstBefore(New, AI);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010429
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000010430 // Scan to the end of the allocation instructions, to skip over a block of
10431 // allocas if possible...
10432 //
10433 BasicBlock::iterator It = New;
10434 while (isa<AllocationInst>(*It)) ++It;
10435
10436 // Now that I is pointing to the first non-allocation-inst in the block,
10437 // insert our getelementptr instruction...
10438 //
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000010439 Value *NullIdx = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
David Greeneb8f74792007-09-04 15:46:09 +000010440 Value *Idx[2];
10441 Idx[0] = NullIdx;
10442 Idx[1] = NullIdx;
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000010443 Value *V = GetElementPtrInst::Create(New, Idx, Idx + 2,
10444 New->getName()+".sub", It);
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000010445
10446 // Now make everything use the getelementptr instead of the original
10447 // allocation.
Chris Lattner7c881df2004-03-19 06:08:10 +000010448 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(AI, V);
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010449 } else if (isa<UndefValue>(AI.getArraySize())) {
10450 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(AI, Constant::getNullValue(AI.getType()));
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000010451 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +000010452 }
Chris Lattner7c881df2004-03-19 06:08:10 +000010453
10454 // If alloca'ing a zero byte object, replace the alloca with a null pointer.
10455 // Note that we only do this for alloca's, because malloc should allocate and
10456 // return a unique pointer, even for a zero byte allocation.
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010457 if (isa<AllocaInst>(AI) && AI.getAllocatedType()->isSized() &&
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +000010458 TD->getABITypeSize(AI.getAllocatedType()) == 0)
Chris Lattner7c881df2004-03-19 06:08:10 +000010459 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(AI, Constant::getNullValue(AI.getType()));
10460
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000010461 return 0;
10462}
10463
Chris Lattner67b1e1b2003-12-07 01:24:23 +000010464Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFreeInst(FreeInst &FI) {
10465 Value *Op = FI.getOperand(0);
10466
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +000010467 // free undef -> unreachable.
10468 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op)) {
10469 // Insert a new store to null because we cannot modify the CFG here.
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +000010470 new StoreInst(ConstantInt::getTrue(),
Christopher Lamb43ad6b32007-12-17 01:12:55 +000010471 UndefValue::get(PointerType::getUnqual(Type::Int1Ty)), &FI);
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +000010472 return EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
10473 }
Chris Lattner6fe55412007-04-14 00:20:02 +000010474
Chris Lattner6160e852004-02-28 04:57:37 +000010475 // If we have 'free null' delete the instruction. This can happen in stl code
10476 // when lots of inlining happens.
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +000010477 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op))
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +000010478 return EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
Chris Lattner6fe55412007-04-14 00:20:02 +000010479
10480 // Change free <ty>* (cast <ty2>* X to <ty>*) into free <ty2>* X
10481 if (BitCastInst *CI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Op)) {
10482 FI.setOperand(0, CI->getOperand(0));
10483 return &FI;
10484 }
10485
10486 // Change free (gep X, 0,0,0,0) into free(X)
10487 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEPI = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Op)) {
10488 if (GEPI->hasAllZeroIndices()) {
10489 AddToWorkList(GEPI);
10490 FI.setOperand(0, GEPI->getOperand(0));
10491 return &FI;
10492 }
10493 }
10494
10495 // Change free(malloc) into nothing, if the malloc has a single use.
10496 if (MallocInst *MI = dyn_cast<MallocInst>(Op))
10497 if (MI->hasOneUse()) {
10498 EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
10499 return EraseInstFromFunction(*MI);
10500 }
Chris Lattner6160e852004-02-28 04:57:37 +000010501
Chris Lattner67b1e1b2003-12-07 01:24:23 +000010502 return 0;
10503}
10504
10505
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010506/// InstCombineLoadCast - Fold 'load (cast P)' -> cast (load P)' when possible.
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +000010507static Instruction *InstCombineLoadCast(InstCombiner &IC, LoadInst &LI,
Bill Wendling587c01d2008-02-26 10:53:30 +000010508 const TargetData *TD) {
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +000010509 User *CI = cast<User>(LI.getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000010510 Value *CastOp = CI->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +000010511
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +000010512 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(CI)) {
10513 // Instead of loading constant c string, use corresponding integer value
10514 // directly if string length is small enough.
Evan Cheng0ff39b32008-06-30 07:31:25 +000010515 std::string Str;
10516 if (GetConstantStringInfo(CE->getOperand(0), Str) && !Str.empty()) {
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +000010517 unsigned len = Str.length();
10518 const Type *Ty = cast<PointerType>(CE->getType())->getElementType();
10519 unsigned numBits = Ty->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
10520 // Replace LI with immediate integer store.
10521 if ((numBits >> 3) == len + 1) {
Bill Wendling587c01d2008-02-26 10:53:30 +000010522 APInt StrVal(numBits, 0);
10523 APInt SingleChar(numBits, 0);
10524 if (TD->isLittleEndian()) {
10525 for (signed i = len-1; i >= 0; i--) {
10526 SingleChar = (uint64_t) Str[i];
10527 StrVal = (StrVal << 8) | SingleChar;
10528 }
10529 } else {
10530 for (unsigned i = 0; i < len; i++) {
10531 SingleChar = (uint64_t) Str[i];
10532 StrVal = (StrVal << 8) | SingleChar;
10533 }
10534 // Append NULL at the end.
10535 SingleChar = 0;
10536 StrVal = (StrVal << 8) | SingleChar;
10537 }
10538 Value *NL = ConstantInt::get(StrVal);
10539 return IC.ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, NL);
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +000010540 }
10541 }
10542 }
10543
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +000010544 const Type *DestPTy = cast<PointerType>(CI->getType())->getElementType();
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000010545 if (const PointerType *SrcTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType())) {
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +000010546 const Type *SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000010547
Reid Spencer42230162007-01-22 05:51:25 +000010548 if (DestPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(DestPTy) ||
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000010549 isa<VectorType>(DestPTy)) {
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000010550 // If the source is an array, the code below will not succeed. Check to
10551 // see if a trivial 'gep P, 0, 0' will help matters. Only do this for
10552 // constants.
10553 if (const ArrayType *ASrcTy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(SrcPTy))
10554 if (Constant *CSrc = dyn_cast<Constant>(CastOp))
10555 if (ASrcTy->getNumElements() != 0) {
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +000010556 Value *Idxs[2];
10557 Idxs[0] = Idxs[1] = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
10558 CastOp = ConstantExpr::getGetElementPtr(CSrc, Idxs, 2);
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000010559 SrcTy = cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType());
10560 SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
10561 }
10562
Reid Spencer42230162007-01-22 05:51:25 +000010563 if ((SrcPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(SrcPTy) ||
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000010564 isa<VectorType>(SrcPTy)) &&
Chris Lattnerb1515fe2005-03-29 06:37:47 +000010565 // Do not allow turning this into a load of an integer, which is then
10566 // casted to a pointer, this pessimizes pointer analysis a lot.
10567 (isa<PointerType>(SrcPTy) == isa<PointerType>(LI.getType())) &&
Reid Spencer42230162007-01-22 05:51:25 +000010568 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSizeInBits(SrcPTy) ==
10569 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSizeInBits(DestPTy)) {
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010570
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000010571 // Okay, we are casting from one integer or pointer type to another of
10572 // the same size. Instead of casting the pointer before the load, cast
10573 // the result of the loaded value.
10574 Value *NewLoad = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(new LoadInst(CastOp,
10575 CI->getName(),
10576 LI.isVolatile()),LI);
10577 // Now cast the result of the load.
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +000010578 return new BitCastInst(NewLoad, LI.getType());
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000010579 }
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +000010580 }
10581 }
10582 return 0;
10583}
10584
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000010585/// isSafeToLoadUnconditionally - Return true if we know that executing a load
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000010586/// from this value cannot trap. If it is not obviously safe to load from the
10587/// specified pointer, we do a quick local scan of the basic block containing
10588/// ScanFrom, to determine if the address is already accessed.
10589static bool isSafeToLoadUnconditionally(Value *V, Instruction *ScanFrom) {
Duncan Sands892c7e42007-09-19 10:10:31 +000010590 // If it is an alloca it is always safe to load from.
10591 if (isa<AllocaInst>(V)) return true;
10592
Duncan Sands46318cd2007-09-19 10:25:38 +000010593 // If it is a global variable it is mostly safe to load from.
Duncan Sands892c7e42007-09-19 10:10:31 +000010594 if (const GlobalValue *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(V))
Duncan Sands46318cd2007-09-19 10:25:38 +000010595 // Don't try to evaluate aliases. External weak GV can be null.
Duncan Sands892c7e42007-09-19 10:10:31 +000010596 return !isa<GlobalAlias>(GV) && !GV->hasExternalWeakLinkage();
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000010597
10598 // Otherwise, be a little bit agressive by scanning the local block where we
10599 // want to check to see if the pointer is already being loaded or stored
Alkis Evlogimenos7b6ec602004-09-20 06:42:58 +000010600 // from/to. If so, the previous load or store would have already trapped,
10601 // so there is no harm doing an extra load (also, CSE will later eliminate
10602 // the load entirely).
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000010603 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = ScanFrom, E = ScanFrom->getParent()->begin();
10604
Alkis Evlogimenos7b6ec602004-09-20 06:42:58 +000010605 while (BBI != E) {
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000010606 --BBI;
10607
Chris Lattner2de3fec2008-06-20 05:12:56 +000010608 // If we see a free or a call (which might do a free) the pointer could be
10609 // marked invalid.
10610 if (isa<FreeInst>(BBI) || isa<CallInst>(BBI))
10611 return false;
10612
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000010613 if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(BBI)) {
10614 if (LI->getOperand(0) == V) return true;
Chris Lattner2de3fec2008-06-20 05:12:56 +000010615 } else if (StoreInst *SI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI)) {
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000010616 if (SI->getOperand(1) == V) return true;
Chris Lattner2de3fec2008-06-20 05:12:56 +000010617 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010618
Alkis Evlogimenos7b6ec602004-09-20 06:42:58 +000010619 }
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000010620 return false;
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000010621}
10622
Dan Gohman2276a7b2008-10-15 23:19:35 +000010623/// equivalentAddressValues - Test if A and B will obviously have the same
10624/// value. This includes recognizing that %t0 and %t1 will have the same
10625/// value in code like this:
10626/// %t0 = getelementptr @a, 0, 3
10627/// store i32 0, i32* %t0
10628/// %t1 = getelementptr @a, 0, 3
10629/// %t2 = load i32* %t1
10630///
10631static bool equivalentAddressValues(Value *A, Value *B) {
10632 // Test if the values are trivially equivalent.
10633 if (A == B) return true;
10634
10635 // Test if the values come form identical arithmetic instructions.
10636 if (isa<BinaryOperator>(A) ||
10637 isa<CastInst>(A) ||
10638 isa<PHINode>(A) ||
10639 isa<GetElementPtrInst>(A))
10640 if (Instruction *BI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(B))
10641 if (cast<Instruction>(A)->isIdenticalTo(BI))
10642 return true;
10643
10644 // Otherwise they may not be equivalent.
10645 return false;
10646}
10647
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +000010648Instruction *InstCombiner::visitLoadInst(LoadInst &LI) {
10649 Value *Op = LI.getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner5f16a132004-01-12 04:13:56 +000010650
Dan Gohman9941f742007-07-20 16:34:21 +000010651 // Attempt to improve the alignment.
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +000010652 unsigned KnownAlign = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(Op);
10653 if (KnownAlign >
10654 (LI.getAlignment() == 0 ? TD->getABITypeAlignment(LI.getType()) :
10655 LI.getAlignment()))
Dan Gohman9941f742007-07-20 16:34:21 +000010656 LI.setAlignment(KnownAlign);
10657
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010658 // load (cast X) --> cast (load X) iff safe
Reid Spencer3ed469c2006-11-02 20:25:50 +000010659 if (isa<CastInst>(Op))
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +000010660 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineLoadCast(*this, LI, TD))
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010661 return Res;
10662
10663 // None of the following transforms are legal for volatile loads.
10664 if (LI.isVolatile()) return 0;
Chris Lattner62f254d2005-09-12 22:00:15 +000010665
Dan Gohman2276a7b2008-10-15 23:19:35 +000010666 // Do really simple store-to-load forwarding and load CSE, to catch cases
10667 // where there are several consequtive memory accesses to the same location,
10668 // separated by a few arithmetic operations.
10669 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = &LI;
10670 for (unsigned ScanInsts = 6; BBI != LI.getParent()->begin() && ScanInsts;
10671 --ScanInsts) {
10672 --BBI;
10673
10674 if (StoreInst *SI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI)) {
10675 if (equivalentAddressValues(SI->getOperand(1), LI.getOperand(0)))
Chris Lattner62f254d2005-09-12 22:00:15 +000010676 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, SI->getOperand(0));
Dan Gohman2276a7b2008-10-15 23:19:35 +000010677 } else if (LoadInst *LIB = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(BBI)) {
10678 if (equivalentAddressValues(LIB->getOperand(0), LI.getOperand(0)))
Chris Lattner9c1f0fd2005-09-12 22:21:03 +000010679 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, LIB);
Dan Gohman2276a7b2008-10-15 23:19:35 +000010680 }
10681
10682 // Don't skip over things that can modify memory.
10683 if (BBI->mayWriteToMemory())
10684 break;
Chris Lattner62f254d2005-09-12 22:00:15 +000010685 }
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010686
Christopher Lambb15147e2007-12-29 07:56:53 +000010687 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEPI = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Op)) {
10688 const Value *GEPI0 = GEPI->getOperand(0);
10689 // TODO: Consider a target hook for valid address spaces for this xform.
10690 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(GEPI0) &&
10691 cast<PointerType>(GEPI0->getType())->getAddressSpace() == 0) {
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010692 // Insert a new store to null instruction before the load to indicate
10693 // that this code is not reachable. We do this instead of inserting
10694 // an unreachable instruction directly because we cannot modify the
10695 // CFG.
10696 new StoreInst(UndefValue::get(LI.getType()),
10697 Constant::getNullValue(Op->getType()), &LI);
10698 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
10699 }
Christopher Lambb15147e2007-12-29 07:56:53 +000010700 }
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010701
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010702 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op)) {
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010703 // load null/undef -> undef
Christopher Lambb15147e2007-12-29 07:56:53 +000010704 // TODO: Consider a target hook for valid address spaces for this xform.
10705 if (isa<UndefValue>(C) || (C->isNullValue() &&
10706 cast<PointerType>(Op->getType())->getAddressSpace() == 0)) {
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +000010707 // Insert a new store to null instruction before the load to indicate that
10708 // this code is not reachable. We do this instead of inserting an
10709 // unreachable instruction directly because we cannot modify the CFG.
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010710 new StoreInst(UndefValue::get(LI.getType()),
10711 Constant::getNullValue(Op->getType()), &LI);
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010712 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +000010713 }
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +000010714
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010715 // Instcombine load (constant global) into the value loaded.
10716 if (GlobalVariable *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(Op))
Reid Spencer5cbf9852007-01-30 20:08:39 +000010717 if (GV->isConstant() && !GV->isDeclaration())
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010718 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, GV->getInitializer());
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010719
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010720 // Instcombine load (constantexpr_GEP global, 0, ...) into the value loaded.
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +000010721 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(Op)) {
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010722 if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::GetElementPtr) {
10723 if (GlobalVariable *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(CE->getOperand(0)))
Reid Spencer5cbf9852007-01-30 20:08:39 +000010724 if (GV->isConstant() && !GV->isDeclaration())
Chris Lattner363f2a22005-09-26 05:28:06 +000010725 if (Constant *V =
10726 ConstantFoldLoadThroughGEPConstantExpr(GV->getInitializer(), CE))
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010727 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, V);
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010728 if (CE->getOperand(0)->isNullValue()) {
10729 // Insert a new store to null instruction before the load to indicate
10730 // that this code is not reachable. We do this instead of inserting
10731 // an unreachable instruction directly because we cannot modify the
10732 // CFG.
10733 new StoreInst(UndefValue::get(LI.getType()),
10734 Constant::getNullValue(Op->getType()), &LI);
10735 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
10736 }
10737
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000010738 } else if (CE->isCast()) {
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +000010739 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineLoadCast(*this, LI, TD))
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010740 return Res;
10741 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +000010742 }
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010743 }
Chris Lattner8d2e8882007-08-11 18:48:48 +000010744
10745 // If this load comes from anywhere in a constant global, and if the global
10746 // is all undef or zero, we know what it loads.
Duncan Sands5d0392c2008-10-01 15:25:41 +000010747 if (GlobalVariable *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(Op->getUnderlyingObject())){
Chris Lattner8d2e8882007-08-11 18:48:48 +000010748 if (GV->isConstant() && GV->hasInitializer()) {
10749 if (GV->getInitializer()->isNullValue())
10750 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, Constant::getNullValue(LI.getType()));
10751 else if (isa<UndefValue>(GV->getInitializer()))
10752 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
10753 }
10754 }
Chris Lattnerf499eac2004-04-08 20:39:49 +000010755
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010756 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000010757 // Change select and PHI nodes to select values instead of addresses: this
10758 // helps alias analysis out a lot, allows many others simplifications, and
10759 // exposes redundancy in the code.
10760 //
10761 // Note that we cannot do the transformation unless we know that the
10762 // introduced loads cannot trap! Something like this is valid as long as
10763 // the condition is always false: load (select bool %C, int* null, int* %G),
10764 // but it would not be valid if we transformed it to load from null
10765 // unconditionally.
10766 //
10767 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op)) {
10768 // load (select (Cond, &V1, &V2)) --> select(Cond, load &V1, load &V2).
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000010769 if (isSafeToLoadUnconditionally(SI->getOperand(1), SI) &&
10770 isSafeToLoadUnconditionally(SI->getOperand(2), SI)) {
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000010771 Value *V1 = InsertNewInstBefore(new LoadInst(SI->getOperand(1),
Chris Lattner79f0c8e2004-09-20 10:15:10 +000010772 SI->getOperand(1)->getName()+".val"), LI);
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000010773 Value *V2 = InsertNewInstBefore(new LoadInst(SI->getOperand(2),
Chris Lattner79f0c8e2004-09-20 10:15:10 +000010774 SI->getOperand(2)->getName()+".val"), LI);
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000010775 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getCondition(), V1, V2);
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000010776 }
10777
Chris Lattner684fe212004-09-23 15:46:00 +000010778 // load (select (cond, null, P)) -> load P
10779 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
10780 if (C->isNullValue()) {
10781 LI.setOperand(0, SI->getOperand(2));
10782 return &LI;
10783 }
10784
10785 // load (select (cond, P, null)) -> load P
10786 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(2)))
10787 if (C->isNullValue()) {
10788 LI.setOperand(0, SI->getOperand(1));
10789 return &LI;
10790 }
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000010791 }
10792 }
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +000010793 return 0;
10794}
10795
Reid Spencer55af2b52007-01-19 21:20:31 +000010796/// InstCombineStoreToCast - Fold store V, (cast P) -> store (cast V), P
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010797/// when possible.
10798static Instruction *InstCombineStoreToCast(InstCombiner &IC, StoreInst &SI) {
10799 User *CI = cast<User>(SI.getOperand(1));
10800 Value *CastOp = CI->getOperand(0);
10801
10802 const Type *DestPTy = cast<PointerType>(CI->getType())->getElementType();
10803 if (const PointerType *SrcTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType())) {
10804 const Type *SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
10805
Reid Spencer42230162007-01-22 05:51:25 +000010806 if (DestPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(DestPTy)) {
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010807 // If the source is an array, the code below will not succeed. Check to
10808 // see if a trivial 'gep P, 0, 0' will help matters. Only do this for
10809 // constants.
10810 if (const ArrayType *ASrcTy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(SrcPTy))
10811 if (Constant *CSrc = dyn_cast<Constant>(CastOp))
10812 if (ASrcTy->getNumElements() != 0) {
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +000010813 Value* Idxs[2];
10814 Idxs[0] = Idxs[1] = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
10815 CastOp = ConstantExpr::getGetElementPtr(CSrc, Idxs, 2);
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010816 SrcTy = cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType());
10817 SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
10818 }
10819
Reid Spencer67f827c2007-01-20 23:35:48 +000010820 if ((SrcPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(SrcPTy)) &&
10821 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSizeInBits(SrcPTy) ==
10822 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSizeInBits(DestPTy)) {
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010823
10824 // Okay, we are casting from one integer or pointer type to another of
Reid Spencer75153962007-01-18 18:54:33 +000010825 // the same size. Instead of casting the pointer before
10826 // the store, cast the value to be stored.
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010827 Value *NewCast;
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +000010828 Value *SIOp0 = SI.getOperand(0);
Reid Spencer75153962007-01-18 18:54:33 +000010829 Instruction::CastOps opcode = Instruction::BitCast;
10830 const Type* CastSrcTy = SIOp0->getType();
10831 const Type* CastDstTy = SrcPTy;
10832 if (isa<PointerType>(CastDstTy)) {
10833 if (CastSrcTy->isInteger())
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +000010834 opcode = Instruction::IntToPtr;
Reid Spencer67f827c2007-01-20 23:35:48 +000010835 } else if (isa<IntegerType>(CastDstTy)) {
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +000010836 if (isa<PointerType>(SIOp0->getType()))
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +000010837 opcode = Instruction::PtrToInt;
10838 }
10839 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SIOp0))
Reid Spencer75153962007-01-18 18:54:33 +000010840 NewCast = ConstantExpr::getCast(opcode, C, CastDstTy);
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010841 else
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000010842 NewCast = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +000010843 CastInst::Create(opcode, SIOp0, CastDstTy, SIOp0->getName()+".c"),
Reid Spencer75153962007-01-18 18:54:33 +000010844 SI);
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010845 return new StoreInst(NewCast, CastOp);
10846 }
10847 }
10848 }
10849 return 0;
10850}
10851
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000010852Instruction *InstCombiner::visitStoreInst(StoreInst &SI) {
10853 Value *Val = SI.getOperand(0);
10854 Value *Ptr = SI.getOperand(1);
10855
10856 if (isa<UndefValue>(Ptr)) { // store X, undef -> noop (even if volatile)
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000010857 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000010858 ++NumCombined;
10859 return 0;
10860 }
Chris Lattner836692d2007-01-15 06:51:56 +000010861
10862 // If the RHS is an alloca with a single use, zapify the store, making the
10863 // alloca dead.
Chris Lattnercea1fdd2008-04-29 04:58:38 +000010864 if (Ptr->hasOneUse() && !SI.isVolatile()) {
Chris Lattner836692d2007-01-15 06:51:56 +000010865 if (isa<AllocaInst>(Ptr)) {
10866 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
10867 ++NumCombined;
10868 return 0;
10869 }
10870
10871 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEP = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Ptr))
10872 if (isa<AllocaInst>(GEP->getOperand(0)) &&
10873 GEP->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
10874 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
10875 ++NumCombined;
10876 return 0;
10877 }
10878 }
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000010879
Dan Gohman9941f742007-07-20 16:34:21 +000010880 // Attempt to improve the alignment.
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +000010881 unsigned KnownAlign = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(Ptr);
10882 if (KnownAlign >
10883 (SI.getAlignment() == 0 ? TD->getABITypeAlignment(Val->getType()) :
10884 SI.getAlignment()))
Dan Gohman9941f742007-07-20 16:34:21 +000010885 SI.setAlignment(KnownAlign);
10886
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000010887 // Do really simple DSE, to catch cases where there are several consequtive
10888 // stores to the same location, separated by a few arithmetic operations. This
10889 // situation often occurs with bitfield accesses.
10890 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = &SI;
10891 for (unsigned ScanInsts = 6; BBI != SI.getParent()->begin() && ScanInsts;
10892 --ScanInsts) {
10893 --BBI;
10894
10895 if (StoreInst *PrevSI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI)) {
10896 // Prev store isn't volatile, and stores to the same location?
Dan Gohman2276a7b2008-10-15 23:19:35 +000010897 if (!PrevSI->isVolatile() && equivalentAddressValues(PrevSI->getOperand(1),
10898 SI.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000010899 ++NumDeadStore;
10900 ++BBI;
10901 EraseInstFromFunction(*PrevSI);
10902 continue;
10903 }
10904 break;
10905 }
10906
Chris Lattnerb4db97f2006-05-26 19:19:20 +000010907 // If this is a load, we have to stop. However, if the loaded value is from
10908 // the pointer we're loading and is producing the pointer we're storing,
10909 // then *this* store is dead (X = load P; store X -> P).
10910 if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(BBI)) {
Dan Gohman2276a7b2008-10-15 23:19:35 +000010911 if (LI == Val && equivalentAddressValues(LI->getOperand(0), Ptr) &&
10912 !SI.isVolatile()) {
Chris Lattnerb4db97f2006-05-26 19:19:20 +000010913 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
10914 ++NumCombined;
10915 return 0;
10916 }
10917 // Otherwise, this is a load from some other location. Stores before it
10918 // may not be dead.
10919 break;
10920 }
10921
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000010922 // Don't skip over loads or things that can modify memory.
Chris Lattner0ef546e2008-05-08 17:20:30 +000010923 if (BBI->mayWriteToMemory() || BBI->mayReadFromMemory())
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000010924 break;
10925 }
10926
10927
10928 if (SI.isVolatile()) return 0; // Don't hack volatile stores.
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000010929
10930 // store X, null -> turns into 'unreachable' in SimplifyCFG
10931 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Ptr)) {
10932 if (!isa<UndefValue>(Val)) {
10933 SI.setOperand(0, UndefValue::get(Val->getType()));
10934 if (Instruction *U = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Val))
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000010935 AddToWorkList(U); // Dropped a use.
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000010936 ++NumCombined;
10937 }
10938 return 0; // Do not modify these!
10939 }
10940
10941 // store undef, Ptr -> noop
10942 if (isa<UndefValue>(Val)) {
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000010943 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000010944 ++NumCombined;
10945 return 0;
10946 }
10947
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010948 // If the pointer destination is a cast, see if we can fold the cast into the
10949 // source instead.
Reid Spencer3ed469c2006-11-02 20:25:50 +000010950 if (isa<CastInst>(Ptr))
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010951 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineStoreToCast(*this, SI))
10952 return Res;
10953 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(Ptr))
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000010954 if (CE->isCast())
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010955 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineStoreToCast(*this, SI))
10956 return Res;
10957
Chris Lattner408902b2005-09-12 23:23:25 +000010958
10959 // If this store is the last instruction in the basic block, and if the block
10960 // ends with an unconditional branch, try to move it to the successor block.
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000010961 BBI = &SI; ++BBI;
Chris Lattner408902b2005-09-12 23:23:25 +000010962 if (BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(BBI))
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010963 if (BI->isUnconditional())
10964 if (SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock(SI))
10965 return 0; // xform done!
Chris Lattner408902b2005-09-12 23:23:25 +000010966
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000010967 return 0;
10968}
10969
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010970/// SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock - Turn things like:
10971/// if () { *P = v1; } else { *P = v2 }
10972/// into a phi node with a store in the successor.
10973///
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010974/// Simplify things like:
10975/// *P = v1; if () { *P = v2; }
10976/// into a phi node with a store in the successor.
10977///
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010978bool InstCombiner::SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock(StoreInst &SI) {
10979 BasicBlock *StoreBB = SI.getParent();
10980
10981 // Check to see if the successor block has exactly two incoming edges. If
10982 // so, see if the other predecessor contains a store to the same location.
10983 // if so, insert a PHI node (if needed) and move the stores down.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010984 BasicBlock *DestBB = StoreBB->getTerminator()->getSuccessor(0);
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010985
10986 // Determine whether Dest has exactly two predecessors and, if so, compute
10987 // the other predecessor.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010988 pred_iterator PI = pred_begin(DestBB);
10989 BasicBlock *OtherBB = 0;
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010990 if (*PI != StoreBB)
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010991 OtherBB = *PI;
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010992 ++PI;
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010993 if (PI == pred_end(DestBB))
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010994 return false;
10995
10996 if (*PI != StoreBB) {
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010997 if (OtherBB)
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010998 return false;
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010999 OtherBB = *PI;
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011000 }
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011001 if (++PI != pred_end(DestBB))
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011002 return false;
Eli Friedman66fe80a2008-06-13 21:17:49 +000011003
11004 // Bail out if all the relevant blocks aren't distinct (this can happen,
11005 // for example, if SI is in an infinite loop)
11006 if (StoreBB == DestBB || OtherBB == DestBB)
11007 return false;
11008
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011009 // Verify that the other block ends in a branch and is not otherwise empty.
11010 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = OtherBB->getTerminator();
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011011 BranchInst *OtherBr = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(BBI);
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011012 if (!OtherBr || BBI == OtherBB->begin())
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011013 return false;
11014
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011015 // If the other block ends in an unconditional branch, check for the 'if then
11016 // else' case. there is an instruction before the branch.
11017 StoreInst *OtherStore = 0;
11018 if (OtherBr->isUnconditional()) {
11019 // If this isn't a store, or isn't a store to the same location, bail out.
11020 --BBI;
11021 OtherStore = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI);
11022 if (!OtherStore || OtherStore->getOperand(1) != SI.getOperand(1))
11023 return false;
11024 } else {
Chris Lattnerd717c182007-05-05 22:32:24 +000011025 // Otherwise, the other block ended with a conditional branch. If one of the
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011026 // destinations is StoreBB, then we have the if/then case.
11027 if (OtherBr->getSuccessor(0) != StoreBB &&
11028 OtherBr->getSuccessor(1) != StoreBB)
11029 return false;
11030
11031 // Okay, we know that OtherBr now goes to Dest and StoreBB, so this is an
Chris Lattnerd717c182007-05-05 22:32:24 +000011032 // if/then triangle. See if there is a store to the same ptr as SI that
11033 // lives in OtherBB.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011034 for (;; --BBI) {
11035 // Check to see if we find the matching store.
11036 if ((OtherStore = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI))) {
11037 if (OtherStore->getOperand(1) != SI.getOperand(1))
11038 return false;
11039 break;
11040 }
Eli Friedman6903a242008-06-13 22:02:12 +000011041 // If we find something that may be using or overwriting the stored
11042 // value, or if we run out of instructions, we can't do the xform.
11043 if (BBI->mayReadFromMemory() || BBI->mayWriteToMemory() ||
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011044 BBI == OtherBB->begin())
11045 return false;
11046 }
11047
11048 // In order to eliminate the store in OtherBr, we have to
Eli Friedman6903a242008-06-13 22:02:12 +000011049 // make sure nothing reads or overwrites the stored value in
11050 // StoreBB.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011051 for (BasicBlock::iterator I = StoreBB->begin(); &*I != &SI; ++I) {
11052 // FIXME: This should really be AA driven.
Eli Friedman6903a242008-06-13 22:02:12 +000011053 if (I->mayReadFromMemory() || I->mayWriteToMemory())
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011054 return false;
11055 }
11056 }
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011057
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011058 // Insert a PHI node now if we need it.
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011059 Value *MergedVal = OtherStore->getOperand(0);
11060 if (MergedVal != SI.getOperand(0)) {
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000011061 PHINode *PN = PHINode::Create(MergedVal->getType(), "storemerge");
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011062 PN->reserveOperandSpace(2);
11063 PN->addIncoming(SI.getOperand(0), SI.getParent());
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011064 PN->addIncoming(OtherStore->getOperand(0), OtherBB);
11065 MergedVal = InsertNewInstBefore(PN, DestBB->front());
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011066 }
11067
11068 // Advance to a place where it is safe to insert the new store and
11069 // insert it.
Dan Gohman02dea8b2008-05-23 21:05:58 +000011070 BBI = DestBB->getFirstNonPHI();
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011071 InsertNewInstBefore(new StoreInst(MergedVal, SI.getOperand(1),
11072 OtherStore->isVolatile()), *BBI);
11073
11074 // Nuke the old stores.
11075 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
11076 EraseInstFromFunction(*OtherStore);
11077 ++NumCombined;
11078 return true;
11079}
11080
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000011081
Chris Lattnerc4d10eb2003-06-04 04:46:00 +000011082Instruction *InstCombiner::visitBranchInst(BranchInst &BI) {
11083 // Change br (not X), label True, label False to: br X, label False, True
Reid Spencer4b828e62005-06-18 17:37:34 +000011084 Value *X = 0;
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +000011085 BasicBlock *TrueDest;
11086 BasicBlock *FalseDest;
11087 if (match(&BI, m_Br(m_Not(m_Value(X)), TrueDest, FalseDest)) &&
11088 !isa<Constant>(X)) {
11089 // Swap Destinations and condition...
11090 BI.setCondition(X);
11091 BI.setSuccessor(0, FalseDest);
11092 BI.setSuccessor(1, TrueDest);
11093 return &BI;
11094 }
11095
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000011096 // Cannonicalize fcmp_one -> fcmp_oeq
11097 FCmpInst::Predicate FPred; Value *Y;
11098 if (match(&BI, m_Br(m_FCmp(FPred, m_Value(X), m_Value(Y)),
11099 TrueDest, FalseDest)))
11100 if ((FPred == FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE || FPred == FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE ||
11101 FPred == FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE) && BI.getCondition()->hasOneUse()) {
11102 FCmpInst *I = cast<FCmpInst>(BI.getCondition());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000011103 FCmpInst::Predicate NewPred = FCmpInst::getInversePredicate(FPred);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +000011104 Instruction *NewSCC = new FCmpInst(NewPred, X, Y, "", I);
11105 NewSCC->takeName(I);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000011106 // Swap Destinations and condition...
11107 BI.setCondition(NewSCC);
11108 BI.setSuccessor(0, FalseDest);
11109 BI.setSuccessor(1, TrueDest);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011110 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +000011111 I->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011112 AddToWorkList(NewSCC);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000011113 return &BI;
11114 }
11115
11116 // Cannonicalize icmp_ne -> icmp_eq
11117 ICmpInst::Predicate IPred;
11118 if (match(&BI, m_Br(m_ICmp(IPred, m_Value(X), m_Value(Y)),
11119 TrueDest, FalseDest)))
11120 if ((IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE || IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE ||
11121 IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE || IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE ||
11122 IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE) && BI.getCondition()->hasOneUse()) {
11123 ICmpInst *I = cast<ICmpInst>(BI.getCondition());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000011124 ICmpInst::Predicate NewPred = ICmpInst::getInversePredicate(IPred);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +000011125 Instruction *NewSCC = new ICmpInst(NewPred, X, Y, "", I);
11126 NewSCC->takeName(I);
Chris Lattner40f5d702003-06-04 05:10:11 +000011127 // Swap Destinations and condition...
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +000011128 BI.setCondition(NewSCC);
Chris Lattner40f5d702003-06-04 05:10:11 +000011129 BI.setSuccessor(0, FalseDest);
11130 BI.setSuccessor(1, TrueDest);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011131 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +000011132 I->eraseFromParent();;
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011133 AddToWorkList(NewSCC);
Chris Lattner40f5d702003-06-04 05:10:11 +000011134 return &BI;
11135 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000011136
Chris Lattnerc4d10eb2003-06-04 04:46:00 +000011137 return 0;
11138}
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000011139
Chris Lattner46238a62004-07-03 00:26:11 +000011140Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSwitchInst(SwitchInst &SI) {
11141 Value *Cond = SI.getCondition();
11142 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Cond)) {
11143 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add)
11144 if (ConstantInt *AddRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
11145 // change 'switch (X+4) case 1:' into 'switch (X) case -3'
11146 for (unsigned i = 2, e = SI.getNumOperands(); i != e; i += 2)
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000011147 SI.setOperand(i,ConstantExpr::getSub(cast<Constant>(SI.getOperand(i)),
Chris Lattner46238a62004-07-03 00:26:11 +000011148 AddRHS));
11149 SI.setOperand(0, I->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011150 AddToWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner46238a62004-07-03 00:26:11 +000011151 return &SI;
11152 }
11153 }
11154 return 0;
11155}
11156
Matthijs Kooijmana9012ec2008-06-11 14:05:05 +000011157Instruction *InstCombiner::visitExtractValueInst(ExtractValueInst &EV) {
Matthijs Kooijman780ae5e2008-07-16 12:55:45 +000011158 Value *Agg = EV.getAggregateOperand();
Matthijs Kooijmana9012ec2008-06-11 14:05:05 +000011159
Matthijs Kooijman780ae5e2008-07-16 12:55:45 +000011160 if (!EV.hasIndices())
11161 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EV, Agg);
11162
11163 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Agg)) {
11164 if (isa<UndefValue>(C))
11165 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EV, UndefValue::get(EV.getType()));
11166
11167 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(C))
11168 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EV, Constant::getNullValue(EV.getType()));
11169
11170 if (isa<ConstantArray>(C) || isa<ConstantStruct>(C)) {
11171 // Extract the element indexed by the first index out of the constant
11172 Value *V = C->getOperand(*EV.idx_begin());
11173 if (EV.getNumIndices() > 1)
11174 // Extract the remaining indices out of the constant indexed by the
11175 // first index
11176 return ExtractValueInst::Create(V, EV.idx_begin() + 1, EV.idx_end());
11177 else
11178 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EV, V);
11179 }
11180 return 0; // Can't handle other constants
11181 }
11182 if (InsertValueInst *IV = dyn_cast<InsertValueInst>(Agg)) {
11183 // We're extracting from an insertvalue instruction, compare the indices
11184 const unsigned *exti, *exte, *insi, *inse;
11185 for (exti = EV.idx_begin(), insi = IV->idx_begin(),
11186 exte = EV.idx_end(), inse = IV->idx_end();
11187 exti != exte && insi != inse;
11188 ++exti, ++insi) {
11189 if (*insi != *exti)
11190 // The insert and extract both reference distinctly different elements.
11191 // This means the extract is not influenced by the insert, and we can
11192 // replace the aggregate operand of the extract with the aggregate
11193 // operand of the insert. i.e., replace
11194 // %I = insertvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, { i32 } { i32 42 }, 1
11195 // %E = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %I, 0
11196 // with
11197 // %E = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, 0
11198 return ExtractValueInst::Create(IV->getAggregateOperand(),
11199 EV.idx_begin(), EV.idx_end());
11200 }
11201 if (exti == exte && insi == inse)
11202 // Both iterators are at the end: Index lists are identical. Replace
11203 // %B = insertvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, i32 42, 1, 0
11204 // %C = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %B, 1, 0
11205 // with "i32 42"
11206 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EV, IV->getInsertedValueOperand());
11207 if (exti == exte) {
11208 // The extract list is a prefix of the insert list. i.e. replace
11209 // %I = insertvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, i32 42, 1, 0
11210 // %E = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %I, 1
11211 // with
11212 // %X = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, 1
11213 // %E = insertvalue { i32 } %X, i32 42, 0
11214 // by switching the order of the insert and extract (though the
11215 // insertvalue should be left in, since it may have other uses).
11216 Value *NewEV = InsertNewInstBefore(
11217 ExtractValueInst::Create(IV->getAggregateOperand(),
11218 EV.idx_begin(), EV.idx_end()),
11219 EV);
11220 return InsertValueInst::Create(NewEV, IV->getInsertedValueOperand(),
11221 insi, inse);
11222 }
11223 if (insi == inse)
11224 // The insert list is a prefix of the extract list
11225 // We can simply remove the common indices from the extract and make it
11226 // operate on the inserted value instead of the insertvalue result.
11227 // i.e., replace
11228 // %I = insertvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, { i32 } { i32 42 }, 1
11229 // %E = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %I, 1, 0
11230 // with
11231 // %E extractvalue { i32 } { i32 42 }, 0
11232 return ExtractValueInst::Create(IV->getInsertedValueOperand(),
11233 exti, exte);
11234 }
11235 // Can't simplify extracts from other values. Note that nested extracts are
11236 // already simplified implicitely by the above (extract ( extract (insert) )
11237 // will be translated into extract ( insert ( extract ) ) first and then just
11238 // the value inserted, if appropriate).
Matthijs Kooijmana9012ec2008-06-11 14:05:05 +000011239 return 0;
11240}
11241
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000011242/// CheapToScalarize - Return true if the value is cheaper to scalarize than it
11243/// is to leave as a vector operation.
11244static bool CheapToScalarize(Value *V, bool isConstant) {
11245 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V))
11246 return true;
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011247 if (ConstantVector *C = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V)) {
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000011248 if (isConstant) return true;
11249 // If all elts are the same, we can extract.
11250 Constant *Op0 = C->getOperand(0);
11251 for (unsigned i = 1; i < C->getNumOperands(); ++i)
11252 if (C->getOperand(i) != Op0)
11253 return false;
11254 return true;
11255 }
11256 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
11257 if (!I) return false;
11258
11259 // Insert element gets simplified to the inserted element or is deleted if
11260 // this is constant idx extract element and its a constant idx insertelt.
11261 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::InsertElement && isConstant &&
11262 isa<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(2)))
11263 return true;
11264 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Load && I->hasOneUse())
11265 return true;
11266 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I))
11267 if (BO->hasOneUse() &&
11268 (CheapToScalarize(BO->getOperand(0), isConstant) ||
11269 CheapToScalarize(BO->getOperand(1), isConstant)))
11270 return true;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000011271 if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(I))
11272 if (CI->hasOneUse() &&
11273 (CheapToScalarize(CI->getOperand(0), isConstant) ||
11274 CheapToScalarize(CI->getOperand(1), isConstant)))
11275 return true;
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000011276
11277 return false;
11278}
11279
Chris Lattnerd2b7cec2007-02-14 05:52:17 +000011280/// Read and decode a shufflevector mask.
11281///
11282/// It turns undef elements into values that are larger than the number of
11283/// elements in the input.
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011284static std::vector<unsigned> getShuffleMask(const ShuffleVectorInst *SVI) {
11285 unsigned NElts = SVI->getType()->getNumElements();
11286 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(SVI->getOperand(2)))
11287 return std::vector<unsigned>(NElts, 0);
11288 if (isa<UndefValue>(SVI->getOperand(2)))
11289 return std::vector<unsigned>(NElts, 2*NElts);
11290
11291 std::vector<unsigned> Result;
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011292 const ConstantVector *CP = cast<ConstantVector>(SVI->getOperand(2));
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +000011293 for (User::const_op_iterator i = CP->op_begin(), e = CP->op_end(); i!=e; ++i)
11294 if (isa<UndefValue>(*i))
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011295 Result.push_back(NElts*2); // undef -> 8
11296 else
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +000011297 Result.push_back(cast<ConstantInt>(*i)->getZExtValue());
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011298 return Result;
11299}
11300
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000011301/// FindScalarElement - Given a vector and an element number, see if the scalar
11302/// value is already around as a register, for example if it were inserted then
11303/// extracted from the vector.
11304static Value *FindScalarElement(Value *V, unsigned EltNo) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011305 assert(isa<VectorType>(V->getType()) && "Not looking at a vector?");
11306 const VectorType *PTy = cast<VectorType>(V->getType());
Chris Lattner389a6f52006-04-10 23:06:36 +000011307 unsigned Width = PTy->getNumElements();
11308 if (EltNo >= Width) // Out of range access.
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000011309 return UndefValue::get(PTy->getElementType());
11310
11311 if (isa<UndefValue>(V))
11312 return UndefValue::get(PTy->getElementType());
11313 else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V))
11314 return Constant::getNullValue(PTy->getElementType());
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011315 else if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V))
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000011316 return CP->getOperand(EltNo);
11317 else if (InsertElementInst *III = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(V)) {
11318 // If this is an insert to a variable element, we don't know what it is.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011319 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(III->getOperand(2)))
11320 return 0;
11321 unsigned IIElt = cast<ConstantInt>(III->getOperand(2))->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000011322
11323 // If this is an insert to the element we are looking for, return the
11324 // inserted value.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011325 if (EltNo == IIElt)
11326 return III->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000011327
11328 // Otherwise, the insertelement doesn't modify the value, recurse on its
11329 // vector input.
11330 return FindScalarElement(III->getOperand(0), EltNo);
Chris Lattner389a6f52006-04-10 23:06:36 +000011331 } else if (ShuffleVectorInst *SVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(V)) {
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011332 unsigned InEl = getShuffleMask(SVI)[EltNo];
11333 if (InEl < Width)
11334 return FindScalarElement(SVI->getOperand(0), InEl);
11335 else if (InEl < Width*2)
11336 return FindScalarElement(SVI->getOperand(1), InEl - Width);
11337 else
11338 return UndefValue::get(PTy->getElementType());
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000011339 }
11340
11341 // Otherwise, we don't know.
11342 return 0;
11343}
11344
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000011345Instruction *InstCombiner::visitExtractElementInst(ExtractElementInst &EI) {
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +000011346 // If vector val is undef, replace extract with scalar undef.
Chris Lattner1f13c882006-03-31 18:25:14 +000011347 if (isa<UndefValue>(EI.getOperand(0)))
11348 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, UndefValue::get(EI.getType()));
11349
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +000011350 // If vector val is constant 0, replace extract with scalar 0.
Chris Lattner1f13c882006-03-31 18:25:14 +000011351 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(EI.getOperand(0)))
11352 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, Constant::getNullValue(EI.getType()));
11353
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011354 if (ConstantVector *C = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(EI.getOperand(0))) {
Matthijs Kooijmanb4d6a5a2008-06-11 09:00:12 +000011355 // If vector val is constant with all elements the same, replace EI with
11356 // that element. When the elements are not identical, we cannot replace yet
11357 // (we do that below, but only when the index is constant).
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000011358 Constant *op0 = C->getOperand(0);
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000011359 for (unsigned i = 1; i < C->getNumOperands(); ++i)
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000011360 if (C->getOperand(i) != op0) {
11361 op0 = 0;
11362 break;
11363 }
11364 if (op0)
11365 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, op0);
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000011366 }
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000011367
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000011368 // If extracting a specified index from the vector, see if we can recursively
11369 // find a previously computed scalar that was inserted into the vector.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011370 if (ConstantInt *IdxC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(EI.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner85464092007-04-09 01:37:55 +000011371 unsigned IndexVal = IdxC->getZExtValue();
11372 unsigned VectorWidth =
11373 cast<VectorType>(EI.getOperand(0)->getType())->getNumElements();
11374
11375 // If this is extracting an invalid index, turn this into undef, to avoid
11376 // crashing the code below.
11377 if (IndexVal >= VectorWidth)
11378 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, UndefValue::get(EI.getType()));
11379
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +000011380 // This instruction only demands the single element from the input vector.
11381 // If the input vector has a single use, simplify it based on this use
11382 // property.
Chris Lattner85464092007-04-09 01:37:55 +000011383 if (EI.getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() && VectorWidth != 1) {
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +000011384 uint64_t UndefElts;
11385 if (Value *V = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(EI.getOperand(0),
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011386 1 << IndexVal,
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +000011387 UndefElts)) {
11388 EI.setOperand(0, V);
11389 return &EI;
11390 }
11391 }
11392
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011393 if (Value *Elt = FindScalarElement(EI.getOperand(0), IndexVal))
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000011394 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, Elt);
Chris Lattnerb7300fa2007-04-14 23:02:14 +000011395
11396 // If the this extractelement is directly using a bitcast from a vector of
11397 // the same number of elements, see if we can find the source element from
11398 // it. In this case, we will end up needing to bitcast the scalars.
11399 if (BitCastInst *BCI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(EI.getOperand(0))) {
11400 if (const VectorType *VT =
11401 dyn_cast<VectorType>(BCI->getOperand(0)->getType()))
11402 if (VT->getNumElements() == VectorWidth)
11403 if (Value *Elt = FindScalarElement(BCI->getOperand(0), IndexVal))
11404 return new BitCastInst(Elt, EI.getType());
11405 }
Chris Lattner389a6f52006-04-10 23:06:36 +000011406 }
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000011407
Chris Lattner73fa49d2006-05-25 22:53:38 +000011408 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(EI.getOperand(0))) {
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000011409 if (I->hasOneUse()) {
11410 // Push extractelement into predecessor operation if legal and
11411 // profitable to do so
11412 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I)) {
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000011413 bool isConstantElt = isa<ConstantInt>(EI.getOperand(1));
11414 if (CheapToScalarize(BO, isConstantElt)) {
11415 ExtractElementInst *newEI0 =
11416 new ExtractElementInst(BO->getOperand(0), EI.getOperand(1),
11417 EI.getName()+".lhs");
11418 ExtractElementInst *newEI1 =
11419 new ExtractElementInst(BO->getOperand(1), EI.getOperand(1),
11420 EI.getName()+".rhs");
11421 InsertNewInstBefore(newEI0, EI);
11422 InsertNewInstBefore(newEI1, EI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +000011423 return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), newEI0, newEI1);
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000011424 }
Reid Spencer3ed469c2006-11-02 20:25:50 +000011425 } else if (isa<LoadInst>(I)) {
Christopher Lamb43ad6b32007-12-17 01:12:55 +000011426 unsigned AS =
11427 cast<PointerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType())->getAddressSpace();
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +000011428 Value *Ptr = InsertBitCastBefore(I->getOperand(0),
11429 PointerType::get(EI.getType(), AS),EI);
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +000011430 GetElementPtrInst *GEP =
11431 GetElementPtrInst::Create(Ptr, EI.getOperand(1), I->getName()+".gep");
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000011432 InsertNewInstBefore(GEP, EI);
11433 return new LoadInst(GEP);
Chris Lattner73fa49d2006-05-25 22:53:38 +000011434 }
11435 }
11436 if (InsertElementInst *IE = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(I)) {
11437 // Extracting the inserted element?
11438 if (IE->getOperand(2) == EI.getOperand(1))
11439 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, IE->getOperand(1));
11440 // If the inserted and extracted elements are constants, they must not
11441 // be the same value, extract from the pre-inserted value instead.
11442 if (isa<Constant>(IE->getOperand(2)) &&
11443 isa<Constant>(EI.getOperand(1))) {
11444 AddUsesToWorkList(EI);
11445 EI.setOperand(0, IE->getOperand(0));
11446 return &EI;
11447 }
11448 } else if (ShuffleVectorInst *SVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(I)) {
11449 // If this is extracting an element from a shufflevector, figure out where
11450 // it came from and extract from the appropriate input element instead.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011451 if (ConstantInt *Elt = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(EI.getOperand(1))) {
11452 unsigned SrcIdx = getShuffleMask(SVI)[Elt->getZExtValue()];
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011453 Value *Src;
11454 if (SrcIdx < SVI->getType()->getNumElements())
11455 Src = SVI->getOperand(0);
11456 else if (SrcIdx < SVI->getType()->getNumElements()*2) {
11457 SrcIdx -= SVI->getType()->getNumElements();
11458 Src = SVI->getOperand(1);
11459 } else {
11460 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, UndefValue::get(EI.getType()));
Chris Lattnerdf084ff2006-03-30 22:02:40 +000011461 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +000011462 return new ExtractElementInst(Src, SrcIdx);
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000011463 }
11464 }
Chris Lattner73fa49d2006-05-25 22:53:38 +000011465 }
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000011466 return 0;
11467}
11468
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011469/// CollectSingleShuffleElements - If V is a shuffle of values that ONLY returns
11470/// elements from either LHS or RHS, return the shuffle mask and true.
11471/// Otherwise, return false.
11472static bool CollectSingleShuffleElements(Value *V, Value *LHS, Value *RHS,
11473 std::vector<Constant*> &Mask) {
11474 assert(V->getType() == LHS->getType() && V->getType() == RHS->getType() &&
11475 "Invalid CollectSingleShuffleElements");
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011476 unsigned NumElts = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getNumElements();
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011477
11478 if (isa<UndefValue>(V)) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011479 Mask.assign(NumElts, UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011480 return true;
11481 } else if (V == LHS) {
11482 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i)
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011483 Mask.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, i));
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011484 return true;
11485 } else if (V == RHS) {
11486 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i)
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011487 Mask.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, i+NumElts));
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011488 return true;
11489 } else if (InsertElementInst *IEI = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(V)) {
11490 // If this is an insert of an extract from some other vector, include it.
11491 Value *VecOp = IEI->getOperand(0);
11492 Value *ScalarOp = IEI->getOperand(1);
11493 Value *IdxOp = IEI->getOperand(2);
11494
Chris Lattnerd929f062006-04-27 21:14:21 +000011495 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(IdxOp))
11496 return false;
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011497 unsigned InsertedIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(IdxOp)->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerd929f062006-04-27 21:14:21 +000011498
11499 if (isa<UndefValue>(ScalarOp)) { // inserting undef into vector.
11500 // Okay, we can handle this if the vector we are insertinting into is
11501 // transitively ok.
11502 if (CollectSingleShuffleElements(VecOp, LHS, RHS, Mask)) {
11503 // If so, update the mask to reflect the inserted undef.
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011504 Mask[InsertedIdx] = UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty);
Chris Lattnerd929f062006-04-27 21:14:21 +000011505 return true;
11506 }
11507 } else if (ExtractElementInst *EI = dyn_cast<ExtractElementInst>(ScalarOp)){
11508 if (isa<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1)) &&
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011509 EI->getOperand(0)->getType() == V->getType()) {
11510 unsigned ExtractedIdx =
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011511 cast<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1))->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011512
11513 // This must be extracting from either LHS or RHS.
11514 if (EI->getOperand(0) == LHS || EI->getOperand(0) == RHS) {
11515 // Okay, we can handle this if the vector we are insertinting into is
11516 // transitively ok.
11517 if (CollectSingleShuffleElements(VecOp, LHS, RHS, Mask)) {
11518 // If so, update the mask to reflect the inserted value.
11519 if (EI->getOperand(0) == LHS) {
Mon P Wang4f5ca2c2008-08-20 02:23:25 +000011520 Mask[InsertedIdx % NumElts] =
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011521 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, ExtractedIdx);
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011522 } else {
11523 assert(EI->getOperand(0) == RHS);
Mon P Wang4f5ca2c2008-08-20 02:23:25 +000011524 Mask[InsertedIdx % NumElts] =
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011525 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, ExtractedIdx+NumElts);
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011526
11527 }
11528 return true;
11529 }
11530 }
11531 }
11532 }
11533 }
11534 // TODO: Handle shufflevector here!
11535
11536 return false;
11537}
11538
11539/// CollectShuffleElements - We are building a shuffle of V, using RHS as the
11540/// RHS of the shuffle instruction, if it is not null. Return a shuffle mask
11541/// that computes V and the LHS value of the shuffle.
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011542static Value *CollectShuffleElements(Value *V, std::vector<Constant*> &Mask,
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011543 Value *&RHS) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011544 assert(isa<VectorType>(V->getType()) &&
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011545 (RHS == 0 || V->getType() == RHS->getType()) &&
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011546 "Invalid shuffle!");
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011547 unsigned NumElts = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getNumElements();
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011548
11549 if (isa<UndefValue>(V)) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011550 Mask.assign(NumElts, UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011551 return V;
11552 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V)) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011553 Mask.assign(NumElts, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, 0));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011554 return V;
11555 } else if (InsertElementInst *IEI = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(V)) {
11556 // If this is an insert of an extract from some other vector, include it.
11557 Value *VecOp = IEI->getOperand(0);
11558 Value *ScalarOp = IEI->getOperand(1);
11559 Value *IdxOp = IEI->getOperand(2);
11560
11561 if (ExtractElementInst *EI = dyn_cast<ExtractElementInst>(ScalarOp)) {
11562 if (isa<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1)) && isa<ConstantInt>(IdxOp) &&
11563 EI->getOperand(0)->getType() == V->getType()) {
11564 unsigned ExtractedIdx =
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011565 cast<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1))->getZExtValue();
11566 unsigned InsertedIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(IdxOp)->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011567
11568 // Either the extracted from or inserted into vector must be RHSVec,
11569 // otherwise we'd end up with a shuffle of three inputs.
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011570 if (EI->getOperand(0) == RHS || RHS == 0) {
11571 RHS = EI->getOperand(0);
11572 Value *V = CollectShuffleElements(VecOp, Mask, RHS);
Mon P Wang4f5ca2c2008-08-20 02:23:25 +000011573 Mask[InsertedIdx % NumElts] =
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011574 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, NumElts+ExtractedIdx);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011575 return V;
11576 }
11577
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011578 if (VecOp == RHS) {
11579 Value *V = CollectShuffleElements(EI->getOperand(0), Mask, RHS);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011580 // Everything but the extracted element is replaced with the RHS.
11581 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i) {
11582 if (i != InsertedIdx)
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011583 Mask[i] = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, NumElts+i);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011584 }
11585 return V;
11586 }
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011587
11588 // If this insertelement is a chain that comes from exactly these two
11589 // vectors, return the vector and the effective shuffle.
11590 if (CollectSingleShuffleElements(IEI, EI->getOperand(0), RHS, Mask))
11591 return EI->getOperand(0);
11592
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011593 }
11594 }
11595 }
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011596 // TODO: Handle shufflevector here!
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011597
11598 // Otherwise, can't do anything fancy. Return an identity vector.
11599 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i)
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011600 Mask.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, i));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011601 return V;
11602}
11603
11604Instruction *InstCombiner::visitInsertElementInst(InsertElementInst &IE) {
11605 Value *VecOp = IE.getOperand(0);
11606 Value *ScalarOp = IE.getOperand(1);
11607 Value *IdxOp = IE.getOperand(2);
11608
Chris Lattner599ded12007-04-09 01:11:16 +000011609 // Inserting an undef or into an undefined place, remove this.
11610 if (isa<UndefValue>(ScalarOp) || isa<UndefValue>(IdxOp))
11611 ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, VecOp);
11612
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011613 // If the inserted element was extracted from some other vector, and if the
11614 // indexes are constant, try to turn this into a shufflevector operation.
11615 if (ExtractElementInst *EI = dyn_cast<ExtractElementInst>(ScalarOp)) {
11616 if (isa<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1)) && isa<ConstantInt>(IdxOp) &&
11617 EI->getOperand(0)->getType() == IE.getType()) {
11618 unsigned NumVectorElts = IE.getType()->getNumElements();
Chris Lattnere34e9a22007-04-14 23:32:02 +000011619 unsigned ExtractedIdx =
11620 cast<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1))->getZExtValue();
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011621 unsigned InsertedIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(IdxOp)->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011622
11623 if (ExtractedIdx >= NumVectorElts) // Out of range extract.
11624 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, VecOp);
11625
11626 if (InsertedIdx >= NumVectorElts) // Out of range insert.
11627 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, UndefValue::get(IE.getType()));
11628
11629 // If we are extracting a value from a vector, then inserting it right
11630 // back into the same place, just use the input vector.
11631 if (EI->getOperand(0) == VecOp && ExtractedIdx == InsertedIdx)
11632 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, VecOp);
11633
11634 // We could theoretically do this for ANY input. However, doing so could
11635 // turn chains of insertelement instructions into a chain of shufflevector
11636 // instructions, and right now we do not merge shufflevectors. As such,
11637 // only do this in a situation where it is clear that there is benefit.
11638 if (isa<UndefValue>(VecOp) || isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(VecOp)) {
11639 // Turn this into shuffle(EIOp0, VecOp, Mask). The result has all of
11640 // the values of VecOp, except then one read from EIOp0.
11641 // Build a new shuffle mask.
11642 std::vector<Constant*> Mask;
11643 if (isa<UndefValue>(VecOp))
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011644 Mask.assign(NumVectorElts, UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011645 else {
11646 assert(isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(VecOp) && "Unknown thing");
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011647 Mask.assign(NumVectorElts, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty,
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011648 NumVectorElts));
11649 }
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011650 Mask[InsertedIdx] = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, ExtractedIdx);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011651 return new ShuffleVectorInst(EI->getOperand(0), VecOp,
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011652 ConstantVector::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011653 }
11654
11655 // If this insertelement isn't used by some other insertelement, turn it
11656 // (and any insertelements it points to), into one big shuffle.
11657 if (!IE.hasOneUse() || !isa<InsertElementInst>(IE.use_back())) {
11658 std::vector<Constant*> Mask;
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011659 Value *RHS = 0;
11660 Value *LHS = CollectShuffleElements(&IE, Mask, RHS);
11661 if (RHS == 0) RHS = UndefValue::get(LHS->getType());
11662 // We now have a shuffle of LHS, RHS, Mask.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011663 return new ShuffleVectorInst(LHS, RHS, ConstantVector::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011664 }
11665 }
11666 }
11667
11668 return 0;
11669}
11670
11671
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011672Instruction *InstCombiner::visitShuffleVectorInst(ShuffleVectorInst &SVI) {
11673 Value *LHS = SVI.getOperand(0);
11674 Value *RHS = SVI.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011675 std::vector<unsigned> Mask = getShuffleMask(&SVI);
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011676
11677 bool MadeChange = false;
11678
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +000011679 // Undefined shuffle mask -> undefined value.
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011680 if (isa<UndefValue>(SVI.getOperand(2)))
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011681 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, UndefValue::get(SVI.getType()));
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +000011682
11683 uint64_t UndefElts;
11684 unsigned VWidth = cast<VectorType>(SVI.getType())->getNumElements();
11685 uint64_t AllOnesEltMask = ~0ULL >> (64-VWidth);
11686 if (VWidth <= 64 &&
Dan Gohman3139ff82008-09-11 22:47:57 +000011687 SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(&SVI, AllOnesEltMask, UndefElts)) {
11688 LHS = SVI.getOperand(0);
11689 RHS = SVI.getOperand(1);
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +000011690 MadeChange = true;
Dan Gohman3139ff82008-09-11 22:47:57 +000011691 }
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011692
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011693 // Canonicalize shuffle(x ,x,mask) -> shuffle(x, undef,mask')
11694 // Canonicalize shuffle(undef,x,mask) -> shuffle(x, undef,mask').
11695 if (LHS == RHS || isa<UndefValue>(LHS)) {
11696 if (isa<UndefValue>(LHS) && LHS == RHS) {
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011697 // shuffle(undef,undef,mask) -> undef.
11698 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, LHS);
11699 }
11700
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011701 // Remap any references to RHS to use LHS.
11702 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
11703 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011704 if (Mask[i] >= 2*e)
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011705 Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011706 else {
11707 if ((Mask[i] >= e && isa<UndefValue>(RHS)) ||
Dan Gohman4ce96272008-08-06 18:17:32 +000011708 (Mask[i] < e && isa<UndefValue>(LHS))) {
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011709 Mask[i] = 2*e; // Turn into undef.
Dan Gohman4ce96272008-08-06 18:17:32 +000011710 Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
11711 } else {
Mon P Wang4f5ca2c2008-08-20 02:23:25 +000011712 Mask[i] = Mask[i] % e; // Force to LHS.
Dan Gohman4ce96272008-08-06 18:17:32 +000011713 Elts.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Mask[i]));
11714 }
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011715 }
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011716 }
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011717 SVI.setOperand(0, SVI.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011718 SVI.setOperand(1, UndefValue::get(RHS->getType()));
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011719 SVI.setOperand(2, ConstantVector::get(Elts));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011720 LHS = SVI.getOperand(0);
11721 RHS = SVI.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011722 MadeChange = true;
11723 }
11724
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011725 // Analyze the shuffle, are the LHS or RHS and identity shuffles?
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011726 bool isLHSID = true, isRHSID = true;
Chris Lattner706126d2006-04-16 00:03:56 +000011727
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011728 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
11729 if (Mask[i] >= e*2) continue; // Ignore undef values.
11730 // Is this an identity shuffle of the LHS value?
11731 isLHSID &= (Mask[i] == i);
11732
11733 // Is this an identity shuffle of the RHS value?
11734 isRHSID &= (Mask[i]-e == i);
Chris Lattner706126d2006-04-16 00:03:56 +000011735 }
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011736
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011737 // Eliminate identity shuffles.
11738 if (isLHSID) return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, LHS);
11739 if (isRHSID) return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, RHS);
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011740
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011741 // If the LHS is a shufflevector itself, see if we can combine it with this
11742 // one without producing an unusual shuffle. Here we are really conservative:
11743 // we are absolutely afraid of producing a shuffle mask not in the input
11744 // program, because the code gen may not be smart enough to turn a merged
11745 // shuffle into two specific shuffles: it may produce worse code. As such,
11746 // we only merge two shuffles if the result is one of the two input shuffle
11747 // masks. In this case, merging the shuffles just removes one instruction,
11748 // which we know is safe. This is good for things like turning:
11749 // (splat(splat)) -> splat.
11750 if (ShuffleVectorInst *LHSSVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(LHS)) {
11751 if (isa<UndefValue>(RHS)) {
11752 std::vector<unsigned> LHSMask = getShuffleMask(LHSSVI);
11753
11754 std::vector<unsigned> NewMask;
11755 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i)
11756 if (Mask[i] >= 2*e)
11757 NewMask.push_back(2*e);
11758 else
11759 NewMask.push_back(LHSMask[Mask[i]]);
11760
11761 // If the result mask is equal to the src shuffle or this shuffle mask, do
11762 // the replacement.
11763 if (NewMask == LHSMask || NewMask == Mask) {
11764 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
11765 for (unsigned i = 0, e = NewMask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
11766 if (NewMask[i] >= e*2) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011767 Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011768 } else {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011769 Elts.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, NewMask[i]));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011770 }
11771 }
11772 return new ShuffleVectorInst(LHSSVI->getOperand(0),
11773 LHSSVI->getOperand(1),
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011774 ConstantVector::get(Elts));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011775 }
11776 }
11777 }
Chris Lattnerc5eff442007-01-30 22:32:46 +000011778
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011779 return MadeChange ? &SVI : 0;
11780}
11781
11782
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000011783
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000011784
11785/// TryToSinkInstruction - Try to move the specified instruction from its
11786/// current block into the beginning of DestBlock, which can only happen if it's
11787/// safe to move the instruction past all of the instructions between it and the
11788/// end of its block.
11789static bool TryToSinkInstruction(Instruction *I, BasicBlock *DestBlock) {
11790 assert(I->hasOneUse() && "Invariants didn't hold!");
11791
Chris Lattner108e9022005-10-27 17:13:11 +000011792 // Cannot move control-flow-involving, volatile loads, vaarg, etc.
Chris Lattnerbfc538c2008-05-09 15:07:33 +000011793 if (isa<PHINode>(I) || I->mayWriteToMemory() || isa<TerminatorInst>(I))
11794 return false;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000011795
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000011796 // Do not sink alloca instructions out of the entry block.
Dan Gohmanecb7a772007-03-22 16:38:57 +000011797 if (isa<AllocaInst>(I) && I->getParent() ==
11798 &DestBlock->getParent()->getEntryBlock())
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000011799 return false;
11800
Chris Lattner96a52a62004-12-09 07:14:34 +000011801 // We can only sink load instructions if there is nothing between the load and
11802 // the end of block that could change the value.
Chris Lattner2539e332008-05-08 17:37:37 +000011803 if (I->mayReadFromMemory()) {
11804 for (BasicBlock::iterator Scan = I, E = I->getParent()->end();
Chris Lattner96a52a62004-12-09 07:14:34 +000011805 Scan != E; ++Scan)
11806 if (Scan->mayWriteToMemory())
11807 return false;
Chris Lattner96a52a62004-12-09 07:14:34 +000011808 }
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000011809
Dan Gohman02dea8b2008-05-23 21:05:58 +000011810 BasicBlock::iterator InsertPos = DestBlock->getFirstNonPHI();
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000011811
Chris Lattner4bc5f802005-08-08 19:11:57 +000011812 I->moveBefore(InsertPos);
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000011813 ++NumSunkInst;
11814 return true;
11815}
11816
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000011817
11818/// AddReachableCodeToWorklist - Walk the function in depth-first order, adding
11819/// all reachable code to the worklist.
11820///
11821/// This has a couple of tricks to make the code faster and more powerful. In
11822/// particular, we constant fold and DCE instructions as we go, to avoid adding
11823/// them to the worklist (this significantly speeds up instcombine on code where
11824/// many instructions are dead or constant). Additionally, if we find a branch
11825/// whose condition is a known constant, we only visit the reachable successors.
11826///
11827static void AddReachableCodeToWorklist(BasicBlock *BB,
Chris Lattner1f87a582007-02-15 19:41:52 +000011828 SmallPtrSet<BasicBlock*, 64> &Visited,
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011829 InstCombiner &IC,
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000011830 const TargetData *TD) {
Chris Lattner2806dff2008-08-15 04:03:01 +000011831 SmallVector<BasicBlock*, 256> Worklist;
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000011832 Worklist.push_back(BB);
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000011833
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000011834 while (!Worklist.empty()) {
11835 BB = Worklist.back();
11836 Worklist.pop_back();
11837
11838 // We have now visited this block! If we've already been here, ignore it.
11839 if (!Visited.insert(BB)) continue;
11840
11841 for (BasicBlock::iterator BBI = BB->begin(), E = BB->end(); BBI != E; ) {
11842 Instruction *Inst = BBI++;
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000011843
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000011844 // DCE instruction if trivially dead.
11845 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(Inst)) {
11846 ++NumDeadInst;
11847 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *Inst;
11848 Inst->eraseFromParent();
11849 continue;
11850 }
11851
11852 // ConstantProp instruction if trivially constant.
11853 if (Constant *C = ConstantFoldInstruction(Inst, TD)) {
11854 DOUT << "IC: ConstFold to: " << *C << " from: " << *Inst;
11855 Inst->replaceAllUsesWith(C);
11856 ++NumConstProp;
11857 Inst->eraseFromParent();
11858 continue;
11859 }
Chris Lattner3ccc6bc2007-07-20 22:06:41 +000011860
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000011861 IC.AddToWorkList(Inst);
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000011862 }
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000011863
11864 // Recursively visit successors. If this is a branch or switch on a
11865 // constant, only visit the reachable successor.
11866 TerminatorInst *TI = BB->getTerminator();
11867 if (BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(TI)) {
11868 if (BI->isConditional() && isa<ConstantInt>(BI->getCondition())) {
11869 bool CondVal = cast<ConstantInt>(BI->getCondition())->getZExtValue();
Nick Lewycky91436992008-03-09 08:50:23 +000011870 BasicBlock *ReachableBB = BI->getSuccessor(!CondVal);
Nick Lewycky280a6e62008-04-25 16:53:59 +000011871 Worklist.push_back(ReachableBB);
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000011872 continue;
11873 }
11874 } else if (SwitchInst *SI = dyn_cast<SwitchInst>(TI)) {
11875 if (ConstantInt *Cond = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getCondition())) {
11876 // See if this is an explicit destination.
11877 for (unsigned i = 1, e = SI->getNumSuccessors(); i != e; ++i)
11878 if (SI->getCaseValue(i) == Cond) {
Nick Lewycky91436992008-03-09 08:50:23 +000011879 BasicBlock *ReachableBB = SI->getSuccessor(i);
Nick Lewycky280a6e62008-04-25 16:53:59 +000011880 Worklist.push_back(ReachableBB);
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000011881 continue;
11882 }
11883
11884 // Otherwise it is the default destination.
11885 Worklist.push_back(SI->getSuccessor(0));
11886 continue;
11887 }
11888 }
11889
11890 for (unsigned i = 0, e = TI->getNumSuccessors(); i != e; ++i)
11891 Worklist.push_back(TI->getSuccessor(i));
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000011892 }
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000011893}
11894
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000011895bool InstCombiner::DoOneIteration(Function &F, unsigned Iteration) {
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000011896 bool Changed = false;
Chris Lattnerbc61e662003-11-02 05:57:39 +000011897 TD = &getAnalysis<TargetData>();
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000011898
11899 DEBUG(DOUT << "\n\nINSTCOMBINE ITERATION #" << Iteration << " on "
11900 << F.getNameStr() << "\n");
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000011901
Chris Lattnerb3d59702005-07-07 20:40:38 +000011902 {
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000011903 // Do a depth-first traversal of the function, populate the worklist with
11904 // the reachable instructions. Ignore blocks that are not reachable. Keep
11905 // track of which blocks we visit.
Chris Lattner1f87a582007-02-15 19:41:52 +000011906 SmallPtrSet<BasicBlock*, 64> Visited;
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011907 AddReachableCodeToWorklist(F.begin(), Visited, *this, TD);
Jeff Cohen00b168892005-07-27 06:12:32 +000011908
Chris Lattnerb3d59702005-07-07 20:40:38 +000011909 // Do a quick scan over the function. If we find any blocks that are
11910 // unreachable, remove any instructions inside of them. This prevents
11911 // the instcombine code from having to deal with some bad special cases.
11912 for (Function::iterator BB = F.begin(), E = F.end(); BB != E; ++BB)
11913 if (!Visited.count(BB)) {
11914 Instruction *Term = BB->getTerminator();
11915 while (Term != BB->begin()) { // Remove instrs bottom-up
11916 BasicBlock::iterator I = Term; --I;
Chris Lattner6ffe5512004-04-27 15:13:33 +000011917
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +000011918 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *I;
Chris Lattnerb3d59702005-07-07 20:40:38 +000011919 ++NumDeadInst;
11920
11921 if (!I->use_empty())
11922 I->replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(I->getType()));
11923 I->eraseFromParent();
11924 }
11925 }
11926 }
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000011927
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011928 while (!Worklist.empty()) {
11929 Instruction *I = RemoveOneFromWorkList();
11930 if (I == 0) continue; // skip null values.
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000011931
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000011932 // Check to see if we can DCE the instruction.
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000011933 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(I)) {
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000011934 // Add operands to the worklist.
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000011935 if (I->getNumOperands() < 4)
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +000011936 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000011937 ++NumDeadInst;
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000011938
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +000011939 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *I;
Chris Lattnerad5fec12005-01-28 19:32:01 +000011940
11941 I->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011942 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000011943 continue;
11944 }
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000011945
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000011946 // Instruction isn't dead, see if we can constant propagate it.
Chris Lattner0a19ffa2007-01-30 23:16:15 +000011947 if (Constant *C = ConstantFoldInstruction(I, TD)) {
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +000011948 DOUT << "IC: ConstFold to: " << *C << " from: " << *I;
Chris Lattnerad5fec12005-01-28 19:32:01 +000011949
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000011950 // Add operands to the worklist.
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +000011951 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattnerc736d562002-12-05 22:41:53 +000011952 ReplaceInstUsesWith(*I, C);
11953
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000011954 ++NumConstProp;
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000011955 I->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011956 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000011957 continue;
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000011958 }
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000011959
Nick Lewycky3dfd7bf2008-05-25 20:56:15 +000011960 if (TD && I->getType()->getTypeID() == Type::VoidTyID) {
11961 // See if we can constant fold its operands.
11962 for (User::op_iterator i = I->op_begin(), e = I->op_end(); i != e; ++i) {
11963 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(i)) {
11964 if (Constant *NewC = ConstantFoldConstantExpression(CE, TD))
11965 i->set(NewC);
11966 }
11967 }
11968 }
11969
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000011970 // See if we can trivially sink this instruction to a successor basic block.
Dan Gohmanfc74abf2008-07-23 00:34:11 +000011971 if (I->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000011972 BasicBlock *BB = I->getParent();
11973 BasicBlock *UserParent = cast<Instruction>(I->use_back())->getParent();
11974 if (UserParent != BB) {
11975 bool UserIsSuccessor = false;
11976 // See if the user is one of our successors.
11977 for (succ_iterator SI = succ_begin(BB), E = succ_end(BB); SI != E; ++SI)
11978 if (*SI == UserParent) {
11979 UserIsSuccessor = true;
11980 break;
11981 }
11982
11983 // If the user is one of our immediate successors, and if that successor
11984 // only has us as a predecessors (we'd have to split the critical edge
11985 // otherwise), we can keep going.
11986 if (UserIsSuccessor && !isa<PHINode>(I->use_back()) &&
11987 next(pred_begin(UserParent)) == pred_end(UserParent))
11988 // Okay, the CFG is simple enough, try to sink this instruction.
11989 Changed |= TryToSinkInstruction(I, UserParent);
11990 }
11991 }
11992
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000011993 // Now that we have an instruction, try combining it to simplify it...
Reid Spencera9b81012007-03-26 17:44:01 +000011994#ifndef NDEBUG
11995 std::string OrigI;
11996#endif
11997 DEBUG(std::ostringstream SS; I->print(SS); OrigI = SS.str(););
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000011998 if (Instruction *Result = visit(*I)) {
Chris Lattner3dec1f22002-05-10 15:38:35 +000011999 ++NumCombined;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000012000 // Should we replace the old instruction with a new one?
Chris Lattnerb3bc8fa2002-05-14 15:24:07 +000012001 if (Result != I) {
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +000012002 DOUT << "IC: Old = " << *I
12003 << " New = " << *Result;
Chris Lattner0cea42a2004-03-13 23:54:27 +000012004
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +000012005 // Everything uses the new instruction now.
12006 I->replaceAllUsesWith(Result);
12007
12008 // Push the new instruction and any users onto the worklist.
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000012009 AddToWorkList(Result);
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +000012010 AddUsersToWorkList(*Result);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000012011
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +000012012 // Move the name to the new instruction first.
12013 Result->takeName(I);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000012014
12015 // Insert the new instruction into the basic block...
12016 BasicBlock *InstParent = I->getParent();
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000012017 BasicBlock::iterator InsertPos = I;
12018
12019 if (!isa<PHINode>(Result)) // If combining a PHI, don't insert
12020 while (isa<PHINode>(InsertPos)) // middle of a block of PHIs.
12021 ++InsertPos;
12022
12023 InstParent->getInstList().insert(InsertPos, Result);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000012024
Chris Lattner00d51312004-05-01 23:27:23 +000012025 // Make sure that we reprocess all operands now that we reduced their
12026 // use counts.
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000012027 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattner216d4d82004-05-01 23:19:52 +000012028
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +000012029 // Instructions can end up on the worklist more than once. Make sure
12030 // we do not process an instruction that has been deleted.
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000012031 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000012032
12033 // Erase the old instruction.
12034 InstParent->getInstList().erase(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +000012035 } else {
Evan Chengc7baf682007-03-27 16:44:48 +000012036#ifndef NDEBUG
Reid Spencera9b81012007-03-26 17:44:01 +000012037 DOUT << "IC: Mod = " << OrigI
12038 << " New = " << *I;
Evan Chengc7baf682007-03-27 16:44:48 +000012039#endif
Chris Lattner0cea42a2004-03-13 23:54:27 +000012040
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000012041 // If the instruction was modified, it's possible that it is now dead.
12042 // if so, remove it.
Chris Lattner00d51312004-05-01 23:27:23 +000012043 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(I)) {
12044 // Make sure we process all operands now that we are reducing their
12045 // use counts.
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000012046 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000012047
Chris Lattner00d51312004-05-01 23:27:23 +000012048 // Instructions may end up in the worklist more than once. Erase all
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000012049 // occurrences of this instruction.
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000012050 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000012051 I->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +000012052 } else {
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000012053 AddToWorkList(I);
12054 AddUsersToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000012055 }
Chris Lattnerb3bc8fa2002-05-14 15:24:07 +000012056 }
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000012057 Changed = true;
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000012058 }
12059 }
12060
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000012061 assert(WorklistMap.empty() && "Worklist empty, but map not?");
Chris Lattnera9ff5eb2007-08-05 08:47:58 +000012062
12063 // Do an explicit clear, this shrinks the map if needed.
12064 WorklistMap.clear();
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000012065 return Changed;
Chris Lattnerbd0ef772002-02-26 21:46:54 +000012066}
12067
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000012068
12069bool InstCombiner::runOnFunction(Function &F) {
Chris Lattnerf964f322007-03-04 04:27:24 +000012070 MustPreserveLCSSA = mustPreserveAnalysisID(LCSSAID);
12071
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000012072 bool EverMadeChange = false;
12073
12074 // Iterate while there is work to do.
12075 unsigned Iteration = 0;
Bill Wendlinga6c31122008-05-14 22:45:20 +000012076 while (DoOneIteration(F, Iteration++))
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000012077 EverMadeChange = true;
12078 return EverMadeChange;
12079}
12080
Brian Gaeke96d4bf72004-07-27 17:43:21 +000012081FunctionPass *llvm::createInstructionCombiningPass() {
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000012082 return new InstCombiner();
Chris Lattnerbd0ef772002-02-26 21:46:54 +000012083}
Brian Gaeked0fde302003-11-11 22:41:34 +000012084
Chris Lattnerb8cd4d32008-08-11 22:06:05 +000012085